Steelwork Corrosion Control
Steelwork Corrosion Controlby
DABayliss and KAChandlerSenior Consultants ITI Anti-Corrosion Ltd Leighton Buzzard Bedfordshire
UK
ELSEVIER APPLIED SCIENCE
London and New York
ELSEVIER SCIENCE PUBLISHERS LTDCrown House Linton Road Barking Essex IG11 8JU England
This edition published in the Taylor amp Francis e-Library 2005
Sole Distributor in the USA and CanadaELSEVIER SCIENCE PUBLISHING CO INC
655 Avenue of the Americas New York NY 10010 USA
WITH 17 TABLES AND 95 ILLUSTRATIONS
uuml 1991 ELSEVIER SCIENCE PUBLISHERS LTD
British Library Cataloguing in Publication DataBayliss Derek A
Steelwork corrosion control1 Steel structures Corrosion Protection
I Title II Chandler Kenneth A6201723
ISBN 0-203-49819-4 Master e-book ISBN
ISBN 0-203-55503-1 (Adobe eReader Format)ISBN 1-85166-575-7 (Print Edition)
Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication DataBayliss Derek A
Steelwork corrosion controlby DABayliss and KAChandlerp cm
Rev ed of Corrosion protection of steel structuresKAChandler and DABayliss 1985
Includes bibliographical references and indexISBN 1-85166-575-7
1 Steel StructuralmdashCorrosion 2 Corrosion and anti-corrosives I Chandler Kenneth A II Chandler Kenneth A
Corrosion protection of steel structures III TitleTA467B38 1991
6201723ndashdc20 90ndash22270CIP
No responsibility is assumed by the Publisher for any injury andor damage to persons orproperty as a matter of products liability negligence or otherwise or from any use or operation
of any methods products instructions or ideas contained in the material herein
Special regulations for readers in the USA
This publication has been registered with the Copyright Clearance Center Inc (CCC) SalemMassachusetts Information can be obtained from the CCC about conditions under which
photocopies of parts of this publication may be made in the USA All other copyrightquestions including photocopying outside the USA should be referred to the publisher
All rights reserved No part of this publication may be reproduced stored in a retrieval systemor transmitted in any form or by any means electronic mechanical photocopying recording
or otherwise without the prior written permission of the publisher
ldquoTo purchase your own copy of this or any of Taylor amp Francis or Routledgersquos collection ofthousands of eBooks please go to wwweBookstoretandfcoukrdquo
Preface
This book is a comprehensive revision and updating of a similar book by the authors published in 1985 As with the previousbook it is designed principally for engineers architects and designers for whom the protection of structural steelwork is animportant albeit a comparatively minor part of their total professional activities
New materials are being developed constantly by the coatings industry and the number of standards codes of practice andpublications on corrosion protection has grown to a stage where it has become increasingly difficult for non-specialists tokeep abreast of the situation
The aim of the book is to set out the basic and old-established requirements and at the same time draw attention to recentdevelopments such as long-life coatings new International Standards on surface preparation new methods and standards ofquality control and the increased awareness of health and safety factors
The book is not intended to be a comprehensive textbook on coating technology but rather a guide to the principlesinvolved and methods of achieving sound steel protection Unless otherwise stated the views expressed are those of theauthors based on many yearsrsquo practical experience
For permission to reproduce illustrative material our thanks are due to the following organisations
Cookson Laminox Ltd
Elcometer Instruments Ltd
Elektro-Physik GB Ltd
Expertus Kemiteknik AB
Graco UK Ltd
Hodge Clemco Ltd
ITI Anti-Corrosion Ltd
ITI Anti-Corrosion Inc
NNC Technology NNC Ltd
The DeVilbiss Company Ltd
Tilghman Wheelabrator Ltd
Winn amp Coales (Denso) Ltd
We also take this opportunity of acknowledging the work of our colleagues in this field They are too numerous to mentionbut many of the views expressed in this book have arisen from discussions with them and the study of their contributions tojournals and conferences over the years
DEREK ABAYLISSKENNETH ACHANDLER
Contents
Preface iv
Chapter 1 Introduction 1
Chapter 2 The Corrosion of Steel 3
21 Corrosion The basic process 3
22 The electrochemical nature of corrosion 4
23 Corrosion terminology 5
231 Potential 5
232 Polarisation 6
233 Passivity 6
24 Corrosion in air 6
241 Steel composition 8
242 Rust 8
25 Corrosion in water 8
251 Composition of water 9
252 Operating conditions 9
253 Steel composition 9
254 Corrosion rates of steel in water 9
26 Corrosion in soil 10
27 Bacterial corrosion 10
References 11
Further reading 11
Chapter 3 Surface Preparation 12
31 Steel surface contaminants and conditions 12
311 Oil and grease 13
312 Millscale 13
313 Surface cleanliness 15
314 Roughness 17
315 Surface defects and welds 17
32 Surface preparation methods 18
321 Degreasing 18
322 Hand and power tool cleaning 19
323 Abrasive blast-cleaning 20
324 Innovative methods 30
325 Flame cleaning 31
326 Pickling 32
References 33
Chapter 4 Paints and Paint Coatings 35
41 General requirements 35
42 The nature of paint 36
421 Paint systems 37
43 Protection by paint films 37
431 Zinc-rich pigments 38
432 Inhibitive pigments 38
433 Barrier coatings 39
44 Properties of paint films 40
441 Adhesion 40
442 Flexibility 41
443 Hardness 41
444 Abrasion resistance 41
445 Permeability 42
446 Resistance to microorganisms 42
447 Ageing of paint films 42
45 Paint film formation 43
46 Binders 43
461 Oxidation type 43
462 Solvent evaporation type 44
463 Chemically reacting type 45
47 Pigments 47
471 Inhibitive pigments 47
472 Other pigments 48
473 Extenders 49
48 Solvents 49
49 Paint classification 49
491 Oil-based and oleo-resinous paints (oxidation drying) 49
492 Solvent evaporation paints 52
493 Chemical reaction paints 54
494 Zinc-rich coatings 57
495 Compatibility of different paints 58
vi
496 Heat-resistant coatings 58
497 Other coating materials and fillers 60
References 60
Further reading 61
Chapter 5 Paint Application 62
51 Methods of application 62
511 Brush application 62
512 Roller application 63
513 Airspray application 64
514 Airless spraying 65
515 Heated spray units 66
516 Application of two-component paints by spray 67
517 Electrostatic spray 68
518 Other application methods 69
519 Comparison of application methods 69
52 Application conditions 70
521 Pre- or post-fabrication 70
522 The painting shop 71
523 Ambient conditions 71
524 Storage of paint 73
525 Preparation of paint before use 73
53 The painter 73
54 Paint manufacturersrsquo data sheets 74
References 75
Chapter 6 Specialist Coatings and Applications 76
61 Coating or lining of tanks 76
611 Corrosion protection 76
612 Lining materials 77
613 Application of linings 79
62 Powder coatings 80
621 Application methods 81
63 Coil coatings 82
64 Wrapping tapes 84
65 Fire protection 85
66 Pipelines 85
661 Submarine pipelines 86
662 Buried pipelines 88
vii
References 89
Chapter 7 Metal Coatings 91
71 Application methods 91
711 Hot-dipping 91
712 Sprayed coatings 95
713 Coatings produced by diffusion 96
714 Electrodeposited coatings 97
715 Other application methods 97
72 Corrosion protection by metal coatings 98
73 Additional protection to metal coatings 99
74 Corrosion data for metal coatings 100
741 Corrosion data for zinc coatings 101
742 Corrosion data for aluminium coatings 102
743 Corrosion data for cadmium coatings 102
75 The selection of metal coatings 102
76 Choice of metal coating and application method 104
77 Treatment of welded areas 104
78 Wet storage stain 104
79 Fasteners 105
710 British Standards for metal coatings for constructional steelwork 105
References 105
Chapter 8 Specifications 106
81 Standards and specifications 106
82 The purpose and drafting of a specification 107
83 Types of specification 108
84 Preparation of a coating specification 108
85 Specification requirements 109
851 Scope 110
852 Surface preparation 110
853 Coating system 112
854 Control of paints and other coating materials 113
855 Coating application 113
856 Treatments of special areas 114
857 Handling transport and storage 115
858 Remedial work 117
859 Inspection and quality control 117
8510 Safety 118
viii
8511 Other aspects of specifications 118
References 118
Chapter 9 Quality Control of Coating Operations 119
91 Introduction 119
92 Inspection requirements 120
93 The approach to quality control 120
94 Requirements for an inspector 122
941 Training and certification of inspectors 122
95 Methods of inspection of paint coatings 123
951 Surface preparation 124
952 Testing of liquid paints 134
953 Coating application 134
96 Inspection of metal coatings 142
961 Hot-dip galvanising 142
962 Sprayed metal coatings 143
97 Inspection instruments 143
98 Reports and records 144
References 146
Chapter 10 Designing for Corrosion Control 148
101 Environmental conditions 148
102 Materials 148
103 Bimetallic corrosion 149
104 Access for inspection and maintenance 150
105 Crevices 151
106 Ground-level corrosion 152
107 Entrapment of moisture and condensation 153
108 Geometry and shape 154
109 Tanks 156
1010 Fabrication and construction 156
1011 Corrosion of steel in contact with other materials 157
Further reading 157
Chapter 11 Maintenance Painting 158
111 Introduction 158
112 The general approach to maintenance painting 159
113 Planning maintenance 160
114 Inspections and surveys for maintenance 161
1141 Survey procedures 161
ix
1142 Feasibility trials 166
115 Maintenance procedures 166
1151 Surface preparation prior to re-painting 167
1152 Painting 168
116 Environmental conditions during repainting 168
Reference 169
Chapter 12 Control Methods other than Coatings 170
121 Cathodic protection 170
1211 Basic principles 170
1212 The application of cathodic protection 171
1213 Sacrificial anode method 171
1214 Impressed current method 171
1215 Choice of method for cathodic protection 171
1216 Practical applications of cathodic protection 172
122 Conditioning of the environment 173
1221 Treatment of the air 174
1222 Treatment of aqueous solutions 174
123 Alloy steels 175
1231 Stainless steels 175
1232 Low-alloy weathering steels 175
References 177
Further reading 177
Chapter 13 Coating Defects and Failures 179
131 Introduction 179
132 Surface preparation 179
133 Coating materials 180
134 Coating application 181
135 Transport and storage 181
136 Types of coating defects 181
1361 Adhesion loss (flaking peeling etc) 182
1362 Bacterial or fungal attack 182
1363 Bleeding 182
1364 Blistering 182
1365 Blooming or blushing 183
1366 Chalking 183
1367 Cissing crawling and fisheyeing 184
1368 Cobwebbing 184
x
1369 Cracking 184
13610 Complete or partial failure to cure of two-part materials 185
13611 Dry spray 185
13612 Fading 185
13613 Lifting or pulling up 185
13614 Orange peel 186
13615 Pinholes and holidays 186
13616 Pinpoint rusting 186
13617 Runs and sags 186
13618 Saponification 186
13619 Skin curing 186
13620 Spot-blast boundary breakdown 187
13621 Thickness faults 187
13622 Uneven gloss 187
13623 Undercutting 187
13624 Wrinkling 187
Reference 188
Chapter 14 The Selection of Coating Systems 189
141 Introduction 189
142 Factors influencing the selection of coating systems 190
143 Selection of coatings for specific environments 191
144 Classification of coatings 193
1441 Paints 193
1442 Metal coatings 196
1443 High-duty coatings 197
145 Costs of protective systems 197
1451 Calculating the costs of alternative protective systems 198
1452 Initial costs of protective systems 199
1453 Final choice of coating system 200
Further reading 200
Chapter 15 Protective Systems for Different Situations 201
151 General steelwork exposed to the atmosphere 201
1511 Bridges 202
1512 Buildings 202
1513 Storage tanks (exterior) 203
152 Offshore structures 203
1521 Atmospheric zone 204
xi
1522 Immersed zone 204
1523 Splash zone 204
153 Ships 205
1531 Surface preparation 205
1532 Areas to be protected 205
1533 Underwater plating 205
1534 Anti-fouling paints 206
1535 Boot topping 206
1536 Topsides and superstructures 206
1537 Steel decks 206
1538 Machinery pipes etc 207
1539 Cargo and ballast tanks 207
15310 Freshwater tanks 207
154 Chemical plants 207
155 Oil refineries and installations 208
156 Sewage systems 208
157 Sheet piling 209
158 Jetties and harbours 209
159 Steel in reinforced concrete 210
1591 Concrete 210
1592 The corrosion of rebar in concrete 211
1593 Types of failure with reinforced concrete 212
1594 Corrosion control methods 213
References 214
Chapter 16 Testing of Coatings 215
161 Introduction 215
162 Test requirements 216
163 Laboratory testing of paint films 217
1631 Determination of drying time 218
1632 Adhesion tests 218
1633 Abrasion resistance 219
1634 Physical state of the film 220
1635 Film thickness 221
164 Testing of paints 222
165 Laboratory performance tests 222
1651 Artificial weathering 222
1652 Salt-spray tests 223
xii
1653 Sulphur dioxide tests 224
1654 Humidity and condensation tests 224
1655 Other laboratory tests 224
166 Instruments for specialised analysis 225
167 Field tests 226
1671 Type of specimen to be used for the tests 226
1672 The coating 227
1673 Exposure of specimens 228
1674 Test sites 228
1675 Monitoring of test sites 230
1676 Methods of measuring atmospheric pollution 231
1677 Conduct of field tests 231
168 Service trials 232
169 Tests in water and soil 233
1610 Formulating the test programme 233
1611 Reporting the results of tests 234
References 234
Appendix British Standard 3900 tests with International Standards Organisation equivalents 235
Chapter 17 Safety 237
171 Introduction 237
172 Surface preparation 237
1721 Open-nozzle blast-cleaning 237
1722 High-pressure water jetting 238
1723 Flame cleaning 238
173 Paint application 239
1731 Airless spray 239
1732 Paint materials 239
174 Metal spraying 243
1741 Compressed gases 243
1742 Electric shock 243
1743 Radiant energy 243
1744 Toxic and respiratory hazards 243
References 243
Index 245
xiii
CHAPTER 1Introduction
Many Resident Engineers for major building projects nowadays echo the sentiment that lsquoPainting amounts to 10 of the jobbut provides 90 of the problemsrsquo Yet at the same time there are unquestionably large areas of coated steelworkwithstanding the most adverse conditions for surprisingly long periods A typical example is the coating of offshore platformsin the North Sea Even in less exotic circumstances for example bridge structures inland engineers have successfullyextended repainting cycles by as much as three times compared with practices of only twenty years ago The majority ofcoatings used nowadays have considerably improved properties over the materials used then However this is not the solereason for the success The following factors have become even more important than previously
(i) Coating specifications should say what they mean and mean what they say See Chapter 8(ii) Coating manufacturersrsquo recommendations regarding application and suitability of their products for the relevant
conditions should be followed as closely as possible See Chapter 14(iii) Materials supplied should be of a consistent standard of quality See Chapter 16(iv) Surface preparation should be no more or no less than is required to achieve the specified durability See Chapter 3(v) Because of the variable performance that can be obtained owing to sometimes even minor differences in the preparation
and application process the whole operation ideally should be monitored by a competent and qualified coatinginspector See Chapter 9
It can be shown even to the satisfaction of the accountants that in the majority of cases there are substantial economicbenefits to be gained in the long term by adopting sound coating practice In the short term however the costs are likely to behigher and this must be appreciated by all concerned (see Section 1452)
As things stand today there is little wonder that even relatively young engineers seem to yearn for the days when paintingsteel structures meant little more than a perfunctory wire brushing followed by red lead in oil primer followed by two coatsof gloss paint Indeed only about twenty years ago this was the standard paint system for many major structures such as thestructural steelwork of new power stations in the UK The advantages of such a system were cheapness and foolproofnessDurability was generally only about 4 years for exterior exposure but the process could be repeated without much expense ortrouble However there is little question that in modern times the slow drying toxicity (see Chapter 17) and repeated cost ofmaintenance (see Section 145) would be unacceptable In contrast today there are several office buildings in London wherethe exposed steelwork has been painted with a zinc silicate primer and two-pack urethane top-coats That is a coating systemwith probably the greatest durability and least tolerance during application (see Chapter 4) Also there are structures with verylimited and expensive access that are being painted with three coats of moisture-cured urethane during the course of one dayeven under damp and other adverse conditions (see Section 4935)
In fact this revolution in the paint industry could really be said to have started back in 1938 Dr Pierre Castan ofSwitzerland a chemist working for a firm making dentures invented epoxy resins A Swiss patent for the invention was filedin 1940 and for a curing agent in 1943 However the firm was unable to exploit the discovery sufficiently in the dental fieldand sold the rights to what is now CIBA-Geigy They started to market epoxy resins under the tradename Araldite in 1946Subsequently Shell (USA) also purchased the patent and marketed under the tradenames Epon and Epikote However it wasat least a decade later that such materials began to be accepted for such specialist operations as tank lining
Of course other synthetic resins had also become available including chlorinated rubbers vinyls etc (see Chapter 4) butit is the epoxies and later the urethanes in their infinite variety that have led to some of the complications of today For thefirst time the paint chemist was able to tailor-make resins to meet almost any requirement The result was that in thecompetitive world of the paint industry each paint firm felt the need to produce something different from its competitors oralternatively to match every product Currently most paint manufacturers in the UK have at least 90 product items in theirpublished collection of data sheets and this only represents a fraction of those that they can supply for special purposes Inaddition the data sheets themselves are unlikely to give all the information good or bad about the product that is necessary to
make the correct choice In fact without very close and expert study of the information supplied it is often very difficult to seewhy one should choose one item rather than another Some manufacturers do not even reveal the nature of the binder (seeSection 41) on which their product is made Sometimes this is because it is a modification or mixture of binders It is littlewonder that many engineers and others find the subject confusing
The development of quick-drying high-build coatings has also brought another complication namely the need for highstandards of surface preparation Even for the old-established oleo-resinous systems it has been known for many years thatapplication on to cleaned surfaces such as blast-cleaned (see Section 323) or pickled (see Section 326) gives consistentlygreater durability than with hand cleaning
The production of the first edition of the Swedish Standard photographs of rust and preparation grades in 1946 was a far-sighted work of exceptional quality for its day This standard was soon used or at least paid lip-service by most of theindustrial nations
In 1978 there was the first meeting of the International Standards Organisation Sub-committee ISOTC 35SC12 Theobjective of this committee was to produce standards for the preparation of steel substrates before the application of paintsand related products It expected to produce a standard similar to if not identical to the Swedish Standard However it soonbecame obvious that it was difficult to define accurately the contamination represented by the different photographs in theSwedish Standard and in particular to relate these to the numerical ratings favoured by the American Standards This has notyet been resolved entirely satisfactorily (see Section 9512) but the ISO Standard and the British Standard were eventuallypublished in 1989 only as first of many parts however Eventually there are likely to be standards for surface contaminationon determination of soluble iron corrosion products dust oil and grease chlorides risk of condensation conductivity and pHThere will also be standards for the composition and cleanliness of abrasives (see Section 9517)
All this may well make the specifierrsquos task more effective but certainly not easier One suspects that there will be a realdanger of demanding the lowest limits of contamination in all circumstances and regardless of the actual requirementsClearly there is a need for specifiers who may be practising engineers architects designers and others for whomcorrosion control and steelwork protection are a comparatively minor part of their overall professional responsibility tounderstand the implications of coating technology
Those fully involved in the field such as steel fabricators paint applicators galvanisers and paint manufacturers havemuch expertise and advice to offer Full benefit should be taken of such information and again a background knowledge ofthe subject will be of considerable assistance
The principles of good corrosion control do not change but the development of new techniques and materials is acontinuing process It is hoped that specifiers and others who study the relevant chapters in this book will be in a soundposition to judge the merits of the alternatives that will be offered to them by a range of different suppliers
Steel protection and corrosion control are essential elements in most modern structures and the authors have aimed topresent the basic facts in a concise manner and where relevant to provide references for those who wish to study the matterin more detail
2 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
CHAPTER 2The Corrosion of Steel
Coatings are used to prevent or control corrosion so an appreciation of the basic principles of corrosion is advantageous tothose concerned with coatings technology When coatings break down then the steel will corrode and the nature andanticipated extent of corrosion may well determine the types of coating to be used Furthermore the type and degree of corrosionunder a paint film will influence its protective value to a marked degree and will to a considerable extent affect maintenancedecisions In the case of bare metal coatings their performance will depend entirely upon the amount of corrosion that occursin the specific environment of exposure Again a basic understanding of corrosion principles is necessary in order toappreciate the way in which cathodic protection operates and the situations in which it can be used
The aim here is to provide a general account in relation to the selection and performance of coatings and the operation ofother control processes that may be used for structures and buildings
21CORROSION THE BASIC PROCESS
The corrosion of steel arises from its unstable thermodynamic nature Steel is manufactured from iron which is made in ablast furnace by reducing ores such as haematite (Fe2O3) with carbon in the form of coke This can be illustrated in simplechemical terms as follows
This reaction occurs at a very high temperature but the final products iron and eventually steel are unstable a great deal ofenergy having been supplied in the process Consequently when steel is exposed to moisture and oxygen it tends to revert toits original form Again in simple chemical terms
Rust is a hydrated oxide similar in composition to haematite This explains why steel tends to rust in most situations and theprocess can be considered to be a natural reversion to the original ore from which it was formed It does not however explainwhy steel corrodes more rapidly than most other constructional alloys All of these with the exception sometimes of copperare found in nature in the form of minerals or ores ie they are combined as oxides sulphides etc Energy is expended inproducing them either by heating as with steel or by some other method As the natural mineral is more stable allconstructional metals have a tendency to revert back to their original form However this tendency which can be calculatedfrom the thermodynamics of corrosion processes is concerned with the equilibrium state of a chemical system and the energychanges that occur Although thermodynamics provides information on the tendency of a reaction to occur it provides no dataon the rate of reaction or in chemical terminology the reaction kinetics
It may be known that steel if exposed to moisture and oxygen will rust but in practice the important point is usually howfast it will rust A piece of steel left in a damp garage during the winter months may exhibit some surfaces rust whereas thesame piece of steel left out in the garden may have rusted to a much greater extent Again a piece of galvanised ie zinc-coated steel left in the garden may show some surface deterioration which can easily be rubbed off leaving the zinc barelycorroded These simple examples illustrate the following points
(i) The same alloy will corrode at different rates in different situations(ii) Different metals and alloys corrode at different rates under the same conditions of exposure
The second of these points arises not as might be supposed because for some reason alloys have different intrinsic corrosioncharacteristics in practice some of the most reactive metals actually corrode at a low rate It is because the corrosion reactionwith air (oxygen) often results in the immediate formation of an oxide film on the surface which protects the metal A typical
example is aluminium which forms a thin surface film (A12O3) on exposure to the atmosphere and so tends to insulate thealuminium metal or alloy from the environment In some situations these films are either not formed or are not particularlyeffective in stopping reactions between the environment and the metal An oxide film basically Fe2O3 is formed on steel butin most situations it is not particularly protective so the environment can react with the metal leading to rusting Howeverthe surface film can be improved by adding certain elements to steel in sufficient amounts For example the presence of 12chromium results in the formation of a more protective film Cr2O3 which acts as a very good barrier reducing the corrosionrate by a considerable amount Such a ferrous alloy containing 12Cr is lsquostainless steelrsquo although generally there is a muchhigher percentage of alloying elements in the more corrosion-resistant stainless steels typically 18 chromium 10 nickeland 3 molybdenum
It will be gathered from the above discussion that generally the corrosion rate of a metal or alloy will be determined by theformation of surface films and their ability to protect the metal from the environment This is not a full explanation of thesituation but is sufficient to show the importance of the environment in determining the rate of corrosion Corrosion can bedefined in various ways but an acceptable definition is lsquoa chemical or electrochemical reaction between a metal or alloy andits environmentrsquo The chemical or electrochemical requirement differentiates corrosion from other forms of deterioration ofmetals eg wear and abrasion which involve mechanical effects
It follows that the corrosion characteristics are not an intrinsic property of an alloy as are for example strength or hardnessat ordinary temperatures Although some alloys are considered to be more corrosion resistant than others it should not beassumed that in all circumstances this will be the case In some chemical solutions eg certain concentrations of sulphuricacid a protective surface film is produced on ordinary steel and this reduces corrosion to a level below that sustained bystainless steels
It can be seen that the rate of corrosion depends upon the environment to which the alloy is exposed and this will beconsidered in some detail for ordinary carbon steels (Section 24) The electrochemical nature of corrosion can also beexplained with reference to steel
22THE ELECTROCHEMICAL NATURE OF CORROSION
As discussed above steel produces a rather poor protective film on its surface so that in the presence of moisture and oxygencorrosion occurs This corrosion is electrochemical ie it is basically the same process as that occurring in a simpleelectrolytic cell (see Fig 21) The essential features of such a cell are two electrodes an anode and a cathode joined by anexternal conductor eg copper wire and immersed in an electrolyte An electrolyte is a solution capable of carrying currenteg rain or tap water The processes involved are complex and will not be discussed in any detail However if pieces ofcopper and zinc are joined together and immersed in an electrolyte with an ammeter in the external circuit a current will bedetected The copper becomes the cathode of the cell and the zinc the anode The potentials of the two metals are different andthis provides the driving force for the cell Current similarly flows if steel is joined to zinc again zinc acts as the anode andsteel as the cathode This experiment can be used to illustrate the principle of two important methods of corrosion controlcathodic protection (see Chapter 12) and protection by zinc coatings (Chapter 7) However if copper is substituted for thezinc and connected to steel the copper is the cathode and steel the anode of the cell and so the steel corrodes
Corrosion occurs at the anode of the cell little or no corrosion occurs at the cathode The simple experiments discussedabove illustrate another important phenomenonmdashbimetallic or galvanic corrosion If different metals or alloys are joined in the
Fig 21 A simple electrolytic cell
4 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
presence of an electrolyte one will corrode at an increased rate whereas the other will corrode at a lower rate or will notcorrode at all This arises because of the potential difference set up when different metals are joined If two pieces of steel arejoined in a cell there may be sufficient variations in the surface condition to produce a small potential difference However ifone of the two pieces of steel is oxygenated ie if air is blown around it or the electrolyte is heated locally near one of thepieces of steel a current will flow Summarising variations in either the metal or the environment may well produce theconditions required to set up a cell with corrosion occurring at the anode
In practice there are small variations over the steel surface If a piece of steel is polished and etched then examined under amicroscope the structure will usually be seen to consist of grains (Fig 22) These produce small potential differences on thesurface If an electrolytemdashthis may be rain or dewmdashis present on the steel surface then small cells can be set up withcorrosion occurring at the anodic areas The corrosion reactions can be illustrated using chemical terminology as follows
anodic reaction
This is a simple way of describing the process where iron is removed as charged particles called ions (Fe2+) and electrons (ecopy)carry current to balance the electric charge
Clearly a balancing reaction must occur at the cathode and under ordinary natural exposure conditions this can berepresented as follows
cathodic reaction
In short hydroxyl ions are produced at the cathode These two reactions can be combined in a chemical equation
The ferrous and hydroxyl ions react together to form ferrous hydroxide
This is a simple form of rust which is unstable and is eventually oxidised (ie reacts with oxygen) to form the familiar reddishbrown rust chemically denoted as FeOOH or more commonly Fe2O3H2O This is the form of rust usually produced in airnatural water and soils However under acidic conditions hydrogen is produced at the cathode and the corrosion product maybe Fe3O4 (magnetite)
23CORROSION TERMINOLOGY
Terms frequently used in relation to corrosion are discussed briefly below Full explanations are available in standard textbooks
231Potential
There is a theoretical emf series of metals (not alloys) called lsquostandard equilibrium potentialsrsquo These are important in purelyelectrochemical terms for the understanding of processes but are of little importance so far as practical corrosion problems areconcerned More useful are potentials experimentally measured using a suitable reference electrode and published in tables
Fig 22 Diagrammatic representation of a steel surface showing anodes and cathodes
THE CORROSION OF STEEL 5
such as the lsquoGalvanic Series in Sea Waterrsquo These have some practical value because the extent of differences in potentialbetween different alloys provides an indication of the effect of coupling them (see Section 22)
Potentials are also important in determining the operating effectiveness of cathodic protection systems (see Chapter 12)
232Polarisation
The potential difference between the two electrodes in a cell provides the lsquodriving forcersquo for the current which determines theextent of corrosion at the anode However when the cell is operating ie when current is flowing the emf of the cell isdifferent from that theoretically predicted by taking the difference in potentials of the two metallic electrodes Polarisationoccurs at both the anode and the cathode
Polarisation sometimes termed overpotential or overvoltage can be defined as the difference of the potential of anelectrode from its equilibrium or steady-state potential This can be considered in terms of the energy required to cause areaction to proceed An analogy would be the initial energy required to push a car on a level path Once the car is moving lessenergy is required but if a slope is reached the energy required on the level is not sufficient to push it up the slope so it tendsto slow down and eventually stops
Once the cell is operating changes occur in the cell ions tend to collect near the anode and reactants tend to surround thecathode The net result is reduction in the potential difference between the electrodes
233Passivity
Under certain conditions a corrosion product forms on the surface of a metal providing a barrier to the environment ie itacts in a similar way to a coating To achieve passivity the corrosion product must adhere to the surface and be stable bothchemically and physically so that it does not disintegrate Such products are sometimes produced near anodic sites and so tendto passivate these areas Iron becomes passive when immersed in concentrated nitric acid because a thin film of ferric oxide isformed which provided it is not disrupted isolates the iron from the corrosive environment
A good example of a passive film is that produced on stainless steels where because of the chromium content of the alloy(over 12) a very resistant film basically Cr2O3 is formed This not only stops stainless steels from corroding to any extentin air but also has the capability of rapidly reforming if it is damaged It is interesting to note that the corrosion performanceof stainless steel is determined by its ability to maintain a passive surface film and if it is broken down and not repaired thepotential of the alloy changes dramatically and is moved towards the anodic end of the galvanic series
24CORROSION IN AIR
Clearly there is a plentiful supply of oxygen in air so the presence or otherwise of moisture determines whether corrosionwill occur Steel is often visibly moist after rain or when there has been fog or dew However the water vapour in the air canalso cause steel to rust even though no visible moisture is present
The amount of water vapour in the air is indicated by the relative humidity and Vernon carried out some experimentswhich showed the effect of relative humidity on rusting1 He showed that in pure air there was little corrosion below 100relative humidity (rh) but in the presence of small concentrations of impurities such as sulphur dioxide serious rustingcould occur above a certain critical humidity which was about 70 Below this level rusting is slight provided moisture fromother sources is not present (see Fig 23) These experiments showed the importance of two factors that determine thecorrosion rate in air ie
(i) relative humidity and(ii) pollutants and contaminants
The effect of moisture is related to the length of time it is in contact with the steels so the influence of relative humidity isgenerally more important than that of precipitation processes such as rain because the relative humidity may remain above70 for long periods particularly in the United Kingdom and other northern European countries However in the absence ofpollution such as sulphur dioxide (SO2) corrosion is only slight but a reasonably linear correlation has been shown to existbetween the corrosion rate and the amount of SO2 in the air2 Although SO2 can
Table 21
6 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
Effect of sea salts on the corrosion of steela
Distance from coast (yards) Salt content of airb Corrosion rate (mm per year)
50 100 095
200 27 038
400 7 006
1300 2 004a Based on tests carried out in Nigeriab Expressed as a percentage of content at 50 yards
dissolve in moisture to form acids the effect is not to produce a direct attack on the steel but rather is the formation of saltssuch as ferrous sulphate (FeSO4) These compounds sometimes called corrosion salts are able by complex reactions toproduce further rusting Additionally they are hygroscopic and so can trap further moisture on the steel surface Such salts areof more than academic interest because their presence in rust is one of the main causes of coating breakdown when paints areapplied to rusted surfaces (see Chapter 3) When chlorides are present on the steel surface typically near the coast where seasalts (sodium chloride) are prevalent corrosion may occur at relative humidities as low as 403 Generally the amount ofchloride in the air drops off rapidly as the distance from the coast increases The effects of this drop in corrosion are illustratedin Table 214
The effects of pollution in particular are demonstrated in Table 22 based on BISRA (British Iron and Steel ResearchAssociation) results As can be seen in these tests carried out some years ago when the amount of pollution was probablyhigher in industrial areas than it is today the corrosion rate in Sheffield was more than three times that in Godalmingmdashthelatter a
Table 22Corrosion rates of steel exposed to different environments in the United Kingdom4
Environment Type Corrosion rate (micro m per year)
Godalming Inlandmdashnon-polluted 48
Llanwrtyd Wells Inlandmdashnon-polluted 69
Calshot Coastal 79
Motherwell Inlandmdashpolluted 95
Sheffield Inlandmdashpolluted 135
comparatively clean environment The results from overseas sites showed clearly that in warm dry unpolluted inland sitessuch as Khartoum in the Sudan and Delhi in India the corrosion rate was negligible compared with that occurring in
Fig 23 Simplified diagram showing the effect of relative humidity and pollution on the corrosion of carbon steel (after Vernon1)
THE CORROSION OF STEEL 7
industrial areas Probably the most interesting result arising from these tests was that for the surf beach at Lagos where thecorrosion rate was over 06 mm per yearmdashnearly fives times that at Sheffield Conditions where sea spray continuouslyreaches the steel surface always lead to severe corrosion The splash zone on offshore structures is always a critical area forcorrosion see Fig 24
The size shape and orientation of the steel all influence the corrosion rate to varying extents because they affect the localenvironment at the steel surface The orientation of the steel has most influence because it has a marked effect on the lsquotime-of-wetnessrsquo of the surface In the Northern hemisphere north-facing steelwork remains moist for longer periods than south-facing steelwork and so tends to corrode more Again on horizontally exposed steelwork the upper surface may corrode lessrapidly than the ground ward side because corrosive particles are washed off by rain and the sun dries the surface morequickly Tests on specimens exposed at an angle of 30Eacute to the horizontal confirmed this5 60 of the corrosion occurred onthe underside Tests on steel plates of different thickness showed a slightly greater corrosion rate on thicker plates eg 95 Uumlmper year on 55-mm plate compared with 75 micro m per year on 5-mm plate
241Steel Composition
Minor variations in the compositions of commercial carbon steels generally have little effect on the corrosion rate the oneexception concerning copper Additions up to 02 provide a marked reduction in the corrosion rate in air but furtheradditions have little or no subsequent effect The addition of copper has little or no effect on steels immersed in water orburied in soils Copper is used as one of the alloying elements in low-alloy steels called lsquoweathering steelsrsquo which aresometimes used without coatings for structures This is discussed more fully in Chapter 12
242Rust
Rust is of course the corrosion product of the processes considered above Although it is generally considered to have thecomposition Fe2O3H2O other minor constituents will also be present in the rust and will have a marked effect on the courseof corrosion and the performance of coatings applied over the rust Rust also causes problems because it has a much greatervolume than the steel (or iron) from which it is produced This can result in the buckling of thin steel sections or sheet ifrusting occurs at crevices or overlaps Under paint films rust formation can result in blistering and cracking of the coating
25CORROSION IN WATER
The basic corrosion reaction is the same for steel immersed in water as for steel exposed to air However there are differencesin the processes that occur In water the availability of oxygen is an important factor whereas in air corrosion does not occurin the absence of moisture Hence in water corrosion is generally inappreciable in the absence of oxygen Under immersedconditions there are more factors to be taken into account than with atmospheric corrosion The environment itself is morecomplex and the rust does not necessarily form on the steel surface because the products of the corrosion reaction eg Fe andOH ions may diffuse from the steel itself and react in the solution
In view of the complexity of the corrosion process in water only a few basic points will be considered A short list ofbooks is provided at the end of the chapter for those wishing to study the matter in more detail
Fig 24 Corrosion at splash zone
8 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
251Composition of Water
Water is presented chemically as H2O but of course there are many other salts solids and gases present in the various watersof practical concern Even fairly pure tap water has a complex composition Water from rivers sea estuaries and wells coversa range of compositions and properties
The pH of water usually falls within a neutral range (pH 45ndash85) but some types are acidic and these can be particularlycorrosive to steel Generally however the main factors in determining the type and extent of corrosion are the dissolvedsolids (which influence the conductivity hardness and pH of the water) dissolved gases (particularly oxygen and carbondioxide) and organic matter The conductivity is important and the presence of salts such as sodium chloride (NaCl) tends tomake seawater more corrosive than fresh water
Corrosion can be prevented by making water alkaline but in some situations the alkalinity is such that only a partialpassive film is formed and this can result in pitting corrosion
Hardness is a particularly important property of waters This determines their ability to deposit protective scales on thesteel surface and is influenced by the amount of carbon dioxide and the presence of salts such as calcium carbonate andbicarbonate The scale formed in what are termed lsquohard waterrsquo reduces the rate of corrosion and lsquosoft watersrsquo can be treated withlime to make them less corrosive Although the formation of protective scales reduces corrosion of steel it may have otherless advantageous effects For example it may reduce the efficiency of heat exchangers and may eventually lead to theblockage of pipes
In seawater the formation of protective calcareous scales has an important influence on corrosion Their formation on theimmersed parts of offshore platforms is one of the reasons why many such structures can be cathodically protected withoutthe requirement for applied coatings
The presence of organic matter particularly in seawater and estuarine waters can have both direct and indirect effects oncorrosion Living organisms result in what is termed lsquofoulingrsquo ie marine growths on steel or on the protective coatingsapplied to steel This fouling is a particular problem when occurring on shipsrsquo hulls because its effect is to increase drag andso increase fuel consumption if speed is to be maintained Special anti-fouling coatings have to be applied to ships (seeSection 1534) A particular problem may occur if certain bacteria are present particularly in mud and around harboursThese can cause bacterial corrosion (see Section 27)
252Operating Conditions
The corrosion of steel under static conditions in water may be quite different from that experienced in practice Many factorswill influence the type and rate of corrosion in particular the temperature and velocity of the water The velocity or rate offlow will be particularly affected by design features such as sharp bends in pipes and may lead to a number of special typesof corrosion such as erosion-corrosion impingement and cavitation These will not be considered here but may particularlyaffect the operation of a process plant
Apart from special effects of velocity the rate of flow is always likely to influence corrosion It may be sufficient toremove protective coatings both scale-formed and applied particularly if abrasive particles are entrained in the water It willalso have an effect on the supply of oxygen which may directly influence corrosion Although in fresh waters a high flowrate may provide sufficient oxygen at the surface to cause passivity generally the corrosion rate increases with velocity Inone series of tests the corrosion rate under static conditions was 0125 mm per year compared with 083 mm per year at a velocityof 46 ms
253Steel Composition
Generally small variations in the composition have no influence on the corrosion rates of steels immersed in water Smallamounts of copper which has an effect on corrosion under atmospheric conditions do not improve corrosion to anysignificant extent under most immersed conditions
254Corrosion Rates of Steel in Water
Although corrosion is generally reasonably uniform on steel immersed in water there is more tendency for it to pit because ofthe effects of design scale formation and variations in rates of flow In particular the presence of millscale (see Chapter 3)
THE CORROSION OF STEEL 9
may lead to serious pitting This may arise particularly in seawater but also in other waters where the steel is virtually coatedoverall with millscale but with a few small areas of bare steel At such areas the galvanic effect of large areas of cathodicmaterial (millscale) in contact with small anodic areas (steel) can lead to severe pitting Many tests have been carried out onsteel specimens immersed in waters of different types in order to determine corrosion rates Generally under fully immersedconditions in seawater rates from 65 micro m per year to 100 micro m per year have been measured The rates at half-tide immersionare much higher than these In fresh water lower corrosion rates around 45 micro m per year have been obtained although in riverwater rates similar to the lower end of the range in seawater are not uncommon
26CORROSION IN SOIL
The corrosion process in soil is even more complex than that in water although again the basic electrochemical process is thesame and depends on the presence of electrolyte solutions ie moisture in the soil Soils vary in their corrosivity Generally high-resistance soils ie those of low conductivity are the least corrosive These include dry sandy and rocky soils Low-resistance soils such as clays alluvial soils and all saline soils are more corrosive The depth of the water table has animportant influence on corrosion and the rate will depend on whether steel is permanently below or above it Probablyalternate wet and dry conditions are the most corrosive In many soils the effect of the water table leads to variations incorrosion with depth of burial of the steel
Steel buried in soil tends to be in the form of pipes or piles Both may be in contact with different layers and types of soilbut pipelines in particular will be influenced by variations in the soil over the long pipe distances The effect of differences insoil resistivity water content and oxygen availability all lead to the formation of differences in potential over the pipeline andthe formation of electrolytic cells Generally this is not a serious problem provided sound protective coatings in conjunctionwith cathodic protection are used Usually a soil survey is carried out before determining the necessary protective measuresWith piles the problem is more acute because although protective coatings are used they are often damaged during drivingoperations In practice however this does not appear to be particularly serious A number of piles have been withdrawn andexamined corrosion has been lower than might have been anticipated
Stray current corrosion is a form of attack that can occur when a steel structure or pipeline provides a better conductingpath than the soil for earth-return currents from electrical installations or from cathodic protective systems in theneighbourhood If such currents remain unchecked then there is accelerated corrosion of steel in the vicinity of the straycurrents
Some indications of the corrosion rates of steel in soils have been published67 The highest rates obtained were 68 micro m peryear in American tests and 50 micro m per year in British tests Pitting was 4ndash6 times greater than these general rates
27BACTERIAL CORROSION
Although the presence of oxygen and moisture or water is generally necessary for corrosion there is an important exceptionwhich is worth considering because it occurs in a number of situations under immersed and buried conditions
The nature and extent of the corrosion will be determined by the form of microbiological activity The form mostcommonly encountered is that arising from the presence of sulphate-reducing bacteria (Desulfovibrio desulfuricans) Theyderive their name because they reduce inorganic sulphates to sulphides and are able to cause corrosion under anaerobicconditions ie in the absence of oxygen Generally under immersed conditions in water or burial in soil oxygen is essentialfor corrosion However in the presence of these bacteria corrosion can occur without oxygen because the process isdifferent
A number of investigations into the mechanism have been carried out and the most likely explanation of the process is asfollows
anodic reaction
cathodic reaction
Combining these equations the overall reaction is represented as follows
This represents the corrosion products obtained when bacterial corrosion occurs and is a more likely reaction than the directone ie
10 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
The exact mechanism is not of practical importance but the reaction products indicated above do provide a means of detectingthe presence of sulphate-reducing bacteria which is usually associated with a distinct lsquosulphidersquo smell and black corrosionproducts on the steel Although sulphate-reducing bacteria do not necessarily attack coatings they are capable of attackingcoated steel if the protective film is porous or damaged Sulphate-reducing bacteria are found in clays muds silts andseawater Coating manufacturers should be consulted to ensure that specific coatings are suitable for conditions wherebacteria are present Cathodic protection can effectively prevent attack by sulphate-reducing bacteria Other forms of bacteriacan attack coatings but these are not of the types that corrode steel
REFERENCES
1 Vernon WHJ Trans Faraday Soc 31(1) (1935) 6682 Chandler KA amp Kilcullen MB Br Corres J No 3 (March 1968) 80ndash43 Chandler KA Br Corres J No 1 (July 1966) 264ndash64 Chandler KA amp Hudson JC Corrosion Vol 1 Newnes and Butterworths 1976 p 375 Larrabee CP Trans Electrochem Soc 85 (1944) 2976 Romanoff M J Res Nat Bur Stand 660 (1962) 223ndash47 Hudson JC and Acock JP Iron and Steel Institute Special Report No 45 London 1951
FURTHER READING
Fonatana MG amp Greene NO (1967) Corrosion Engineering McGraw-Hill New YorkScully JC (1975) The Fundamentals of Corrosion Pergamon Press Oxford
THE CORROSION OF STEEL 11
CHAPTER 3Surface Preparation
The long-term performance of a coating is significantly influenced by its ability to adhere properly to the material to which itis applied This is not simply because the coating might flake away or detach from the surface but because poor adhesion willallow moisture or corrosion products to undercut the coating film from areas of damage
The adhesion of some coating materials such as hot-dip galvanising is due to the formation of a chemical bond with thesurface For example in hot-dip galvanising the zinc combines with the steel to form ironzinc alloys This is undoubtedly themost effective adhesive bond However for the most part organic coatings adhere to the surface by polar adhesion which ishelped or reinforced by mechanical adhesion
Polar adhesion occurs when the resin molecules act like weak magnets and their north and south poles attract oppositegroups on the substrate A few organic coatings have no polar attraction at all for example some formulations of vinylcoatings can be stripped from a steel substrate in sheets and are therefore used as temporary protectives But in all cases theattraction is only effective to a molecular distance from the steel and films of dirt oil water etc can effectively nullify alladhesion
Mechanical adhesion is assisted by roughening the surface and thereby increasing the surface area for example by two orthree times when abrasive blasting upon which the coating can bond Some coatings for example the unsaturated polyestersused in glass-fibre laminates develop excessive shrinkage on curing and require a high surface profilemdashthe term used to denotethe height from peak to trough of a blast-cleaned surface The majority of organic coatings can obtain adequate adhesion onsurface profiles in excess of 25 micro m Another important factor of mechanical adhesion is the firmness or stability of the substrateFor example unstable substrates would include millscale rust scales or old paint that is liable to flake and detach from thesubstrate and friable powdery layers of dirt rust etc Modern fast-drying high-build high-cohesive-strength coatings suchas epoxies applied by spray put considerably greater stress on the adhesive bond during their drying and curing process thando lsquoold-fashionedrsquo brush-applied slow-drying highly penetrating materials such as red lead in oil primers
Because of the cost and difficulty of carrying out surface preparation to the required high standards in recent years therehas been a move towards the use of so-called lsquosurface-tolerantrsquo coatings These perform in two ways firstly by containinghydrophilic solvents or surface-active agents which combine with the moisture on a surface and disperse it through the paintfilm These can be effective providing that the amount of moisture present does not exceed the available solvent or agent or thatthey are not trapped in the film by premature overcoating or skin curing One proprietary epoxy material also combines withoil in this case not to disperse the oil from the paint film but to combine with it to form a new polymer The second method isto use two-pack epoxies often formulated with aluminium pigmentation to give good lsquowettingrsquo and penetration (ie highlythixotropic systems are not suitable) and so designed as to form flexible films which allow the relief of internal stress andshrinkage
In general all paint systems including the lsquoold-fashionedrsquo systems will give improved performance on surfaces preparedto a high standard of cleanliness The use of lsquosurface-tolerantrsquo coatings should be the unavoidable exception rather than therule
31STEEL SURFACE CONTAMINANTS AND CONDITIONS
The effects of steel surface contaminants and conditions on coating performance are described below Methods of detection ormeasurement are described in Chapter 9
311Oil and Grease
Residues of oil grease cutting oils silicones etc left on a steel surface for example after fabricating operations will weakenthe adhesive bond of subsequent coatings (see Fig 31) Such residues must be removed before any further surfacepreparation operation such as mechanical cleaning or blast-cleaning since these are likely to spread the contamination overa wider area Where abrasive is re-used as in centrifugal blast-cleaning this can also spread the contamination onto erstwhileclean surfaces
312Millscale
Steel sections and plates are produced by rolling the steel at temperatures in the region of 1200EacuteC The temperature at therolling is likely to be well over 1000EacuteC so the steel reacts with oxygen in the air to form oxide scales In general terms thereaction can be expressed as follows
In practice the scale is composed of a number of layers the thickness and composition of which will be determined by factorssuch as the type and size of the steel the temperature of rolling and the cooling rate At the temperatures generally used forrolling three layers are present The proportion of each layer will vary but the general proportions are as follows12
FeO (weacutestite) 40ndash95Fe3O4 (magnetite) 5ndash60Fe2O3 (haematite) 0ndash10
FeO (weacutestite) is unstable below 575EacuteC so scales produced at temperatures lower than this do not contain this layer Alloysteels form a scale with somewhat different properties although basically of iron oxides often they are thinner and moreadherent than those formed on unalloyed steel In practice the composition and formation of millscale is not of particularimportance other than in determining its ease of removal or its effect on coatings if allowed to remain on the steel to bepainted The latter point is particularly important and will be considered below
Fig 31 Flaking of paint from surface contaminated with grease
SURFACE PREPARATION 13
Millscale is a reasonably inert material and in principle if it adheres well to the steel surface might prove to be a highlyprotective coating However it is brittle and during handling of steelwork parts of the scale tend to flake off comparativelyeasily Experiments have been carried out in the rolling mill in an endeavour to produce scales with improved properties soas to provide a sound base for paint coatings However little success has been achieved in this area of research
The presence of millscale on steel has two important effects on coating performance(i) Although millscale is an oxide when it is in contact with steel a galvanic cell is set up (see Chapter 2) The millscale is
cathodic to the steel and a potential difference of as much as 04 V may be set up in seawater Consequently at breaks in themillscale quite deep pitting of the steel may occur particularly under immersed conditions and particularly when the area ofthe cathode (the millscale) is large relative to the area of the anode (the bare steel) Even if the scaled steel is painted somemoisture will reach the steel surface because all paint films are to some extent permeable Furthermore coatings can becomedamaged thus allowing moisture to remain in contact with the scale This galvanic effect can be serious under immersedconditions but it is not the only problem caused by the presence of millscale as discussed below
(ii) During handling scale on the steel surface is inevitably damaged and if exposed to a corrosive environment eg that ofa stockyard then the steel will corrode The general course of corrosion follows a pattern
(a) The steel section will be carrying some intact millscale and some areas of bare steel where the scale has cracked orflaked off
(b) Although the millscale will not rust the steel will react with the atmosphere and the rusting will tend to undermine thescale leading to blistering (see Fig 32) or flaking The amount of flaking will depend upon the environment ofexposure and the time the steel is left to rust In tests carried out in Sheffield in the UK on -in (95 mm) plates 66of the scale was removed in 2 months but only an additional 10 was removed over the next 8 months
(c) If the steel is cleaned manually eg by scrapers and wire-brushes loose scale and rust will be removed but intact scaleis merely burnished
(d) If the steel is then painted the performance will depend on a number of factors in particular the chemical and physicalstate of the surface the environment of exposure and the paint systems used
Where the scale has been virtually all removed then the surface will be covered with rust and the effects will be as discussedbelow (Section 3131)
Table 31Life of paint system on different steel surfaces3
Condition Average life of paint system (years)
As rolledmdashintact millscale 85
Fig 32 Blistering of paint resulting from the presence of millscale under the coating
14 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
Condition Average life of paint system (years)
Weatheredmdashrust and scale 26
De-scaledmdashno rust or scale 100
On the other hand if the scale is practically intact with little or no rusting then the paint performance may be reasonablygood This situation rarely occurs in practice but in tests carried out in Sheffield on three groups of specimens coated withsimilar paint systems the results shown in Table 31 were obtained
However the most common situation with scaled steel is where it has been weathered and some intact scale remains withsome rust This covers a range of conditions and possible effects Generally there is a considerable reduction in the life of thesystem but a potentially disastrous situation can arise After normal cleaning with removal of loose scale a considerablepercentage of apparently intact scale may be left on the surface However this scale may have been undermined to a greatextent by rust and after painting the scale carrying the paint may flake off within a few weeks In tests carried out in acoastal atmosphere on steel specimens weathered for a period of 3 months leaving some apparently intact millscale wire-brushed and then painted virtually all the paint flaked off within a few months On similar specimens where all the scale hadbeen removed by weathering the paint coating lost adhesion due to rust after about 2 years4
Clearly painting over steel carrying millscale is likely to cause problems and it is generally accepted that visible andidentifiable scale should be removed This can be accomplished by leaving steel sections exposed to the atmosphere so thatall the scale eventually flakes off However this is achieved only by allowing the scale to be undermined by rusting soleaving a layer of rust on the steel and some pitting This is not a sound substrate on which to apply coatings as discussedbelow
313Surface Cleanliness
3131Rust
Rust is the corrosion product formed when steel reacts with oxygen and water This has been discussed in Chapter 2 Thecorrosion reaction is generally denoted as follows
Although rust is primarily hydrated ferric oxide it also contains other compounds Rusts have a wide range of compositiondepending on the conditions under which they are formed Typical compositions cannot therefore be given but analyses of arange of rusts have indicated that air-formed rusts generally contain about 5 of compounds other than Fe2O3H2O Thesederive in part from the steel which contains elements other than iron eg copper silicon and manganese and in part fromatmospheric contaminants and pollutants mainly sulphates and chlorides although other pollutants such as ammonium salts arealso generally present in rust
3132Water-Soluble Contaminants
The main constituents of rust ie iron oxides are not themselves the main problem in determining the performance of paintapplied over rust In fact iron oxides are commonly used as pigments in paints The constituents formed by reactions betweensteel and pollutants such as sulphur dioxide sometimes called lsquoiron saltsrsquo or lsquocorrosion saltsrsquo cause most problems
Sulphur dioxide in the air reacts with moisture to form acids Considerable publicity is frequently given to what has beendescribed as lsquoacid rainrsquo arising from such reactions Weak sulphuric acid solutions react with the steel to form ferroussulphate the presence of which can be readily detected in rust These salts tend to form in shallow pits at the steel surface andthe corrosion process is such that the sulphates tend to move inwards to the anodic areas which are likely to be in crevicesthe bottom of pits etc The salts are also not lsquorustrsquo coloured being white or light coloured They are very difficult if notimpossible to remove with tools such as scrapers and wire brushes and are often difficult to remove even with blast-cleaningThe presence of salts such as ferrous sulphate leads to rather complex reactions involving the regeneration of the sulphuricacid from which they were formed This in turn causes further corrosion and the production of more rust As rust has aconsiderably greater volume than the steel from which it is produced this leads to disruption of the paint film applied over itby cracking blistering and eventually flaking (Fig 33)
SURFACE PREPARATION 15
Ferrous sulphate is the salt most commonly found in rusts formed in industrial-type atmospheres Near the coast chloridesare likely to be a greater problem The reactions arising from the two types of salt sulphate and chloride are not necessarilythe same Chlorides are hygroscopic ie they absorb moisture It has been shown in laboratory tests5 that whereas rusting mayoccur at relative humidities below 70 with sulphates the presence of chlorides in rust can result in corrosion of the steel atrelative humidities as low as 40 Chlorides may therefore be a greater immediate problem than sulphates but all saltspresent under a paint film will lead to a reduction in the coatingrsquos life
The rusting of steel is complex and in many ways unpredictable An investigation of the process was carried out by theformer British Iron and Steel Research Association (BISRA) and some of the results have been published6 These show thatthe amount of rust formed on a steel surface is not necessarily related to the length of time the steel has been exposed andperhaps even more important the amount of sulphate in the rust also does not relate to the length of exposure In rustssampled in January about 8gm2 of sulphate were measured in rusts formed over a period of 2 months ie from steel exposedinitially in November of the previous year This rose to a figure of about 12 gm2 for rusts formed over a period of a yearHowever for rusts sampled in the summer months much lower sulphate contents were obtained In July rusts formed over aperiod of a year contained about 6 gm2 and over 2 months contained 25 gm2 It follows therefore that irrespective of theperiod of rust formation the amount of sulphate is higher in winter Consequently painting over rusted steel is a somewhathaphazard operation because without carrying out chemical tests on the rust it is virtually impossible to know the extentof iron salt formation Painting in the summer at inland sites in the UK is likely to provide better performance from the paintcoating than in winter
Similarly chloride contamination in coastal areas can depend upon prevailing wind direction and even the steepness orshallowness of the coast line Against this must be set the fact that the chloride has a higher solubility than the sulphate andtherefore more is washed from the surface by rainfall For both contaminants the situation where rusted surfaces are subjectto atmospheric pollution and are not washed by rain is the most aggressive
The reduction in durability of coatings due to soluble iron corrosion products trapped beneath coatings is most obvious forsurfaces exposed to severe marine environments or frequent condensation and also for the linings of storage tanks containingaqueous liquids The effect is less obvious on coatings subject to normal weathering but this can also depend upon the type ofcoating Some coatings are thick and have a high cohesive strength and others are thick and are very flexible in both thesecases substrate corrosion can be masked until it has reached an advanced state For conventional paint systems such as alkydsthe effect can generally be seen within a few years by the appearance of corrosion blisters in the paintwork The corrosionblisters form from the underlying corrosion pits
Morcillo et al7 have carried out experimental work using shot-blasted steel panels seeded with different concentrations ofsodium chloride and ferrous sulphate They found that some paint systems blistered during the first months of atmosphericexposure while other systems took several years The type of environment and the thickness of the coating played animportant role in the delay of visible breakdown but after 3 or 4 years it was visible in all environments and practically allpaint systems and film thicknesses The exception was zinc silicate primer which showed the greatest tolerance This waspresumably due to the silicate molecule picking up ferrous ions and also absorbing chloride to form the insoluble zincoxychloride
Later work by Morcillo et al8 studying the onset of corrosion under thin varnish films showed that the morphology of theblistering varied according to the type of water-soluble contaminants existing at the interface Ferrous sulphate tended toproduce a large number of small blisters whereas sodium chloride induced a few but large blisters Mixtures appeared to havean additive effect
The problem with all such experiments on seeded panels is that the contamination is in a different form and situation thanoccurs in practice For example sodium chloride contamination as sea spray is likely to be spread over a surface Ferrous
Fig 33 Blistering of paint resulting from the presence of soluble iron corrosion products under the coating
16 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
chloride contamination is likely to be at the bottom of a corrosion pit and encapsulated in rust Such layers of rust can hardlybe a complete barrier to moisture penetration but they can possibly slow down the osmotic reaction Some work carried out byone of the authors of this book is of interest On several previously rusted surfaces with known ferrous ion concentrationsranging from 100 to 350 mgm2 and coated with a full chlorinated rubber system the first signs of breakdown occurred onareas that had been blast-cleaned to Sa 3 but eventually the severest breakdown was on areas blast cleaned only to Sa 2
There is also now ample evidence from the UK Department of Transportrsquos experience that conventional oleo-resinous paintsystems normally with a life expectancy of 5ndash7 years have lasted at least 2 or 3 times longer One of the essential ingredientsfor such success is the monitoring of blast-cleaned surfaces to ensure they are free from contamination
All of the current methods of determining soluble contaminants are discussed in Chapter 9 but as a guide it can be assumedthat the deeper the corrosion pitting before surface preparation the greater the problem This is another sound economicreason why no area however small of a painted structure should be allowed to deteriorate into severe corrosion beforemaintenance is carried out
3133Non-Water-Soluble Contaminants
In the oil industry the handling of sour crudes is a major source of hydrogen sulphide Sulphides also occur in certain processplants such as sewage treatment and metal refining Although iron sulphide is insoluble it is cathodic to steel and thereforewill initiate corrosion
Contamination of surfaces by fatty acids can occur in several types of process plants for example those dealing with foodpaper and grain Fatty acids can react with a steel surface to form insoluble soaps which are difficult to remove completelybut if overcoated can cause loss of adhesion
Silicones are used in many industrial applications Silicones possess a special affinity for steel and are difficult to removeLeft on the surface they can readily cause severe loss of adhesion of subsequent coatings
Oils greases and waxes are frequently used as temporary protective films on steel surfaces Wax is also a constituent ofmany crude oils and may be left on the surface after the oil has been removed Generally all oils greases or waxes must beremoved before further coating and this is sometimes difficult to accomplish because of the tenacity with which suchsubstances cling to steel surfaces Even slight traces of wax not visible to the eye can cause overall loss of adhesion
314Roughness
The degree of roughness of a surface to be coated is important since too smooth a surface will impair adhesion and too rougha surface can leave prominent areas of the steel inadequately coated
When steel is blast-cleaned the surface is inevitably roughened and this characteristic has been described as the lsquoanchorpatternrsquo lsquosurface roughnessrsquo and lsquosurface profilersquo The later term is the one now used in International and British StandardsOver past years the term lsquoanchor patternrsquo has been officially discouraged because it was felt that it led to operators trying toobtain as rough a surface as possible The disadvantages of very rough surfaces are that they use more paint and there isalways the likelihood with these films that peaks of the metal profile are not being adequately protected However there issome evidence that the lsquoanchorrsquo formed when a paint film penetrates into the three-dimensional irregularities that form a blast-cleaned surface is very beneficial for the adhesion of modern high-build systems It is necessary to be able to specify thesurface profile because some coatings for example very high-build paint coatings and metal coatings need a surface with ahigh profile and therefore a large surface area per unit area in order to ensure that the adhesive bond is greater than thecohesive bond Indiscriminate use of large abrasives however particularly for relatively thin coats of priming paint meansthat the peaks of the blast-cleaned surface are not adequately covered and rust spot if not quickly overcoated
Methods for the determination of surface profile are described in Chapter 9
315Surface Defects and Welds
Defects on the surface of hot-rolled steel such as laminations and shelling can often remain undetected until the surface hasbeen cleaned particularly by blast cleaning Apart from the need to check the extent and depth of the defects to ensure they donot impair the strength of the steel such sharp slivers of steel and the accompanying crevices cannot be coated satisfactorilyGenerally the most effective method of removal is by mechanical grinding or discing Some authorities specify the reduction
SURFACE PREPARATION 17
in thickness which is allowable before the item is rejected Any area that has been ground smooth may be too smooth for theadhesion of high-performance coatings and may require to be roughened for example by abrasive blasting
Any burrs around cut or drilled edges for example around bolt holes should be removed before coatingWeld areas require particular attention during surface preparation Frequently in service the paint coating on a weld area
will fail while the remainder of the paintwork is still in excellent condition Much of this breakdown must be attributed to theroughness of the weld protruding into the paint film thickness but contamination left by the weld process also plays its part
Manual metal arc welding tends to leave particularly rough surfaces depending upon the difficulty of the operation and theskill of the welder Some of the coated electrodes give acidic weld flux (slag) deposits but mainly the contamination isalkaline This latter contamination can cause relatively rapid failure of alkyd or oleo-resinous paints Undercut edges of weldsneed to be ground flush where necessary but deep-seated undercutting or other similar serious defects require grinding out andrewelding
Coatings will not penetrate properly into any surface blowholes on welds Coated over there will be entrapped air whichcan then cause pinholes in the coating Such blowholes should be filled either by welding or with a filler such as a solventlessepoxy
Gas welding or cutting with an oxyacetylene or other type of flame leaves an oxide film or thick scale on the weld or nearthe cut edge and this should be removed before painting
TIG and MIG welding with effective gas shielding give only a very thin adherent layer of oxide and depending upon thecoating to be used and the service required may not need to be removed
Fully automatic submerged arc welding should produce a weld with a smooth dome-shaped weld surface which is normallysatisfactory for painting with the minimum amount of weld dressing
Weld spatter is a problem because it is seldom removed by abrasive blastcleaning Weld spatter is not only large in relationto most paint film thickness but like weld slag is generally cathodic to steel and therefore a source of initial corrosion underwet conditions Anti-spatter coatings which can cover a wide range of types can cause loss of adhesion of subsequent coatsand should be removed
Non-continuous welds ie skip or spot welding may be used where continuous welding is not required for strengthpurposes Such welding is impossible to protect from corrosion and should not be used in aggressive environments
With all welding it is important to remember that while the requirements of welding may be met satisfactorily the surfaceproduced may be unsuitable for long-term durability of corrosion-protective coatings
Regarding surface preparation of weld areas ideally all welds should be first dressed as described above all loose slag andall weld spatter removed by chipping and then the weld should be abrasive blast-cleaned The small vacuum blast machinesare ideal for this purpose Chemical cleaning of welds for example with acid gels involves very special and difficultprocedures that are fraught with problems unless very carefully controlled For manual welds even after suitable dressing itis still advisable to apply an extra coat of primer to the weld area ie stripe coating
32SURFACE PREPARATION METHODS
321Degreasing
The four main methods of degreasing steel surfaces prior to painting are liquid solvent cleaning solvent vapour cleaning alkalinecleaning and detergents In all cases it is advisable to remove excessive deposits of oil and grease by scraping before anyother operation
3211Liquid Solvent Cleaning
Liquid solvent cleaning is a widely used method for degreasing on site using such solvents as white spirit or solvent naphthaPetrol must not be used because of the fire and explosion hazard plus the additional danger of lead poisoning Halogenatedhydrocarbons such as trichlorotrifluoroethane and trichloreothane can be used providing normal safety precautions regardingtoxicity are observed Trichloroethylene is too toxic to be normally recommended as a cold cleaning solvent
At works the cleaning may be carried out by immersion or spraying the solvent over the surface On site it is normally byscrubbing with rags Too frequently the technique is to saturate a rag with solvent wipe the contaminated area and itssurrounds and allow the solvent to evaporate This procedure does little more than spread the contamination in a thinner layerover a wider area The following procedure should be followed
18 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
1 Wipe or scrub the surface with rags or brushes wetted with solvent2 Wipe the surface with a clean lint-free rag3 Repeat steps (1) and (2) until all visible traces of contaminant are removed 4 Carry out final wiping with a clean rag and clean solvent5 If considered advisable test surface to ensure it is oil free
This method is becoming less used these days because of the increasing number of regulations restricting the use of organicsolvents
Some proprietary solvent cleaners contain emulsifying agents and this has the advantage that instead of wiping with ragsthe work can be hosed off with clean water
3212Solvent Vapour Cleaning
This is a procedure for works use only The items to be degreased are suspended in a specially designed vapour degreasingplant which has an atmosphere of solvent vapour in equilibrium with boiling solvent in a heating tank When condensation ofsolvent virtually ceases on the steel surface the work is removed If a non-greasy residue remains after processing it may beremoved by wiping with a clean lint-free cloth If greasy residues remain the process should be repeated
Initially trichloroethylene was almost universally used for this type of plant nowadays there are a wide range ofhalogenated solvents with different degrees of efficiency toxicity and potential damage to the ozone layer
3213Alkaline Cleaning
Alkaline cleaners for steel are mainly based on sodium hydroxide as 20ndash60 by mass of the active constituents which alsogenerally include sodium carbonate sodium tripolyphosphate and surface-active agents They are specially formulated toavoid any appreciable attack on the steel and are generally used at elevated temperatures ie 80ndash100EacuteC Before theapplication of coatings any cleaned surfaces should be washed with clean water or steam until free of alkalinity
3214Detergents
There are a number of proprietary cleaners with a wide range of formulae mainly based on detergents and emulsifiers Theywork by wetting the surface and emulsifying the oil and greases so that they can be washed from the surface The method isgenerally very effective and relatively free from toxic hazard Its disadvantage in some circumstances is the need to use waterwashing
322HandETHand Power-Tool Cleaning
Basically any hand-held tool falls into this category included are scrapers wire brushes chipping hammers needle guns andabraders Some of these can be used manually or as power tools Generally speaking power tools give an improved degree ofcleanliness and certainly a higher rate of working than hand-operated tools However care must be taken with power tools toensure that the steel surface is not damaged producing sharp ridges or gouges for example
No handmdashor power-tool cleaning method as yet devised can give a standard or visual cleanliness comparable with abrasiveblast-cleaning and in particular such methods are generally incapable of removing rust and soluble iron corrosion productsfrom pits
Hand cleaning is ineffectual in removing intact millscale from as-rolled steel ie unweathered steel from the mill The practiceof weathering as-rolled steel to make it easier to remove the millscale is undesirable since it encourages pitting corrosionwhich is even more difficult to clean adequately Hand-tool cleaning in particular requires the subsequent use of primers withgood surface wetting ability Handmdashor power-tool methods of cleaning may be suitable for steel that is to be fully encasedfor example in concrete or for use in dry warm interiors of buildings
For steel that is to be exposed in other than the mildest of environments abrasive blast cleaning should be the first choiceof surface preparation method However abrasive blasting has its limitations These include the generation of dust andabrasive particles that can damage motors pumps and other machinery that may be in the vicinity Furthermore there is
SURFACE PREPARATION 19
generally a large quantity of spent abrasive to be removed Abrasive blast cleaning also has more safety hazards than handmdashorpower-tool cleaning For these reasons power-tool cleaning sometimes has to be used for important structures such as off-shore oil platforms
Power tools can be divided into two main categories impact and abrading An old fashioned but still widely used impacttool is the needle gun (Fig 34) A typical model consists of a bundle of 65 2-mm diameter flat-ended hardened steel needlesheld in individual slots in a tube suitable for holding in the hand These tools require approximately 130kgm3 of compressedair per minute at 06Nmm2 pressure The needles are propelled and retracted by a spring-loaded piston about 2400 times perminute The advantages of the method include the facts that (i) there is no loose abrasive (ii) it produces a surface profile and(iii) it has some ability to penetrate awkward corners shapes pits etc Its disadvantages include the facts that (i) blunt needlestend to impact contamination into the surfaces (ii) the method generates a considerable amount of noise and (iii) it is tiring touse
A more recent development in impact tools and one that appears to be gaining acceptance in North America is the flapassembly This consists of a flexible loop construction with tungsten carbide spheres bonded to the peening surfaces of eachof the metal supports fastened to the loop One model that has been found suitable is 3Mrsquos Heavy-Duty Roto-Peen
Modern developments of the abrading type of power tool use a nylon web material of continuous undulated filamentsimpregnated with silicon carbide abrasive
The abrading tools are suitable for use on previously rusted surfaces where the corrosion has produced a roughenedsurface For smooth surfaces such tools may not produce a satisfactory surface profile In all cases care must be taken not toproduce a burnished or polished surface of the rust
The National Association of Corrosion Engineers (NACE) of America claim that visual standards of cleanliness equal toSa2 of ISO 8501ndash11988 can be achieved when using either impact or abrading tools that incorporate the new abrasivematerials
323Abrasive Blast-Cleaning
This method of surface preparation is essentially one of mechanical removal of scale and rust by continuous impact of abrasiveparticles onto the surface There are two methods of achieving this (i) by using equipment to carry the abrasive in a stream ofcompressed air through suitable hoses and nozzles and (ii) by using impellers to throw the abrasive onto the surface bycentrifugal force The latter method requires comparatively large static equipment and is used mainly in works Thecompressed air method is also used in works but is essentially portable and so can be utilised on site
Fig 34 Needle gun in use
Fig 35 Air blast cleaning on site
20 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
The effectiveness of the method depends upon the energy produced at the steel surface this is related to the mass ofabrasive particles and their velocity ie
where M is the mass of the particle and V is its velocityBecause for a particular machine velocity is effectively constant the impact energy is determined by the mass of the
abrasive ie its volume and density However although the energy of impact is critical other factors also influence theeffectiveness and type of surface finish obtained with blast-cleaning Both the shape and type of abrasive are important andthese are discussed in Section 3235 The superficial area cleaned ie the coverage by the abrasives also determines theoverall effectiveness of the operation
There are no standard names for these methods but the one using compressed air is generally called either air blast or opennozzle blast (Fig 35) and the method using blast wheels is called centrifugal or airless blast
3231Air Blast-Cleaning
The sizes of blast-cleaning machines vary but essentially the equipment consists of the following parts
(i) a pressure tank or lsquopotrsquo which contains the abrasive and the necessary valves screens etc for correct operation (ii) air hoses
(iii) hoses for carrying the abrasive onto the steel surface through a nozzle(iv) moisture and oil separators(v) control valves
(vi) a compressor of suitable size
All the equipment must be capable of withstanding the pressures involved ie a pressure at the blast nozzle of 620ndash689 kPa(90ndash100 psi) which will be correspondingly greater at the compressor Operators carrying out the blast-cleaning operationmust be suitably clothed and use a proper helmet into which air is fed The air supply to the blast-cleaning machine providesthe pressure necessary to carry the abrasive onto the steel surface
The efficiency of the blast-cleaning operation is governed largely by the pressure at the blast nozzle Increase in thepressure at the nozzle results in a greater force per unit area that can be applied to the surface to be cleaned The pressure alsogoverns the size of the surface area that can be covered Ideally the pressure should be as close to 689 kPa ie 100 psi aspossible Each blast nozzle may require an airflow of depending upon size The compressor must be of adequate size tosupply a sufficient volume of air for any given nozzle diameter to ensure that the correct pressure is maintained Acompressor should always be selected to supply more air than is required by theoretical calculations in order to have a reserveto allow for worn nozzles extra length of hose restrictions in the air line and so on
There are two main types of blast hose Four-ply hose is used for heavyduty use and when there is a danger that theoperator will allow the hose to rest in a right-angled bend If the latter occurs the abrasive impinges directly upon the hosewall and can cause it to perforate Two-ply hose is lighter and easier to handle but is obviously not as strong
The diameter of the blast hose should be as large as possible in order to reduce loss of air pressure by friction losses It isrecommended that the hose should not be smaller than 320-mm id but operators often prefer to have 3 or 4 m of 190 mm idhose at the operating end for ease of handling This will cause a pressure drop and should only be used where it is necessaryGenerally speaking the internal diameter of the blast hose should be at least three times the orifice size of the blast nozzle
To avoid contamination of the work surface the compressed air should be free of condensed water or oil Adequateseparators and traps should be provided in the air lines
Blasting pressures at the nozzle are normally limited to 689 kPa Higher pressures could be an advantage and work carriedout by Seavey9 on blasting pressures up to 1034 kPa (150psi) demonstrated that as the pressure increased both productivityand efficiency continued to increase The main problems at the higher pressures were (i) a shortened life of compressorswhich were only rated for the lower discharge pressures (ii) increased thrust at the nozzle so that extra operator strength andtechnique was required and (iii) some abrasives were too friable and shattered to dust on impact In these tests copper slagwas unsatisfactory and silica sand was satisfactory but particularly for the latter there are a wide range of materials withdifferent properties that could give different results
In works situations the steel may be cleaned in a cabinet so containing the spread of abrasive However on-site theabrasive is not usually contained within the immediate confines of the machine Screens eg tarpaulins are frequently used to
SURFACE PREPARATION 21
prevent wide dispersal of the abrasive In some situations it may be essential to employ such screening to comply with healthand safety regulations The abrasives are not re-circulated during site cleaning and so expendable types are used
3232Vacuum Blast-Cleaning
A special form of this equipment has been designed to collect the abrasive by vacuum recovery after cleaning (Fig 36) Arubber shield around the nozzle allows abrasive to be sucked back and screened so that it can be reused This has theadvantage of containing the abrasive and restricting dust but it is a good deal slower than the open method Although varioustypes of nozzles are available for complex shapes the vacuum recovery method is most suitably employed on fairly large flatareas or on very narrow contained areas such as welds The pressure type of equipment is most commonly employed for blast-cleaning heavy steelwork but another form of equipment using suction is also available The abrasive is contained in anunpressurised tank and is sucked through a nozzle and blown by a jet of air onto the steel surface It is slower than thepressure method and is generally used for component cleaning in cabinets and for touch-up work The vacuum recoverymethod can also be adapted for this type of cleaning
3233Centrifugal Blast-Cleaning
Although portable equipment has been developed for some purposes most cleaning of this type is carried out in fairly largestatic equipment in fabricatorsrsquo works (Fig 37) The essential features of the method are
(i) Wheels with blades fitted radially onto which the abrasive is fed from the centre of the wheel As the wheel revolvesthe abrasive is thrown onto the steel surface The force of impact is determined by the size of the wheel and its radialvelocity Usually a number of wheels are employed placed at different angles relative to the steel being cleanedCommonly 4-or 8-wheel units are used and a range of different sized wheels operating at different velocities isavailable
(ii) An enclosure or cabinet to contain the wheels(iii) A recycling system for the abrasives with separator greens to remove fine particles and dust and allow reclamation of
suitable sized abrasives which are then fed back into the hopper(iv) A system of dust collection(v) Suitable methods of feeding the steelwork into the equipment
The method is particularly suitable for cleaning steel plates because of their simple geometry On more complex shapes it maybe necessary to hand-blast re-entrant angled steelwork Centrifugal cleaning is faster than air-blast cleaning particularly for largesections although the main control of the efficiency of the cleaning process is the speed at which the article is transportedthrough the equipment Often the cleaning installation is arranged as part of a line in which the steelwork emerging from thecleaning process is immediately protected with a coat of quick-drying priming paint
Large plants containing many blast wheels have been constructed to clean specifie fabricated items for example railwaywagons In the USA the larger plants are used to clean fabricated sub-sections of ships and up to 40 centrifugal wheels may beused Normally however for structural steel the method is used prior to fabrication The advantages of the method comparedwith the air blast type include
Fig 36 Diagram of vacuum recovery system (Reproduced by permission of Hodge Clemco)
22 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
(i) Greater economy(ii) Relatively automatic and in-line operation
(iii) Containment of dust from blast operation(iv) More efficient metallic abrasives can be used because abrasive can be recycled easily(v) The plant does not require compressed air
The disadvantages include
(i) High initial cost of the equipment(ii) Higher maintenance cost due to the wear and complexity of the equipment
(iii) Difficult or impossible to clean complicated steel shapes and even relatively simple shapes such as girders may requiresupplementary air blast-cleaning
(iv) The use of steel shot in order to reduce wear on the plant can peen the steel surface and also drive contaminants intothe surface
(v) The separators used on these machines remove large particles of fines they do not lsquocleanrsquo the abrasive If the abrasivebecomes contaminated with oil or soluble iron corrosion products for example from cleaning old rusty surfaces suchcontamination will be carried on to future work
The method is also used for repetitive cleaning of small items and there is a wide range of plants for use at works such as tumblingmill machines where the wheel units are mounted on the roof of a cabinet in which parts are tumbled in a revolving millbelow There are several designs of table machines where items are swung or turned underneath fixed blast wheels (seeMallory10)
3234Wet Blasting
Two factors have led to the introduction of water into the blast-cleaning operation firstly the increasing environmentalrequirements to reduce the dust hazard particularly when removing old lead-based paints and secondly the realisation thatcoatings can only achieve their optimum life when applied to surfaces substantially free of water-soluble contaminantsTherefore wet blasting methods are essentially for maintenance painting
The methods of surface preparation using water can be divided into two main groups water jetting ie high-pressure waterwithout the addition of abrasive and wet abrasive blasting ie a combination of water and abrasive
Water jetting uses a high-velocity stream of water produced by passing a flow of pressurised water through a speciallydesigned small orifice nozzle Pressures as high as 50000 psi are used for specialist applications such as rock cutting butexperience has shown that the most practical pressure for surface preparation is between 2500 and 5000 psi The volume ofwater used is between 15 and 501min Pressures above 5000 psi constitute a hazard because they are difficult to handle andput undue stress on the operator11
A special form of high-pressure water jetting known as ultra-high pressure is occasionally used This employs a very smalljet akin to that used for airless spray application of paint and normally operates in excess of 20000 psi In a large andcomprehensive trial of wet blast-cleaning methods sponsored by the US Department of Transportation MarineAdministration in cooperation with Avondale Shipyards USA12 the method was found to be capable of removing old paintand visible rust but could not remove tight millscale Also because the cleaning path is very narrow the method is
Fig 37 Centrifugal blast cleaning at works
SURFACE PREPARATION 23
comparatively slow Its main advantage would be for situations in confined spaces or close to sensitive equipment ormachinery where abrasives could not be tolerated
In general the advantages of water jetting are
(i) The equipment is relatively simple(ii) It can be used without abrasive
(iii) It is very successful in removing surface deposits eg marine growths or dirt without undue damage to the underlyingsurface
The disadvantages are
(i) The water jet is dangerous to life and limb (ii) Generally excessive quantities of water are required
(iii) It does not abrade the surface and therefore does not provide a surface profile(iv) It has limited efficiency in removing soluble salts from pitted surfaces(v) The back thrust from the jet is difficult and fatiguing for the operative
(vi) The splash-back makes it difficult for the operative to see what he is doing and to judge the standard of cleanlinessachieved
(vii) The cleaning rates are 30ndash50 of that achieved by dry blasting12
(viii) It leaves the surface wet
Modifications can be made to some water jetting methods so that abrasives can be added This does produce an erosive effectbut adds to the hazard Generally the low-pressure wet abrasive methods are more suitable particularly for site conditions
Wet abrasive blasting (see Fig 38) uses the same pressures as for conventional dry blasting Such units can be convertedusing the same compressor blast pot and nozzles but specially designed equipment is more efficient (Fig 39) The water canbe introduced at various points in the system between the blast pot containing the abrasive and the blast nozzle held by theoperative A common method is to introduce the water immediately behind the nozzle so that the water is atomised andaccelerated through the nozzle orifice along with the air and abrasive Alternatively controlled amounts of water can beintroduced at the base of the blast pot and are then mixed with the air and abrasive along the length of the blast hose It isclaimed that the latter method achieves a more efficient mix of abrasive and water
The type of water used is normally townsrsquo mains supply or water from non-esturine rivers For North Sea off-shore workbecause of the shortage of fresh water seawater has been used with a final fresh water rinse This obviously requires that theequipment pumps etc should be capable of handling seawater It is as yet too early to assess the effects of using seawater onthe durability of subsequent coatings
A draft report13 on Wet Abrasive Blasting in the UK and Offshore (North Sea British Sector) concludes that from a clientrsquospoint of view the method has worthwhile advantages although a disappointing number of contractors and their operatives arenot sufficiently experienced in the use of the equipment or fully aware of its versatility
The advantages of wet abrasive blasting include
(i) Efficient removal of soluble iron corrosion products from a corroded pitted surface(ii) Removal of soluble salt contamination that may exist in the abrasive
(iii) A standard of cleanliness ie freedom from soluble salt contamination generally achieved quicker than with dryblasting
Fig 38 Wet blast cleaning
24 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
(iv) Compared with water jetting the quantity of water used is relatively small for example 11min (v) Reduction in dust hazard enabling blasting to be carried out in places where dry blasting could be unacceptable
(vi) Reduction of spark dangers in hazardous areas(vii) It can be used for the selective removal of coatings for example of degraded top coats without damaging undercoats
(viii) For maintenance or repair work the ability to lightly abrade or lsquofeatherrsquo edges of existing sound coats(ix) It may allow blasting to proceed during periods of high humidity
The disadvantages include
(i) The surface is left wet and this requires either the use of an inhibitor or a moisture-tolerant primer or a final dry sweep-blast
(ii) The abrasive slurry produced by the operation tends to collect on the work surface and surrounds and has to be washeddown with air and water The slurry is much more difficult to remove than dry abrasive particularly when it dries out toform a cement-like layer
(iii) The abrasive slurry also collects on the operatives visor making it difficult to see what has been done(iv) The surface tension of the water can hold abrasive particles on the steel surface which can cause even more grit
inclusions than occur with dry blasting(v) In general operatives prefer dry blasting to wet blasting This is mainly due to the wet conditions and the difficulty of
seeing the work surface Consequently if unobserved it is possible for them to dry-blast the surface and then splash itwith water This produces the visual appearance of wet blasting without achieving the required degree of cleaning
When inhibitors are used in the water it is important that they are added in controlled amounts since concentrations left on thecleaned surface will result in water-soluble salt contamination The inhibitors can be added in the required concentration towater held in the storage tanks for the equipment or they can be dosed by measured amounts into the blast unit itself Anumber of proprietary inhibitors have been used for this purpose but those based on polyphosphates appear to be the mostsuitable It is always a wise precaution to check with the manufacturer of the paint system to be used whether a particularinhibitor or indeed any inhibitor should be used in conjunction with their products
Generally it seems desirable that operatives of wet abrasive blast equipment should have control of liquid and air flow sothat they can carry out the following functions
(i) blast with air and abrasive(ii) blast with air abrasive and water
(iii) wash down with air and water(iv) blast down with air only to remove excess water
The only variable they should not control is the inhibitor additionA variation to the wet abrasive blasting process but not widely used in the UK is where the water and abrasive are mixed
together in the blast pot This is called slurry blasting These units are designed for high-production work and typically haveseveral nozzles and hoses connected to a single control They are frequently operated at lower pressures than in conventionaldry blasting
A further variation now generally going out of favour is to add the water to the stream of abrasive after it leaves thenozzle This is accomplished by a simple water ring adaptor fitted over the standard blast nozzle This method reduces the dusthazard but has little effect on the cleaning efficiency since the water does not mix with the abrasive
Fig 39 Diagram of wet blast system (Reproduced by permission of Hodge Clemco)
SURFACE PREPARATION 25
3235Abrasives for Cleaning Steel
The cleaning of steel by abrasives is a straightforward concept depending upon sufficient impact energy at the surface toremove scale rust and other deposits However in practice the types of surface to be cleaned vary and a number of differentprocesses are used for the blast-cleaning Consequently a range of different abrasive particles has been developed
Basically abrasives are used not only to clean the surface but also to roughen it so that coating adhesion will besatisfactory This roughened surface sometimes termed lsquoetchingrsquo produces a lsquoprofilersquo or lsquoanchor patternrsquo The profile isdiscussed in more detail later but the size of the abrasive used will clearly have a marked influence on it (Figs 3ndash10 3ndash11 and3ndash12)
Steel surfaces before cleaning are not perfectly smooth even where they are covered with virtually intact millscale whichcan be removed comparatively easily with reasonably coarse abrasives there will be small depressions or pits in the steelThese require small abrasive particles for thorough cleaning Where steel has rusted there will be considerable shallow pittingcontaining various iron salts Again finer abrasives will be required for cleaning such areas Apart from their effect oncleaning steel surfaces the abrasives will by their nature cause abrasion and wear on the blast-cleaning equipment so they mustbe chosen in relation to the equipment used All abrasives have a limited life because during blast-cleaning operations they
Fig310 Manual blast cleaning with chilled angular grit
26 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
fracture or disintegrate in the process Where they are recovered and recirculated this must be taken into account by theaddition of new abrasive particles to ensure that a suitable mix is maintained The mix used for cleaning is important to ensurethat a suitable size distribution of particles is maintained during the process Many factors will influence the size distributionof particles such as the original size and shape hardness of the abrasive the velocity of the blast (ie the energy of impact atthe surface) the type of material used for the abrasives and the type of surface being cleaned The last factor is importantbecause steels vary in their hardness and the composition and rolling procedures used to produce a particular section willinfluence the thickness and adhesion of the millscale Some indication of the variations in profile obtained with different sizesof abrasive is shown in Fig 313
Two broad categories of abrasive are used for the cleaning of structural steel metallic and non-metallic Metallic abrasivesgenerally clean more effectively than non-metallic abrasives particularly on new steel covered by hard tight millscaleBorch14 claims that 1 tonne of steel grit is as effective as 100ndash150 tonnes of sand However since metallic abrasives aresignificantly more expensive than the commonly used non-metallic abrasives the former are only used in processes where theabrasive can be recycled Metallic abrasives are not used for wet cleaning processes
An important factor in the choice of abrasive is its hardness Increasing the hardness has several consequences it canreduce the usable life of the abrasive since increased hardness can result in the increased brittleness and the particles tend to
Fig 311 Centrifugal cleaning with steel shot
SURFACE PREPARATION 27
fracture rather than wear away Harder abrasive tends to clean faster owing to the sharpness and energy of the impact theharder the abrasive the greater the wear on the equipment
Chilled cast iron abrasive is the hardest but has high break-down rates owing to brittleness Steel shot or grit are the mostcommonly used There is a limited use of cut steel wire as an abrasive
The hardness of metallic abrasives according to ISO Standards is reported in Vickers Hardness Numbers (HV) AmericanStandards tend to use Rockwell C Hardness Numbers but tables are available that allow an approximate correlation Cast steelabrasive highmdashor low-carbon range 392ndash513 HV Chilled cast iron abrasives are approximately 650 HV
The size of the abrasive is important since it governs not only the surface profile but also the cleaning rate Small abrasivesclean faster because of the increased ricocheting and therefore the larger number of impacts per unit weight of abrasive Onthe other hand larger abrasive particles have a greater impact on the surface for example S340 shot (to BS24511963) hasfive times more impact energy than S170 shot
The shape of the abrasive is also important Shot tends to peen the surface and drive impurities into the surface Grit ismore effective in cutting into the surface but gives greater wear on the equipment Frequently operators use a mixture of shotand grit in centrifugal machines as a compromise
Fig 312 Centrifugal cleaning with malleable angular grit
28 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
International Standards that will specify the properties and test requirements of metallic abrasives are to be produced by theISO Committee on surface preparation
It is expected that the following will be specified
(1) Size classification Range and distribution(2) Hardness Percentage of particles tested to be above the required hardness (3) Density The minimum density required(4) Shape Maximum percentage allowable of such defects as elongated particles of shot or uncrushed or half-round grit(5) Voids Maximum percentage of particles containing voids and a limit to their cross-sectional area(6) Shrinkage Maximum percentage of particles containing shrinkage in the form of an area of microporosity or as an
internal cavity(7) Cracks Maximum percentage of particles containing cracks for example a crack may be considered as a defect if its
length is greater than 20 of the diameter of the abrasive particle(8) Foreign matter Maximum percentage of foreign matter such as slag permitted(9) Chemical composition for example carbon manganese silicon sulphur and phosphorus content
(10) Moisture The abrasives must be in a dry condition
Sampling procedures for abrasives are important and will be described in a separate ISO Standard It is anticipated that theStandards will be ready for publication by 1992
Non-metallic abrasives which are only available in the form of grits include natural minerals such as silica sand olivinesand staurolite garnet and corundum refinery slags such as copper refinery slag iron furnace slags coal furnace slags andnickel refinery slags others such as fused aluminium oxide silicon carbide synthetic emery glass beads broken glass andwalnut shells In general such abrasives have a lower impact and greater rate of breakdown than metallic abrasives but aremuch cheaper and are not re-usable Only a few very hard and expensive non-metallic abrasives are recycled
The Steel Structures Painting Council (SSPC) have reported15 that the use of non-metallic abrasives results in consistentlygood coating performance equal to or better than that obtained with metallic abrasives Non-metallic abrasives are less liableto raise spikes or minute laminations generally known as hackles on the metal surface They are however more likely toremain embedded in the clean surface typically to the extent of over 106 particles per square metre Providing such particlesdo not contain corrosion-promoting substances such as chlorides there is no evidence that such embedded particles affect thesubsequent coating performance It is possible that metallic abrasives also become embedded into the steel surface but sincethey are basically of the same composition they are more difficult to detect Embedded non-metallic abrasives do affect the colour
Fig 313 Profiles constructed from dial gauge measurements The mean height indicates theoretical cover by one coat of paint of 25 Uumlmthickness (after Ref 10)
SURFACE PREPARATION 29
of the cleaned surface Sand abrasives for example give a bright white finish whereas black abrasives such as copperrefinery slag give an overall darker finish
Sand abrasive is still widely used throughout the world and in European countries particularly for wet blasting Howeverbecause of the chances of silicosis from inhaling finely divided particles wet or dry (see Chapter 17) there are an increasingnumber of prohibitions and regulations regarding its use
If sand is used it should be the material specially prepared by washing drying and grading to the required size distributionIt should contain less than 10ppm of chloride and therefore sands from coastal areas are not recommended At least 90 ofthe sand should be in the form of quartz and it should contain little or no clay or silts or other substances that will form apowdery layer on the cleaned surface and interfere with subsequent coating adhesion
Olivine is a non-silica sand that is sometimes used as a replacement for silica sand It is a natural mineral which in Europeis mainly obtained from Norway but its composition varies according to its source It tends to be a dusty material when usedas an abrasive and gives a low surface profile
Staurolite is a natural mineral marketed solely by DuPont in the USA It is more expensive than refinery slags and cancontain some free silica
Garnet is a silica-free natural mineral mainly obtained from India the USA or Australia Although more often thought ofas a semi-precious stone it has been used for some time as an abrasive on coated abrasive papers and in polishing powders Avery hard material with a reasonably low breakdown it gives a good cleaning rate It is however expensive and is normallyused in small blasting cabinets where it can be recycled
Carborundum is native aluminium oxide occurring in cleavable masses or in pyramidal crystals in rocks such as granite inmany parts of the world Only diamond is harder and it is used for coated abrasive papers but is generally too expensive foruse on structural steel
Fused aluminium oxide is a synthetic material similar to carborundum but manufactured by a melting process from eitherbauxite or high-purity aluminium oxide Bauxite is the ore most widely used for the manufacture of aluminium and its browncolour arises from the presence of a small amount generally less than 05 by mass of iron oxide It is a very hard abrasivemore expensive than refinery slags It is often used for the preparation of stainless steel but is gaining favour in some quartersas an abrasive for structural steel
Refinery slags are the cheapest and most widely used non-metallic abrasives for structural steel They are particularly usedunder site conditions with open nozzle blasting and should not be recycled Copper refinery slag results from copper smeltingand is basically iron silicate slag It is available in many countries including the UK Coal slag results from the burning ofhard coal in coal-fired power stations and is basically aluminium silicate slag It is also readily available in most industrialcountries Nickel slag results from nickel smelting and is basically iron silicate slag
The silica in all slags used as abrasives should be present in a silicate bond which does not present a free silica hazardAll of the slags give a similar performance and the choice rests mainly on availability at a particular location However all
refinery slag abrasives are essentially by-products which are granulated in water If the water used in the refinery process isseawater as it is in some countries this leads to an unacceptable level of soluble chlorides in the abrasive It is claimed thatthe majority of European and American slag abrasives contain less than 10 ppm but some contain as much as 50 ppm and thishas led to premature paint failure Chloride contents as high as 250 ppm have been reported in the USA
Slags also contain other substances such as beryllium cadmium lead and arsenic These can obviously present a toxic hazardin the abrasive dusts (see Chapter 17) Some authorities16 also believe that because such metals and their oxides can becathodic to steel the embedded particles are the cause of early flash rusting of uncoated blast-cleaned surfaces and theoccurence of early blistering of paint films on immersion
International Standards for all the types of non-metallic abrasives mentioned above are in course of preparation It is hopedthat these will be able to define requirements and limits for particle size and distribution apparent density bulk density mohshardness moisture content water-soluble content and specifically chloride content The Standards are not expected to bepublished until at least 1992
324Innovative Methods
For many years an alternative to abrasive blasting has been sought if not to replace it entirely at least to provide analternative and effective method of achieving a high standard of cleanliness in sensitive situations Ideally the method shouldnot add to the waste disposal problem
The use of frozen carbon dioxide pellets has been reported in the USA17 but the Steel Structures Painting Council in theirStudy of Existing and Promising New Methods of Surface Preparation15 states that it appears to be impractical for structuralsteel applications the pellets do not remove tight millscale the pellet making machinery is prohibitively expensive and
30 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
difficult to maintain there are problems with fog formation at the nozzle which reduces visibility for the operative it may bedifficult to achieve sufficient ventilation in confined spaces
The possibility of using water in the form of crushed or solid ice particles has attracted many investigators over the years Areport from the USA18 finds it a suitable method for the removal of marine fouling and old paint The method has promiseand is still under investigation in the UK
A new technique is the use of very intense pulses of light Such methods are particularly effective for the removal of oldpaint By adjusting the intensity of the pulses of light and the number of times the surface is irradiated it is possible to controlthe thickness of paint removed Surface contaminants such as oil and grease need not be removed beforehand since they alsoare incinerated along with the paint film The process has the advantage of not producing any dust Because of the high energyrequirement of the equipment it seems unlikely that the method would be used on a large scale but it possibly has anapplication for maintenance painting in confined spaces crammed with delicate equipment Two types of such systemsometimes called flash blasting are under development in the USA The most promising consists of xenon flash lamps thatgive rise to the emission of short intense pulses of light The lamps need to be very close to the surface to be treated19
Another method uses repetitively pulsed laser beams of several kilowatts strength as the light source The beam scans acrossthe area to be cleaned and vaporises the paint A vacuum system removes the paint vapours One developer in the USA claimsthat the method is cost-effective for the removal of old paint will not initiate corrosion and provides minimal clean-up costs
In 1984 liquid nitrogen was used to remove layers of old paint from the copper interior skin of the Statue of Liberty in NewYork The liquid nitrogen was sprayed onto the surface to embrittle the paint and make it crack away from the surface Thepressure of the spray at 1035 kPa (150 psi) also aided the paint removal It is claimed that a cleaning rate of 22ndash33 m3 perhour was obtained The method was not completely successful because it did not remove an original coating of coal tar whichthen had to be removed by more conventional means Incidentally the structural steel of the statue was cleaned by vacuumblasting
The US Airforce has sponsored the development of a controlled cavitation erosion method for removing coatings fromaircraft surfaces Cavitation is the well-known destructive phenomenon caused by collapsing bubbles in a flowing liquid Theeffect is most frequently seen on shipsrsquo propellers and inside pumps By modifying a conventional water jetting system toproduce cavitation the cleaning efficiency is greatly improved The technique has been successfully used for rock drilling andthe removal of marine fouling from ships hulls As with conventional water jetting the limited factor tends to be operatorfatigue but the method holds promise for use on structural steel
325Flame Cleaning
In this method an oxyacetylene or oxypropane flame is passed across the steel (Fig 314) The heating causes millscale andother scales to flake off as a result of the differential expansion between the scale and the metal In addition any rust presentis dehydrated Immediately after the passage of the flame any loose millscale and rust that remains is removed bywirebrushing This generally leaves a powdery layer which must also be removed by dusting down
The level of cleanliness obtained is generally considered to lie between that obtained by abrasive blast-cleaning and thatresulting from manual cleaning and the method is used for maintenance work rather than for cleaning new steelwork Theadvantages of the process are
(i) The relative mobility of the equipment enables it to be used at any stage of fabrication or erection(ii) It can be used under relatively wet and damp conditions and helps to dry the surface
(iii) If priming paint is applied while the surface is still warm this ensures that there is no condensation and it also speeds upslightly the drying of the primer
The disadvantages are
(i) If the flame is traversed too slowly unbonded scale or other foreign matter is fused to the surface of the steel oralternatively thin sections of the steel are warped
(ii) It is a fire hazard(iii) If not carefully controlled it can affect the metallurgical properties of the steel and should never be used near high
strength friction grip bolts(iv) It is an expensive method taking into account its comparative inefficiency in cleaning steel
SURFACE PREPARATION 31
Over the years this method has been in and out of fashion It has been dropped from the SSPC and NACE Specificationsbecause it is considered a method no longer in use in North America It has been incorporated in ISO 8501ndash11988 because itis apparently used in Germany as a surface preparation method for the maintenance of road bridges
326Pickling
Before the advent of blast-cleaning as an effective method for the thorough cleaning of structural steelwork the removal ofrust and scale by immersion in dilute acids was sometimes employed This method of cleaning steel is called picklingNowadays it has only a limited use on structural steel to be painted although it is employed on steel to be hot-dip galvanisedIt is also the method most commonly used to clean steel sheet and strip usually as part of a continuous treatment process
The composition of scale has been discussed in Section 312 Both the magnetite (Fe3O4) and haematite (Fe2O3) layers arerelatively insoluble in acids The layer of scale nearest to the steel surface weacutestite (FeO) is generally partially decomposedand can be fairly readily removed provided acid can diffuse through the cracks in the brittle layers of magnetite andhaematite The acid attack is partly on the weacutestite layer and partly on the steel substrate this undermines the scale allowing itto become detached from the steel Hydrogen is produced during these reactions and this leads to the removal or lsquoblowing offof the scale during the process Rust is also removed during the pickling process but depending on its form and thicknessmay require longer pickling times than do many scales
Scale is not removed in even layers from the steel so where it is quickly lifted away the acid can attack the steelSometimes scales are readily removed whereas at other times the steel may need to be immersed in the acid for some timebefore it is fully descaled This could lead to an unacceptable level of attack on the steel itself To prevent this happeninginhibitors are used with the acids These may be organic or inorganic in nature
3261Inhibitors
Inhibitors are used to stop attack on the steel and to save unnecessary use of acid The attack on the steel is likely to belocalised producing surface pitting which may affect coating processes Furthermore such attack will be influenced by thesteel composition and the type of scale produced during processing so the addition of inhibitors adds a degree of control tothe pickling operation Inhibitors also reduce the amount of carbonaceous matter left on the steel surface
A wide range of organic inhibitors is marketed many under proprietary names The requirement is to reduce attack on the steelbut at the same time they must not slow down the pickling process to any marked extent If electroplating is to followinhibited pickling it may be necessary to clean the surface eg by an acid dip to remove traces of the inhibitor remaining onthe steel surface Inorganic inhibitors are not widely used for commercial pickling although they are used for laboratory de-rusting
Fig 314 Flame cleaning of steel
32 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
3262Hydrogen Embrittlement
A detailed discussion of hydrogen embrittlement is outside the scope of this book but a few points are worth noting Duringthe pickling process hydrogen is evolved and plays an important role in removing the scale Most of it is evolved as a gas butsome may diffuse into the steel in the atomic form This can lead to hydrogen embrittlement of the steel which as the nameimplies will affect the mechanical properties of the alloy With some steels this may result in actual cracking of the materialAdditionally the atomic hydrogen that has diffused into the steel may combine in voids to produce gaseous hydrogen whichsets up a pressure that may be sufficient to cause blistering of the steel Generally the effects can be ameliorated by suitableheat treatment but advice should be sought if high-strength or high-carbon steels are to be pickled
Although inhibitors reduce the amount of hydrogen evolved their presence in the acid solution does not necessarily reducethe likelihood of hydrogen embrittlement of the steels In fact some may increase the absorption of hydrogen
3263Pickling Procedures
Although the basic pickling process is simple in practice considerable control is required to ensure efficient and economiccleaning of steelwork Generally sulphuric acid is used for pickling structural steelwork although both hydrochloric(muriatic) acid and phosphoric acid are employed to some extent Hydrochloric acid may be preferred for the continuouspickling of steel strip because although it is usually more expensive than sulphuric acid the waste liquor can be removedmore cheaply Phosphoric acid is too expensive for use as the main scale-removing acid but may be used as a final treatmentto produce a thin iron phosphate coating on the steel This acts as a good basis for paint provided the phosphate layer is nottoo thick Thick phosphate layers have poor cohesive strength and can delaminate if a paint coating is applied over them socausing loss of adhesion
During pickling in a bath containing sulphuric acid iron is dissolved mainly from the steel itself and reacts with the acidto form iron salts eg ferrous sulphate (FeSO4) These salts influence the pickling procedures and tend to slow them downConsequently the acid must be discarded before it becomes saturated with the salts Steel must be washed after pickling toensure that such salts are removed Hydrochloric acid similarly produces chloride salts but these are more easily removedfrom the steel surface
The general procedure for acid pickling is as follows
(i) Removal of all grease oil etc by suitable solvent cleaning Heavy deposits should be scraped off before theapplication of the solvent
(ii) Removal of heavy deposits of rust scale and paint by suitable manual methods eg scraping (iii) Immersion of steel in a bath containing the acid with inhibitors at a suitable temperature For sulphuric acid a 5
(volume) solution is often used at a temperature of 75ndash80EacuteC(iv) After scale removal the steel is thoroughly rinsed or immersed in clean water(v) Where appropriate immersion in an aqueous solution containing inhibitors in suitable concentrations eg 075
sodium dichromate
Generally the pickling process is improved with agitation of the acid bath The Steel Structures Painting Council of America(SSPC) has published a specification for pickling lsquoSurface Preparation Specification No 8rsquo (Steel Structures Painting ManualVol 2 Steel Structures Painting Council Pittsburgh USA)
REFERENCES
1 Iron and Steel Institute Second Report of the Corrosion Committee Special Report No 5 1934 p 2452 Smuts J amp de Villeas PR J Iron Steel Inst 204 (1966) 787ndash943 Fancutt F Hudson JC Rudram ATS amp Stanners JF Protective Painting of Structural Steel Chapman and Hall London 1968
p 334 Chandler KA amp Reeve J J Oil and Colour Chemists Assoc 49 (1966) 464ndash765 Chandler KA Br Corros J 1 (1966) 264ndash66 Chandler KA amp Stanners JF Second International Congress on Metallic Corrosion NACE Houston 1966 pp 325ndash337 Morcillo M Feliu S Galvan JC amp Bastidas JM Some observations on painting contaminated rusty steel J Protective
Coatings and Linings (Sept 1987 ) 38ndash438 Morcillo M Hernandez LS Simancas J Feliu S Jr amp Gimenez S Underfilm corrosion of steel induced by saline
contaminants at the metalpaint interface J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 73 (1990) 24ndash30
SURFACE PREPARATION 33
9 Seavey M Abrasive blasting above 100 psi J Protective Coatings and Linings (July 1985) 26ndash3710 Mallory AW Description of centrifugal wheel (airless) blast systems Materials Performance 21(10) (1982) 15ndash2411 Recommended Practice Surface Preparation of Steel and Other Hard Materials by Water Blasting Prior to Coating or Recoating
National Association of Corrosion Engineers (NACE) Standard RP-01ndash7212 Evaluation of the Effectiveness of Wet Blast Cleaning Methods of Surface Preparation US Department of Transportation Maritime
Administration in cooperation with Avondale Shipyards New Orleans June 198513 Corrosion Control Engineering Joint Venture Task Group E5-1 The state of the art of wet abrasive blasting in the UK and offshore
(North Sea British Sector) Vol 4 no 2 Industrial Corrosion Journal 14 Borch EA Metallic abrasives Good Painting Practice Vol 1 Steel Structures Painting Council Pittsburgh15 Keane JD Bruno JA amp Weaver REF Survey of Existing and Promising New Methods of Surface Preparation Steel Structures
Painting Council Pittsburgh16 Testing and specifying slag abrasives for US Navy Shipyards J Protective Coatings and Linings (Aug 1985) 22ndash3317 Fong C Pollution-free blasting Paper presented at the NPCA 16th Annual Marine Coating Conference 197618 Sandwich CJ amp Briewik T High velocity ice particles for cleaning shipsrsquo hulls Paper presented at the 4th International Congress
of Marine Corrosion and Fouling 197619 Bleile H High energy light pulse techniques for cleaning structural steel Paper presented at the First World Congress on New
Coating Systems for Bridges 1981 University of Missouri Rolla
34 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
CHAPTER 4Paints and Paint Coatings
Paint is the material most commonly employed to protect steel although in practice the term lsquopaintrsquo covers many differentmaterials with a range of properties They are comparatively easy to apply with no limitation on the size of steelwork that canbe treated Furthermore paint coatings can provide a decorative finish to steel structures
There should be a clear differentiation between paints and paint coatings the former being the liquid material and the latterthe protective film on the steel surface Many of the advantages of paint can be lost during conversion of the liquid paint tothe dry protective coating eg by employing poor application techniques
Modern paints have been developed to provide improved properties however these improvements will be achieved onlyby careful attention to factors such as surface preparation paint application and selection of paints suitable for a specificsituation
41GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
The paint coating has to have certain properties such as reasonable hardening and the ability to be repainted but most of all itmust provide the protective properties required for the particular set of conditions to which it will be exposed The paintmaterial must also meet certain requirements including ease of application reasonably long storage life fairly quick dryingproperties and of course a suitable price
Paint basically consists of solid particles called pigments dispersed in a liquid When mixed and applied to steel the liquidpaint dries and binds the pigments into a coherent film hence the liquid is called the binder In practice as will be discussedlater paints generally contain additional substances to improve application and other properties
The binder provides the properties required to resist attack by the environment so it is generally the most importantconstituent of the paint Naturally occurring oils such as linseed oil were originally used as binders However they had anumber of disadvantages eg slow drying so a range of synthetic binders has been developed over the last 50 years Virtuallyall paints now used are totally or partially manufactured from synthetic materials
When oil was used as the only binder many painters mixed their own paints and there was no paint technology as we knowit The lack of knowledge of chemistry probably did not hinder the manufacture or use of paints to any extent However asorganic chemistry and in particular polymer chemistry developed the possibilities of producing a vast range of materialssuitable for use in both the solid and liquid form by using solvents became apparent
These binders with names such as alkyd epoxide and urethane have a range of properties and can be used without adetailed knowledge of their chemical structure Paint manufacturers supply data sheets which provide the basic informationnecessary to use the paints to the best advantage Nevertheless some broad understanding of the nature of paint isadvantageous because in the context of protection of steelwork from corrosion paint has what can be termed an lsquoengineeringdimensionrsquo Engineers are called upon to specify protective systems for structures and while they will usually seek advicethey acccept the final responsibility for deciding on the coatings to be used The costs of protecting large structures may ofcourse run into hundreds of thousands of pounds and some background knowledge of paint coatings must be considered asessential for specifiers
Unlike many engineering materials which are purchased in the finished form and can be tested to ensure that the propertiesare as specified paint coatings are applied by the user and this at least to some extent determines the final properties In thissense there are similarities with cement and concrete
The protective properties of coatings applied from a can of paint can vary depending on application procedures andcleanliness of the steel surface However it is not always by any means certain that paints with the same general descriptionwill in practice produce similar coatings even under the most carefully controlled conditions There are few Britishspecifications for paints other countries have many more standards and specifications for paints but within the overallrequirements of such standards it is possible to make paints varying quite considerably in properties In the final analysis the
performance in practice is the important property but this is virtually impossible to predict except in the most general wayFortunately paint companies have a vested interest in producing sound products but the broad generic terminology used forpaints may well confuse many specifiers There are no doubt good reasons for the overall lack of standards for paints inmany countries Nevertheless the generic terminology could be improved with certain minimum requirements regardingcomposition and properties Paint companies claim with some justification that this would lead to many of their competitorsproducing a product of lower quality which nevertheless would fall within the standard requirements Howeverimprovements could usefully be made because in some cases the generic terminology may give a false impression of theparticular paint being considered
42THE NATURE OF PAINT
As noted earlier paints are essentially a dispersion of solid particles (pigment) in a liquid These after application dry toprovide a protective film on the surface of the steel or in a paint system on the previously applied paint coating To achievethese requirements the paints must
(i) be capable of application under a specified set of conditions(ii) dry within a specified time limit
(iii) be able to provide the dry film with suitable properties of hardness gloss etc(iv) provide the necessary decorative requirements and(v) react with or lsquowetrsquo the surface so that the dry film adheres to the substrate
The dry film must also have a range of properties which include
(i) durability in the particular service environment(ii) protection of the steel from corrosion for a suitable period
(iii) formation of a coherent film that remains adherent to the surface(iv) physical properties capable of resisting impact and mechanical damage and(v) low permeability to moisture oxygen and corrosive ions eg those arising from sulphur dioxide (SO2) and sea salts
To achieve these requirements suitable pigments and binders are selected However certain properties such as applicationand drying may require additional constituents so the paint usually includes ingredients other than those that would ideallyappear in the final protective dry film
Some of the more common constituents in a paint are considered belowBinder This is the film former and contributes mainly to the durability of the paint coating and provides the necessary
mechanical and physical properties cohesion and flexibility It is also the factor that determines the adhesive qualities of thefilm It may vary from 20 to 50 by weight of the paint but will be a higher percentage of the dry film
Pigment This provides colour and opacity to the dry film It contributes to the hardness and abrasion resistance of the filmand reduces its permeability Also since pigments are generally inert to the effects of ultraviolet light their presence in apaint film reduces the degradation of the primer by sunlight For that reason binders without pigment ie varnishes have ashorter life outdoors than the comparable paint However the proportion of pigment to binder is a critical factor in paintformulation
Some pigments have a flake or lamellar shape and it is claimed that such pigments eg micaceous iron oxide may improvethe durability of the film Most pigments are inert but a few used in priming paints may have inhibitive properties Others mayreact in acidic or alkaline environments such reactive pigments can reduce the durability of the paint film
The percentage of pigment may vary from about 15 to 60 in the paint In zinc-rich paints the pigment may be over 90by weight in the dry film
Extenders These are similar to pigments they are also insoluble in the binder but have little or no opacity or colouringfunction They may be added as a form of cheap pigment but generally are used to modify the paint properties and are usuallypresent in comparatively small amounts
Solvent This is used to reduce viscosity to a level suitable for application It evaporates completely and plays no part in thedry film Although essential to ensure application it is preferably kept to as low a level as possible Solvents should evaporatecompletely in a reasonable time and hence play no part in the dry film Problems can arise if solvents become trapped in theprotective film
36 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
There may be 5ndash40 by weight in paint and the type used will depend upon the binder Some paints are lsquosolventlessrsquo butthese are not commonly used for structural steelwork (Thinners may be added prior to application but are not part of the paintcomposition)
Diluent These are volatile organic liquids which are not capable of dissolving the binder but which are added to improveapplication or to improve evaporation at a lower cost than by using true solvents The rate of evaporation of diluents andsolvents must be balanced to ensure that sufficient true solvent is always available during application Generally as muchdiluent as is practicable will be added because of the saving in cost
Driers These are generally salts of lead manganese and cobalt with suitable organic acids eg naphthenic acids used toaccelerate the drying of the oil portion of oleo-resinous alkyd and epoxy ester binders Usually they are present in smallquantities up to 1
Anti-skinning agents These prevent skin formation on the surface of paint in partially filled containers They act to inhibitoxidation and drying and generally being fairly volatile evaporate when the paint is applied to the steel
In some paints a thixotropic agent is added to control sagging of the paint and to allow application of coatings of highthickness (high-build paints) Binders pigments and solvents will be considered in more detail in later sections
421Paint Systems
Most paints do not provide protection to steelwork with a single coat of paint although it may be possible with some two-pack materials to build up very thick coatings in one application Generally however a number of coats are applied Thepaints used for the various coatings may be different and they will be considered below
4211Priming Coat
Strictly the priming coat is the one that is applied to the steel substrate but the term is generally used to indicate the types ofpaints that can be used for that purpose and sometimes two coats of primer are applied In some paint systems there is littledifference in composition between the primer and other coats but with most of the conventional one-pack paints an inhibitivepigment is used (see Section 471) The priming coat is the foundation for the whole system and must lsquowetrsquo the surface andhave good adhesive properties to the substrate
4212Undercoats
Although there may be no essential difference between the priming coat and undercoat in some paint systems the undercoatperforms a different role from the primer The pigments in undercoats are inert and the coating is used to build up the overallthickness of the system In oleo-resinous and alkyd systems its formulation is similar to that of the finishing coat although itdoes not have the same gloss properties It is advisable to use different tints if more than one undercoat is to be used in orderto ensure proper coverage
4213Finishing Coat
Sometimes called the lsquotopcoatrsquo or lsquoweather coatrsquo it serves to protect the system from environmental factors such asultraviolet light from the sun and provides the main abrasion resistance It also is where appropriate the decorative coatcontaining the pigments to impart the required colour In decorative systems it often provides an appearance of high gloss Insome systems to provide the required appearance it may be of a type of paint different from that of the rest of the system
Problems can arise when different types of binder are used within a paint system This is discussed in Chapter 13In the next section the mechanism by which paint protects steelwork is considered
43PROTECTION BY PAINT FILMS
Paint films protect in three general ways
(i) by insulating the steel from the environment (barrier coatings)
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 37
(ii) by inhibiting the attack on the steel substrate (inhibitive primers)(iii) by galvanic action (zinc-rich paints)
In all cases (i) is involved (ii) and (iii) may be involved with certain paint systemsThe corrosion mechanism for steel has been considered in Chapter 2 The overall reaction can be represented as
This can be divided into two reactions one producing electrons the anodic reaction and the other consuming electrons thecathodic reaction
The corrosion process can be prevented or retarded by suppressing either the cathodic or anodic reaction or by inserting a highresistance in the path of the corrosion current flowing in the electrolytic cell The cathodic reaction can be suppressed bypreventing the passage of oxygen and moisture to the steel It has been demonstrated by a number of workers that organicpaint films allow diffusion of sufficient water and oxygen to allow the steel substrate to rust at the same level as it would ifthe steel had not been painted1 2 3 It can therefore be concluded that paint films are too permeable for suppression of thecathodic reaction The anodic reaction can be suppressed by supplying electrons from an external source and so making thepotential of the iron sufficiently negative to prevent corrosion This is the basis of cathodic protection
431Zinc-rich Pigments
Polymers do not contain free electrons so cathodic protection will not operate unless there is sufficient metallic pigment inthe paint film capable of supplying the necessary electrons Zinc fulfils this role being less noble than iron However it mustbe present in sufficient concentration in the film to allow direct contact between the iron (or steel) and the zinc particlesAlthough zinc-rich paints act in this way in both organic and inorganic binders their effectiveness depends upon theconductivity of the electrolyte present at the surface Consequently this mechanism may operate when steel coated with zinc-rich paint is immersed in seawater but to a lesser extent if exposed in a fairly mild atmospheric environment Such coatingsact in a manner similar to but not as effectively as hot-dip galvanised zinc coatings and will protect the steel for a timewhere the paint is scratched or damaged
Although zinc-rich paints act to some extent to suppress the anodic reaction this is only a limited part of their functionoccurring in the early stages or if the paint film is damaged the suppression of the anodic reaction by this method is verylimited as a mechanism of protection
432Inhibitive Pigments
The anodic reaction can also be suppressed by the use of inhibitors Essentially solutions of certain salts and compoundscalled inhibitors act to passivate the anodic areas on the steel surface so reducing or preventing corrosion Some pigmentshave these inhibitive properties and are used in paints generally in the priming coat of systems used to protect steel in airThey are not usually employed for immersed paint systems The best-known inhibitive pigment is red lead which was at onetime widely used in oil-type paints It was very effective and red lead primers performed reasonably well on rusted surfacesThe method of inhibition was somewhat complex depending on the lead salts produced in linseed oil media There aredisadvantages with red lead in oil paints They are slow drying difficult to spray and toxic Consequently they are not nowwidely used Red lead pigments can also be used in non-oil media eg chlorinated rubber but are unlikely to provide thedegree of inhibition experienced in oil paints
Other inhibitive pigments based on salts of hexavalent chromium have also been widely used eg zinc chromateHowever these pigments also cause toxicity problems particularly in manufacture In view of the various toxicity problemsthat may arise with these pigments they have to a large extent been replaced by zinc phosphate This is also inhibitive butless effective than red lead or zinc chromate in many binders
38 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
433Barrier Coatings
Many paint systems do not contain either an inhibitive primer or a zinc-rich primer and it is therefore probable that they actto suppress corrosion because of their electrical resistance which impedes the movement of ions The water molecule is smalland can penetrate into organic coatings The moisture may be absorbed in the intermolecular spaces or pass through thecoating The moisture in the film tends to stabilise with the movement into the coating being balanced by evaporationConsequently the water content tends to be reasonably constant This absorption of water is not necessarily a serious problemThe electrical resistance remains at a level where the driving corrosion current is small This means that corrosion of the steelsubstrate is also low However this situation can change if ions such as chloride (Clcopy) or sulphate penetrate the paint filmbecause they will lower the electrical resistance
It has been shown that the rate of diffusion of ions is much lower than that for either oxygen or water Furthermorealthough it is probable that electrolytes such as sodium chloride (NaCl) can penetrate the film this tends to occur only wherethe density of cross-linking is low Nevertheless over a period of time the entry of ions will reduce the resistance of the filmand this will lead to corrosion and deterioration of the coating It is also possible that there is a degree of ion exchange asaggressive ions permeate through a paint film and some paint formulations have been developed to take this aspect intoaccount
Clearly if the film is able to prevent ingress of corrosive species it will protect the steel from corrosion However apartfrom diffusion processes through the molecular structure of the paint ingress of moisture and other corrosive elements mayoccur because of defects concerned with the physical and mechanical integrity of the film These may be related to theformulation of the paint the ageing process which is of course inevitable or the problems of applying some films to providea reasonably compact coherent film The effects of temperature variations may particularly on thicker films produce stressesthat lead to loss of adhesion or even cracking of the film Some coatings tend to retain solvent which as it slowly evaporatesfrom the film leaves small holes These small cavities may not always seriously affect the protective value of the film but insome cases it seems likely that they would increase the possibility of greater diffusion or take-up of corrosive species
Paint films may be influenced by osmotic effects Osmosis is the term used to describe the passage of water through a semi-permeable membrane when the solutions on either side of the membrane have different concentrations Water moves from theless concentrated solution to the one of higher concentration This may be a problem if there are salts on the steel surfaceunder the paint film particularly under immersed conditions or where a good deal of condensation occurs on the paint filmThe salts increase the concentration at the steel surface so increasing the movement of water through the paint film This canresult in blistering of the film The salts may arise from atmospheric deposits eg sodium chloride in marine environments orfrom sweat which may leave acidic salts on steel Salts may also be present on the steel surface as a result of corrosionprocesses particularly where steel is allowed to rust before cleaning
Work carried out by a number of investigators has demonstrated that rusts produced when steel corrodes in the atmospherecontain salts such as ferrous sulphate (FeSO4)4ndash6 If these remain on the surface after cleaning off the rust then they can affectthe life of the coating subsequently applied When manual methods such as wire-brushing and scraping are employed aconsiderable amount of adherent rust remains on the steel surface and this includes a comparatively large amount of FeSO4
(up to 5) However it might be assumed that after blast-cleaning all these salts would be removed This though is notnecessarily the case If before blast-cleaning steel has been allowed to rust to an extent where it is pitted then some saltformation in the small pits can be anticipated It may prove to be very difficult to remove these salts by blast-cleaning andeven if the steel surface meets the requirements of the various visual cleaning standards eg BS 7079 there may still be smallquantities of salts present These can sometimes be seen on the surface if viewed with a magnifying glass but cannot usuallybe detected by the naked eye
If such salts are present then because both oxygen and moisture are able to penetrate paint films corrosion reactions canoccur Mayne5 has suggested that salts such as FeSO4 short-circuit the resistance of the paint film and then become oxidisedand hydrolysed with the production of voluminous rust which can disrupt the paint film Other salts such as ferrous chloride(FeCl2) can act in the same manner and are likely to be found in marine environments
This mechanism of paint breakdown undoubtedly occurs when paints are applied to rusty surfaces Generally in thesesituations oleo-resinous and alkyd paints are used to a comparatively low film thickness (more resistant paints such as epoxieswould not usually be applied to rusted surfaces) The volume of the rust formed is sufficient to cause first blistering thencracking of the paint film
On blast-cleaned surfaces with such salt deposits the reaction may be stifled at the steel surface depending on a number offactors such as the following
(i) concentration of salts present(ii) distribution of the salts on the surface eg whether in small pits
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 39
(iii) type of paint applied to the surface(iv) thickness of coating(v) general standard of the coating eg pore-free no entrapped solvents etc
(vi) adhesion of coating to the steel substrate
A thick well-applied resistant coating with sound adhesion to the steel may still allow diffusion of oxygen and water inamounts capable of producing rust However the mechanical nature of the film will play an important role in determining thereaction at the surface Rust has a greater volume than the steel from which it is produced and in any confined situation suchas a crevice or under a paint film the course of the corrosion reaction will be determined by physical and mechanicalrestraints The rust can only form if certain conditions are fulfilled Either the rust as it forms exerts sufficient force to deformthe paint or once the rust has filled the voids present it will act to stifle further reactions On comparatively thin reasonablyelastic films the force will be sufficient to deform and eventually disrupt the coating On thicker well-adhering coatingshowever the force produced by rust formation may be insufficient to disrupt the protective film The main problem withcoating disruption from corrosion processes occurring on the steel surface is likely to arise when coatings are repainted Boththe quality of surface cleanliness and the standard of paint application are likely to be lower in such situations and there is agreater probability of coating breakdown leading to further corrosion
A discussion of protection by paint coatings would not be complete without considering the ageing effects on the coatingitself The physical changes that occur in the paint film may lead to deterioration sufficient to allow the ingress of variouscorrosive ions and a reduction in adhesion Although paint coatings are applied to suppress the corrosion of the steel they arenot themselves immune from attack in aggressive environments
Clearly the performance of the protective coating will be determined by its properties The more important of these areconsidered in the following section
44PROPERTIES OF PAINT FILMS
Specifications and standards for paints and paint coatings are very much concerned with their properties and a range of testshas been devised to check them Test methods are considered in Chapter 16
441Adhesion
Adhesion is of fundamental importance for any paint film Good adhesion to the steel surface is essential but sound adhesionbetween different coats of paint is also important Some of the many aspects to be considered have been discussed byMcGill7 Adhesion is influenced by both physical and chemical factors as discussed in Chapter 3
Blast-cleaning provides a roughened surface to the steel that helps to entrap paint in the surface irregularities Thisimproves adhesion particularly with thicker coatings but mechanical cleaning probably has an even greater influence on thesecondary forms of chemical bonding of paints to steel With increase in the overall surface area more potential points forbonding arise Furthermore the removal of rust and scale provides a clean steel surface which improves bonding with thepaint film
The standard of surface cleanliness has to be higher with two-pack materials than with the oil-type of paint Red-lead-in-oilpaint is particularly good for applying to rusted steel because it is slow drying and penetrating enough to lsquowetrsquo the surfaceHowever the fact that such paints are always brush-applied is probably an important factor Not only does this assist in theremoval and dispersion of small particles of dust and dirt it also leads to immediate contact between the paint and the surfacebeing painted Apart from the paint the surface to be painted will influence the adhesion All metals have some type ofsurface film On steel this is an oxide but this only forms well on a very smooth surface On blast-cleaned surfaces the oxidebecomes broken up On the other hand the oxide films on aluminium and stainless steel are much more coherent and maycause difficulties with adhesion Special etch primers are used on aluminium prior to painting and generally a slightroughening of stainless steel appears to improve adhesion The adhesion of paints to hot-dip galvanised steel surfaces oftenleads to problems and this is discussed in Section 73
Apart from oxide films moisture on the surface to be painted may also lead to poor adhesion The moisture film may not bevisible and may be only a few nanometres in thickness This may however be sufficient to reduce the close contact betweenthe paint and the steel Dirt and grease on the surface similarly influence adhesion In practice the effects of adhesion are notalways clear In the most extreme cases paints flake off but even when tests (see below) indicate comparatively pooradhesion the paint film may continue to provide sound protection There is probably an interaction between adhesion andother properties such as impact resistance However it seems reasonable to assume that high adhesion values are generally
40 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
advantageous especially in situations where there has been a local breakdown of the coating and the substrate has begun tocorrode The sideways attack on the substrate will probably be reduced if there is strong bonding between it and the paint
Adhesion is clearly an important property but it is also a somewhat qualitative matter It must be sufficient to ensure thatthere is no detachment of the film from the substrate but equally there is no experimental evidence of a clear relationshipbetween the degree of adhesion and the practical performance of paint films once the minimum required adhesion has beenachieved
A good deal of maintenance painting arises because of doubts about adhesion of paint films to steelwork rather than fromactual breakdown of the coating This can be an expensive operation with thicker coatings When an area of coating breakdownis cleaned by blast-cleaning prior to repainting it is commonly observed that a good deal of apparently sound paintwork canbe easily detached from the substrate at the edges of the cleaned area Consequently a considerable area of paint may need tobe removed to ensure a sound basis for repainting
Adhesion is still not very well understood and this is reflected in the test methods used to measure it and the lack ofprecision in determining the significance of the results8 Furthermore the influence of time and ageing of the film on its adhesiveproperties has not been clearly established The test methods for determining adhesion are discussed in Chapter 16
442Flexibility
Flexibility or the ability of a paint film to stretch without cracking is a measure of the degree to which a dry paint film is ableto withstand deformation of the surface to which it is attached This property is related to the elasticity of the film which istime dependent Furthermore it is affected by the level of adhesion between the paint and its substrate Good flexibility is anessential property for pre-coated steel sheet which is to be formed into profiles where the elasticity of the films may beimportant It is of less importance for paints applied to structural steelwork where the final complete paint system is appliedafter fabrication
The tests used to determine the degree of flexibility of paint films are broadly concerned with either bending round amandrel or measuring extensibility by deformation These tests measure partly adhesion and partly the brittleness of the filmand so in the hands of experts provide useful information regarding the overall properties of the film Brittle films are morelikely to crack when subjected to considerable temperature change and are more liable to be affected by abrasion or impactdamage
Flexibility can be introduced into polymers in various ways In cross-linked films any loosening of the structure by spacingthe cross-links to provide a more open pattern will improve flexibility The addition of plasticisers ie smaller molecules intolinear polymers also improves flexibility by separating the large polymer chains and allowing movement between them
443Hardness
Although the hardness of the paint films can be measured by various tests eg by indentation scratching etc it is not aproperty that can easily be defined in relation to the durability or performance of the paint film It is an important requirementfor stoved finishes of domestic appliances such as refrigerators and for car finishes but may have less relevance for paintsapplied to structural steelwork
Hardness can first be considered in relation to drying time where it is an important property so far as the handling andstorage of steelwork is concerned Soft films tend to be easily damaged and deformed during handling so a reasonably hardfilm is beneficial One of the main disadvantages of red-lead-in-oil paints is the very long time required to produce areasonably hard film Generally though modern polymer coatings dry reasonably quickly to provide acceptably hard filmsthe hardness of which may increase on prolonged exposure to a point where they become brittle Although hardness is oftenrelated to toughness and durability considered to be advantageous properties it may equally be considered in relation tobrittleness which may not be a desirable property
444Abrasion Resistance
Resistance to abrasion and erosion ie the wearing away of coats in a paint system by mechanical means may be ofparticular importance in some situations Obvious examples include environments where sand is blown about and industrialworks where particles of coke and other substances are wind blown Other situations include tanks in which abrasivematerials are stored and shipsrsquo hulls Abrasion resistance is related to other properties such as hardness and impact resistanceGenerally two-pack paints such as epoxies and hard coatings of the zinc silicate type are reasonably resistant to abrasion
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 41
445Permeability
The permeability of a paint film is the property concerned with its ability to absorb and release small molecules or ionsAlthough this is an important property it is difficult to relate it to practical experience It seems reasonable to suppose thathigh degrees of permeability would be disadvantageous and that impermeable films would provide maximum protectionThere is evidence to show that the pigment volume concentration (pvc) has a bearing on permeability Van Loo9 showed theimportance of pvc in his tests the permeability of the paint film rose markedly beyond what was termed the lsquocriticalpigment volume concentrationrsquo (cpvc) This varies with different paints but may serve to indicate how well the pigment ispacked with sufficient binder to maintain a coherent film If there are unfilled parts of the film ie insufficient binder thenthere will be interstices or pores which may provide paths for water to enter the paint film The rapid escape of volatilesduring film formation may also leave pores as may the release of solvents during drying of the film
Other work by one of the authors has indicated that the method of paint application may also influence permeability10
There is a difference between voids and pores which can be seen possibly with the aid of an optical microscope andmolecular paths available for ionic diffusion What might be described as physical paths can be measured by means of variousinstruments and can be detrimental to coating performance particularly under immersed conditions However the effects ofdiffusion paths at the molecular level are more difficult to quantify
The ability of a paint film to absorb moisture or to allow it to diffuse through it does not appear to relate particularly well toits performance as a protective coating For example in work carried out by a number of investigators1 2 3 it has beendemonstrated that the amount of water that can diffuse through paint films is greater than the amount that would be consumedby an unpainted steel specimen during the corrosion process Furthermore Gay11 found that under normal conditions paintfilms may be saturated with water for half their life It follows that permeability and diffusion of moisture through paint filmsdo not have the effect on their protective properties that might have been anticipated It must therefore be concluded thattests for permeability are of limited value in protective paints To some extent this is illustrated by the results of humiditytests which often cause intense blistering of paint films although this degree of blistering is not encountered in practice
Blistering of paint films can occur in two distinct ways (i) by the local accumulation of corrosion products under the filmwhich eventually leads to disruption by cracking and (ii) by the presence of water under the paint film at local sites There isnot complete agreement on the mechanism of water-formed blisters Some workers12 consider that they arise mainly fromosmotic effects caused by the presence of soluble salts in the film whereas others13 consider that it can be explained purely onthe basis of water penetration into the film causing swelling Generally water blisters are less of a problem than rust-containing blisters with paints applied to structural steelwork
446Resistance to Microorganisms
Attack by bacteria and other microorganisms can cause problems with protective coatings Microbiological attack may be aproblem and certain fungicides may be incorporated into paints These include organo-tin and organo-mercurial compoundsorganic copper compounds and chlorinated phenolics A number of papers have been published on this topic1415
447Ageing of Paint Films
Paint films have a limited life and require to be maintained The deterioration may be concerned with decorativerequirements eg loss of gloss or colour fading This must be considered as an inevitable effect of ultraviolet light and generalair pollution which does not necessarily seriously reduce the protective properties of the paint film On the other hand otherforms of deterioration have a marked influence on the protective nature of the coating These arise from changes in the paintfilm with time ie ageing or from corrosion of the substrate which disrupts the film Although these properties are importantit is almost impossible to predict them Experience gained in using similar coating materials in similar circumstances is theusual way of assessing such properties Various accelerated tests are used (Section 165) but generally they are not effective indetermining the overall properties required to determine durability15
This inability to predict performance except in the most general way is undoubtedly one of the main difficulties in bothselecting and specifying paints for a particular situation Most of the properties discussed in this section are capable ofmeasurement or assessment by various test methods However these test results may not provide clear data for longer-termperformance because of the ageing process
With the improvement in techniques apparatus and instruments it is to be hoped that the ageing properties of films will bemore fully investigated and understood so that reasonable assessments of performance can be made particularly with new
42 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
products Matters such as the changes in the visco-elastic nature of polymer films their ability to withstand stresses theeffects of such changes on adhesion and the causes of physical disruption all require further investigation
Paint films fail for a number of reasons and some can be avoided but others appear to be a natural result of the ageingprocess These limit the life of the paint film and often lead to problems in the repainting of the coating which may have to becompletely removed
45PAINT FILM FORMATION
The protective dry paint film is usually produced from a liquid paint consisting basically of binder pigment and solvent Thesolvent evaporates during drying and the binder is converted to a solid film The conversion occurs in different waysaccording to the type of binder Clearly the balance of pigment binder and solvent must be carefully controlled to ensure thatthe dry protective film achieves its main purposemdashto protect the steel from corrosion There may also be other requirementssuch as gloss and abrasion resistance The paint formulator must balance the paint constituents to ensure that all therequirements are achieved However even the best liquid paint may not convert to a sound protective coating if theapplication is poor It is essential that the paint manufacturersrsquo recommendations are followed to ensure that the conversionfrom liquid paint occurs in a manner that will provide a good protective film
46BINDERS
Most of the organic binders commonly used for protective paints can be classified into one of three broad groups dependingon the manner of film formation
(i) oxidation(ii) solvent evaporation
(iii) chemical reaction
Inorganic silicate binders fall into a special group and there are also binders which depend upon reaction with atmosphericmoisture for their film formation These do not strictly fall into any of the three groups above but will be considered underchemical reaction binders
(i) Oxidation Natural oils and binders combining oils and resins ie oleoresinous dry in this way They combine withoxygen in the air and dry to a hard film
(ii) Solvent evaporation Essentially resins are dissolved in suitable solvents which produces a liquid paint that can beapplied to a surface The solvent then evaporates leaving a dry film In practice a number of solvents may be used to ensurethat films with suitable properties are produced The paints that dry in this way include vinyls chlorinated rubber acrylatedrubber and bitumens
(iii) Chemical reaction Although oxidation is strictly a chemical reaction between the binder and atmospheric oxygen thisgroup covers binders where the reaction occurs within the binder Binders can be classified in other ways A broad groupingcovers those that change chemically during drying called convertible and those that do not react to produce changes callednon-convertible These are usually resins dissolved in a solvent which evaporates during drying so producing a protectivefilm which can be re-dissolved with appropriate solvents
Although paints are usually classified by the main binder(s) eg alkyd the pigmentation may be an important element sopaints with the same binder may vary in their properties Paints will be considered in Section 49 in this section binders willbe discussed briefly to indicate their general characteristics
461Oxidation Type
Oils such as linseed and tung dry to a solid film under ordinary atmospheric conditions Other oils such as castor oil do notdry The drying properties are related to the content and type of fatty acid These oils because they are able to form areasonably coherent dry film were among the first protective paints or varnishes to be used (a varnish may be considered asan unpigmented paint) The organic chemistry of such oils was not known and was not important to their use some centuriesago For many years paints were based on these oils extracted from the seeds and fruit of various types of vegetable matterand they are still used However oils are now more generally used in oleo-resinous paints in which the oil is mixed with otherresins The resins may react to provide larger molecules or depending on the resin chosen they may not actually react with the
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 43
oil at all but are added to improve the nature of the binder Phenolic resins are commonly used in oleo-resinous binders butothers such as coumorone-indene and rosin are also employed The chemical formulae will not be discussed here
Whereas oils can be applied without the use of solvents once resins are added solvents are required to reduce the viscosityof the paint The addition of resins tends to harden the film and improve the gloss Provided the resin does not contain estergroups it adds to the watermdashand chemical-resistance of the paint and generally improves durability The ratio of oil to resinweight is called the oil length 3ndash5 parts of oil to 1 of resin is called a lsquolong oilrsquo whereas a ratio of 05ndash15 of oil to 1 of resinis called a lsquoshort oilrsquo The length of oil determines whether the paint will be similar to an oil paint eg long oil or will bemarkedly influenced by the resin additions Many synthetic resins are produced for paint binders and these provide films withconsiderably improved properties compared with oleo-resinous paints These resins are called polymers
A polymer is a molecule composed of many smaller units linked by covalent bonds The polymer may be built from similaror dissimilar molecules joined together to form a very large molecule A monomer is the small molecule used as the startingpoint for the production of the polymer The many molecules are joined together to form long chains and the process bywhich the monomer molecules react is called polymerisation The most commonly used oleo-resinous binders used forconstructional steelwork are considered below
4611Tung Phenolic
These contain up to 70 natural oils with phenolic additions and chemically are the simplest of the oleo-resinous binders
4612Alkyds
Alkyds are condensation polymers of the reaction between dibasic acids ie having two carboxyl groups and dihydric alcoholsie having two hydroxyl groups In fact the name lsquoalkydrsquo derives from these two products alcohol and acid although thespelling has been changed In practice alkyds are generally produced from oil by converting it to a monoglyceride by heatingwith glycerol and then reacting with phthalic anhydride (a derivative of phthalic acid) Other polyhydric acids such aspentaerythritol can be used The organic formulae can be obtained from books on paint chemistry but are not important forthis particular discussion However by varying the reactants a range of different resins can be produced
Alkyds may be formulated with other binders to produce paints with special characteristics eg silicone alkyds andurethane alkyds
4613Epoxy Esters
These are made by esterifying the epoxy and hydroxyl groups with oil fatty acids to produce a binder more comparable withalkyds than two-pack epoxides A range of properties can be obtained by varying the amount of acid relative to the number ofreactive groups in the resin This can affect the drying time gloss and chemical resistance Epoxy esters are best comparedwith alkyds and should not be considered as epoxides in the usual way the term is used The epoxy ester binders have someadvantages over alkyds because whereas the alkyd is composed of ester linkages which are susceptible to attack by alkalisepoxy esters despite their name have a proportion of ether linkages and so are more resistant to alkalis The binder is usedfor priming and for undercoats for the protection of steelwork they are considered to have improved chemical resistancecompared with other oleo-resinous paints
462Solvent Evaporation Type
These are non-convertible binders
4621Chlorinated Rubber
Natural rubber has many properties including chemical and water resistance that would make it suitable as a coating forsteel However it does not provide satisfactory film-forming properties and if vulcanised cannot be dissolved in solventsNatural rubber will though react with chlorine to produce a solid which is called chlorinated rubber and is supplied as awhite or cream coloured powder which contains about 65 chlorine
44 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
This powder can be dissolved in a suitable blend of solvents to produce a paint However the films produced are brittle soa plasticiser is added in amounts varying from about 20 to 50 Suitable plasticisers include chlorinated paraffin waxes andchlorinated diphenyls both of which have a chemical resistance of the same order as the chlorinated rubber After suitablepigmentation the paints are applied and dry by simple solvent evaporation to produce a highly resistant dry film
Chlorinated rubber is soluble in esters aromatic hydrocarbons chlorinated hydrocarbons and some ketones The blend ofsolvents is determined by the required application method Often other additions are made and while these paints are stillcalled chlorinated rubber their properties are not necessarily the same as the true product For example to improve gloss andto allow for brush application additions of oils and alkyds may be made Alkyds improve adhesion and have been used toprovide what has been termed a lsquotravel coatrsquo to allow for more rapid handling and storage of chlorinated rubber coatedsteelwork
4622Vinyls
Polyvinyl chloride (PVC) powders are used for plastic coatings eg as a powder in a fluidised bed and as plastisolsHowever simple dispersion or dissolution in solvents is not a practicable way to produce air-drying paints at ambienttemperatures To provide a paint it is necessary to polymerise vinyl chloride with about 5ndash20 of vinyl acetate A range ofproducts can be produced with different viscosities and solvent characteristics Little if any plasticiser is required in thesebinders Copolymers of vinyl chloride and vinyl acrylate are also blended to provide binders As with chlorinated rubber vinylpaints solidify to the protective film by simple evaporation of the solvent
4623Acrylated Rubber
This binder is based on styrene butadiene and is produced in several grades some of which are based on white spirit Thebinder has only been produced commercially in the last ten years so there is limited experience of its use in paints
4624Bitumen
Bituminous coatings are still widely used to protect steelwork As film formers they fall into two distinct groups naturallyoccurring eg gilsonite which usually contain mineral matter and may be called asphalts (particularly in North America) andthose distilled from petroleum and coal products Pitches are produced from the distillation of tars and fall within the samegroup
Generally the materials are used in a suitable solvent for ease of cold application or are hot-applied They may be lsquoblownrsquoie oxidised by blowing air through molten bitumen to form materials that provide tougher films
463Chemically Reacting Type
These binders dry or lsquocurersquo by chemical reaction between different components which are mixed before the paint is applied
4631Epoxy
Epoxy resins are usually made by reacting dimdashor polyhydric phenols with epihalohydrins The phenol used commercially isone called bisphenol-A and the epihalohydrin used is generally epichlorhydrin The reactions are complex and will not beconsidered here However the properties of epoxides arise from their structure
(i) There are no ester groups so the resin does not saponify(ii) The chains have many polar groups leading to good adhesion
(iii) The large number of aromatic rings contributes to their hardness
The structure also leads to disadvantages because epoxides are not soluble in the cheaper types of solvent and they are notcompatible with many other binder materials
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 45
Epoxy resins are produced with a range of melting points and molecular weights and include those that are liquid atambient temperatures These serve as the basis for solvent-free application When used at ambient temperatures epoxideresins are cured by the addition of amines or polyamides The curing agent is stored separately from the epoxide and mixedjust before application of the paint in suitable proportions After mixing there is a limited period during which it can be usedie before the paint hardens in the can This is called the lsquopot lifersquo and varies usually being between 2 and 8 hours but can beless Instead of using the amine an amine-adduct may be preferred The amine and epoxide are partially reacted beforehandand this provides some advantages The amounts of adduct and epoxide are often similar so the mixing is simpler and moreaccurate furthermore the adduct is less of a skin irritant than the amine and generally the films produced have improvedproperties Polyamides are also used as curing agents and have some advantages over amines They are cheaper and themixing ratios are less critical than with amines The films produced are more water resistant but are softer and exhibit lessresistance to chemical attack and to solvents The advantage of longer pot life is to some extent outweighed by the longercuring times required with polyamides
Isocyanates may be used to cure coal-tar epoxides These are modified epoxides containing 50ndash70 of coal-tar pitchesThis serves to produce a cheaper coating with many of the advantages of unmodified epoxides with better water-resistanceThey are inevitably black or dark brown in colour so are not suitable where appearance matters Coal-tar epoxides are widelyused for immersed conditions particularly in seawater
4632Polyurethanes
Polyurethanes are produced by reacting organic isocyanates with the hydroxyl groups of polyols usually polyesters There area number of different products within the overall term lsquopolyurethanersquo and this can lead to some confusion
There is a range of two-pack materials in which the two components are mixed in the correct proportions before use and aresomewhat similar to the two-pack epoxies in their properties producing tough abrasion-resistant coatings Variations in theformulation provide a range of finishes from high gloss to semi-matt in a wide choice of colours Two-pack urethane pitchesand coal-tar urethanes are also produced and are used for similar purposes to the coal-tar epoxies Generally the type ofcuring agent influences the physical rather than the chemical-resistant properties
Single-pack materials are also produced in which free isocyanate groups react with moisture in the air to provide a cross-linked polymer structure These are often termed lsquomoisture-curing polyurethanesrsquo Urethane alkyds sometimes calledurethane oils are similar to alkyds and do not fall within the category of chemical curing binders
4633Other Binders
(a) Silicates All the binders considered so far have been organic whereas silicates are inorganic While paints based onsilicates are used for painting plaster and similar surfaces so far as the protection of steelwork is concerned the only paint tobe considered is zinc silicate
The chemistry of zinc silicate coatings is complex and a number of papers have been written concerning the mechanismsinvolved1617 In simple terms the binders consist of zinc dust mixed in a silicate solution which on curing cements the zincparticles into a hard dry film The silicate solution may be produced from a range of silicate materials including sodiumpotassium and lithium silicates with the addition of suitable solvents either watermdashor organic-based The solvent evaporatesafter application and reactions with moisture and carbon dioxide in the air occur
As with zinc metal eg hot-dip galvanised coatings some carbonic acid is formed which reacts with zinc to form zinccarbonate and the weakly acidic moisture assists in hydrolysing the organic silicate to silicic acid The zinc then reacts withthe silicic acid to form a somewhat porous coating which as reactions continue forms into a cement-like matrix around thezinc particles The initial pores are filled with zinc hydroxides and carbonates to produce a fairly compact hard coating Inpractice the silicate alkalinity is neutralised either by reaction with the carbonic acid formed from the atmosphere as alreadynoted or by using post-curing solutions
In the process considered above alkali silicates were the basis of the silicate solution and these are of course inorganicHowever similar reactions are possible using alcohol solutions of alkyl silicate esters eg ethyl or isopropyl silicates inorganic solvents Sometimes the two types of coating are referred to as inorganic and organic silicates but the final film isinorganic because the organic silicate hydrolyses and the alcohols evaporate leaving the silicic acid to form a cement matrixas with inorganic solutions
The above coatings are formed from two-pack materials but single-pack zinc silicates are also produced These involvevarious routes including ester exchange reactions with various types of silicates eg alkyl to produce similar reactions to
46 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
those already discussed18 However such films are not completely inorganic and generally do not possess the equivalentproperties of the two-pack materials
(b) Silicones Silicone resins have high-temperature resistance properties and are mainly used in paints for that purposeWith suitable pigmentation usually aluminium such paints will withstand temperatures up to about 250EacuteC
Some of the advantages of silicone which is an expensive resin can be obtained by modifying it with other bindersparticularly alkyd to produce silicone alkyd binders Provided they contain over 30 silicone they produce higher glossretention and improved durability particularly in resisting intense sunlight compared with alkyd binders
47PIGMENTS
Although the binder determines the main characteristics of a paint pigments also influence durability and other properties Thechemistry of pigments and their properties in relation to the formulation and manufacture of paints is beyond the scope of thisbook Apart from certain pigments for primers and micaceous iron oxide in finishing coats paints are generally categorisedand specified by binder However so far as the production of suitable and satisfactory paints is concerned pigments areimportant Typical properties include the provision of colour improvement of the strength of the film reduction of filmpermeability and improvements in adhesion However there are two prime requirements of pigments They must be insolublein the other constituents of the paint and they must not chemically react with them Furthermore there must be sufficientpigment in the paint to achieve the required properties The mere presence of for example red lead in a priming coat ormicaceous iron oxide in a finishing coat is not sufficient it must be present in the correct quantity to meet the particularrequirements The relative amount of pigment and binder in the paint is important Although this relationship was at one timeexpressed in terms of weight of pigmentvolume of paint it is now recognised that the volume concentration is more importantand this is expressed as the pigment volume concentration or pvc
A critical pvc (cpvc) which provides the particular properties for a specific product is an essential element in paintformulation Many of the pigments used are basically to provide colour whereas others serve other purposes concerned withthe protective qualities of the paint film The latter class will be considered below
471Inhibitive Pigments
Some pigments used in priming coats have inhibitive properties At one time a range of such pigments was available butmost have some toxic properties and are tending to be barred by many authorities However many are still used so will beconsidered below
Red lead in sufficient quantity in an oil medium eg paints produced to BS 2523 is the best pigment for protectiveprimers for rusty steel However it is slow drying and toxic It is unlikely to be as effective in non-oil media eg chlorinatedrubber because the inhibitive properties arise from reactions with oil
Zinc chromate is less widely used nowadays It relies on the solubility of the pigment for its inhibitive effect and isavailable to provide different degrees of solubility Blistering may occur with some pigments For blast primers a low-solubility pigment is used It may be combined with red oxide to provide a cheaper pigment for some priming paints
Metallic lead has been used mainly in paints for bridges It is quicker drying than red lead and effective in primers It is notwidely used nowadays because of its toxicity
Calcium plumbate has been used mainly as a pigment in oil-type primers for galvanised zinc surfaces The specification iscovered in BS 3698 It is toxic and very reactive with acids and may affect paints applied over it eg alkyds because of itsalkalinity
Zinc dust is used with zinc oxide as a primer but its widest use is as a pigment for zinc-rich and zinc silicate paintsProvided it is present in the dry film in sufficient concentration (over 90) it provides a measure of cathodic protection
Zinc phosphate is considered as an inhibitive pigment and because of problems of toxicity with many other pigments is nowthe most widely used Its effectiveness may be influenced by the type of binder used
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 47
472Other Pigments
Red oxide or iron oxide is used in priming paints but only for cheapness as it has no inhibitive properties because of itscolour it may mask rust staining It strongly absorbs ultraviolet radiation
Micaceous iron oxide (MIO) is widely used particularly in the UK for undercoats and finishing coats The lamellar formof this pigment tends to form parallel to the surface with overlapping of individual flakes it is claimed that this providesincreased durability to paint films by reducing their permeability and increasing their tensile strength
The pigment is found naturally in various places around the world and although chemically similar there are significantdifferences in the pigment shape From many of the sources the pigments are not lamellar and therefore impart differentproperties to the final paint film The Austrian source claims to produce the most lamellar form The pigment is grey so onlydark colours are possible in the paint film Modifications to provide other colours eg green render the pigment less effectiveas regards durability Paints containing MIO tend to weather to produce a metallic lustre and are not considered as decorativecoatings
For many years attempts have been made to produce MIO synthetically Now an entirely new process has been developedin the UK The method uses scrap iron as the main raw material In a single-stage batch process lamellar crystals of very pureiron oxide are formed at elevated temperatures by the oxidation of molten iron complexes By adjusting reaction parametersthe crystal size and aspect ratio of the particles can be varied It is possible to produce flakes so thin that they are semi-transparentwith a pink pearlescent appearance or the particle dimensions can be matched closely to the best natural MIO (see Fig 41)19
Outdoor exposure tests have shown an improved performance when compared with the same paints formulated with thenatural material This is presumably due to the fact that the synthetic MIO is free from such contaminants as sulphurcompounds which may be present in the natural material
Aluminium pigment is produced in two forms leafing and non-leafing The leafing property depends upon a thin layer ofstearic acid on the pigment surface and this causes the flakes to lie close to the surface of the paint and by overlapping givean almost continuous bright metallic finish The pigment also improves the performance of paints under atmosphericconditions particularly as regards the effects of sunlight The non-leafing pigment is widely used to lighten the colour ofpaints made from dark pigments such as micaceous iron oxide However aluminium is amphoteric and so is attacked by bothacid and alkali and therefore paints incorporating either type are not resistant to chemical attack
Other lamellar pigments such as glass flake and stainless steel are used in protective paints to a limited extent Stainlesssteel pigments do not provide the paint with any of the qualities of the alloy and act purely as barrier pigments Graphite isalso used for heat-resistant paint White pigments such as titanium dioxide (rutile) are inert and are widely employed inundercoats and finishing coats
Fig 41 SEM photomicrograph of synthetic micaceous iron oxide pigment
48 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
473Extenders
These are not strictly pigments but are used to modify the paint properties andor as a form of cheap pigment They will not bediscussed here but include materials such as barytes (BaSO4) blanc fixe (BaSO4) talc and china clay
48SOLVENTS
Solvents are not a useful constitutent of the dry protective film and so may be considered as adding unnecessarily to the costof paints Certainly a lsquohigh solidsrsquo content is desirable but solvents are essential for the sound application of most paintcoatings A careful balance between viscosity and volatility is required so that paints can be satisfactorily applied by therequired method but at the same time avoid settlement of pigment in the can during application and ensure that the paint onceit reaches the steel surface quickly achieves stability For high-performance paint systems a blend of solvents is normallyused to give the range of properties required The blend has to be suitable for the appropriate ambient conditions andformulations for temperate climates may not be suitable for hotter or colder climates
The rate of evaporation of solvent from the applied paint film during the drying period may affect the properties of the finalcoating Although solvents can evaporate readily in the early stages of film drying at later stages the rate is controlled by theability of the solvent to diffuse through the modules in the binder If solvent evaporates too slowly it may be trapped in thefilm causing soft films on the other hand too rapid evaporation can lead to defects in the final dry film Generally onlysufficient solvent to ensure satisfactory application should be used in the paint
Some of the solvents commonly used in paints are listed belowAliphatic hydrocarbons such as white spirit are commonly used for oleoresinous paints and have a high flash point (41EacuteC)
and high threshold limit value (TLV) of about 500 ppm (TLV is an indication of the safe concentration in the air for workersin the vicinity of such solvents)
Aromatic hydrocarbons such as xylene and toluene are stronger solvents than the aliphatic materials with a lower TLV ofabout 200 ppm The flash point of xylene is about 30EacuteC Generally their odour is more pronounced than that of white spirit
Ketones include methyl ethyl ketone (MEK) with a TLV of about 200 ppm and a low flash point below 0EacuteC Methylisobutyl ketone has a higher flash point (19EacuteC) but a lower TLV generally these are strong solvents and are a potential firerisk They are used for epoxies and urethanes
Esters such as butyl acetate are more expensive than ketones but have a higher flash point (32EacuteC) and a similar TLV Alcohols such as ethanol are less of a hazard than many other solvents with a TLV of about 1000 ppmTurpentine once the common solvent for oil paints is rarely used having been replaced by the cheaper white spirit
49PAINT CLASSIFICATION(see Fig 42)
Paint properties are determined mainly by the type of binder As discussed in Section 46 there are three main groups oforganic binder based on the method of film formation
It is convenient to consider the paints in groups based on the type of binder because many of the properties of paints withinthe group will be similar
491Oil-based and oleo-resinous paints (oxidation drying)
All the paints in this group contain drying oils and this determines many of the propertiesOil paints Oil paints ie those without combined resins are rarely used nowadays As a group they had advantages
particularly when most steel was merely wire-brushed and painted on-site However with modern application methods theseare outweighed by the disadvantages The best known paint in this group is red lead in oil (BS 2523 Type B) which was atone time widely used as an effective primer for rusty steelwork
ADVANTAGES
(i) Particularly effective as primers for rusty steelwork provided they contain an inhibitive primer(ii) Easily overcoated
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 49
(iii) Easily applied particularly by brush(iv) Good wetting properties(v) Relatively cheap
DISADVANTAGES
(i) Very slow drying so not really suitable for painting at works(ii) Poor resistance to alkalis and acids and not suitable for cathodic protection
(iii) Not recommended for immersed conditions(iv) Embrittle with age
Fig 42 Paint classification chart
50 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
Oleo-resinous paints The combination of oil with synthetic resins improves many of the properties compared with oil paintsbut they still suffer many of their disadvantages Consequently they are not generally used for very aggressive or immersedsituations but are the most widely used paints for the protection of steelwork in a range of environments
The three most commonly used paints in this group are
alkydtung oil phenolicepoxy ester
Alkyds are often modified to produce paints such as silicone alkyds urethane alkyds and vinyl alkyds All fall within thegroup but tend to be used for specialised situations
ADVANTAGES
(i) Ease of application(ii) Many paints in the group provide a range of colours and good gloss
(iii) Reasonable durability in many atmospheric situations(iv) Usually can be overcoated without difficulty(v) Cheaper solvents such as white spirit can be used
(vi) Generally reasonably cheap
DISADVANTAGES
(i) Because of their oil content they saponify under alkali conditions so cannot be used for example where steel iscathodically protected
(ii) Not recommended for immersed or very damp conditions(iii) Limited film thickness (25ndash50 Uumlm per coat)(iv) Poor resistance to solvents
Alkyds For steelwork the long oil type of alkyd is used Their main advantages are cost and good appearance Available in arange of colours they maintain their gloss well and are particularly suitable as decorative coatings They provide reasonableprotection in less aggressive atmospheric situations but are not particularly resistant to continuously damp conditions and arenot recommended for immersion
Urethane alkyds provide a harder tougher filmSilicone alkyd paints are a good deal more expensive than ordinary alkyds but more durable particularly in strong sunlight
and retain their gloss well They are not widely used but are specified for many highway bridges in the UKThe paints noted above are those commonly used but it is possible to make an almost unlimited number of modifications to
produce different types of binder eg alkyds can be modified with phenolic vinyl chlorinated rubber styrene and acrylicGenerally the paints tend to provide properties somewhere between those of the component parts Sometimes they areproduced for specifie purposes eg chlorinated rubber-alkyd paints have been used as primers for a chlorinated rubber basedsystem or as lsquotravel coatsrsquo to avoid damage during handling of chlorinated rubber systems which tend to remain soft for sometime after application Again this alkyd modification is more easily brushed often the modified paint dries more quickly egstyrenated alkyds
Epoxy ester These have the same order of resistance as alkyds although having rather better water resistance They areconsidered to have some advantages over alkyds particularly under adverse drying conditions Some authorities claim that anadvantage of these paints is their quick-drying properties which makes them eminently suitable for primers However thismay depend on the nature of the formulation
Tung phenolics These have better chemical resistance than either alkyd or oil paints and dry faster They tend to be ratherdark in appearance and become darker on exposure They produce hard paint films so there is a limit on the overcoating timeif intercoat adhesion problems are to be avoided They can be used for some immersed conditions and are more resistant thanmost other oleo-resinous paints to humidity their gloss retention is poorer than that of alkyd paints
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 51
492Solvent Evaporation Paints
The two paints in this group most commonly used for structural steelwork are chlorinated rubber and vinyl Bituminouscoatings fall within this group but they are not comparable in performance with the other paints in the group
These paints are one-pack materials with a number of advantages over both oleo-resinous and chemically reacting paintsThey are sometimes called one-pack chemical-resistant paints
ADVANTAGES
(i) Provide protection in aggressive environments where oleo-resinous paints do not perform particularly well(ii) Suitable for immersion and damp conditions
(iii) Easily re-coated(iv) Good resistance to many acids and alkalis suitable for cathodically protected steelwork(v) Available in a range of colours but not high gloss
(vi) One-pack materials This is an advantage compared with two-pack chemical reaction coatings often used as alternativesto these coatings
(vii) Although high quality cleaning of the steel surface is always advisable paints in this group are likely to perform betterthan two-pack materials on poorly prepared surfaces
DISADVANTAGES
(i) A limit on temperature resistance generally a maximum at 60EacuteC for continuous heat(ii) Dark colours not always suitable for high temperatures overseas
(iii) Not resistant to most solvents(iv) High solvent content of paints (typically 60ndash75) may cause problems with solvent entrapment or removal of solvent in
enclosed spaces
4921Chlorinated-Rubber Paints
Chlorinated-rubber powders are available in a range of viscosities The higher-viscosity powders are generally considered toprovide better film properties but the lower-viscosity ones are used for thicker films and there are advantages in using paintsproduced from the two viscosity grades in a chlorinated-rubber paint system The lower viscosity powders can be used forundercoats to provide sufficient film thickness with the higher viscosity materials being used to provide a durable finishingcoat
The paints have excellent chemical resistance and low water permeability Although they require high-quality surfacepreparation for exposure to aggressive environments because of their solvent nature they are somewhat more tolerant toinadequate surface preparation than are the two-pack materials These paints are more effectively applied by spray than brushalthough brushing grades are normally available these are generally modifications and require special brushing techniquesIdeally brush application should be confined to small areas
Suitable non-saponifiable plasticisers are required and provided the correct quantities are incorporated into the paint adhesionto the steel is good and a high level of durability can be attained The addition of too much plasticiser can result in softeningat high ambient temperatures Solvent retained in the film can act as a plasticiser with the same results as adding too much onthe other hand insufficient plasticiser can cause films to become brittle on ageing Some plasticisers tend to slowly evaporateso that during exposure films may become brittle This is particularly so for elevated temperatures and no chlorinated-rubbersystem should be used on surfaces continuously above 60EacuteC In hot climates which may not appear to reach suchtemperatures dark colours in particular have been known to fail rapidly sometimes even with the evolution of hydrochloricacid as a degradation product
Problems can arise when these paints are sprayed if the viscosity is not right then what is termed lsquocobwebbingrsquo may occurThe term is self-descriptive indicating the difficulty of applying a sound paint film Solvent entrapment may also take placeleading to what is called lsquovacuolesrsquo in the dry paint film ie small pores or holes
Although chlorinated rubber dries to the touch fairly quickly retained solvent and the comparatively soft nature of the filmsin the early stages after application can lead to problems with handling and stacking The soft films tend to stick togetherwhich seriously damages the coating This can be overcome by ensuring that the paint is fully dried and by handling andstacking sections with some care
52 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
Maintenance is comparatively straightforward because the solvent in the paint allows for excellent adhesion betweencoatings Chlorinated-rubber paints are not particularly resistant to many solvents or oils
Care must be taken when welding steelwork that has been coated with chlorinated rubber because if the temperaturereaches a certain level acid decomposition products can cause attack on the steel at some distance from the actual weld
The pigments used in the primers of these paints are similar to those used in oleo-resinous paint eg red lead metallic leadand zinc phosphate It is questionable whether they act inhibitively in chlorinated-rubber binders Brush application isrecommended for the lead-based pigments zinc dust is also used and one-pack zinc-rich paints can be produced althoughthey are unpopular with paint manufacturers because the liquid paint if it absorbs any moisture turns into a gel This makesthe paint more sensitive to manufacturing conditions and makes its storage properties poor
Undercoats and finishing coats are usually pigmented with titanium dioxide(rutile) and a range of colours can be producedalthough high gloss is not obtained Micaceous iron oxide is also used where colour is not of prime importance
Chlorinated rubber paints are widely used for chemical marine and other environments They are resistant to many acidsand alkalis and being one-pack paints are easier to apply than two-pack materials There are no intercoat adhesion problemswith chlorinated rubber paint systems and no strict time limits on overcoating They are sometimes applied to two-packepoxies to provide easier maintenance
4922Acrylated-Rubber Paints
These paints are somewhat similar to chlorinated-rubber paints but they are claimed to have improved properties and do notfor example suffer from lsquovacuolesrsquo
4923Vinyl Paints
These have something in common with polyvinyl chloride (PVC) These paints have similarities to chlorinated rubber andalso dry by solvent evaporation They are superior to chlorinated rubber in their ability to resist solvents but are still attackedby many of the stronger ones including esters ketones and aromatic hydrocarbons such as xylene They are less tolerant ofinadequate surface preparation especially surface moisture than chlorinated rubbers but are more tolerant than the two-packmaterials When the paints are blended in appropriate proportions little if any plasticiser is required and this can beadvantageous because plasticisers can cause problems (cf chlorinated rubber)
Generally vinyl systems have a higher gloss than chlorinated rubber systems However they are more sensitive to surfacemoisture which can affect their adhesion to steel To improve adhesion a maleic-modified primer is commonly used Thepigments used for vinyl paints are similar to those for chlorinated rubber
Provided attention is paid to application (which may require somewhat more control than with chlorinated-rubber paints)vinyls are usually more durable Generally they are used for similar applications as chlorinated rubber and are often preferredto them in North America
For seawater immersion some authorities consider that a wash primer should be applied before application of the full vinylsystem Wash primers such as those based on polyvinyl butyral resins combined with phosphoric acid and some phenolic toimprove moisture resistance fall into the category of vinyl coatings They are also called etch primers and pretreatmentprimers Apart from their use with paint systems they are also used to prepare a galvanised surface for painting Howeverthey are susceptible to the presence of moisture during drying Vinyls can be modified with other binders such as alkyds andsuch paints are reasonably durable in all but the most aggressive environments and can be applied by brush Furthermore theyare not so sensitive to surface conditions during application
Vinyl tars Combinations of selected coal tars and vinyl resin can be used in many of the situations where coal-tar epoxies areused (Section 4932) but are cheaper and easier to apply However they cannot be applied to the same thickness as epoxiesso a multi-coat system is required They are generally not so durable as the epoxies
4924Bituminous Coatings
These can be considered as comparatively cheap one-pack chemical-resistant paints although they can only be used in alimited number of situations They should not be confused with the hot-applied coatings used for buried and submergedpipelines which are usually very thick and are not normally considered as paints There are however other thinner coatingsthat are used in the same way as paints and are sometimes called black paints (tar-based) as in BS 1070 They are solventbased and after application the solvent evaporates leaving a bituminous coating
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 53
They are quite useful as coatings for immersed conditions although coal-tar epoxies provide a greater durability Underatmospheric exposure conditions bituminous coatings are liable to crack and sag in hot weather They also exhibit a form ofcoating defect called lsquoalligatoringrsquo where the bituminous coating contracts from the steel surface Bituminous paints are notusually pigmented and so are black or dark brown but the addition of aluminium flake improves both the durability andappearance under atmospheric exposure conditions In tests aluminium-pigmented bituminous coatings have performed welland it is somewhat surprising that they have not been used to a greater extent for industrial situations One possible reason isthat many paint manufacturers are reluctant to manufacture such materials because of the possibility of contaminating otherpaints being made at the same time They therefore tend to buy-in items from the specialist manufacturer
493Chemical Reaction Paints
These are two-pack materials based on epoxies and urethanes They are not commonly used for general structural steelworkexposed inland but are widely used for severe marine situations off-shore structures and shipsrsquo hulls They are the most durableof all site-applied coatings but application requires careful control if the full potential of such coatings is to be attained
ADVANTAGES
(i) Durable coatings resistant to seawater many chemicals solvents and oils(ii) Can be applied to provide a much thicker coating than is possible with other types of paint
(iii) Do not saponify under alkaline conditions
DISADVANTAGES
(i) More expensive than other paints(ii) The majority are two-component materials requiring more control over mixing and application
(iii) A high standard of surface preparation is required(iv) Maintenance painting is more difficult than with most other paints Generally old surfaces need to be abraded(v) After mixing there is limited time during which paint can be applied
(vi) Coating cure is temperature dependent and problems may arise particularly at low temperature
Despite these disadvantages the paints in this group prove to be the most suitable coatings for very aggressive situationsHowever these coatings will only realise their full potential in situations where surface preparation application etc are of ahigh standard If these standards cannot be met then alternative coatings should be considered Because two components aremixed to produce these materials the term lsquopot lifersquo is used to indicate the length of time available before the paint is nolonger suitable for application The component added to polymerise the paint is sometimes called a catalyst although this isnot a correct description More suitable terms are curing agent hardener or additive
4931Epoxies
These are two-component materials and require mixing prior to application The reaction to produce the dry film istemperature and time dependent
Epoxies are available in a range of materials from liquids to solids depending on their molecular weight The chemistryinvolved in polymerisation is fairly complex but basically the hardening agent reacts with groups in the resin to produce a filmsuitable for its purpose as a protective coating As various curing agents can be used so a range of different epoxy coatingscan be produced
For coatings to protect steelwork two main types of curing agents are used polyamides and polyamines The former aremore commonly used and their properties and uses can be summarised as follows
Polyamide curing
(i) Generally the two components are of similar volume making mixing less critical(ii) Slow curing at low temperatures does not cure below 5EacuteC
(iii) Longer pot life than with polyamines(iv) More flexible and durable than polyamines cured epoxies take longer to cure
54 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
(v) Excellent alkali resistance but poorer acid resistance than polyamines(iv) Less tendency to lsquobloomrsquo
Polyamine-cured epoxies are generally used for specialist purposes such as tank linings Their overall properties aresummarised below
Polyamine curing
(i) Excellent chemicalmdashand corrosion-resistant properties(ii) Good solvent resistance better than polyamides
(iii) Excellent alkali resistance(iv) Good water resistance(v) lsquoChalkrsquo badly on atmospheric exposure
(vi) Can form amine lsquobloomrsquo when coatings applied at high humidities if this is not removed poor intercoat adhesion mayoccur
(vii) Amines may cause skin irritation during handling(viii) The mixing ratios are more critical than with polyamides
Amine-adduct curing The amine is partially reacted with the epoxy beforehand This provides some advantages because themixing ratio is simpler so less control is required Furthermore the adduct is less of a skin irritant
Isocyanate curing This is sometimes used for curing at low temperatures down to 0EacuteC A short pot life of 15ndash2 hours anda tendency for film embrittlement on ageing are disadvantages
Epoxies provide hard durable films although they tend to chalk fairly readily They must be applied to steel that has beenblast-cleaned to at least ISO Standard Sa2auml Primers may be pigmented with zinc phosphate or zinc dust Provided the lattergives a suitable concentration of pigment in the dry film then the paint is a zinc-rich type In many situations primers as suchare not used undercoats sufficing for application to the steel Often solvent additions are made to the undercoat producing acoating material that will lsquowetrsquo the steel surface when it is used as a primer Undercoats and finishing coats are pigmentedwith titanium dioxide (rutile) and colouring pigments to provide a full range of colours Micaceous iron oxide pigments canalso be used Aluminium is sometimes added as a pigment but this is not recommended for exposure to chemicalenvironments
Epoxy paints are widely used for offshore structures and for other aggressive and chemically polluted situations They aresometimes employed in less aggressive environments for long-term protection but maintenance is not always astraightforward matter with these paints They produce hard films which tend to harden further on ageing This generallyresults in difficulties with the adhesion of maintenance coatings unless the old epoxy coating is roughened eg by light blast-cleaning before repainting
Epoxies generally contain suitable solvents and are applied by spraying Solventless materials are also used and are sprayedusing a special two-component hot airless spray Solventless products are available for spraying at ambient temperaturesHigh-film-thickness coatings can be applied by Solventless application eg 300 micro m to over 1 mm
A greater measure of skill is required for epoxy coating than for onepack materials Mixing of the two components must becarried out correctly The requirements regarding lsquopot lifersquo must be carefully observed and if it is exceeded paints must bediscarded Some epoxy materials cure slowly below certain temperatures or cure very quickly at higher ambient temperaturesso careful attention must be paid to manufacturersrsquo data sheets Incidentally some data sheets do not contain sufficientinformation on the effects of temperature
4932Coal-Tar Epoxies
Coal-tar epoxies sometimes called epoxy pitches are epoxies that have been modified with coal tar to provide a cheaper butvery useful coating material with excellent water-resistant properties this makes such coatings particularly useful forimmersion in seawater and because of their non-saponifiable character they are suitable for use with cathodic protectionsystems
Various agents are used to cure these materials but the polyamides provide coatings of high moisture resistanceIsocyanate-cured coal-tar epoxies are also used and have been reported as being particularly suitable for sheet steel piling andhave the considerable advantage for the UK of curing below 5EacuteC It is claimed that such materials can cure satisfactorily totemperatures well below 0EacuteC but of course if ice is present on the surface to be painted this will be of no avail
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 55
Coal-tar epoxy coatings can also be employed for atmospheric exposure and do not suffer from the forms of breakdown typicalof bituminous coatings If applied under damp conditions they may lsquoblushrsquo ie produce rather unsightly deposits on thecoating
Coal-tar epoxies can be applied by all the conventional methods although spray application is generally recommendedThere is a limit on the time between the application of successive coats to ensure good intercoat adhesion 7 days at 20EacuteC isoften considered to be a maximum Generally these paints are not pigmented although micaceous iron oxide or carbon blackcan be added A disadvantage of coal-tar epoxides is their dark colour black or dark brown which is not suitable fordecorative purposes Primers such as zinc-richepoxy and zinc silicate paints are sometimes used as part of a protective systembut authorities differ in their views on the use of zinc-containing primers for immersed conditions Often the standard coal-tarepoxy with added solvent to improve application is used as a priming coat Coal-tar epoxies are almost as corrosion-resistantas epoxy-polyamides but are less resistant to solvents Coal-tar epoxies are widely used for shipsrsquo hulls immersed parts ofoffshore platforms dock gates sewage systems tanks and many similar purposes
4933Two-Pack Polyurethanes
The organic chemistry of urethanes is fairly complex and will not be considered here However in simple terms the coatingsare based on the reaction of isocyanates with hydroxyl groups present in a variety of compounds most commonly polyolsTwo types of isocyanate are used for coating materials aliphatic and aromatic These produce different properties Thealiphatic type are used for atmospheric exposure and have excellent abrasive and chemical resistance They are hard and havegood gloss and colour retention The aromatic coatings are cheaper and have poorer gloss and colour retention but unlikealiphatic urethanes they are suitable for some immersion service
Urethanes may be used as a finishing coat for epoxy systems because they retain their gloss for a longer period butcomplete urethane systems can also be employed The aromatic types are often used for the primer and undercoats with thealiphatic type as a finishing coat
Since the range of products falls within the overall lsquourethanersquo classification and problems may arise if they are usedwithout the required background knowledge of particular products it is advisable to seek advice before using these materialsThe National Association of Corrosion Engineers (NACE) has published a useful technical committee report on urethanecoatings20
Two-pack urethanes are similar to epoxies in their properties such as resistance to water and solvents but with improvedatmospheric durability particularly to intense sunlight and with lower curing temperatures Moisture must be excluded duringapplication because the isocyanate an essential component reacts with the hydroxyl group in water
These coatings are not widely used for structural steelwork
4934Urethane Pitches
These are comparable with coal-tar epoxies with similar properties and are used for the same type of service conditions Thetwo-pack urethanes are normally modified with asphaltic pitch or coal tar to produce suitable coatings which can be appliedby all the usual methods although spraying is generally recommended The coatings are black or brown and so are not suitablefor decorative purposes
4935Moisture-Curing Urethanes
These are not two-pack materials but produce coatings that fall into this category Basically a polyol is pre-reacted withexcess isocyanate so producing a one-pack material that will react with atmospheric moisture Problems can arise in theproduction of these materials not least that of excluding moisture from the material As most pigments contain moisture itmust be removed to prevent reaction in the can Provided these paints are manufactured and used properly they are a usefuladdition to the range of paints available for steelwork The advantages claimed are as follows
(i) One-pack material that provides a high level of protection to steelwork(ii) Will cure at low temperatures below 0EacuteC
(iii) Can be applied under adverse weather conditions which may make them particularly useful for maintenance work(iv) Because of the nature of the coating it is useful for anti-graffiti purposes(v) The very short overcoating time makes it possible to apply a complete three-coat system in a single day
56 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
However the very rapid cure also has its disadvantages in that an undercoat can become too hard and solvent-resistant toprovide a suitable key for subsequent coats Therefore these materials should be overcoated as soon as is practicable andparticularly in conditions of high humidity partial immersion and exposure to direct strong sunlight Another cause ofintercoat adhesion weakness is undue delay in the use of the paint after the can has been opened21
494Zinc-Rich Coatings
These are mainly used as primers but can be used at suitable thickness for a complete paint system Unlike all the other paintcoatings discussed above which are based on the binder certain zinc pigmented paints with a high proportion of zinc in thedried film have special properties which can reasonably be considered as relating mainly to the pigment (although the bindersare important) and can be considered as a special group of coatings
Although comparatively small amounts of zinc powder and zinc oxide can be used to pigment paints those in the classunder consideration all contain about 80ndash90 zinc in the paint There are two types of zinc paint in this category and they arevariously described but are formulated (i) with organic binders and generally called zinc-rich paints and (ii) with inorganicbinders based on silicates and called zinc silicate paints These paints contain sufficient zinc to provide a measure of cathodicprotection in low-resistivity electrolytes but should not be considered as metal coatings because the binder albeit in smallamounts effectively alters their properties as compared with for example hot-dip galvanised coatings These coatings aresometimes called lsquocold galvanisedrsquo but that can be misleading
4941Organic Zinc-Rich Paints
The most resistant paint coatings are based on two-pack epoxies although a range of single-pack products has been producedbased on chlorinated rubber styrene butadiene polystyrene and high-molecular-weight epoxy The single-pack products areeasier to apply but are not generally used for structural steelwork with the exception of the epoxy type A high level ofsurface preparation is necessary to ensure the highest performance from zinc-rich coatings Although coatings of sufficientthickness may be used without further protective coatings eg to patch damaged or weld areas on hot-dip galvanisedsteelwork they are more frequently used as primers for other coating systems eg epoxies
While these primers are generally excellent in the atmosphere some authorities have reservations regarding their use underimmersed conditions because of the possibility of attack on the zinc by moisture or water permeating through the paint systemSuch attack could cause adhesion problems However a more serious problem may arise if the zinc in the primer corrodes andis not properly treated before it is overcoated as this can lead to breakdown of the system
4942Inorganic Zinc-Rich Paints
Zinc silicate coatings are unlike all the other paints considered in this section based on an inorganic binder Silicate bindersare either aqueous solutions of alkali silicate usually sodium potassium or lithium silicates or alcohol solutions of alkylesters of silicate The former are commonly termed lsquoalkali silicatesrsquo and the latter lsquoalkyl silicatesrsquo or lsquoorganic zinc silicatesrsquobecause they are based on organic silicates however the organic silicate hydrolyses releasing volatile alcohols leaving aninorganic dry film (see Section 4633 for a discussion of the mechanism of formation)
Zinc silicate coatings are cement-like being based on polysilicic acid which cements the zinc particles into a hard filmAlthough the amount of zinc may vary it must be of the required high concentration if the coating is to fall within the class ofzinc-rich paints However films with lower zinc contents also provide useful properties The cement-like nature of the coatingconfers a number of useful properties the films are resistant to solvents and the alkyl silicates provide heat-resistance up toabout 400EacuteC They are more resistant to abrasion than paints based on organic binders and because the coefficient of frictionof the dry film is about 05 compared with about 20 of that for most paints they can be used for surfaces to be connected byhigh-friction grip bolts Surface preparation of the steelwork must be of the highest standard ie Sa3 or the equivalent and acomparatively low profile height is generally recommended (25ndash50 micro m) Zinc silicates will not adhere properly to surfacescarrying the remnants of old organic coatings ie most conventional paints Unlike most paints a reasonably high humidity isadvantageous because the film must remain lsquowetrsquo at least for a few seconds to ensure curing of the binder Otherwise lsquodrysprayrsquo will cause poor adhesion of subsequent coats or lack of durability of the final coat
The paints are usually sprayed to provide a thickness of about 75 micro m only small areas should be coated by brushing lsquoMud-crackingrsquo a self-descriptive term only occurs if coatings are applied at thicknesses in excess of the paint manufacturerrsquosrecommendations
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 57
Zinc silicates are widely used with no further protection eg for tank linings However where they are used as primers forother systems care must be exercised to ensure that zinc salts are not present on the silicate coating as this may impairadhesion of coats applied over it If they are present then removal either by vigorous use of a bristle brush or by light blast-cleaning is recommended Brushing is preferred because of the loss of coating with blast-cleaning which if not carefullycontrolled may be significant Most of the chemically resistant paints can be applied to zinc silicate without difficulty but itsporous nature can trap air or solvent and then cause pinholing of subsequent coats The application of a thin sealer coat generallyeliminates this problem Paint manufacturersrsquo lists may contain a considerable number of silicate paints some single-packmany of them will not compare in properties on durability with those considered above so advice should be sought to ensurethat suitable silicate paints are chosen
Table 41
Applied second coat First coat
Bitumen Vinyl Chlor-rubber Alkyd Epoxide CT epoxide Poly-urethane
Bitumen ouml ouml ouml ouml ouml ouml
Vinyl ouml ouml ouml B
Chlor-rubber ouml B
Alkyd ouml ouml ouml B
Epoxide ouml ouml ouml ouml B ouml
CT epoxide ouml ouml ouml ouml ouml
Poly-urethane ouml ouml ouml ouml B
Probably all rightouml Not recommended Results in crazingB Adhesion may be satisfactory but appearance affected by lsquobleedingrsquo
495Compatibility of Different Paints
Caution should be exercised when mixing different types of binder in a single paint system Table 41 gives a broad indicationof the effect of applying one type of binder over another However it is advisable to consult paint suppliers before mixingbinders in the system Summaries of the properties and characteristics of selected paints are given in Tables 42 and 43
496Heat-Resistant Coatings
Surfaces subject to temperatures up to 95degC A normal paint system of primer (red lead calcium plumbate etc) and glossfinish is usually satisfactory For surfaces subject to temperatures approaching 95EacuteC better results are obtained by omittingundercoats and applying one or more coats of finishing paint direct to the primer
If alkali resistance is also required (as with painting lagging etc) then chlorinated rubber paint systems are suitable forsurfaces up to 65EacuteC
Surfaces subject to temperatures between 95 and 130degC It is generally satisfactory to apply gloss finishing coats over azinc chromate primer although discoloration of the lighter shades must be expected Aluminium (general-purpose) paint canbe used over a zinc chromate primer
Table 42Summary of properties of selected paintsa
Binder High-buildapplication
Handlingtransport
Durability Low-temperaturedrying
Tolerance toinferior surfacepreparation
Delay inovercoating orrepainting
General costb
Chlorinatedrubber
Limited F G G F G ouml
Vinyl Limited F G G P G 1middot5ouml
Some American aut horities recommend a much lower standard
58 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
Binder High-buildapplication
Handlingtransport
Durability Low-temperaturedrying
Tolerance toinferior surfacepreparation
Delay inovercoating orrepainting
General costb
Epoxy Yes G G P P P 2ouml
polyamide
Polyurethane Yes G G G P P 3ouml
Epoxy pitch Yes F G P P P ouml
Urethane pitch Yes G G G P P 1middot3ouml
Bituminous Limited F F-G G F G 0middot5ouml
Oleo-resinousalkyd
Limited F F G G G ouml
a G good F fair P poorb Taking oleo-resinous as standard ouml (costs of films of equal thickness)
Table 43General characteristics of protective paintsa
Nature of binder Mode of dry Resistance to Durability Special features
Acids Alkali Water Solvents
Oleo-resinous including alkyd O F F-B F-B F-P G-B General purpose paints for most non-aggressive situations
Epoxy resin (two pack) CR F-G VG G VG E Durable but gives rapid loss of gloss-requirescure
Coal-tar epoxy (two pack) CR G VG VG G G Chemical and water resistance good suitablefor under water
Chlorinated rubber S G G VG P G High resistance to moisture and alkali
Polyurethane (two pack) CR F-G G VG VG VG-E Chemical resistance and gloss retention good
Vinyl resin S VG VG VG P G Normally thin films but high build typesavailable-durable
Zinc silicates CR P P E E E Some forms need post application treatmentgive re-coating problems
Special care required in surface preparationGood abrasion resistance
a O oxidation S evaporation of solvent CR chemical reaction E excellent VG very good G good F fair P poor B bad
Surfaces subject to temperatures between 130 and 150degC It is preferable to use alkyd gloss finishing paint only withoutundercoats or primers
Surfaces subject to temperatures between 130 and 260deg C Application direct to bare metal of an aluminium (general-purpose)paint often gives better results than the heat-resisting type based solely or partly on silicones Where acid resistance is alsorequired (in steel chimneys ducts etc) a zinc-dust-graphite paint applied in one single heavy coat can be effective for theshort term
Surfaces subject to temperatures between 120 and 950degC Wherever possible sprayed aluminium metal coatings are to bepreferred to paint coatings for heat resistance A very high standard of surface preparation is required and the coatings mustcomply strictly with BS 2569 Part 2
Surfaces subject to temperatures between 260 and 540degC Silicone-based aluminium paints can be used for this temperaturerange but it is essential if good results are to be obtained to ensure that the metal surfaces are really clean and free from rustThese paints also require a minimum temperature for curing (usually about 260EacuteC) Another difficulty with these paints isthat although they have good resistance to high temperatures they have poor corrosion and weather resistance properties
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 59
497Other Coating Materials and Fillers
A number of materials based on waxes oils and greases are used either for temporary protection of steel components or forprotection of steelwork particularly in fairly inaccessible areas These materials are not paints but for convenience they areconsidered here
Waxes and greases sometimes containing inhibitors are generally applied as thick reasonably soft films to provide barrierprotection Some of the compositions are hot-applied and are useful for injection into spaces where steel may be in contactwith damp materials Others are cold-applied to produce either hard wax-like or soft greasy coatings Although these coatingsare often effective and do not require a high degree of surface preparation their use on structures is limited to areas whichpersonnel are not likely to visit very frequently eg interiors of box girders or virtually inaccessible areas They are difficultto inspect for corrosion because often a considerable amount of rust may form before it becomes noticeable They are cheapand easily applied but authorities differ in their views on their overall effectiveness It is advisable to consult themanufacturers of these products before using them because they cover a wide range of properties For example some hardento a marked degree and can be overpainted with conventional paints to provide a coloured finish
Generally the same types of paint are used for initial and maintenance painting even though the conditions under whichthe two types of painting are carried out is often vastly different A few special types of coating have been developed Theseare sometimes called lsquosurface-tolerant coatingsrsquo These are designed to be applied to a range of coatings to rusty steel and todamp surfaces High-build epoxy aluminium mastics were introduced in the late 1970s They are high in solids (over 80 byvolume) so thick films can be obtained with a few coats using brush application They are formulated to give good wettingproperties and to reduce solvent attack on the old paint coatings to which they are applied They have good resistance tosolvents and to saponification Generally they provide protection equal or better than many of the conventional paints but arenot particularly decorative
Temporary protectives are so-called because the coatings can easily be removed by simple solvents such as white spirit andthis term is not necessarily an indication of the time of protection afforded by them Generally they fall into a number ofclearly defined groups as classified in BS 1133 The Packaging Codersquo Section 6
(i) Solvent-deposited type consisting of film-forming ingredients dissolved in solvents to provide low-viscosity liquidsOn evaporation of the solvents a thin tough abrasion-resistant film is formed The materials are usually applied bydipping or spraying They are not particularly suited to batches of items that might stick together but are used forcomponents of fairly high surface finish
(ii) A soft-film type similar to (i) but less resistant to abrasion and mainly used for the interior protection of assemblies(iii) A type rather similar to (i) above but applied by hot-dipping to produce thicker films which are more protective(iv) Types based on grease sometimes containing an inhibitor which are applied by smearing or brushing unlike (i)ndash(iii)
which are applied by dipping(v) More expensive strippable coatings are also available generally they are fairly expensive but can easily be removed
without solvents
Mastics are thick coatings used to fill gaps crevices overlaps etc in a manner similar to wax and grease paints They aregenerally based on synthetic rubbers synthetic resins and bitumen Polysulphides are frequently used as are butyl rubbersMost mastics tend to harden to some extent with ageing and some shrinkage may occur Consequently their effectivenessshould be checked regularly eg during maintenance to ensure that wide gaps are not converted to crevice situations whichmay be worse from the corrosion standpoint
REFERENCES
1 Edwards JD amp Wray RI Industrial Engineering Chem 28 (1936) 5492 Guruviah S J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 53 (1970) 6693 Mayne JEO Corrosion Vol 2 Newnes Butterworths London 1976 p 15264 Mayne JEO J Iron Steel Inst 176 (1954) 1435 Mayne JEO J Appl Chem 9 (1959) 6736 Chandler KA amp Stanners JF Second International Congress on Metallic Corrosion 1966 NACE Houston pp 325ndash337 McGill WJ J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 60 (1977) 1218 Walker P Paint Technology 31(8) (1967) 289 Van Loo M Official Digest 28 (1956) 14410 Bayliss DA amp Bray H Materials Performance 20 (1981) 1111 Gay PJ J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 31 (1948) 481
60 PAINTS AND PAINT COATINGS
12 Bullett TR amp Rudram ATS J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 44 (1961) 78713 Brunt NA J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 47 (1964) 3114 Klens PF amp Lang JF J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 39 (1956) 88715 Shapiro S Official Digest 30 (1958) 41416 Munger CG Material Performance 14(5) (1975) 2517 Ginsberg T et al J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 59 (1976) 31518 Steel Structures Painting Manual Vol 1 Steel Structures Painting Council Pittsburgh 1982 p 1319 Carter EV A new synthetic process for the manufacture of lamellar iron oxide pigment for use in anti corrosive coatings J Oil
and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 5 (1988) 132ndash820 Urethane protective coatings for atmospheric exposure 6B273 NACE Houston21 Thompson I amp Temple C The relationship between cure and performance of single pack moisture cured urethanes Industrial
Corrosion 8 (1990) 11ndash16
FURTHER READING
Boxall J amp Von Fraunhofer JA (1980) Paint Formulation George Godwin London Introduction to Paint Technology Oil and Colour Chemists Association London 1967Paint Technology Manuals Services published for the Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Association by Chapman and Hall London including Part
1rsquoNon Convertible Coatingsrsquo and Part 3 lsquoConvertible CoatingsrsquoTurner GPS (1967) Introduction to Paint Chemistry Chapman and Hall London (A simple account of the organic chemistry of paint
binders drying mechanisms and paint composition and formulation)
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 61
CHAPTER 5Paint Application
Paint application has an important influence on the life of a paint system and must be properly controlled to ensure thatcoatings attain their full potential This is achieved by employing skilled operatives and ensuring that paint is appliedcorrectly
Despite the improvements that have taken place which allow for more economic application the older methods are stillwidely used Methods such as brush application are basically simple but still require to be properly controlled if good coatingsare to be obtained Furthermore well-trained painters are far more likely to produce sound coatings than those with littleknowledge of paint application
In this chapter only the application methods commonly used to paint constructional steelwork will be considered in detailMethods used to apply paints to domestic equipment cars and consumer goods are not used to any extent for constructional workFurthermore they are applied under factory-controlled conditions to the manufacturersrsquo specifications which cannot easily bevaried by the purchaser
51METHODS OF APPLICATION
The methods used for paint application fall into the following general categories
(a) manual applicationmdashbrush and roller(b) spraymdashairspray and airless hot or cold(c) dip coating(d) flow coating(e) roller coating(f) electrostatic(g) powder coating
Additionally paint coatings may be air-dried or stoved For constructional steelwork methods (a) and (b) are generally used for applying paint Method (e) is sometimes used and
(f) and (g) may be used but generally are only for special components or for plastic coatings
511Brush Application
Application of paint by brushing is still the method most commonly used particularly for maintenance painting Although itis centuries old considerable improvements have been made in the design and manufacture of paint brushes A wide rangeexists for the purposes required eg large flat brushes for covering large areas of steelwork and smaller ones for a variety of otherjobs
The brush serves two purposes It acts as the container for the paint as it is transferred from the can or kettle and also as theactual method of transfer This means that the bristles must be capable of holding sufficient paint to allow for reasonable coverageat each transfer and must also be of material capable of transferring the paint in an even way through the points of contact atthe steel surface These requirements appear to be most satisfactorily achieved with bristles from the Chinese hog Brushesmade from these bristles are tapered and hold paint away from the stock ie where they are fixed to the handle Furthermorethey are lsquoflaggedrsquo ie they divide into two at the tip providing more points of contact In recent years nylon fibres have beendesigned and are claimed to provide similar advantages with better wearing properties Polyester fibres are also used toprovide synthetic bristles Sometimes brushes contain animal bristles and both polyester and nylon fibres
Apart from the conventional brush described above another type made from short synthetic fibres about lagrave in (32 cm)long attached to a flat base about 4 in is also used This holds more paint and covers a greater area It is particularly useful forforcing paint into crevices and for use where it is difficult to apply the paint in the conventional manner
Various attempts have been made to mechanise the process by using methods such as hoses to supply the paint to thebrush Recently equipment of this type has been made available for the application of emulsion paints for the domestic marketGenerally such methods are not widely used for the painting of steel In part this arises from the additional cleaning ofequipment required so eliminating one of the main advantages of brush application Additionally skilled painters used toapplication with conventional brushes appear to find that they lose some of the control over the operation if the paint isautomatically fed to the brush The advantages of brush application are considered to be as follows
(i) Cheap requiring no expensive equipment(ii) Relatively clean requiring no masking of adjacent areas
(iii) Can be used in restricted areas(iv) Particularly suitable for displacing dust and moisture on imperfectly prepared surfaces(v) Allows paint to be worked into crevices and other difficult areas
(vi) Brushes are easily cleaned and can be easily maintained in good condition(vii) The only practicable method of applying certain types of paint eg lead-based
The main disadvantage is the slow rate of application which can be less than 10 of the rate achieved by spray methodsHowever taking into account the time saved on masking cleaning etc the overall rate of application is better than this figurewould indicate It is also generally used for stripe coats along edges corners etc even where other methods may be used forthe application of paint to the main areas In such situations the paint must be suitable for application by both methods
Brushing may not be suitable for some paints eg those drying by solvent evaporation such as chlorinated-rubber paintsThis is because the solvent evaporates quickly leaving a very viscous polymer and to apply the paint satisfactorily requires alow viscosity material which may cause sagging of thicker films Problems also arise with applying subsequent coats by brushbecause the solvent tends to dissolve the previous coat However suitably formulated solvent-type paints are produced forbrush application
Generally brushing is used to apply oleo-resinous types of paint (including long oil alkyds) for which solvents of the white-spirit type are used Rapidly drying paints eg those drying in under 1 hour are difficult to apply satisfactorily by brushAlthough other types of paint may be applied by brush special formulations are usually required
There is little justification for the belief that one should always apply primers by brush However for maintenance workwhere a high quality of surface preparation is not proposed brush application gives better wetting of rusty and pitted surfaces
512Roller Application
This method should not be confused with roller coating application which is a means of applying paint to flat steel sheetunder factory conditions In the context of painting structural steelwork it is similar to the method commonly used to applyemulsion paints in domestic situations
Roller application is particularly suitable for painting large flat areas and does not require the same skill as for sprayapplication Rollers also allow for application rates up to four times faster than those achieved with brushes With this methodlarge trays or containers are used for the paint and the roller is dipped in to transfer the paint to the steel surface Although usefulfor rapid covering of large areas the method does not have the advantages of brush application for priming coats on hand-cleaned steel surfaces and generally requires the additional use of a brush for edges corners and other areas not accessible tothe roller
In general rollers are not recommended for the application of primers or high-build coatings because it is difficult to controlfilm thicknesses with such a method of application There is also the tendency to lsquoroll outrsquo the coating ie to apply it toothinly especially with high-opacity coatings containing aluminium pigment In these cases it is necessary to apply anincreased number of coats to obtain the correct film build Also with metallic pigmented paints it is necessary to finish off inone direction to avoid showing the path of each rolling
The size of the roller affects the speed of application a roller will hold 2auml times as much paint as a roller Extensionhandles can help to gain access and reduce scaffolding but it is doubtful whether the practice sometimes seen of a roller fixedto the end of a long pole leads to a uniform paint application or increased speed of application
The type of roller surface is important Roller naps of 5 mm to 10mm are best for smooth surfaces and 10mm to 20mm forrough pitted surfaces Special rollers are available for pipe coating work Care must be taken with some modern high-performance coatings since their solvents may attack the adhesive within the roller
PAINT APPLICATION 63
Because of the inherent difficulty in getting even films with brush or roller it is advisable in the interests of overallpracticability to give the contractor some tolerance regarding film thickness A reasonable figure is that for roller applicationnot more than 10 of the dry film thickness readings may be up to 10 below the specified minimum
Cleaning is not usually a problem because the roller covers are often discarded at the end of the dayrsquos work The mostcommonly used cover materials are mohair lambswool nylon and polyester The material and the length of nap are usuallychosen in relation to the paints being applied The roller itself must be made of a material resistant to the solvents usedfor particular paints Special rollers consisting of a series of narrow rolls are often used for application to complex-shapedsurfaces and pipes Although rollers are generally used by dipping the roller into the paint and then applying the paintmechanised methods are utilised In these the paint is supplied from a pressurised tank into the roller head Other methodssuch as paint pads or special lambswool gloves or paint mitts are also sometimes used to apply paint Generally thesemethods are more suitable for general coverage rather than for controlled painting They are useful for painting areas ofdifficult access and restricted space eg back-to-back angles
513Airspray Application
Airspray was the first type of spray equipment developed to provide speedier application of paints particularly when thequicker-drying types were developed as these could not easily be applied by brush With airspray application sometimesknown as lsquoconventionalrsquo spray application compressed air is used both to atomise the paint and to carry it to the surface to bepainted Paint is fed to the spray gun by one of the following methods
(i) Gravity feed the paint is contained in a cup on top of the spray gun and is fed by gravity to the gun nozzle This actionis also helped by a vacuum created at the nozzle by the flow of compressed air Gravity feed guns are normally used for paintswith low or intermediate viscosities and are very popular for painting small areas because of the ease with which they can berefilled and cleaned They cannot be used for spraying surfaces overhead
(ii) Suction feed the paint is contained in a cup fixed to the underneath of the gun and is sucked to the paint nozzle by avacuum obtained with compressed air (see Fig 51)
Both gravity feed and suction feed are relatively low speed application methods(iii) Pressure feed container the paint under pressure is supplied to the gun by a displacement pump operated by air
pressure This method is the most efficient for large applications and is particularly effective for applying mastic or coatingscontaining large or abrasive pigments
Important considerations in air (conventional) spray painting are
(1) Proper gun distance from the work (150ndash200 mm) (2) Gun should be held perpendicular to the surface to be painted(3) Paint should be sprayed at the lowest possible atomisation pressure that will adequately atomise the paint
Fig 51 Airspray gun with suction feed
64 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
(4) Since it is possible to adjust the controls of the gun to alter the application volume pattern etc the operator should beskilled in its use
(5) Material losses are likely to be 25ndash50 depending upon numerous factors(6) The air to the gun should be passed through suitable filters or traps to remove moisture Airlines to the gun can be
extremely moist and this can cause problems with paint materials particularly urethanes and some types of epoxy
514Airless Spraying
In conventional air spraying the volume of air required to atomise a given volume of paint is considerable This arises fromthe large differences in the specific gravities of air and paint and the requirement to impart high velocity to the paint Thisleads to an inbuilt inefficiency in the system because of the large volumes of air needed and the high overspray that occurswith this method Airspraying can be efficiently used in automatic plants and in properly designed spray booths but is lessefficient for painting a wide variety of structural-steel shapes Airless spraying is generally more suited to this type ofapplication (see Fig 52)
In airless spraying the paint is forced through a small jet so that it reaches the velocity required for atomisation and as witha garden hose a spray of droplets is produced As there is no expanding compressed air as in airspraying to disperse the fluidparticles most of the paint adheres to the work surface thus eliminating to a great extent spray mist and paint wastage Thisresults in a faster rate of spraying (up to twice that of air spraying) and less loss of paint by overspray
The spray gun used looks similar to that used for air spraying but does not have a compressed-air hose connected (seeFig 53) However the operating parts inside are different There is a ball valve and seat a sieve and a tip The gun isconnected by a suitable hose to an air-powered pump which forces the paint to the tip at a pressure some 20ndash50 times that ofthe compressed air used to operate the pump Consequently although the air pressure is of the same order as that used for airspraying the actual spray pressure is 12ndash35 MNm2 (1800ndash5000 psi)
Very thin fluids such as sealers can be successfully atomised at pressures around 400ndash800 psi Most protective coatingsrequire 1500 to 2000 psi while some high-build paints need 2500 psi Mastics and high-solids materials may have to beapplied at pressures up to 5000 psi The high pressures involved with airless spray present a safety hazard see Chapter 17
Since airless spray does not require compressed air to atomise and deliver the paint it is not essential for the operation ofthe airless spray pump and electric or petrol motors can be used instead This means that the units can be made extremelyportable Agitators are often built into spray units to ensure adequate mixing during operation The tip of the gun is made oftungsten carbide to reduce wear from pigments in the paint and is an essential element in the control of the process A rangeof tip shapes is available for different spray patterns and different types of paint and the paint suppliersrsquo recommendationsmust be followed regarding the tip to be employed Apart from the choice of tip the only other variables in the process are thepaint viscosity and the input pressure Extension units or lsquopole gunsrsquo may be employed with airless spraying to reduce oravoid scaffolding These may be up to 3 m in length
The main advantages of airless spray over airspray are
(a) Higher output
Fig 52 The airless spray system
PAINT APPLICATION 65
(b) Less paint fog or rebound(c) Gives the painter the ability to apply thick films in a single pass (d) Coatings often require no thinning before application(e) Gives good penetration into pits and crevices due to the high kinetic energy involved(f) Extensions can be used to reach some inaccessible areas(g) An operator can install the pump and feed at floor level and in dry conditions and work at a height with only a single fluid
line
The main disadvantages are
(a) Higher purchasing cost(b) Greater safety hazard(c) Cannot be used for all types of paint(d) Cannot be used with pigments with large particle sizes(e) Not suitable for fine decorative finishes since the spray edges are not sufficiently lsquofeatheredrsquo(f) Since the spraying characteristics ie both volume and spray pattern are fixed with the airless spray tip or nozzle a
selection is required to meet a variety of spraying conditions Over 90 types of airless spray nozzle are currentlyavailable
(g) Inorganic zinc-rich primers and other highly abrasive paints are not generally suitable for airless spray application(h) Frequent clogging of the gun and wear on the orifice causes problems(i) It requires a greater distance from the work surface normally 400ndash500 mm than conventional spray(j) Although it requires less skill than the use of air spray it still requires experience and care in handling and regular
maintenance of the equipment is important
515Heated Spray Units
The spray methods considered above are operated at ambient temperatures but both conventional and airless spray can beused with devices incorporated to heat the paint (Fig 54) Satisfactory spraying under ambient conditions is achieved byreducing the paint viscosity with thinners to a level suitable to ensure atomisation Viscosity can also be lowered by heatingthe paint to a suitable temperature usually 60ndash80EacuteC At these temperatures the viscosity may be reduced to about one-third ofthat at ambient temperature An added advantage of heating paint in conventional air spraying arises from the reduced amountof compressed air required about half that of conventional spraying This considerably reduces the paint losses duringoperation Furthermore as more of the solvent evaporates before the paint deposits on the surface the final paint filmcontains less solvent The hot paint spreads better and gives better coverage because of the high non-volatile content and inaddition the drying time is shortened and the paint surface can be handled quicker without damage In fact the method can beused for some very viscous and very quick-curing solventless types of coatings The heating of the paint can be achieved bythe use of an electrically heated water jacket using superheated air or by direct electrical heating Heated conventional spray
Fig 53 Airless spray guns
66 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
units are not used to any great extent for the painting of constructional steelwork but rather for factory-applied industrialfinishes
Hot airless spray equipment is also available and is being used increasingly to apply thick single coats of solventlessepoxies or urethanes to large surface areas For example it is possible to apply as much as 1000 micro m in one coat which setshard within minutes A typical successful application was to the inside and outside of the large gates on the UK ThamesBarrier This was applied in 1983 and is still in excellent condition in 1990
The equipment is bulky and the initial cost is high It requires a special skill and experience in handling it correctlyHowever when mastered it can supply a glass-like finish that is superior to that obtained from a cold application
Since faulty application can affect such a large area and be extremely difficult and expensive to remedy it is essential thatthe equipment has built-in alarms to ensure that each component is at the correct temperature and is being pumped to the gunin the correct proportions
Problems may arise if the steel surface is cold because condensation may affect adhesion However provided the steel is nottoo cold the method can be used at lower ambient temperatures than with non-heated spray
516Application of Two-Component Paints by Spray
Two-component paints such as epoxies have a separate base and catalyst or hardener which are mixed before applicationImmediately they are mixed a chemical reaction begins which proceeds over a period of time to produce a solid product Thisoccurs at ambient temperature and the speed of the reaction is influenced by the nature of the two components Clearly oncethe components have been mixed there is a limit to the time they can be used in the spraying equipment because they willsolidify reasonably quickly Because the final product is soluble only in strong solvents problems can arise if these materialsare not used during the comparatively short period during which application is practicable This period is called the lsquopot lifersquoof the paint To overcome these problems spraying equipment is available in which the two components are mixed at orimmediately before the spray gun so there is no possibility of chemical reaction between the two components in the rest ofthe equipment
Such equipment must be designed to ensure accurate mixing otherwise the final paint film on the steel surface will nothave the requisite properties There are two common ways of mixing the components (i) by mixing with a small agitator inthe gun itself and (ii) by forcing the two components through small orifices allowing the mixing to take place either in thegun or in the spray In the latter method the mixing is achieved by the turbulence of the flow The method is commonly usedfor spraying glass-reinforced polyester coatings In that case the chopped glass fibres are also blown into the two componentsmixing in the stream in front of the gun
The correct mixing ratios are achieved in various ways including the use of calibrated piston pumps where the correctproportions are achieved by varying either the diameter or the stroke of one piston relative to the other Other methods includeregulation of the flow of the two components by adjusting the pressure or the use of two pumps operating at different speeds
Methods such as these for spraying two-component materials depend for their effectiveness on very careful metering of thetwo components to ensure that they are mixed in the correct proportions The main disadvantages of such methods are
Fig 54 Heated airless
PAINT APPLICATION 67
(a) The very high purchase cost compared with more conventional equipment with consequent limited availability(b) The complexity of the apparatus means that the operators should be specially trained in its use(c) It is sometimes necessary to employ additional operators to maintain a continuous watch on the equipment to ensure
that it is functioning correctly for the entire spraying operation(d) The equipment must be well maintained on-site and regularly serviced in the workshop
517Electrostatic Spray
This method is suitable for spraying either liquid or powder coatings Unlike other spraying processes it has the ability topaint all parts of an object from a fixed position eg the whole of a pipe can be coated without moving the spray from thefront of the pipe to the back (see Fig 55) This is achieved by passing paint droplets through a powerful electrostatic field duringwhich they receive a high charge typically up to 75 kV for handheld guns and up to 180kV for some automatic equipmentand so become attracted to the item to be coated which is earthed
This method is widely used for tubular goods eg pipes garden furniture bicycle frames and wire fences Electrostaticspray painting is generally more economical than other types It is universally used for the factory application of fusionbonded epoxy powder coatings to the external surfaces of pipelines The method is not used for the painting of generalconstructional steelwork but on sites it is well suited for open steel work such as gratings or railings
The advantages of electrostatic spraying include
(a) It can give a fairly complete overall coverage simultaneously to both back and front of small sections of simple shape(b) There is less spray loss than with other methods of application(c) It gives a uniform film thickness(d) It is quicker than conventional spraying techniques and when operated in works no complex exhaust systems or paint
booths are required
Its disadvantages include
(a) Only comparatively thin coatings can be applied(b) It can only be used on the bare conductive substrates(c) Generally only one coat can be applied by this method since the applied coating insulates the surface(d) The paint or powder has to be specifically formulated for the purpose(e) Paints containing conductive pigments for example zinc-rich primers cannot be used(f) The high voltages used present a safety hazard(g) The equipment is more expensive and more cumbersome to use than a normal spray gun(h) It is not possible to spray into some crevices or internal surfaces due to the Faraday Cage effect
Fig 55 Electrostatic gun
68 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
518Other Application Methods
Most structural steelwork is painted by one of the methods discussed above However other application methods are alsoused to a limited extent and these will be briefly discussed in this section
5181Dipping
Application by dipping is sometimes carried out for small fabrications difficult to paint by other methods pipes are alsocoated by dipping The method is basically simple Either the steel is dipped into a tank containing paint or sometimes thetank is raised to cover the stationary steelwork Paints have to be specially formulated and suitably thinned for the dippingmethod Owing to the large exposed surface of the paint excessive evaporation of solvent can occur and the viscosity must beregularly monitored and corrected with addition of more solvent The whole process is generally less easily controlled thanthe other methods and is not suited to all types of paint Clearly there is a limitation on the size of steelwork that can betreated in this way partly because of the size of tank and partly because of the amount of handling required Provided thedesign of the process allows for flow of the paint to all parts internal and external surfaces can be coated in one operationThe method is rapid and skilled operators are not required However lsquodripsrsquo and lsquotearsrsquo tend to occur on the lower parts of thepainted steelwork and there is a tendency for edges to be coated to a lower thickness than the main surfaces
This method is widely used for comparatively small fabrications particularly where final stoving is carried out and wherethe process can be automated However it is not generally used for structural steelwork because it is not suited to many ofthe paints commonly used for such structures and the shear bulk of the steelwork would make handling difficult
5182 Flow Coating
As a variation of the dipping process items on-site are occasionally flow coated This consists of building a watertightreservoir generally in plastic around the base of the item to be coated and pumping the paint through a hose to the top of theitem It is most useful for complicated structures such as transformer radiator tanks where an operator directs the hose from apoint above so that the paint covers the inner surfaces The only alternative to reach such surfaces is by spray nozzles on theend of extension tubes and in most such cases the spray operator has to work lsquoblindrsquo Such a process still requires the cleaningand preparation of the surface before painting and if this cannot be achieved by solvent or steam washing the paintapplication is unlikely to achieve its object
If flow coating is carried out the paint must be carefully selected for its purpose and during the flow coating operation thepaint viscosity must be checked and rectified at frequent intervals
5183Miscellaneous Methods
Methods such as trowelling on thick coatings of high viscosity are sometimes used Barrelling similar to the method used forsheradising zinc coatings is also used for small components Other methods widely used for industrial painting such as rollercoating and curtain coating are not used for structural steelwork
519Comparison of Application Methods
The main comparison between the four common methods of application must be on the speed of operation The followingfigures indicate the average area of steelwork that an operator might be expected to cover with one coat of paint per daybrush 100m2 roller 200ndash400 m2 airspray 400ndash800m2 and airless spray 800ndash1200m2
The rate of application is not the only matter to be taken into account but the advantages to be gained by spraying areclearly demonstrated Brush application is the slowest but for many situations the most effective and masking and loss ofpaint by overspray are avoided Roller coating is generally limited to large flat surfaces although special rollers have beendeveloped for other shapes Spraying is the fastest method and in most situations airless spray is preferred
PAINT APPLICATION 69
52APPLICATION CONDITIONS
Only paint application will be considered here surface preparation is considered in Chapter 3To obtain a satisfactory job with all methods of coating application the following are important
(1) There is access by an unrestricted safe working platform(2) A cleaning team is ahead of the applicators This particularly applies to airless spray which pumps out a large volume of
paint so that there is a tendency for applicators to spray everything in the path of the spray gun Most experiencedpainting inspectors can recall such items as mud piles of abrasive cigarette packets broken light bulbs etc that have allreceived a coat of paint in lieu of the substrate
(3) Correct lighting so that the operative can move about safely and have sufficient light on the work surface to carry outthe job correctly This is particularly important for high-build coatings such as coal-tar epoxies where succeeding coatsare of the same or very similar colour
(4) For spray operators on large work there should be a paint loader to keep up with the sprayersrsquo output(5) With spray operation it is preferable to have another operator to follow up the sprayer and touch-in and remedy visual
defects
521Pre- or Post-Fabrication
For new structural steelwork there are four main procedures for carrying out the coating operations
(1) Surface preparation and priming at the fabricators Coating system completed on site after erection(2) Surface preparation and priming plus the main part of the coating system completed at fabricators Damage repaired
and final coat only applied on site after erection(3) Surface preparation priming and coating on the ground at site and before erection(4) Surface preparation priming and coating at site and after erection
Obviously there are further variations possible but one of the above is normally the main choice It is not possible to state thatany one method is preferable there are advantages and disadvantages to each one A NACE publication1 comprehensivelysets out the factors that have to be considered Briefly the choice depends upon amongst other factors
(1) The size and complexity of the fabrication(2) The extent to which welding has to be completed after surface preparation and priming(3) Availability of facilities at the fabricators such as convenience of access to items on the ground adequate and suitable
storage etc(4) Access on site(5) Type of coating materials to be used eg quick-drying stacking resistance etc(6) Ambient conditions on site
Pre-fabrication surface preparation and priming is generally the most economic option In such cases the user is seldom ableto specify the paint manufacturer to be used since it is not practicable for the fabricator to change materials frequentlyIdeally specially formulated primers should be used such as those based on polyamide-cured epoxy and pigmented with zincphosphate These dry rapidly and can be overcoated with most other types of paint for periods up to at least one year withoutthe need for special preparation other than the removal of dirt and repair of damage The addition of fine-grade micaceouspigment to such primers also has advantages since it can provide a matt surface that aids overcoatability
If primers are to be on the surface during welding operations it is important that they should have two quite separatecertificates of approval (i) to indicate a satisfactory level of toxicity during the welding operation and (ii) to confirm that itwill not adversely affect the strength of the weld The latter is dependent upon paint film thickness and manufacturersrsquorecommendations to this effect should be followed If the area to be welded is relatively large then preparation and primingafter fabrication may well be the most efficient and economical option
In almost all cases there are considerable advantages in stripe coating that is applying an extra coat of primer along edgeswelds etc This is not popular with many painters because of the amount of effort involved for such a relatively small area ofcoverage It must also add to the cost of application but for the end-user there is ample economic justification in increaseddurability Paint systems commonly fail first at edges welds etc because of the reduced paint thickness TNOPaint
70 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
Research Institute in the Netherlands has studied the rheology of coatings applied to edges and has found that for normalsolvent-based paint systems there is a reduction of 40ndash70 of film thickness compared with the adjacent flat surfaces2
522The Painting Shop
The layout equipment and environmental controls are important factors in determining both the efficiency of the paintingprocess and the standard of the coating ie its overall durability Generally insufficient attention is paid to the ability of afabricator to achieve the necessary standards required and specified It may well be advantageous to carry out a check or auditof the works before contracting the painting of steelwork Apart from surface preparation which is now capable of fairlystrict controls poor painting procedures are the most likely causes of inadequate coating performance Against the obviousadvantages of shop-controlled work must be weighed the occasional situation where numerous small loose and separate itemshave to be painted or where access has to be obtained to all faces of a large fabricated structure close to or on the ground
Requirements such as cranes suitable for handling the steelwork sufficient weatherproof area to paint and store thesteelwork properly maintained equipment for painting sufficient trained operators and a proper division between blast-cleaning and painting operations are very important and should be checked However the particular factors that affect paintapplication are those concerned with environmental control temperature and lighting and these will be considered inthis section These will often be considered for health and safety reasons rather than for purely technical ones Neverthelessthese environmental factors do influence the efficiency of paint application and should be properly controlled
523Ambient Conditions
Although it would seem obvious that site painting should be scheduled for the most favourable months of the year in practiceit is a common experience to observe paint being applied under virtually any weather conditions short of heavy rainfall Evenwith the latter it is also a common experience to see work re-start immediately after the rain has stopped and when thesurfaces are still at least damp This is perhaps not surprising in countries like the UK with unpredictable summersMcKelvie3 has produced evidence on the influence of weather conditions in the UK This shows that the period of Decemberand January cannot be expected to be favourable for outdoor painting unless special precautions such as enclosure heatingandor special paint systems are used February is also generally unsatisfactory and November and March to a lesser extentThe months of May and June provide the best conditions with a greater likelihood of efficient use of working time when thepainting is started later in the day The work applied to London Manchester and the Cardiff area further north for example inthe Shetland Isles the lsquoweather windowrsquo is generally even shorter and in some years ideal conditions have been non-existentIt is more important in these circumstances to select paint systems on the basis of their tolerance to application conditionsrather than standard systems that really only give high performance under close to ideal application conditions
5231Temperature
Temperature influences coating application in a number of ways eg drying time curing time of two-pack materials solventevaporation and paint viscosity Temperature has a marked effect on the viscosity of paints the actual effect depends on thepaint but a typical gloss paint may become twice as viscous when temperatures drop from 30 to 20EacuteC The temperature atwhich paint is stored is also important Depending on the type of paint and temperature it may be necessary to warm or coolthe paint before use
Two-pack materials which cure by chemical reaction are extremely sensitive to temperature Low temperatures will slowthe reaction and high temperatures will cause it to accelerate
Most epoxies will not cure below 5EacuteC and ideally should be applied to surfaces above 10EacuteC Any paints applied to a coldsurface will instantaneously cool to the temperature of the substrate and this will impair the flow into the inumerableinterstices and crevices of for example a blast-cleaned surface
Conversely at high temperatures the viscosity of any type of paint will drop possibly to the point where it will haveundesirable rheological characteristics such as runs and sags on vertical surfaces
In extremes of temperature brush and roller application may require the addition of extra solvent with consequent loss offilm thickness Spray operation both air or airless will also need modification to spraying pressures tip sizes and possibly theuse of special solvent to avoid dry spray and other film defects
Temperature is also critical for the application of water-borne coatings since there is a minimum temperature at which aproper film will form by coalescence
PAINT APPLICATION 71
Many paint manufacturers only provide data about their products such as two-pack epoxies at standard temperatures of 20or 23EacuteC whereas variations from the standard can make significant practical differences to such properties as pot lifeminimum and maximum allowable overcoating periods and drying and curing times Very approximately a difference of 10EacuteC can double or halve the time as appropriate The effect varies with the quantity of solvent present the type of curing agentand mass of paint This should be checked for each type and make of paint used Apart from their effect on paints lowtemperatures may lead to moisture condensation on cold steel surfaces This can lead to problems with paint applicationWhen temperatures have to be raised only indirect heating methods should be used Heaters that produce combustionproducts inside the shop should be avoided In situations where it is impracticable to heat the whole shop local heating in theworking area may be employed Where the steel surface has to be heated this must be carried out cautiously to avoidcontamination or overheating of the steel itself
The outer surface of a paint film should never be force heated in order to speed drying This is because with most materialsparticularly two-pack that cure by chemical reaction this will cause the top surface of the paint to cure and leave theunderlying paint film uncured this can occur in hot sunlight on a newly applied paint and the effect is magnified with blackor dark-coloured coatings
5232Relative Humidity
The moisture content of the air has an influence on painting operations and is indicated by the relative humidity at a particulartemperature Relative humidity is important during paint application for two reasons Firstly depending on the amount ofmoisture in the air and the temperature of the steel surface some condensation may occur on the steel and this may lead toadhesion problems with some paints Secondly some paints are sensitive to humidity during their curing regardless ofwhether condensation occurs or not
It is normal practice to specify that paints shall not be applied to surfaces that are within 3EacuteC of the dewpoint The higherthe relative humidity the greater the risk of condensation for example in the temperature range 0ndash10EacuteC if the RH is 80 thetemperature needs to drop 4 degrees before condensation occurs but at 98 RH it only needs to drop a half a degreeTherefore if the RH is 85 or higher painting operations should be critically reviewed since the dewpoint is only 1 or 2EacuteCaway at the most These degrees of cooling may be reached during application solely by solvent evaporation effectparticularly when there is rapid evaporation of solvents such as with low-boiling types with high evaporation rates Fastevaporation of solvents can therefore reduce the temperature of the paint droplets below the dew point during the applicationWhen this occurs moisture from the atmosphere condenses on the surface of the paint particles and is then entrapped in thepaint film This may prevent proper film formation
An important factor is the trend of humidity conditions If weather conditions can confidently be expected to remain staticor improve in say the following 6 hours then application could start when the surface to be painted is less than 3EacuteC abovedewpoint
Some paint systems such as moisture-cured urethanes and zinc silicate primers require a degree of moisture before theywill cure but most high-performance coatings are adversely affected by moisture during application and curing
The relative humidity conditions applicable to various coatings should be but are not always given in the paintmanufacturerrsquos data sheets
5233Ventilation
Ventilation is necessary in a paint shop or confined space to keep the concentration of fumes and vapours to an acceptablelevel This requirement is determined by the threshold limit value (TLV) for solvents
This is the total in parts per million of the solvent which over an 8-hour day will give no ill-effects Tables providing thisinformation have been prepared and for some solvents including most ketones it is low eg 50ndash100ppm Generally in modernpainting shops overspray is collected using either down-draught ventilation near where the painting is carried out or by usingspray arrestors However ventilation is also required in other parts of the shop to reduce the possibilities of explosion of low-flash-point solvent and also to reduce the amount of dust and contamination in the shop
72 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
5234Lighting
Adequate lighting might appear to be a fairly obvious requirement but in some paint shops and under some site conditionsthe amount of light is in fact inadequate for proper painting of the steel and effective inspection of the applied paint coating Theintensity will be determined by the type of work but generally requires to be between 500 and 1000 lux
5235Wind and Weather
Exposure of surfaces before paint application or of uncured paint films to rain frost or dew will generally have a damagingaffect both on the inherent adhesion and on the ultimate durability
Painting in high winds should be avoided especially when spraying as apart from risk of overspray the wind blowing acrossthe atomised paint can result in a powdery porous dry-sprayed film High winds also increase the possibility of dirt sanddebris etc falling on the cleaned surface of the wet paint
524Storage of Paint
Paint must be stored in proper store rooms under proper temperature control with adequate fire precautions and should beopen only to authorised personnel All paint and solvent containers should be clearly marked and recorded in a book so thatstock is used in the correct order If the shelf life is exceeded then the particular paints should be disposed of or dependingon the contract terms returned to the supplier
525Preparation of Paint Before Use
Even where paints are properly stored it is necessary to prepare them correctly before use Pigments tend to settle duringstorage so thorough mixing is required to ensure homogeneity This is particularly important with heavy pigments eg inzinc-rich paints If these are not thoroughly mixed the dry film may not meet the requirements of the specification Beforemixing the paint should be brought to the approximate temperature of use Mixing is usually carried out mechanically in specialequipment by means of revolving stirrers Alternatively up to about 20-litre cans can be prepared by shaking in suitable unitsIf manual mixing is to be carried out this should not be attempted with larger containers of paint a can size of about 10 litresis the maximum that can be mixed in this way Two-component paints eg epoxies must be mixed carefully The lsquohardenerrsquoshould be added in the correct ratio as specified by the paint manufacturer Two-pack materials should only be used in thecomplete lsquopackrsquo size Attempts to use fractions inevitably lead to incorrect proportions Apart from the inaccuracies inmeasurement there is also the difficulty of making an allowance for the amount of viscous material left on the sides of themeasuring container
The pack size should always be chosen in order to allow for application within the lsquopot lifersquo of the paint Thinning of paintbefore and during application must be carried out in accordance with the paint manufacturerrsquos recommendations Onlythinners of the recommended type must be used and should be added to a well-mixed paint If after mixing there is any skinor contamination of the paint then it should be strained to remove all foreign particles It is probably necessary to strain allpaints that have been used and left standing for some time
53THE PAINTER
Paradoxically in many countries including the UK a house painter and decorator is more likely to be trained and experiencedin the methods of paint application than an industrial painter working on a major industrial project To rectify this theNational Association of Corrosion Engineers (NACE) in the USA is starting a paintersrsquo qualification programme Painterswill be required to demonstrate their skill in or knowledge of safety regulations degreasing surface preparation of both steeland concrete methods of application and use of quality control instruments such as wet film thickness gauges (see Fig 56) dryfilm thickness gauges and wet sponge holiday detectors
It is to be hoped that other countries will follow this excellent lead However in the past painting contractors have beenreluctant to finance such schemes because of the transient nature of the employment Such ideas can only work if the end-userinsists on and pays a premium for qualified painters and also makes allowance for the interim period at the start of the scheme
PAINT APPLICATION 73
Fortunately in many countries including the UK and the USA there are schemes being implemented for the pre-qualificationor approval under a quality assurance scheme of painting contractors This may well redress this deficiency
54PAINT MANUFACTURERS DATA SHEETS
Data sheets produced by the paint manufacturers provide the major source of information concerning their materials Veryoften compliance with the manufacturerrsquos data sheet forms part of the requirements of the contract Disregarding theserecommendations could relieve the paint manufacturer of any responsibility in the event of subsequent problems It is essentialto possess the latest version of the relevant data sheets which are available to both painters and quality control inspectors
Of necessity a paint material has to be a compromise of properties some of which are in direct conflict with each otherUnfortunately paint manufacturers are reluctant to mention any aspect that requires special care and attention in case itimplies a weakness in their own proprietary material rather than an inherent weakness of the particular type of paint Thefollowing information is the minimum required
(a) General descriptive name and colour(b) Principal characteristics and recommended uses(c) General description of binder and if appropriate main pigmentation(d) Any special requirements in application and use(e) Mass density(f) Solids content by volume and tolerance allowable(g) Recommended dry film thickness with a minimum and maximum permitted(h) Touch-dry time(i) Minimum safe period for the stacking of painted articles(j) Minimum interval before overcoating(k) Maximum interval before overcoating(l) Full cure
(m) Pot life if applicable(n) Properties (h)ndash(m) as above at a range of temperatures
Fig 56 The principle of the wet film thickness gauge
74 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
(o) Shelf life and recommended storage conditions(p) Recommended methods of application(q) If appropriate precautions necessary for any particular form of application(r) Recommendations for suitable spray set-ups where appropriate(s) Recommended thinners(t) Cleaning solvent required(u) Compatibility with primers or topcoats as applicable(v) Mixing instructions(w) Induction time if applicable(x) Safety precautions For most modern paint systems there should be separate data sheets on safety requirements giving
full details of threshold level values and lower explosive limits and any other hazards applicable
REFERENCES
1 Structural Steel Painting A Comparison of Various Work Sites and Procedures NACE Publication 6H 184 19842 Winkeler M amp Van Der Poel H Improved service life expectancy through better edge coverage J Protective Coatings and
Linings (Dec 1989) 16ndash203 McKelvie AN Prediction of the suitability of the weather conditions for external painting Br Corros J 10(2) (1975) 107ndash10
PAINT APPLICATION 75
CHAPTER 6Specialist Coatings and Applications
Modern paint systems can provide very corrosion-resistant coatings and are used successfully in many aggressive environmentsThere are however some situations such as the lining of tanks where although the materials may be similar to those used forstructural steel there are special requirements
There are also specialist coating materials such as powder coatings tapes and fire-proofing coatings that are alsoassociated with structures
61COATING OR LINING OF TANKS
Coatings for tank internals are often called linings and they may be applied directly to the steel as coatings or as sheets cut toshape and cemented to the steel to provide a barrier to the liquids in the tank The choice of coating is generally determined bythe nature of the liquid and its corrosivity to the steel However with some solutions tainting with even a small amount ofiron corrosion products is not acceptable Consequently even a limited amount of corrosion which might not seriously affectthe integrity of the tank has to be avoided by the choice of suitable lining materials and application methods
611Corrosion Protection
From a corrosion protection point of view a tank can be divided into three areas bottom walls and roof both internally andexternally
6111Internal Tank Bottom Corrosion
Providing it is supported the bottom plate is not considered a structural member and is therefore often made of thinner platethan the walls Since water sometimes seawater can collect at this point and differential aeration cells can form due todeposits on the surface bottom plates can suffer severe pitting and metal loss for example 05ndash20 mm per year
Sulphate-reducing bacteria have been detected in oil-storage tanks and this could add to the problem but Delahunt1
considers that pitting from this cause is minimal
6112External Tank Bottom Corrosion
Tank bottoms resting on the ground are susceptible to corrosion attack Ideally the foundations should consist of an inert andcompact surface such as a layer of fine aggregate covered with oiled sand or asphalt or bitumen The use of coal cinders orother acidic materials or large rocks that allow differential aeration cells to form can greatly accelerate corrosion
Corrosion can also be caused by stray currents An external source of DC such as from electrified railways or nearbyimpressed-current cathodic protection may cause current to flow through the ground to the tank bottom and cause pittingMeasurements of potential and particularly fluctuations in the potential can indicate stray currents
6113Internal Wall Corrosion
Attack on the shell occurs at the junction with the bottom plate owing to water collection but this normally extends no higherthan 300mm Corrosion can also occur in the upper courses of the shell because of condensation and corrosive atmospheresentering the tank owing to expansion and contraction of the stored product
6114External Wall Corrosion
The external wall is subject to normal atmospheric corrosion attack with two added problems Firstly the temperature of thestored product if it is different from the ambient can cause condensation Such condensation contaminated with forexample salt spray from a marine atmosphere can cause severe corrosion Secondly if the tanks are lagged then regardless ofthe type of insulation used corrosion under the lagging can be very rapid and severe
Hot tanks experience severe attack of the walls at the bottom where the insulation can become saturated with waterRefrigerated tanks can corrode under the insulation on the roof and upper strakes Pitting rates of up to 15 mm per year havebeen reported and such corrosion is impossible to locate by visual inspection without removal of the insulation
Methods of prevention for such corrosion usually include the provision of external cladding of either metal or a masticcoating to prevent water penetration Mastic systems based on butyl or Hypalon rubber are becoming increasingly popularbecause they can be more easily and effectively sealed at points where the insulation is penetrated for example at ladderfixings and the like In addition it is advisable to paint the steel before applying the insulation with a suitable barrier coat suchas polyamide-cured epoxy or coal-tar epoxy Zinc-rich systems should not be used for this purpose
6115Internal Corrosion of Tank Roofs
In roof areas corrosion can occur owing to condensation and the corrosion rate may be greatly accelerated by chlorides fromthe atmosphere or hydrogen sulphide from the product under store such as oil Overlapping roof plates that are not sealedunderneath also provide crevices that cannot be painted and will promote corrosion If permissible in the design of thestructure such areas should be sealed by welding
Severe corrosion can occur with floating roof construction because the movement of the roof can dislodge corrosionproducts and reveal a fresh surface for corrosion attack
6116External Corrosion of Tank Roofs
This is similar to that occurring on the tank walls except that buckling of plates depressions on flat surfaces etc can causeponding of water and accelerated corrosion
612Lining Materials
A wide range of coating materials is used for tank linings The choice will depend upon the nature of the solutions to becontained or in the case of solid materials the amount of abrasion and wear likely to occur
The materials considered below are those most commonly used Some general indication of their chemical resistance isgiven but detailed advice should be sought before selecting linings for highly corrosive liquids Useful tables on the chemicalresistance of various materials have been published2 but it may be necessary to carry out tests before finalising the choice oflining Variations from published data such as differences in concentration and temperature or impurities in the solutionsmay affect the performance of lining materials
6121Organic Coatings
These are usually liquid materials applied by spray roller or brush The types most frequently used are based on two-packepoxy coal-tar epoxy chlorinated rubber vinyl or zinc silicates To provide a high-build material some of these may be
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 77
reinforced with sand carbon glass fibre or glass flake When the epoxies are used they may be cured by less common curingagents such as those based on amine adduct which give added chemical resistance but require more care in application
For tank linings surface preparation is even more important than for structural steel and additionally full continuity testingof the finished coating may well be specified (see Chapter 9)
For very thick coating systems and particularly for the repair of corroded tank bottoms hand lay-up of glass reinforcedpolyester coatings over an epoxy primer is frequently used Glass fibre or glass flake-reinforced epoxy resins are also usedand have excellent adhesion and good chemical resistance particularly to alkalis which is a weak point for the polyestersThe epoxy systems however are generally more expensive and because only solventless types can be used at the thicknessrequired they tend not to wet out the glass fibre or flake quite so satisfactorily
In the petroleum industry there has been a move towards vinyl esters because they have superior resistance to unleadedfuels The vinyl esters are based on an epoxy resin reacted with an acrylate monomer and dissolved in styrene Likepolyesters they cure by the addition of a peroxide catalyst
The polyesters and vinyl esters in particular require special care in handling and application Nill of Phillips PetroleumUSA has published a comprehensive proposal for the method of installing fibre-reinforced plastic (FRP) coatings inpetroleum storage tanks3 It is particularly concerned with the safety requirements method of repairing holes surfacepreparation and quality control
For exceptional corrosion and solvent resistance it is sometimes possible to use the heat-cured systems based on phenolicor epoxy phenolic resins In the fully cured state these are odourless tasteless and non-toxic and are therefore suitable for thestorage of food products or drinks They also have excellent resistance to boiling water acids salt solutions hydrogensulphide and various petroleum products Curing temperatures depend upon the formulation being used but are normally between130 and 300EacuteC both temperature and time are critical and therefore such applications are difficult or sometimes impossiblefor site work
Other organic-type lining systems include thermoplastic resins such as polyvinyl chloride polypropylene polyvinylidenefluoride4 chlorinated polyether and chlorosulphonated polyethylene2 Although in some cases these plastics can be applied asdispersions for tank linings they are normally in sheet form The sheets are often provided with a woven glass fibre clothbacking in order to assist adhesion to the steel The seams are then heat-welded to provide a continuous lining Thesematerials or their adhesives have temperature limitations but have the advantage of being able to apply a thick film in oneapplication Sheet linings are usable in thicknesses varying from 15 to 6mm
A number of sheet lining systems are based on elastomeric materials such as semi-hard or soft rubber neoprene or hypalonThe rubber systems have excellent ageing properties particularly when protected from heat or oxidising solutions Neopreneis superior to rubber in its resistance to oils sunlight heat etc Hypalon is used where resistance to sunlight ozone abrasionaliphatic oils and oxidizing chemicals is required
6122Cementitious
Cementitious linings are composed of inert aggregate in an inorganic binder such as potassium or sodium silicate Thesematerials can be applied by trowel but for linings normally a special high-pressure spray system is used To assist adhesionspecial anchor points are generally welded to the substrate
The actual lining material has good heat abrasion and corrosion resistance but in situ tends to crack due to thermal cyclingand has poor resistance to steam alkalis and weak acid solutions They are therefore normally applied over an acid-resistantmembrane
In the majority of cases Cementitious linings are applied at site because transport of a lined tank would involve extraweight and the danger of cracking of the lining due to the flexing of the tank walls
Acid-resistant brick linings are also used for the protection of certain types of tanks or process vessels The cement mortarbetween the bricks can be based upon polyester phenolic epoxy or Furan cements depending upon the service conditions
78 SPECIALIST COATINGS AND APPLICATIONS
613Application of Linings
6131Design Requirements
Tank linings require an exact specification careful application and rigorous inspection Surface preparation is normallyrequired to a higher standard than for structural steel
Correct design of the tank is important For example it has to be realised that there must be sufficient and suitably sizedaccess holes for all the equipment ventilation hoses etc
All holes cracks and the like need to be repaired before work starts It is also generally necessary to fill all lap seamsdepressions sharp corners etc with epoxy putty to provide a smooth surface All steel edges should be rounded to a smoothcontour Porous or rough welds must be treated In riveted tanks it is desirable to seal-weld the rivets and install water stops3
Contrary to what may appear obvious many authorities believe that coating application should start at the bottom of the tankand work upwards This is because it is exceptionally difficult to rid the tank floor of all traces of abrasive Treating thatsurface first gives the minimum amount of abrasive that has to be removed before the coating is applied Only non-metallicabrasives should be used Obviously the applicator must take special care to avoid damage to the coating already appliedRubber soled shoes or overshoes should be worn by any person inside the tank after the primer has been applied and ideallythese shoes should be changed and left inside the tank on entering and leaving
6132Rigging or Scaffolding
Tanks up to 10m to the higher point in the roof are often painted using movable platforms The height of the work platformshould not exceed four times the main base dimension
Beebe5 suggests that higher tanks and those up to 9 m in diameter can be painted with a paintersrsquo boom or lsquomerry-go-roundrsquo This consists of a tight vertical cable between a roof opening and a fixing lug on the tank bottom The painterrsquos stageis controlled by ropes attached to the vertical cable and manipulated by the painter and a helper on the floor of the tank
Even larger tanks can be painted using a swing stage This requires two attachment points one at or near the top centre ofthe tank and one on or near the tankrsquos walls
All this points to the need to consult experts on rigging at the design stage of the tank so that attachment points can beincluded to provide safe effective and economic access
6133Ventilation
Toxicity of solvent vapours and risk of explosion are the hazards most likely to be present when painting inside a tank orconfined space However ventilation is not only necessary for reasons of safety the performance of a coating system can begreatly affected by the type and amount of solvent trapped in a coating when it cures or dries Adhesion water resistancemechanical or chemical properties can all be adversely affected Very slow evaporation of trapped solvents can also developinternal stresses Condensation of solvent onto adjacent coated surfaces can also cause problems
Many solvents are heavier than air and if the ventilation is inadequate can remain in stagnant pockets at the base of the tankIdeally air should be exhausted from the bottom of such tanks and clean air drawn in from the top of the tank In additionsuction fans tend to reduce the air pressure within the tank slightly and this helps with solvent evaporation
Exhaust fans must be capable of achieving the required volume of air movement Table 61 gives typical ventilationvolumes for maintaining solvent vapour concentrations below 10 of the Lower Explosive Limit6
Table 61Typical ventilation volumes required to maintain solvent vapour concentrations below 10 of the LEL
Tank volume (ft3) Ventilation volume (ft3min)
670 1000
2800 2000
8400 3000
11200 4000
14000 5000
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 79
Tank volume (ft3) Ventilation volume (ft3min)
28000 6000
56000 10000
112000 20000
168000 30000
From Ref 6
6134Dehumidification
In cold climates or at night-time in hot climates the temperature of the air inside the tank is often higher than outside This isparticularly so if the temperature is raised in order to speed cure and the walls are not insulated Under these conditions thehot air impinging on the tank walls can cause copious condensation The solution is dehumidification of the air to reduce themoisture content to 50 RH or less However some applicators claim that very dry conditions for example below 20 RHmake the atmosphere uncomfortable to work in and causes respiration problems
In selecting a dehumidifier for the job emphasis should be put on its low-temperature performance since this is when it ismainly required Refrigeration dehumidifiers are commonly used in industry and are capable of removing large amounts ofwater at high temperatures and during winter conditions when the water has to be frozen out of the air rather than condensedas a liquid Absorption or desiccant dehumidifiers on the other hand have nearly the same performance in summer or winterbecause the affinity of the chemical absorbent for moisture is not greatly affected by temperature
The benefits of dehumidification to the contractor are considered7 to be that
(1) Crews can start work earlier in the morning(2) It generally enables large areas to be prepared and completed in one go(3) It avoids possible delays between application of coats(4) It enables a contractor to predict accurately when the work will be completed rather than being at the mercy of the
weather
6135Inspection
Inspection of the application of tank linings generally needs to be even more rigorous than for structural steel NACE haveprepared a recommendation for the inspection of linings on steel and concrete8
62POWDER COATINGS
The use of powder coatings has increased significantly in recent years They offer films with excellent corrosion and chemicalresistance high resistance to abrasion and excellent adhesion to metal and being totally free from solvents they are moreacceptable in this age of heightened awareness of environmental issues
There are two broad groups of resins or polymers used for powders to produce what are commonly called plastic coatingsThese are thermoplastic polymers which can be heated without chemical change the process can be repeated any number oftimes and thermosetting polymers which when heated produce a chemical change which is permanent Some examples ofthermoplastic powders used for corrosion protection are nylon 11 nylon 12 low-density or high-density polyethylenepolypropylene ethylene vinyl acetate (EVA) polyvinyl chloride (PVC) and chlorinated polyether (Penton)
In general the nylons have excellent resistance to oils solvents and abrasion the polyethylenes can resist strong acids andother corrosive fluids EVA resists mild acids and alkalis and is particularly suitable for marine conditions PVC has goodresistance to impact and moisture and is comparatively cheap Penton is a relatively expensive material which is used for thecoating of smaller items such as pumps and valve bodies
All thermoplastic materials have limited resistance to heatSome examples of thermoset powder coating systems used for corrosion protection are epoxy epoxypolyester hybrids
polyestertriglycidal isocyanate (TGIC) and polyesterisocyanate (PUR) In general these materials harden rapidly have good
80 SPECIALIST COATINGS AND APPLICATIONS
adhesion after curing and excellent chemical and corrosion resistance The epoxy and epoxypolyester systems haveoutstanding chemical resistance especially against aqueous acids and alkalis The epoxypolyester powder systems arepreferred for decorative interior use but have limited gloss retention and resistance to yellowing on exterior exposure Whereweather resistance is required the TGIC and PUR systems are preferred The TGIC system has the advantage of lower curingtemperatures and shorter curing times plus better film coverage on edges9
621Application Methods
The following methods are used to apply these coatings(i) Spraying most thermoplastic materials can be applied in this way although it is usually more expensive than the
dipping processes Some fluorocarbons can only be applied with this technique(ii) Flame spraying in which the powder is heated as it passes through the nozzle of a special spray gun and the molten
powder falls onto the steel in the form of globules which are then fused together with gentle use of a flameA comparatively recent development is flame spraying of thermoplastic powder back pack weighing ca 6 kg (13 lb) that
is portable enough to be used for application on site10 The system uses finely ground powder fed through a propane-compressed air flame The flame melts the plastic into droplets which strike the substrate with enough velocity to flatten outand form a continuous film It is claimed that the coating thickness can be controlled at any required thickness between 75 and300 micro m Since the flame is used only to melt the powder and is not directed onto the surface it can be applied to any type ofsubstrate
(iii) Electrostatic spraying has been discussed in Chapter 5 and is unusual in that the whole surface of components can besprayed from one position This is the most widely used method of applying thermoset powders as for example in pipecoating see section 66
(iv) Vacuum coating is a specialised process used mainly for pipes and chemical vessels to be coated with Penton powderA high vacuum is used to draw powder from a fluidised bed onto the heated object to be coated The vacuum is maintainedduring the fusion of the powder so eliminating the possibility of air entrapment
(v) Dipping covers two different processes The plastisol method consists of dipping a primed and heated steel object into atank of cold plastisol which is a colloidal dispersion of the resin in a plasticiser The action of the heat results in the formationof a gelatinous deposit arising from the cross-linking of the main components Heating at about 175EacuteC results in fusion into asolid film This method is used to coat tanks pipes and other components with PVC in one coating operation which canproduce thicknesses up to 12mm The technique is widely employed to coat steel strip (see Section 63)
The other method of dipping is based on the fluidised bed technique In this method a tank with perforations at the bottomis used Air is introduced through the perforations to maintain the powder in the tank as a suspension The powder insuspension acts as a fluid When a steel object heated to a temperature just above the melting point of the powder in the bathis dipped into the fluidised bed the powder in contact with the steel fuses to the surface and flows to produce a coating Thesteel object is then removed from the bath and chilled in cold water The thickness of the coating will be determined by thetemperature of steel article when dipped and by its heat capacity effectively its mass
A number of components can be treated at one time in the fluidised bed and in some situations the powder may becomeagglomerated because of the temperature and heat capacities of the objects being processed One method of overcoming thisproblem is to cause the powder to adhere to the article by electrostatic action so eliminating the need to heat the articlesbefore dipping The electrostatic charge is applied from a grid mounted just above the tank bottom which is maintained at asuitable potential to impart the charge to the powder As more of the powder particles adhere to the article the force ofattraction between the article and the charged particles in suspension is decreased due to the insulating effect of the coating build-up and the consequent decrease in electrical conductivity This allows the thickness of coating to be controlled by altering theapplied potential The article with adherent powder is finally fused by heating after removal from the bath
Compared with paint and metal coatings plastic coatings are used to a limited extent on steel structures They are beingincreasingly employed for components cladding and subsidiary parts of structures eg balustrades and for submarinepipelines They are comparatively expensive to apply so tend to be utilised where appearance is important or for specialisedpurposes where plastic-coated steel can be used as a replacement for more expensive alloys or where coatings of highintegrity are required The application of plastic coatings must be carefully controlled to ensure sound films with full fusion ofpowders to provide reasonably pore-free coatings When plastic-coated steelwork is damaged or where it has to be weldedafter coating application some form of lsquotouch-uprsquo is required Generally this is an air-drying paint which is unlikely toprovide protection equivalent to the original plastic coating even special fusion sticks are unlikely to meet this requirementAlso when maintenance is required then air-drying paints are usually used
Special methods have been adopted for field welds on fusion-bonded epoxy coatings which provide coatings of a highstandard However such methods are not generally used for plastic coatings
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 81
63COIL COATINGS
Plastic coatings are applied to thin gauge steel which is used generally in profiled form for cladding and roofing for buildingsand also when formed for some structural purposes Many of the coatings are primarily decorative with only limitedcorrosion resistance and are used internally for domestic appliances office furniture and shelving These will not be discussedin this section which is concerned with those coatings intended for exterior application
Coatings are generally applied to steel that has been zinc coated or hot-dip galvanised for exterior exposure This preventsor delays corrosion at the edges and damaged areas The plastic coatings are applied in one of two ways liquid coatingssimilar to those discussed in earlier sections of this chapter are more commonly used but some coatings are produced using afilm of the plastic material which is bonded to the steel surface Both methods are used in a continuous process applying thefilms to coils of steel which after coating are cut into sheets of suitable size hence the term lsquocoil coatingrsquo
The general method of applying liquid coatings is as follows the coil is fed through the line and is either pickledbeforehand or in some cases is pickled in-line After cleaning of the surface a primary coat is usually applied then baked inan oven and followed by the application of the final coat Different companies vary the process but it follows these general lines
A number of different organic finishes have been developed to provide different levels of performance The major generictypes are as follows
Polyesters at a nominal 25 micro m thickness are low-cost coatings with reasonable flexibility but relatively poor performanceoutdoors Life to first maintenance is claimed as 5ndash7 years11 Silicone modified polyesters at a nominal 25 Uumlm haveimproved colour fastness and resistance to sunlight than polyesters but less flexibility and are more expensive Life to firstmaintenance is claimed as 7ndash10 years11
Polyurethanes at 25 micro m have a durability similar to the silicone modified polyesters but are more flexible and cheaperFluorocarbons can be a 35-Uumlm thick film bonded to the substrate or a dispersion in an acrylic resin to a nominal 25 Uumlm
These materials have good colour stability and chalk resistance but the relatively thin films are more easily damaged duringinstallation than the thicker plastisols It is claimed that these materials will give a life to first maintenance of 10ndash12 years innon-aggressive environments
PVC plastisols at 100ndash200 micro m have the maximum flexibility and resistance to damage and abrasion of all the coatedcladding systems However these materials degrade under the influence of sunlight and rainfall so that the film is erodedbecomes porous and eventually can detach from the substrate (see Figs 6162 and 63) Therefore its durability is least inclean sunny environments and greatest in shaded or dirty industrial atmospheres It is claimed that life to first maintenanceshould be between 10 and 25 years If the system is caught before it starts to lose adhesion it can be overpainted otherwise itis necessary to strip off the coating and replace it with a new coating
There are also special proprietary cladding sheets available which consist of felt impregnated with bitumen on a sheetwhich is generally galvanised The sheet is then top-coated with a coloured finish such as a styrenated alkyd The aestheticdurability therefore tends to be governed by the performance of the top coat
Fig 61 Surface of PVC plastisol before long-term exposure (ouml80)
82 SPECIALIST COATINGS AND APPLICATIONS
Most of the pre-coated sheets are embossed for decorative purposes These tend to collect dirt and grime This can often beremoved by suitable cleaning with warm water containing a detergent with careful brushing where required The use ofsolvents to clean the coatings should be carried out with caution Both chlorinated hydrocarbons and ketones attack PVC so acheck should be made before using organic solvents
With all types of coated cladding it is advisable that the purchaser fully understands the implications of the manufacturersrsquoclaims for durability In some cases this might mean a relatively simple overcoating and in others complete stripping of theoriginal material and replacement with a new and different material In some cases this latter option may be economically oroperationally unacceptable Advice should be sought on this aspect
Premature failure of cladding sheets may also occur due to poor fixing or inadequate design of detailsPre-coated sheets are supplied as standard products and reliance must be placed on the quality control systems operated by
the suppliers As the whole process is capable of a much higher level of control than would be anticipated with coatingsapplied to structural steel there should be little or no requirement for further inspection by the user Any shortcomings in theprocess are not likely to be immediately evident but will result in premature failure of the coating or loss of decorative aspects
Fig 62 Magnification (ouml60) of the surface of a PVC plastisol showing the deterioration after approximately ten years southerly exposurein the UK
Fig 63 Surface of PVC plastisol after 10-plus yearsrsquo exposure to sunlight and weather (ouml80)
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 83
such as colour fading There are no obvious ways by which users can check the properties likely to cause such failures beforeuse The thickness of the coating its freedom from pinholes and forming properties can be checked by standard test methods
Materials used for repainting coated cladding sheets need to be specially formulated to allow for the required flexibilityadhesion etc Currently in the UK a single-pack moisture-cured urethane primer and a high-build single-pack moisture-curedurethane finishing coat is the main system being used for this purpose These materials have the added advantage for siteapplication that they can be applied to slightly damp surfaces and will cure at temperatures as low as copy9EacuteC12
64WRAPPING TAPES
Wrapping tapes are utilised mainly for tubular sections and pipes They can be used for angles and I-beams but the wrappingis more difficult and the protection is therefore often less effective than on round sections If properly applied with suitableoverlapping tapes provide sound protection in many situations They are widely used to protect bare pipes and pipe jointseven where other forms of protection are employed for the main surface Sometimes they are used to provide additionalprotection where pipes are buried in rocky soils
Tapes can be applied by hand over comparatively short lengths but special wrapping machines are generally used thesemay be hand or power operated (see Fig 64) Although tapes are sometimes applied directly to the steel surface it is moreusual to apply a suitable primer and often a mastic or heavy grease to improve the contours for wrapping particularly at jointsThe wrapping may consist of a number of different tapes to provide the required protection with the outer tape chosen to suitthe environmental condition
A range of tapes is available and some of those most commonly used include the following(i) Petrolatum compound tapes consisting of a fabric of natural or synthetic fibre impregnated with a jelly-like petrolatum
compound usually with neutral fillers A petrolatum type primer is generally recommended Such tapes are highly conformabledo not harden and can be applied to irregular profiles They can be wrapped externally with bitumen-type or plastic tapes toresist damage particularly when used under atmospheric conditions
(ii) Petrolatum compound reinforced with woven polypropylene laminate is used with special machines for wrappingpipelines A bitumentype primer is used
(iii) Plastic materials such as PVC or polyethylene are also used for tapes these are usually coated on one side with a rubber-bitumen or a butyl rubber compound
(iv) Cold-applied two pack cementitious coatings combined with reinforcing fabric are used for the protection and sealingof petrolatum tapes
(v) Bitumen and coal-tar compounds are also used with fabric reinforcements A range of products is used some involveheating the material with a flame and some authorities consider this method to be safer to apply than hot-poured floodcoatings These tapes are generally used for buried pipes and a suitable primer is applied before wrapping Other materials arealso used as tapes eg polyethylene may be extruded as a wrap on pipes (see Section 6613)
Fig 64 Applying wrapping tape with a special machine to ensure uniform application
84 SPECIALIST COATINGS AND APPLICATIONS
Although most generally used for pipelines tapes are also used for other purposes eg for insulating bimetallic jointsLogan13 has discussed the use of tapes for protecting steel used in marine environments and an earlier paper14 gave examplesof the application of petrolatum-coated tapes in such situations Generally only tubular or box-type sections have beenprotected as these allow spiral or circumferential wrapping Jetty piles have been protected with tapes in many parts of theworld In all cases the primary protection has been by petrolatum tape over a specially formulated petrolatum primer pasteOuter wraps are chosen on the basis of the aggressivity of the environment and the degree of damage anticipated they haveincluded a cold applied bitumen tape using a nylon carrier with a PVC backing PVC and polyethylene tapes and even apreformed glass reinforced jacket bolted round the pile where severe mechanical effects were considered to be likely
Although tapes are usually comparatively easy to apply the manufacturerrsquos instructions must be followed to ensure a highdegree of protection to the steel If tapes are not properly applied and corrosion occurs at the steel surface it may be someconsiderable time before this is detected Unlike conventional coatings where signs of rusting can be rapidly detected eitherby the visual appearance of rust staining or changes in the coating itself eg blistering there may be no immediate changes inthe appearance of tapes Recommendations should cover the following
(i) Method of application to ensure close contact with the steel and a tight fit without folds(ii) Overlap required when wrapping
(iii) Mastic to be used to contour projections and protuberances(iv) Primer to be used(v) Requirements for outer wrap
65FIRE PROTECTION
Increasingly there is a need to give some fire protection to steel structures This is particularly so for petroleum and petrochemicalinstallations both on- and off-shore The materials traditionally used such as cementitious products have limited physicalstrength and flexibility and are easily damaged in an operational environment This has led in recent years to the developmentof fire-retardant coatings
The majority of paint binders are organic in nature Their organic molecules contain carbon which Under heat will react withatmospheric oxygen and so burn quite readily The function of a fire-retardant coating is to minimise or delay theconflagration and even more important to delay the flames or hot gases coming into contact with the substrate
Fire-retardant coatings fall into three different types(i) Those that work by forming a heat barrier and giving off non-inflammable gases when subjected to a fire Early types
were silicate based but nowadays there are more durable systems based on phenol formaldehyde and polyamide resins In afire these are gradually destroyed to form a heat-insulating carbonaceous char and give off carbon dioxide and water
(ii) Those that are generally based on halogenated compounds such as chlorinated alkyds or chlorinated paraffin andevolve non-combustible gases such as hydrogen chloride or bromine when heated These paints usually contain antimonyoxide pigments and can be formulated on water-or solvent-based resins They are very effective in retarding fire but thecorrosive nature of the gases evolved can be a problem
(iii) Intumescent coatings which are becoming increasingly popular At elevated temperatures they swell up and form athick insulating layer of char or foam Non-combustible gases are also trapped in this layer and add to the insulationOriginally these coatings were based on thermoplastic binders either solventmdashor water-based but there are proprietarymaterials based on epoxy resins which claim improved durability and faster use15
66PIPELINES
There are a number of forms of pipelines (i) laid above the ground (ii) buried and (iii) submarine Some pipelines mayappear in all three forms From the standpoint of corrosion protection buried and submarine pipelines are likely to cause mostproblems The selection of coatings is a specialised matter and often sophisticated application techniques are used Theimportant requirements for factory application of pipe coatings are14 16
(i) All incoming steel must be stored to prevent localised corrosion and in the factory the metal surfaces must be suitablydressed and cleaned from contamination such as oil grease water paint waxes and soluble iron corrosion products
(ii) The surface preparation of the metal must produce a chemically clean surface with the required blast profile overall(including dressed areas)
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 85
(iii) Application must produce homogeneous coatings and where heat is required for curing this must be uniformly appliedand the cure carefully controlled
(iv) Quality control of the preparation and application must be continuous and to a high standard(v) Coated objects must be suitably handled and stored to minimise mechanical damage
In this section some of the more common forms of protection are considered but there are continuing developmentsparticularly on submarine pipelines and those concerned with such matters should keep abreast with them
661Submarine Pipelines
A number of factors must be reviewed when selecting coatings for pipelines immersed in water However one aspect specificto such pipelines is the requirement for concrete weight coatings to ensure negative buoyancy The problems of applying aconcrete weight coating are
(i) The method of application and the aggregate causes damage and penetration of the corrosion protection coating(ii) In the laying operation there can be slippage between the concrete weight coating and the corrosion protection coating
due to poor bonding between the two
These problems particularly apply to relatively thin hard coatings such as the fusion-bonded epoxy In some cases a polymercement barrier coating is used which it is claimed both reduces damage from the concrete weight coat and preventsslippage However such a coating requires a special machine for application and special curing conditions Another solutionis to increase the coating thickness of materials such as fusion-bonded epoxies to a minimum of 625 micro m although apart fromthe extra cost there is no assurance that this is sufficient to eliminate damage Another method to reduce slippage is to use a 1-m wide band of two-pack epoxy heavily filled with aggregate and installed near the trailing end of each pipe before theweight coat is applied
Furthermore cathodic protection is generally used which may involve the removal of part of the coating to allow for thewelding of small steel plates to hold the anode The method chosen for the laying of the pipeline may also influence thecoating selection The four methods commonly employed are
(i) pulling method in which the pipeline is constructed in lengths and pulled into position by winches fixed on shipsanchored at sea
(ii) lay barge method where the pipes are assembled and jointed on a special barge and then lowered to the sea bed fromthe barge
(iii) float and sink method in which the pipeline is prepared on the shore then floated using buoyancy tanks It is thenlowered into place from pontoons
(iv) reel barge in which the pipeline is reeled in long lengths from special craft
The ability of the coatings to resist bending and the effectiveness of field joints will be typical of the factors to be taken intoaccount when selecting coatings Others include
(i) durability in seawater(ii) adhesion to the pipe
(iii) resistance to marine organisms and bacteria present in seawater(iv) abrasion resistance and(v) resistance to cathodic disbondment
The coatings typically used for submarine pipelines are considered below although as noted above there are continuingdevelopments in this field
6611Coat and Wrap
lsquoCoat and wraprsquo was at one time extensively used but other types of coating tend to be preferred nowadays This methodcovers various types of application both hot and cold but generally for hot application the steel is blast-cleaned and pre-heated to about 90EacuteC A coal-tar primer is then applied to the hot pipe followed by a flood coating of a suitable enamel An
86 SPECIALIST COATINGS AND APPLICATIONS
inner wrap such as glass fibre is pulled into the hot enamel and the coating is finally covered with a coal-tar impregnatedwrapping (see Fig 65) Because of the possible carcinogenic properties of coal tar some authorities insist on replacement bybitumen This however can raise problems of reduced durability and increased susceptibility to bacterial attack
Welded joints on-site are often coated by the use of shrink wraps or sleeves These are composed of an irradiated polyolefinbacking which upon brief exposure to a temperature in excess of 128EacuteC for example from a propane torch will shrink fromthe expanded diameter as supplied to a predetermined recovered diameter The sleeves are precoated internally with acontrolled thickness of thermally activated adhesive which bonds to either metal or existing coatings Some problems havearisen due to the fact that the heat application since it depends upon the operator can be non-uniform and cause disbondingat the overlap A further problem arises with overlapping onto bitumen or coal tar in that careless operation of the flame cancause damage
In the USA and the UK there has been a move away from both coal-tar and bitumen enamel coatings because oflimitations in their performance In particular they are
(i) easily damaged during construction(ii) prone to cracking on bending or hydrostatic testing
(iii) cracked and torn by stresses(iv) liable to soften at the higher operating temperatures(v) affected by loss of adhesion between the coating and the steel substrate which combined with the flexibility of the material
allows appreciable corrosion to proceed without detection and(vi) subject to disbonding between the enamel and the concrete weight coating
However there is an equally strong school of thought that still considers that they have an important role for buried and sub-sea pipelines because the coatings are
(i) generally more foolproof in application(ii) sufficiently thick to accommodate flaws in the steel surface
(iii) generally cheaper than other types and(iv) the only ones with genuinely long-term experience
6612Fusion-Bonded Epoxy Coatings
Fusion-bonded epoxy coatings (as compared with coat and wrap coatings) are thin films about 03 mm thick so theireffectiveness depends very much upon the quality of the coating procedures The coating processes can vary but generallyfollow a pattern such as
(i) Degrease then pre-heat to remove moisture(ii) Initial blast-clean to reveal steel surface defects
(iii) Remedy defects by grinding(iv) Final blast-clean to required standard(v) Heat pipe
(vi) Apply epoxy powder by electrostatic methods while pipe rotates
Fig 65 Concrete weight coating on coat and wrap application
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 87
(vii) Quench in water
The steel surface must be of a high standard and the blast-cleaning is carried out to Swedish Standard Sa2auml or Sa3Inspection of a high standard is essential with such a comparatively thin coating and full lsquopinholersquo surveys are generally
carried out The pinholes are repaired before the pipeline is immersed in the sea Large areas of damage are repaired by theapplication of a two-pack epoxy and small pinholes by means of nylon lsquomelt sticksrsquo Lengths of coated pipe have to bewelded together as there is a limit to the length that can be reeled at one time Such areas are often coated in the field with thesame material using portable blast-cleaning induction heating and application equipment Problems that have arisen include
(i) Non-uniform heat sink at the weld causing non-uniform heating and therefore inadequate curing of the epoxy(ii) Water absorption by existing coating at the overlap causing blistering on heating
(iii) Damage by burning of previous repairs using melt sticks which are too close to the weld area
Fusion-bonded epoxy coating cannot be applied in all field situations eg tie-in welds Alternative coating materials must beused Multi-component urethane coatings applied by hot airless spray have been used successfully for this purpose
6613Polyethylene Coatings
In general early experience with these materials mainly applied by the sintered process was very unsatisfactory There werepinholes or lsquoholidaysrsquo in the coatings and large-scale failure from disbonding of the coating from the steel Considerableimprovements have now been made
(i) The application method is by flat extrusion(ii) High strength polyethylene with suitable elongation properties is used
(iii) The materials are checked to ensure that they have high resistance to environmental stress cracking (tested to ASTM D1693ndash70)
(iv) By attainment of correct profile on the blast-cleaned surface(v) Use of hot thermal bonded primer
German Standard DIN 30670 lsquoPolyethylene coating for steel pipes for gas and water supplyrsquo and British Gas Draft Eng StdPSCW4 lsquoStandard for specification for polythene cladding on steel pipersquo are useful references Some of the problemsremaining are
(i) Although the thicker and more flexible nature of the polyethylene coating is considered to be more resistant to damagefrom the concrete weight coat application there remains the problem of bonding between the two materials The surface ofthe polyethylene needs to be roughened either mechanically or by addition of a surface dressing of small aggregate during thecoating process while the coating is still soft
(ii) Polyethylene coatings must be protected from damage by weld spatter The joints have to be coated by cold wrappingtapes or heat shrink wrap-arounds
6614Other Coating Materials
Neoprene and solventless epoxies may also be considered for the protection of submarine pipelinesGenerally the pipelines are regularly monitored in situ and cathodic protection is also normally employed to ensure overall
protection of a high quality The satisfactory protection of submarine pipelines is a matter requiring considerable expertiseand advice should normally be sought from specialists before selecting coatings
662Buried Pipelines
Most buried pipelines are coated and provided the soil is of a suitable resistivity are also cathodically protected Therequirements for the coatings vary depending upon the conditions of burial but the following are typical
(i) Good adhesion to the steel pipe(ii) The coating is reasonably impervious to moisture
88 SPECIALIST COATINGS AND APPLICATIONS
(iii) Resistance to mechanical damage both in handling and during burial(iv) Stability over the temperature range encountered in service(v) Where appropriate suitability for use with cathodic protection and resistance to cathodic disbondment
(vi) Resistance to bacteria in the soil(vii) Suitable electrical resistivity
A range of coatings is employed and selection will be determined by factors such as accessibility of the pipe for repairs typeof soil operating temperatures availability of application methods and of course cost
Sometimes a thermal insulation coating is applied to ensure that the material flowing inside the pipe does not solidify Suchcoatings are usually applied over those applied for corrosion protection Some of the coatings used for pipelines immersed inthe sea are also used for those buried in the ground but the requirements are not the same Buried pipes may be of muchgreater diameter and can be laid directly into trenches The coatings commonly used are discussed below
(i) Galvanised coatings are rarely used without additional protection but provide some cathodic protection at scratches(ii) Bituminous materials produced from naturally occurring bitumens or from petroleum and gas by-products have been
the most widely used coatings for buried pipelines often with glass reinforcements and felt wraps A number of applicationscan be made to build up the overall thickness of the coating The application may be by cold or hot methods and for somepurposes flame-treated tapes of bitumen or coal tar are applied in preference to hot-poured coatings
There has been a good deal of satisfactory experience with these coatings and they are comparatively cheap Furthermorethey can be applied in the field using special machines Damaged areas can also be repaired fairly easily On the other handthey have a limited temperature range somewhere in the region of 0ndash80EacuteC
Coal-tar coatings are used in a manner similar to the bituminous ones They also have a limited temperature range butsomewhat better than for bituminous coatings Asphalt mastics containing sand limestone and reinforcing fibres may beextruded onto pipes to provide thick seamless coatings
(iii) Fusion bonded coatings similar to those used for submarine pipelines can also be used in underground situations(Section 6612)
(iv) Extruded polyethylene coatings (see Section 6613) are also used(v) Tapes are widely used for protecting joints on pipelines and they can also be utilised for the main protection Special
wrapping equipment is used for cold application of the tapes either in works or in the field Generally a number of tapes areapplied to produce a coating of sufficient thickness
(vi) Epoxies coal-tar epoxies and phenolics can also be used and are applied by spray methods The materials may besolventless and are usually applied with specially designed equipment where the steel pipe is first blast-cleaned then coatedand often treated with hot air to assist in curing
REFERENCES
1 Delahunt JF Coating and lining applications to control storage tank corrosion J Protective Coatings and Linings (Feb 1987)22ndash31
2 Coatings and Linings for Immersion Service TPC Publication No 2 NACE Houston 19723 Nill K A proposed standard for installing FRP linings in petroleum storage tanks J Protective Coatings and Linings (Dec 1984)
32ndash424 Johnson ME Chem-Therm Liningsrsquo PVF2 Impregnated Glass Laminate Corrosion Resistant Linings Managing Corrosion with
Plastics NACE Houston 19775 Beebe DG Rigging and ventilation in tank painting J Protective Coatings and Linings (March 1985) 18ndash246 Procedure Handbook Surface Preparation amp Painting of Tanks and Closed Areas Prepared by Complete Abrasives Blasting
Systems Inc in co-operation with Avondale Shipyards Inc USA Sept 19817 LaCasse GA amp Bechtol D Using dessicant dehumidification during surface preparation and coating operations Material
Performance (Aug 89) 32ndash368 RP 0288ndash88 Standard Recommended Practice Inspection of Linings on Steel and Concrete NACE Houston 9 Hoppe M Powder Coatings J Oil and Colour Chemistsrsquo Assoc 71(8) (1988) 237ndash4010 Bocchi G Field application of powder coatings for corrosion resistance J Protective Coatings and Linings (July 1986) 4ndash7 7511 Vyse RG Pre-printed strips for the building and construction industrymdash products and performance Proceedings UK Corrosion 89
Institute of Corrosion Science and Technology London 1989 pp 21ndash21812 Asher JMB amp Pratt EN Repaint Systems for Cladding Proceedings UK Corrosion 89 Institute of Corrosion Science and
Technology London 1989 pp 227ndash23713 Logan AGT Splash zone protection and corrosion tape systems UK National Corrosion Conference Institute of Corrosion
Science and Technology London 1982 p 4514 Parker WD amp Yeigh WH Materials Protection 11 (1972) 31ndash3
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 89
15 Dunk JV Fire-proofing of Offshore Structures with Epoxy Intumescent Materials JOCCA 8910 pp 413ndash42116 Bayliss DA The importance of quality control on fusion bonded epoxy pipe coatings Paper presented at Pipetch 84 Conference
Birmingham 1984
90 SPECIALIST COATINGS AND APPLICATIONS
CHAPTER 7Metal Coatings
Under most conditions non-ferrous metals are more corrosion resistant than carbon steels However they are more expensiveand for many purposes do not have the required mechanical properties The advantages to be gained by combining theproperties of the two groups of metals by coating steel with a non-ferrous metal are clear Zinc has been used to coat steelarticles for over a hundred years and many other examples of metal coatings are commonplace eg chromium plate for cartrims Metal coatings can be applied for decorative and engineering purposes eg for hard facings However as these are notprimarily for steel protection they will not be considered here The metals most commonly applied to impart corrosion-resistance properties to constructional steelwork are zinc and aluminium Of these zinc is by far the most widely used Othermetals and alloys are also used to coat steel in certain critical situations eg lsquoMonelrsquo Although they will be discussed suchalloys are not used as general protective coatings for steelwork
The choice of metal coating for steel is determined by the cost of the particular metal its corrosion resistance and the abilityto apply it economically to the steel The more commonly used application methods will be considered below
71APPLICATION METHODS
Although metals can be applied to steel in a variety of ways including vacuum evaporation and plasma spraying fourmethods are commonly used for structural steel and the components used for construction
(i) hot-dipping(ii) spraying
(iii) electrodeposition(iv) diffusion
(i) and (ii) are used for structural sections and (i) (iii) and (iv) for components and smaller items Other methods are also usedfor protecting steelwork in critical areas in particular cladding and weld overlays Although they are not as widely used as thefour noted above they are sometimes employed for aggressive situations so will also be considered
711Hot-Dipping
Zinc is the metal most widely applied by this method and for heavy steel sections is the only one Tin and lead are commonlyapplied by hot-dipping but not for structural steelwork Aluminium is also applied by this method particularly to sheet steelwhich is marketed as a pre-coated product often as Zn-Al coated sheet Although aluminium can be applied to heaviersections of steel by hot-dipping it is a more difficult and expensive process than for zinc and is rarely if ever used Howeverif an economic form of this process could be developed it might well prove to be a suitable method of coating with aluminiumwhich in many situations provides a higher degree of corrosion resistance than does zinc
Zinc is particularly suited to hot-dipping because of its low melting point (420EacuteC) and the nature of the alloy layer formedduring the process Aluminium is by no means as easy to apply by dipping techniques It has a higher melting point than zinc(660EacuteC) and this means that the bath usually has to be operated at a temperature over 700EacuteC At this temperature the reactionbetween aluminium and steel is rapid resulting in high dross formation Furthermore at this temperature because of thereaction with steel it is necessary to use ceramic-lined tanks which are more expensive than the standard steel type used for zincAluminium oxidises readily to produce an oxide (Al2O3) and this makes fluxing more difficult than with zinc Oxide particlesmay also become entrapped in the coating
7111Hot-Dip Galvanising
The procedures for hot-dip galvanising are as follows(a) Steel is cleaned of grease and oil by a suitable method often with warm caustic soda If the steelwork has been previously
painted it may be necessary to remove any deposits by mechanical cleaning to ensure that proper reactions can occur betweenthe steel and the molten zinc in the bath
(b) The steel is then immersed in a bath containing acid(s) to remove rust and scale This is termed lsquopicklingrsquo and is usuallycarried out in a dilute solution of hydrochloric or sulphuric acid Blast-cleaning may be employed before pickling either to obtainthicker zinc coatings on steel or to remove all sand from iron castings
(c) The steel is then fluxed with ammonium chloride either by immersion in a pre-fluxing bath or by immersion throughflux on the molten metal in the bath Sometimes both methods may be employed
(d) The steel is then dipped into the molten zinc Large sections of steel are dipped directly into the bath If the section to becoated is longer than the bath it may be possible to lsquodouble diprsquo it provided the overall length of the steel is somewhat lessthan twice that of the bath Small components are either fixed in a jig or placed in a suitable perforated container then on removalcentrifuged to remove excess zinc and to eliminate irregularities in the coating This reduces the coating thickness and tends toproduce a matt surface on the other hand it removes excess zinc from threads on nuts and bolts
(e) Sometimes further treatments may be carried out immediately after the steel has been removed from the bath Theseinclude wiping and centrifuging to remove some of the molten metal from the steel
7112Continuous Galvanising
Heavy steel sections are individually dipped but wire tube and sheet can be coated by continuous processes To producecoated sheet coils of thin gauge steel are degreased then treated to remove scale and rust before passing through a protectivegas atmosphere into the zinc bath The strip from the bath passes through fine jets of air or steam which remove zinc toprovide the thickness of coating required The strip emerging from the process may be cut into sheets or coiled for storage andtransport prior to further coating treatments hence the process is often called lsquocoil coatingrsquo
Zinc is the metal most commonly applied in this way However in recent years alloys of aluminium and zinc have beenapplied by the process and are claimed to have superior corrosion properties to zinc Two groups of alloys are used
(i) 55 Al 45 Zn(ii) 5 Al 95 Zn (with small additions of rare earth elements)
The first group are marketed by proprietory names including lsquoGalvalumersquo and lsquoZincalumersquo the second group as lsquoGalfanrsquoThe continuous process is not used for heavy sections but components made from sheet may be used in structures and buildings
7113Reactions Occurring in Hot-Dip Galvanising
When steel is placed in the molten zinc a reaction occurs in which the zinc diffuses into the steel and forms a metallurgicalFe-Zn bond Diffusion continues during the period in which the steel is immersed in the bath zinc diffusing into the steel andiron (from the steel) diffusing into the zinc Consequently the coating consists of a series of Fe-Zn alloys with almost purezinc at the surface In practice the degree of alloying within the coating will be determined by a number of factors Thecomposition of the steel has a marked effect but there are other influences such as the temperature of the bath the time thesteel is immersed in it and the withdrawal rate from the bath
The constituent in the steel that has most influence is silicon which may be present because of its use as a deoxidant in themanufacturing process of steel When rimmed and aluminium-killed steels are galvanised the Fe-Zn crystals are tightlypacked and tend to prevent the molten zinc from reacting directly with the steel so the coating grows by diffusion and tendsto be relatively thin However when silicon is used to deoxidise the steel the coating structure is different and either verysmall or long perpendicular-type crystals form These are loosely packed so the molten zinc is more easily able to penetrate tothe steel Consequently a rapid reaction occurs and a thicker coating is formed than with rimmed and aluminium-killed steelsfor equal immersion times
Although with silicon-containing steels a thin zinc layer forms on the surface and is present when the steel is removed fromthe bath the reaction rate may be sufficient to transform it to a Fe-Zn layer during the time taken to cool the steel to below
92 METAL COATINGS
about 300EacuteC Where this occurs the Fe-Zn layer reaches the surface and this may result in a grey rather rough coating ofuneven appearance
The effect of silicon composition is not linear with respect to the thickness of coating produced and tends to have mosteffect at about 01 Si in the range up to about 02 Si At higher silicon levels than this there may be a reasonably linearrelationship between the silicon content and thickness However it is not possible to generalise because there is aconsiderable variation in the effects of the silicon contents of steels1 2 If steel is blast-cleaned before pickling thenirrespective of its composition it will provide a greater surface area and a thicker coating will be produced
When sheet is galvanised in the continuous process the composition of the steel the time of immersion and thetemperature of the zinc are all carefully controlled to produce a coating with a very thin Fe-Zn layer only a few micrometresthick The remainder of the coating is pure zinc
Steel sheet is often profiled so it is necessary to minimise the formation of the brittle alloy layer to ensure sound formingcharacteristics
7114Influence of the Bath on Coatings
At normal levels of temperature (440ndash470EacuteC) small variations in temperature do not affect the reaction rate to anyappreciable extent
The time of immersion in the bath is usually 5 minutes or less If for some reason the steel is immersed for a longer periodthere is only a small increase in the thickness of the coating not usually more than about 10 However this is influenced bythe silicon content of the steel and the effect will be greater with higher contents The thickness of the coating produced isaffected by the mass of the steel being treated and by its thickness Electrolytic zinc (99ndash95 Zn) is generally used for thebath with small additions of lead and aluminium the latter to improve the brightness of the coating
7115Thickness of Hot-Dip Galvanised Coatings
As noted earlier the thickness of hot-dip coatings is determined by the galvanising procedures and cannot be varied to anymarked extent with most steels Furthermore unlike other coatings the thickness is not quoted in units such as micrometres(microns) or mils (10copy3 in) but in weight of zinc coating per unit area eg ozft2 or gcm2 (for both sides) It is possible toconvert these units to coating thicknesses eg microns taking into account the density of zinc however the coating is oftenof course a series of layers of Fe-Zn alloys and not pure zinc The surface layer may be only a small percentage of the totalthickness on some types of steel Hence while the thickness calculated from the weight per unit area will provide a soundmeasure of the overall protective value of the coating during exposure as the zinc corrodes away some lsquorust stainingrsquo mayoccur This staining arises from the nature of the Fe-Zn layers not from the steel itself
For structural steelwork the thickness of coating is normally in the range 75ndash125 micro m but this can be increased to about 175micro m by blast-cleaning the steel before pickling Steels with high silicon levels will also produce thicker coatings because ofincreased Fe-Zn alloy formation Thicknesses cannot be increased to any significant extent by dipping the steel more thanonce
7116Design of Fabrications for Hot-Dip Galvanising
Although fabrications can usually be galvanised without serious problems care must be exercised in the design of the steelworkto ensure that all parts are adequately coated and that distortion is avoided Experienced galvanisers can advise on therequirements but a number of general points can be made
Venting is particularly important for enclosed spaces During immersion in the zinc bath any liquid eg from picklingcontained in enclosed areas may vaporise and the pressure may be sufficient to cause distortion or even bursting of the steel
Distortion may also occur in the fabrication particularly if steels of widely differing thickness are used This arises mainlyfrom uneven heating in the bath Thinner materials below about 3 mm may need stiffeners to avoid distortion At crevices andjoints acid may remain after pickling When the fabrication is galvanised the acid may become entrapped by the zinc coatingleading to attack on the steel interface under the coating
The molten zinc must be able to reach all parts of the fabrication while it is in the bath To ensure such flow holes should beprovided wherever necessary Some indication of the recommended sizes for vent holes for tubes is given in Table 711
Figures 71 to 73 show recommendations for different types of fabrication3 It is always advisable to discuss the design withthe galvaniser to ensure that adequate coating of the steel is achieved
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 93
Dross is formed during the galvanising process from iron-zinc alloys
Table 71Suitable sizes for vent holes in tubesa
Inside tube diameter (mm) Hole size (mm)
lt13 5ndash6
13ndash25 6ndash8
25ndash40 8ndash10
40ndash50 10ndash15
gt50 gt15a After Ref 1
which being heavier than zinc sink to the bottom of the bath and can cause lsquopimplesrsquo on the surface of the zinc coating Zincoxide forms on the surface of the molten zinc and if it is not skimmed away from the steelwork before immersion and duringwithdrawal it also can lead to poor appearance
Galvanised coatings often have a bright spangled appearance but this is not an essential requirement for a good protectivecoating Steels with high silicon content often produce a dull grey coating This is likely to be thicker than the brightercoatings and provides sound protection where appearance is not important
The general roughening of the galvanised surface may be produced in a number of ways including over-pickling andexcessive immersion times Although not pleasing in appearance such coatings may provide perfectly sound protection
Fig 71 Cropping of internal diaphragms for hot-dip galvanising (Reproduced by courtesy of the Zinc Development Association London)
Fig 72 Where contact surfaces cannot be avoided continuously welded edges of contact areas and a hole drilled through both memberseliminates the danger of explosion in the galvanising bath (Reproduced by courtesy of the Zinc Development Association London)
94 METAL COATINGS
712Sprayed Coatings
Metal coatings applied by spraying should not be confused with paints such as zinc-rich or inorganic zinc silicate Althoughthese may have a high percentage of zinc in the final coating they also contain a binder Sprayed metal coatings are purelymetallic and are sprayed directly from a gun (see Fig 74) onto the steel surface so no binders or solvents are involved
The essential features of the process are as follows Metal in the form of a powder or wire is fed through a nozzle with astream of air or gas and is melted by a suitable gas-oxygen mixture The melted particles are then sprayed onto the steelsurface by compressed air or gas The particles of metal impact onto the surface and a coating consisting of a large number ofthese particles is formed Such coatings are porous because they are made up of many discrete particles which are not meltedtogether There is no metallurgical bonding at the steel surface as occurs with hot-dipping processes There are also no alloylayers the coating is virtually the same composition as that of the wire or powder used for the process Wire is now morecommonly employed than powder for corrosion-resistant coatings
Another method of application is by arc spraying (see Fig 75) This process is based on the formation of an electric arcimmediately before the jets of compressed air The metal is broken into a fine spray of particles by the arc and is projectedonto the steel surface The process operates at a much higher temperature than does the more commonly used gas-oxygensystem for melting the metal Consequently some incipient welding may occur between the sprayed particles and the steelsurface Whether for this reason alone or in combination with others improved adhesion is obtained by arc spraying Thisprocess is sometimes used for aluminium but not for zinc coatings
Since the adhesion of sprayed coatings does not rely upon a metallurgical bond (cf hot-dipping) some form of mechanicalkeying is required Therefore steel must be blast-cleaned with angular grit to provide a suitably roughened surface of highcleanliness To ensure sufficient adhesion for aluminium the steel must be cleaned to the highest standard ie Sa3 (Swedishscale) or the equivalent A similar degree of cleanliness is advantageous for sprayed zinc coatings although adhesion may besatisfactory if cleaning is to a slightly lower standard ie Sa2auml
Fig 73 Cropping of external stiffeners to allow free flow of zinc in galvanising bath (Reproduced by courtesy of the Zinc DevelopmentAssociation London)
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 95
713Coatings Produced by Diffusion
Although diffusion occurs in the hot-dipping process some coatings are produced purely by diffusion processes in which thecoating metal usually in the form of a powder is reacted with steel at a temperature below the melting point of the metalThere is diffusion of the coating metal into the steel and some reverse diffusion of iron from the steel Many metals can beused to provide such coatings but only zinc is used to any extent for corrosion resistance purposes Aluminium and chromiumdiffused coatings are also produced on steel but not primarily for protection against corrosion The term lsquocementationrsquo issometimes used for the method when powders of low-melting-point metals such as zinc or aluminium are used
The process for producing zinc diffusion coatings is called lsquosherardisingrsquo The coatings themselves are generally termed asbeing lsquosherardisedrsquo Sherardising is used primarily for small components such as nuts and bolts it is not used for the mainsteelwork of structures In this process the components are first degreased and pickled They are then packed in zinc powder ordust usually with a diluent such as sand contained in a steel drum This is slowly rotated and the temperature is raised to justbelow the melting point of zinc eg 400EacuteC The drum is rotated for some hours depending on the size of the componentsand the coating thickness required (see Fig 76)
The coating produced is an Fe-Zn alloy An advantage of this method is that there is only a very slight change in thedimensions of the component after coating This is particularly useful for threaded components such as nuts and bolts Sincethe coating is an Fe-Zn alloy it will discolour on exposure to an atmospheric or aqueous environment producing a lsquorustyappearancersquo This does not indicate corrosion of the steel but is unattractive Furthermore sherardised coatings are usually only
Fig 74 Metal spray gun gas type
Fig 75 Metal spray gun arc type
Fig 76 Rotating drum for diffusion process
96 METAL COATINGS
about 25 micro m thick So for both appearance and corrosion performance it is generally recommended that they be paintedSherardising is the only diffusion coating process commonly employed for components used for constructional steelwork
Aluminium coatings can be applied by a cementation process similar to sherardising It is called lsquocalorisingrsquo and althoughsuch coatings can be used for fasteners for steelwork they are much more commonly used to resist high-temperatureconditions lsquoChromisingrsquo is the term used for the diffusion process used to produce chromium coatings They can be producedfrom powders from chromium halide vapours or from a combination of both These are mainly used for oxidation resistanceor for special purposes related to chemical environments eg the prevention of intergranular corrosion of certain alloys Othermetal coatings can be produced by diffusion processes but will not be considered here because they are not used for generalcorrosion-resistance purposes
714Electrodeposited Coatings
Electrodeposition or electroplating as it is more commonly known is a process used to apply many different metals to bothsteel and non-ferrous metals Many of the coatings produced are mainly decorative eg silver plating Chromium plating hasbeen widely used for car trims and for some nuts and bolts normally used for interior purposes However for constructionalsteelwork zinc is the metal most commonly applied by this method usually to fasteners and other small components Theonly other metal used to any great extent is cadmium which is considered to provide better protection in some environmentsHowever cadmium-plated fasteners are not generally used for the bolting of heavy constructional steelwork
The electroplating process is an electrochemical process with the same basic mechanism as that discussed for corrosion inChapter 2 The metal to be coated eg steel is the cathode and the coating metal eg zinc is the anode of the cell Theelectrolyte contains salts of the coating metal and other additions often of a complex nature Proprietary solutions are oftenused for commercial electroplating The steel must be thoroughly cleaned usually by pickling before it is electroplatedComponents such as nuts and bolts may be plated in batches in a revolving barrel while steel wire and strip are usually treatedby a continuous process Generally comparatively thin coatings are produced (about 25 micro m) and these require additionalprotection for exposure outdoors
There is also a form of chemical or electroless plating this is a chemical process and is widely used for nickel lsquoplatingrsquo ofcomparatively expensive components to provide corrosion and wear resistance There is no alloying between the steel and thecoating in either of these methods
715Other Application Methods
Although cladding of one metal onto another eg by rolling is used to produce stainless coatings on carbon steel this type ofcoating is used more for process plants than for constructional work Cladding is used to protect steelwork in the splash zoneof offshore structures although usually only the hot riser pipes The cladding is generally provided by wrapping lsquoMonelrsquo
Table 72Metal coatings for constructional steelwork
Metals generally applied
Application method Alloy layer Structural steel Components General thickness (micro m)
Hot-dipping Yes Zn Zn Al 75
Spraying No Zn Al Zn Al 100
Electroplating No Nil Zn Cd 5
Diffusion Yes Nil Zn Ala 20a Generally only for heat-resistant purposes
(a Ni-Cu alloy) sheet round tubular members and then welding it into place It is a comparatively expensive method and ifdamaged there may be ingress of sea water behind the sheeting leading to galvanic attack on the steel
For other critical areas of ships process plant and offshore platforms highly resistant but expensive metals or alloys maybe applied as weld overlays In this method the alloy eg Inconel 625 is welded to the steel and then treated to produce asmooth surface4 The method is normally used in limited areas for example it has been used for trunnions on lock gates
A summary of metal coatings used for constructional steelwork is given in Table 72
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 97
72CORROSION PROTECTION BY METAL COATINGS
The corrosion protection afforded by metal coatings is basically that of an environmental barrier Its effectiveness isdetermined mainly by the thickness of the coating and its ability to resist attack from the environment
Zinc is amphoteric but stable in the pH range 6ndash125 In air a protective layer of zinc oxide forms on zinc and in dryconditions attack is negligible The presence of moisture leads to the conversion of the oxide to zinc hydroxide which reacts withcarbon dioxide in the air to form a basic zinc carbonate This is insoluble so in comparatively unpolluted atmospheres thecorrosion is low However in the presence of industrial pollutants such as sulphur dioxide acidic surface moisture dissolvesthe zinc Although basic salts are reformed over a period of time zinc corrosion progresses and there is a good correlationbetween the corrosion rate of zinc and the amount of pollution in the atmosphere Chlorides have less effect than industrialpollutants but their presence leads to the corrosion of zinc
Zinc coatings behave in the same way as zinc metal but both hot-dipped and diffused coatings have Fe-Zn alloy layers Theseare at least as corrosion-resistant as zinc (some authorities consider that the corrosion resistance of the alloy is 30ndash40greater than that of zinc6) but they behave differently producing a brown rust-like corrosion product
Generally there is a fairly linear relationship between the thickness of a metal coating and its protective life5 (see Fig 77)Metal coatings unlike paints corrode and it is the rate of the corrosion in a particular environment that will determine the lossof coating thickness and the period of its effectiveness as a barrier Consequently the lives of metal coatings are directlyrelated to coating thickness and to the conditions of exposure The method of application has an influence on the corrosionperformance in part because of the thickness of coating produced by the different methods and also because the nature of thecoating varies with different forms of application The most straightforward example is that of an electrodeposited coatingwhich is in effect a protective layer of non-ferrous metal with no metallurgical bonding to the steel substrate Such coatingsare usually thin and when exposed to an environment they corrode until all the coating metal has been converted to corrosionproducts leaving the steel substrate to be attacked by the environment The period of protection will be determined bythickness of coating and the corrosion rate of the particular metal in the environment of exposure In warm dry interiors therate may be very low so a comparatively long period of protection may be achieved However in most exterior or immersedenvironments the life afforded by such a thin coating will be short and additional protection will be necessary In fact formost constructional purposes electrodeposited coatings of zinc or where employed cadmium should be considered astemporary protection prior to painting
Hot-dip coatings of zinc will initially behave in much the same way as electrodeposited coatings because there will usuallybe a layer of nearly pure zinc at the surface The thickness of this layer will vary On continuously rolled sheet most of thecoating will be zinc whereas on many structural sections only a thin zinc layer will be present Eventually this will corrodeaway leaving the Fe-Zn alloy layer exposed to the environment Although the Fe-Zn alloy layer provides protection to thesteel the appearance is not necessarily acceptable for all structures Therefore for purely cosmetic purposes some form ofpaint coating may be considered as a requirement These circumstances do not arise under immersed conditions or whereappearance is not important
Fig 77 Lives of metal coatings in an industrial atmosphere5 (Reproduced by courtesy of the Institute of Metals London)
98 METAL COATINGS
Diffused coatings such as sherardised zinc are composed virtually entirely of Fe-Zn alloy layers so the brownishcorrosion products are formed at an early stage Furthermore the coatings tend to be thin (12ndash25 micro m) although thickercoatings can be obtained Therefore such coatings are usually applied to components such as nuts and bolts where the changeof dimensions in the threads is slight and finally painted
Both aluminium and zinc sprayed coatings are similar in that small globules of the molten metal strike the surface and areelongated as they solidify Both coatings are porous but aluminium is usually somewhat more so than zinc up to 10although usually about 5 Particles in the coating are surrounded by oxides but eventually there are enough discontinuities toallow sealing of the pores by the corrosion products
Problems can arise with aluminium sprayed coatings exposed to fairly mild conditions because the steel substrate may rustslightly producing some stain on the coating Eventually the pores are blocked but the appearance may be affected by the ruststaining The influence of corrosion product formation may have effects on paints applied over sprayed coatings that havebeen exposed before painting This is likely to be more of a problem with zinc than aluminium coatings The presence ofsoluble zinc corrosion products under the paint film can lead to its premature failure by blistering and eventual flaking Inmost circumstances sealing of sprayed coatings rather than painting is recommended (see Section 73)
The metals commonly used to protect structural steel and the components used with it zinc aluminium and cadmium are allanodic to steel This means that they will protect steel at damaged areas and edges of sheets Furthermore sacrificialprotection will occur at small pores in the coating This additional protection is clearly beneficial but is not the main reasonfor using such coatings this is for overall protection of the steelwork Sprayed aluminium coatings provide this form ofgalvanic protection when immersed in seawater but it is by no means so effective with electrolytes of high resistivity eg inriver waters or in many atmospheric environments
Where the protection to the steelwork is in the form of cladding or weld overlays then over the general areas of coating thecorrosion rate will be determined by that of the metal used for the particular form of protection In the case of weldedcoatings the performance will be similar to that of the cast rather than wrought form of the alloy and these may differ The maindifficulty with cladding where the protective metal is rolled onto the steel arises at edges and these must be given additionalprotection With lsquowrap roundrsquo cladding eg of Monel on offshore platforms any tear or other form of damage may allowwater ingress behind the cladding In the absence of suitable precautions such as applying a thick coat of paint to the steelserious bimetallic attack on the steel may occur Furthermore of course wrap round cladding can generally be applied only totubular members
73ADDITIONAL PROTECTION TO METAL COATINGS
Diffused and electrodeposited coatings nearly always require additional protection mainly because these methods tend toproduce thin coatings Both spraying and hot-dipping are capable of producing comparatively thick coatings and in manysituations these will be sufficient to protect the steel for 25 years or more (see Section 74) so additional coatings may not berequired However in many environments the coatings will not protect the steelwork for this length of time and even wherethey do the appearance may not be acceptable Both hot-dip galvanised and sprayed coatings tend to produce a ratherunattractive appearance after a period of exposure This is more noticeable on large sections than on smaller items such aslamp posts Some form of additional decorative coating may therefore be considered to be necessary The decision to applythe coating may be taken initially or after a period of exposure and the timing does affect the approach to be adopted Forinitial protection it is considered preferable to seal rather than paint the sprayed-metal coatings The sealer impregnates thepores and produces a smoother surface to the coating A range of materials is available7 including two-pack epoxies and two-pack polyurethanes
Vinyl acetate copolymer with non-leafing aluminium flake is often used to seal both zinc and aluminium sprayed coatingsFor a more decorative finish a suitably pigmented vinyl copolymer may be applied as a second sealing coat Some authoritiesconsider that a suitable pretreatment such as a two-pack pigmented polyvinyl butyral coat should be applied to the sprayedcoating before sealing The sealing process is usually carried out in the works immediately after the sprayed coating has beenapplied
The sealing method cannot be used for sprayed coatings that have been exposed for some time If further protection isconsidered necessary in those circumstances then painting will be the only option open This may be satisfactory withaluminium coatings provided they are thoroughly cleaned by brushing and washing However this may not be acceptable forzinc coatings and there may be early breakdown of the paint coating although this will largely depend on the environmentand the nature of the zinc corrosion products It may be necessary in some situations to remove the sprayed coating by blast-cleaning rather than attempting to paint it
The painting of freshly galvanised surfaces provides problems of a rather different kind Often adhesion between the paintand zinc coatings may be poor leading to fairly rapid flaking of the paint This arises from the nature of the freshly galvanised
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 99
surface which is often shiny and may be contaminated with flux and so be somewhat greasy If this greasy film is notremoved the adhesion between the zinc and paint film may be affected A number of approaches have been proposed to dealwith this difficulty and they can be summed up as follows
(i) Light blast-cleaning of the galvanised surface to provide a mechanical key for the paint This method is not alwayspracticable and must be carried out carefully to avoid undue loss of zinc from the coating However it may be the onlymethod suitable for coatings such as two-pack epoxies and urethanes which require a good key for sound adhesionparticularly under immersed conditions
(ii) Application of a solution of T-wash8 a non-proprietary formulation obtainable from many paint companies It isbasically a solution of phosphoric acid in methylated spirits containing a small quantity of copper carbonate which reacts withthe zinc surface to turn it black the surface is then suitable for painting If the surface does not turn black then the treatmenthas to be repeated This method must be used with some caution because an acidic solution is involved Furthermore duringapplication the T-wash reaction with the zinc produces a rather unpleasant smell Although widely and successfully used formany types of paint it may not be a satisfactory preparation for two-pack epoxies and urethanes because the etching may notbe sufficient to provide a good key
(iii) Priming the zinc surface with a suitable paint pigmented with calcium plumbate BS 3698 (1964) provides a suitablestandard for such paints This method is less popular nowadays for two reasons (a) the paints are lead-based and thereforetoxic and (b) they may cause blistering of alkyd top coats
(iv) Two-pack etch primers of a type suitable for applications to galvanised surfaces are also used Such primers can besatisfactory if applied to clean surfaces but are affected by moisture during their curing period and by over-thick coatings
Galvanised coatings initially exposed bare may require painting to ensure the continued protection of the steelworkTypically steel electric transmission towers for electricity require lives in excess of that provided by a galvanised coating in manyenvironments
It is advantageous to paint while there is a reasonable layer of zinc remaining about 30 micro m of zinc coating has beenrecommended as being reasonable This makes for easier surface preparation and provides a good base for the paint Wheregalvanised steel has been exposed before painting is carried out advice is provided in a booklet published jointly by the ZincDevelopment Association (UK) and the Paintmakers Association of Great Britain9 The recommendations are that insituations where there is no rusting of the steelwork all loose corrosion products should be removed and the surface washedwith clean water to remove soluble zinc salts After drying standard primers can be applied Where appropriate lightabrading of the surface and the application of T-wash or an etch primer is recommended
Generally there are no problems in painting sherardised and electroplated coatingsIf the zinc coating has virtually corroded away leaving rusted and pitted steel then it should be cleaned in the same way as
other rusty steelworkProblems may arise if the zinc coating has been given a chromate treatment as a protection against wet storage stain Such
coatings are commonly applied to galvanised sheet steel but more rarely to sections Advice should be sought from the paintmanufacturers if galvanised steel has been chromated and requires to be painted
74CORROSION DATA FOR METAL COATINGS
There is a considerable amount of data on the corrosion of zinc and zinc coatings Tests have been carried out in a variety ofdifferent environments and they have been summarised in a publication of the International Lead Zinc Research Organisation10
Less data are available for aluminium coatings although what has been published tends to show their high level of corrosionresistance Many of the data on zinc coatings have been obtained from the exposure of zinc metal specimens so actualcorrosion rates have been obtained
Although similar tests have been carried out on aluminium specimens corrosion rates are not necessarily quoted as loss inmicrometers per year because the metal tends to pit unlike the more general corrosion of zinc (and carbon steel)Consequently many of the test programmes concerned with aluminium coatings provide qualitative evidence of corrosionperformance based on appearance Nevertheless this evidence is sufficient to show the excellent properties of aluminiummetal coatings In most aggressive environments they are more protective than zinc coatings of the same thickness the mainexception is under alkaline conditions
As noted previously coatings of aluminium and zinc alloys are produced in sheet form by continuous hot-dipping methodsBoth the main groups of alloys 55 Al 45 Zn and 95 Zn 5 Al (with rare earth additions) are superior to zinc in corrosionresistance Only limited data are available In one series of tests the 55 Al-Zn coatings corroded about 2ndash2 micro myear in amarine environment less than half that of the zinc in these particular tests On the other hand aluminium corroded at abouthalf the rate of the alloy coating However the results are not directly comparable and the full results should be studied11
100 METAL COATINGS
741Corrosion Data for Zinc Coatings
7411Atmospheric
A summary of the corrosion performance of zinc coatings is provided in Fig 78 which is based on data supplied by the ZincDevelopment Association and published in BS 5493 (1977) These results are related to the time to first maintenance iebefore actual rusting of the steel occurs This is more realistic than using data based on the corrosion rate of zinc unless thecoating has been chosen for the life of the structure with no planned future maintenance requirements It will be obvious froma study of Fig 78 that the corrosion rate of zinc is markedly affected by the environment of exposure and the protection valueof the coating is directly related to its thickness Whereas a 75-micro m coating may last for over 20 years in a mild atmosphere inone that is polluted ie industrial the life may be only 6ndash7 years Tests have shown a reasonably good correlation betweenthe amount of pollution in the air in particular sulphur dioxide and the corrosion rate of zinc5 The average corrosion rate ofzinc specimens exposed at different sites is shown in Table 73 The description of the sites is of a general nature and the dataare provided to show the general variations in the corrosion rates of zinc For example in tests carried out at three
Table 73Average loss of zinc at various locations (2-year tests)a
Site Type Zinc loss (micro myear)
State College Pennsylvania USA Rural 12
Durham New Hampshire USA Rural 16
Ottawa Canada Urban 111
Columbus Ohio USA Urban 22
Detroit Michigan USA Industrial 14
East Chicago Indiana USA Industrial 16
Cleveland Ohio USA Industrial 28
Battersea London UK Industrial 58
Widnes UK Industrial 105
Manila Philippines Marine 15
Fig 78 Lives of zinc coatings in different environments3 (Reproduced by courtesy of the Zinc Development Association London)
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 101
Site Type Zinc loss (micro myear)
Daytona Beach Florida USA Marine 21
Dungeness UK Marine 37
Galeta Point Beach Panama Canal Zone Marine 159a Based on Metal corrosion in the atmosphere 1967 ASTM STP 435
different sites in Sheffield (England) all within an area of a few square miles the average rates of corrosion were 675 115and 125 micro m per year5
Tests carried out by the American Welding Society12 on sprayed zinc coatings provide useful data over a period of 19 yearsAlthough corrosion rates were not determined the report contains full visual descriptions of the specimen surfaces Theadvantages of sealing are demonstrated and generally the corrosion follows the anticipated pattern
7412Immersion in Seawater
As can be seen from Fig 78 the corrosion rate in seawater is about 15ndash17 micro m per year A range of tests has shown corrosionrates from 10ndash25 micro m per year In the splash zone higher rates of corrosion may occur particularly on some tropical and surfbeaches where inhibiting magnesium salts may not be present in the seawater In most natural waters zinc performs well butthis is to some extent determined by the formation of protective scales so corrosion will be higher in soft waters
742Corrosion Data for Aluminium Coatings
As noted earlier there is little firm corrosion rate data for aluminium coatings For constructional steelwork only sprayedcoatings are of direct interest As shown in Fig 77 based on tests carried out in the industrial environment at Sheffieldaluminium coatings are usually more resistant than those of zinc This is confirmed in the American Welding Society 19-yeartests where in many environments aluminium was still protecting the steel over this period In seawater immersion testssealed aluminium coatings of thickness 150Uumlm were still protecting the steel after 19 years although there was evidence ofcorrosion of the aluminium Zinc coatings did not protect the steel for this period when immersed in seawater Even underalternate exposure to the atmosphere and seawater of splash-zone conditions the sealed aluminium coatings over 80 micro m inthickness performed well
In tests carried out on hot-dip aluminium specimens11 again aluminium and incidentally 55 Al-Zn coatings performedmuch better than zinc coatings
743Corrosion Data for Cadmium Coatings
The corrosion rates for cadmium in different environments have been established in a number of test programmes13 Typicalcorrosion rates in micrometres per year are as follows industrial 102 urban 23 and marine 13
75THE SELECTION OF METAL COATINGS
A number of points must be taken into account when considering metal coatings as the method of protecting steel Theobvious comparison is with paint coatings but even where metal coatings have been selected the choice of metal and in thecase of zinc the method of application have to be considered Compared with paint coatings there are advantages anddisadvantages these can be summarised as follows
ADVANTAGES OF METAL COATINGS
(i) Application is more straightforward than with paint systems and is more easily controlled(ii) The life is more predictable and usually premature failures do not occur
(iii) Handling is easier because there is no requirement for drying and metal coatings resist damage to a greater extent(iv) If damaged there will be sacrificial protection by the coating metal This is more certain with zinc than with aluminium
coatings
102 METAL COATINGS
(v) They have good abrasion resistance(vi) Unlike paint coatings they generally have a thick coating on edges
(vii) Standards exist for most metal coatings and this makes specification more straightforward and ensures a higher level ofcertainty of performance
A particular advantage of hot-dip zinc coatings is that faults in the coating are readily detected This is not of course the casewith paint coatings nor are faults so readily detectable on sprayed metal coatings On hot-dip and sherardised coatings thereis a metallurgical bond with the steel ensuring the highest level of adhesion
DISADVANTAGES OF METAL COATINGS
(i) For many situations the coating will not of itself provide protection for more than a short time so has to be painted Inmost situations maintenance painting will be required over the life of the structure where metal coatings are appliedinitially but this would also be required with paint coatings
(ii) Where welding is carried out after the metal coating has been applied or where severe damage to the coating occurs itis difficult to treat such areas to provide the same standard of protection as the rest of the structure (Fig 79) (Similarproblems also arise with paint coatings)
(iii) With hot-dip galvanising there is a limit to the size of fabrication that can be treated and a limit on the availability ofgalvanising plant Also the smaller the section the thinner the zinc coating which inevitably leads to fixings nuts andbolts etc having poorer protection than the main structure
(iv) Without additional protection metal coatings often develop an unattractive appearance
ADVANTAGES OF PAINT COATINGS
(i) Painting facilities are widely available in shops and on-site(ii) A wide range of colours is available and paint coatings can provide a high cosmetic appearance eg gloss
(iii) A range of materials is available for different requirements Unlike metallic coatings paint coatings are available withgood resistance to acidic conditions
(iv) There are no limits on size or type of structure(v) Paint application is generally straightforward
DISADVANTAGES OF PAINT COATINGS
(i) The main disadvantage of paint coatings arises from the application process This provides endless opportunities forpoor workmanship which can often not be detected after the next stage in the process has been completed This canhowever be taken into account by adopting suitable quality control procedures
(ii) It is often difficult to predict the life of paint coatings Even where standards or specifications for paint are availablethey do not provide the same degree of certainty regarding the product as do standards for metal coatings
Fig 79 Rusting at untreated weld on galvanised tube
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 103
76CHOICE OF METAL COATING AND APPLICATION METHOD
For all practical purposes the choice of metal coating for structural steel sections lies between sprayed aluminium sprayedzinc and hot-dip galvanised zinc
The advantages of spraying over hot-dipping arise from the limitations in size of the galvanising bath and the ability tospray metal coatings on-site although in practice this is rarely done Hot-dipping is more easily controlled and if steel isblast-cleaned reasonably thick coatings can be applied Problems can arise if freshly galvanised steel is to be painted butthese problems can be overcome In most circumstances hot-dip galvanising would probably be preferred to sprayed coatingsif only because of the difficulties that may arise from painting sprayed coatings after some years of exposure Sprayedaluminium coatings have been shown in tests to provide a high level of corrosion protection to steelwork and although suchcoatings have been applied to structures quite successfully there are many fewer coated with aluminium than with zincNevertheless it is somewhat surprising that so few structures are coated with aluminium in view of its corrosion-resistanceThis may arise in part because the amount of aluminium used for coatings is a very small percentage of the total use of the metaltherefore there is no great incentive on the part of aluminium producers to encourage its use
This is quite a different situation from that concerning zinc where the use of the metal for coatings is a significantpercentage of the total production Consequently more data are available and a considerable amount of marketing is carriedout The standard of surface preparation probably has to be higher with sprayed aluminium than with sprayed zinc coatings toensure satisfactory adhesion
The choice between hot-dip galvanising and sherardising for components such as nuts and bolts is not clear-cut Theadvantage of sherardising is the control of tolerances particularly useful for threaded components However the method ismore expensive than hot-dipping for equivalent coating thicknesses Generally fasteners are painted and the sherardisedcoating provides a suitable surface for paints
Electrodeposition is only economic for very thin coatings For exterior application such coatings should be considered asproviding temporary protection prior to painting
77TREATMENT OF WELDED AREAS
Where metal coatings are applied after fabrication welded areas can be cleaned and treated in the same way as the rest of thesteelwork However where field welding is required welded areas must be treated on-site Although the most satisfactoryway of dealing with welds would be to grind them then blast clean and metal spray with zinc this is often not practicable andis rarely carried out The usual way of dealing with welded areas is to clean them often by wirebrushing and scraping andthen to apply a zinc-rich paint The application of a suitable thickness of a zinc-rich paint to a blast-cleaned surface provides areasonable measure of protection although in many situations less than that of the metal coating However application of thepaint to a surface that has not been well prepared will result in early breakdown at the weld areas This reduces the advantagesof using metal coatings for long-term maintenance-free protection Usually the areas in the vicinity of the weld are not metalcoated or the coating is removed before welding
To protect the weld areas of hot-dip galvanised steel a fusible stick similar to solder can be applied to the area aftersuitable cleaning This can be an effective method but is rarely used Figure 79 illustrates rusting on a welded galvanisedtube where the weld has not been protected
78WET STORAGE STAIN
A white porous powdery deposit may appear on zinc surfaces This is often called lsquowhite-rustingrsquo and occurs usually onfreshly galvanised surfaces as a result of wet or damp storage conditions This type of corrosion is most likely to occur withsheets that are not properly stored but can also manifest itself with components such as steel angles and occasionally even onsections
In freely exposed atmospheric conditions zinc coatings corrode to produce zinc oxide and zinc hydroxide which istransformed by carbon dioxide in the air to basic zinc carbonate Where however there is restricted access of air andmoisture or condensates are present on the surface the basic carbonate may not form Typical situations are the crevicesformed by sheets closely packed together The lsquowhite-rustrsquo basically a layer of zinc oxide and zinc hydroxide is voluminousup to 500 times the volume of the zinc from which it is produced It does not adhere well to the zinc so while any moisture ispresent oxygen is available for the corrosion process to continue This form of attack does not usually occur on zinc that hasbeen weathered and so has a protective carbonate layer
104 METAL COATINGS
Although white-rusting often appears to be serious there is usually only a slight attack on the zinc coating This may besufficient to cause problems with thin electroplated coatings but not generally with hot-dip coatings Proper storage conditionswill avoid white-rusting attack by ensuring that moisture does not come into contact with freshly galvanised surfaces steelitems should be arranged so that they are well ventilated with a good flow of air
Sheets cause a particular problem because there is a tendency to stack them together protection against storage stain maybe provided by chromating the zinc surfaces after galvanising such treatments often produce a yellow-green appearance onthe zinc Advice should be sought from paint manufacturers regarding the adhesion of their products to such treatments
79FASTENERS
There are clear advantages to be gained from using metal-coated fasteners even for painted structures Steelwork is oftenpainted in the shop with a final coat being applied on site after erection If bolts are used then if they are given just the finalsite coating which often happens the paint will fail on the fasteners after a comparatively short period Additionally if blackor pickled steel bolts are used they may well rust before the site coat is applied The use of sherardised or hot-dip galvanisednuts and bolts will overcome such difficulties
710BRITISH STANDARDS FOR METAL COATINGS FOR CONSTRUCTIONAL STEELWORK
BS 7291971 (Confirmed 1986) Hot-dip galvanised coatings on iron and steel articles Composition of zinc in galvanisingbath coating weight appearance and uniformity of the coating Repair of damage and embrittlement of steel
BS 1706 1960 (Confirmed 1988) Electroplated coatings of cadmium and zinc on iron and steel Thickness appearanceadhesion Methods of testing for thickness adhesion Humidity tests for passivated coatings
BS 2569 1964 Part 1mdashProtection of iron and steel by aluminium and zinc against atmospheric corrosion Composition ofcoating metal surface preparation of steel coating application Requirements for thickness and adhesion Methods of testingPart 2mdashProtection of iron and steel against corrosion and oxidation at elevated temperatures Covers similar requirements asPart 1 for higher-temperature applications
BS 3382 (Confirmed 1979) Electro-plated coatings on threaded components Part 1mdashCadmium on steel Part 2mdashZinc onsteel components thicknesses and inspection methods
BS 4479 1969 Recommendations for the design of metal articles that are to be coated Covers electroplating hot-dippingand metal spraying as well as other application methods
BS 4921 1988 Sherardised coatings on iron and steel articles
REFERENCES
1 Nordis Forzinkningsforenig Rust Prevention by Hot Dip Galvanising Zinc Development Association London 19802 Ruddle GH et al amp Leroy V et al Second International ILZRO Galvanising Seminar St Louis International Leaded Zinc
Research Organisation New York 19763 Galvanizers Association Galvanising for Structural Steelwork Zinc Development Association London 19794 Powell GA amp Davis RV Proceedings UK National Corrosion Congress London Institution of Corrosion Science and
Technology Birmingham 19825 Iron and Steel Institute Sixth Report of the Corrosion Committee Special Report No 66 London 19596 Kucera V amp Mattsson E Bulletin 78 Korrosioninstitutet Stockholm 19767 Protective Coating of Iron and Steel Structures Against Corrosion BS 5493 British Standards Institution London 1977 p 278 BS 5493 1977 p 379 Recommendations for Painting Galvanised Steel Paintmakers Association of Great Britain and Zinc Development Association
London 198210 Slunder CJ amp Boyd WK Zinc Its Corrosion Resistance Zinc Development Association London 197111 Townsend HE amp Zoccola JO Materials Performance 18 (1979) 1012 American Welding Society Corrosion Tests for Flame Sprayed Coated Steel 9 year report AWS CZ14ndash74 197413 Clarke SG amp Longhurst EE Proceedings First International Congress on Metallic Corrosion Butterworths London 1962
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 105
CHAPTER 8Specifications
Specifications are an essential part of any industrial process and the protection of steelwork is no exception Unfortunatelythe term lsquospecificationrsquo has tended to be used in a variety of ways so before discussing the requirements for the technicalspecification for protective systems on steelwork it may be useful to make a few general points regarding the variousterminologies and documents involved in the specifying process
81STANDARDS AND SPECIFICATIONS
The terms lsquostandardrsquo lsquospecificationrsquo lsquocode of practicersquo and lsquomethodrsquo tend to be used somewhat indiscriminately and thereappear to be no internationally agreed definitions Generally a standard implies a document or method that has been formallyadopted by a recognised group of authorities eg International or British Standards Organisations However standards arenot necessarily authoritative in the sense that they are generally accepted by all those working in a particular field Largeorganisations and government bodies produce standards which are used primarily for procurement purposes In the authorsrsquoview a standard should provide a method of testing its effectiveness and should be precise within the limitations set downleaving no doubt as to whether or not the requirements have been met Typically a standard for a paint should either providesufficient compositional data to ensure that paints made to the standard fall within a clearly defined range of products or provideclear performance requirements Usually of course unlike standards for materials such as steels those for paint because ofthe way it is manufactured cannot normally provide the stringent compositional requirements that would ensure every paintmade to the standard was virtually the same As an analogy with the kitchen this is similar to the fact that cakes baked to thesame recipe by different people do not always taste the same Nevertheless some compositional data are necessary if only forthe purposes of being able to specify a particular type of paint
Generally performance specifications are preferred by paint manufacturers and most paint standards combine compositionand performance requirements Sometimes what have been referred to here as standards are termed lsquospecificationsrsquo Forexample the Steel Structures Painting Council of America has a series of paints specifications eg for silicone alkyd paint (No21)1 which could be considered as standards The term specification has two connotations it may be as above a standard orit may be a contract document providing a precise set of requirements Included in the latter type of specification there wouldalmost certainly be reference to other standards and specifications eg for surface preparation of the steelwork
To provide the legal framework of such a specification it is necessary to state the technical requirements in unambiguousterms However this is not always an easy matter because of the implication of contracts and procedures not least theresponsibility of the contractor in providing the client with a satisfactory final product Nevertheless the starting point for anysatisfactory operation of this type is the preparation of a sound technical specification and it is this aspect that will beconsidered in this chapter
Before discussing specifications in detail a few comments should be made on documents such as codes of practice Unlikemost products concerned with engineering requirements the final value of coatings in particular paint is determined by thequality of workmanship If steel is ordered with reference to a certain standard then there may be a requirement for aconsiderable degree of skill and a high level of workmanship to produce the steel This has been demonstrated by problemsthat have arisen in manufacturing some pipe steels for the oil industry However once it has been manufactured there areclearly defined methods for checking that it meets the standard Problems may arise if it is not properly fabricated (inparticular it is reliant on the quality of welding) Again however clear procedures for checking testing and inspecting havebeen formulated to ensure that sound fabrication is achieved This is ensured partly by standards and specifications and partlyby codes of practice
Codes of practice have an important role to play in steel protection because the quality of workmanship is so essential andalso because it is not always possible to provide standards to cover every aspect of the work This arises partly because of thelack of technical knowledge and partly from the difficulty of preparing a definitive standard that would cover all the situations
and possibilities that can arise when coating steelwork A code of practice is not a standard in the sense that it provides a setof requirements that are contractually binding Rather it sets out the alternatives and advises rather than specifies Someconfusion exists regarding such codes For example it is imprecise or misleading to say in a specification that all surfacepreparation shall be carried out in accordance with BS 5493 (1977)2 the British code of practice for protecting steelworkwithout qualifying the statement BS 5493 and similar codes provide information on all types of surface preparation and adefinitive standard eg ISO 8501ndash119883 should be specified with the grade required
There is a place for codes of practice lsquotechnical guidesrsquo lsquoguides to good practicersquo and other similar documents As thetechnology of coating protection develops with new coatings and techniques for increasingly aggressive situations newproblems are bound to arise Standards cannot be prepared until sufficient data have been collected so as to provide a methodbased on a high probability of success Often though useful information is available and while it may be published in ajournal the views expressed are those of the author The views of an authoritative group of specialists produced by nationaland even international organisations in some form of lsquoguidersquo document would be useful to specifiers
82THE PURPOSE AND DRAFTING OF A SPECIFICATION
The specification has two main purposes
(i) To ensure that the steelwork is properly protected and that the coatings provide the degree of protection required(ii) To provide a suitable basis for accurate pricing and tendering
A poor specification is unlikely to achieve either of these requirementsIt is worth noting that other advantages follow where a sound specification is prepared Disputes are less likely to occur
with the delays that ensue from them and a complete technical reference document is available for all those involved in theproject In the case of a dispute though the conciseness and clarity of the specification will have a considerable influence inany arbitration proceedings or litigation that may follow Many specifications do not meet the required criteria and leadto unnecessary problems It is by no means uncommon for specification documents concerned with an engineering project toconsist of pages of requirements for the materials of construction often in great detailmdashthen a paragraph will appear at theend on the lines of lsquoThoroughly clean the steel surface and apply two coats of a suitable resistant paintrsquo This might beacceptable if an effective guarantee of performance had been included but without it the phraseology and technical contentprovide no useful information for either comparisons of tenders or likelihood of performance As the specification is preparedto ensure that the clientsrsquo requirements are met in a satisfactory manner it is not a confidential document and should be madeavailable to all those who require the information contained in it
The drafting of a specification requires technical expertise and should not be prepared by somebody who does notunderstand the technology involved in coating steel The wide use of computers and word processors has led to the adoption ofa standard specification with inserts to meet the specific project This may be satisfactory in some cases but the finalspecification must always be studied carefully to ensure that it does provide relevant requirements The specification shouldprovide clear guidance for every stage of the process It should be unambiguous practicable and achievable There is often avagueness in specifications which arises either from a lack of expertise on the part of the specifier or as a deliberate policy inthe hope that in some way this will result in a lower cost for the work Although contractors may have faults one of them isnot an inability to ensure that they are paid for the work they do Vagueness will lead to delays or an unsatisfactory jobTypically phrases such as lsquoremove all rust and scale by manual cleaningrsquo should not appear in a specification At one timesuch phraseology was common it is less so now but still occurs All scale and rust cannot be removed in any practicable wayby manual cleaning If this requirement is to be achieved then blast-cleaning should be specified On the other hand if manualcleaning has been specified then the specification should state the actual requirement within practical possibilities of theamount of rust and scale to be removed
There can never be any disadvantage in preparing a sound specification It will probably be criticised by those involved inimplementing it and based on their expertise and practical knowledge it may be advisable to make changes However suchchanges should be made only after careful consideration of the alternative proposals put forward Changes should not be madepurely to suit the convenience of the contractor if this is likely to lead to an inferior protective system On the other hand noadvantage is ever gained by preparing a vague ambiguous and impracticable specification It will not reduce costs in fact itis more likely to escalate them and while there may be no immediate problems with the coating system it is probable that itslife will be reduced considerably leading to increased maintenance costs
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 107
83TYPES OF SPECIFICATION
There are two broad types of coating specification
(i) The lsquomethodrsquo type in which the full details of the requirements for every stage of the process are written down This isthe type that has been discussed in general terms in Section 82 above
(ii) The performance type which the performance required from the coating is specified and the contractor provides aguarantee that it will be achieved
Clearly the performance specification has many attractions It eliminates the requirements for drafting a long detaileddocument removes the problems of selecting suitable coating systems and of course ensures that if a failure occurs the costof remedial and repair work will not have to be met by the client However in practice matters have not always been quite asclear-cut as might have been anticipated There are in fact a number of problems inherent in the performance specification ifused with no back-up from a method type
(i) The criterion of failure must be specified precisely and this is not an easy matter Various requirements such as lsquonotmore than 01 rusting over any area of 10m2rsquo can be specified but to cover all the potential types of failure requires aconsiderable degree of expertise
Disputes can also occur as to whether the guarantee applies to the paint finish or to the integrity of the steelwork Forexample a painted surface covered in closed blisters could be argued as acceptable until there is visible corrosion of themetal Contractors quite correctly are not prepared to guarantee coatings that have been mechanically damaged This leads todifficulties in determining the extent to which general failures have arisen from such damage and who is responsible
(ii) The guarantee may be covered by some form of insurance policy but inevitably the contractor builds in the price of acontingency for interim maintenance and this tends to increase the overall cost of the coating process
In addition any guarantee is worth very little unless the specifier has spent a reasonable period of time evaluating thecontractorrsquos past performance integrity and financial capability
(iii) Often the guarantee covers a much shorter time period than could reasonably be expected from many modern high-performance coating systems
(iv) It is difficult to ensure that work progresses at a satisfactory rate If the contractor refuses to continue coating workbecause in his view the conditions are not suitable then it may be necessary to remove the guarantee requirement to ensurethat the work is completed according to schedule
(v) Often the guarantee is of a reducing type where a percentage of the total cost of reinstatement is met by the client witheach year to failure eg if the guarantee is for 5 years then if the failure occurs after 4 years the client pays 80 of the costsHowever even when the guarantee covers all remedial costs during its lifetime it will not include the additional costs oftenmuch greater than those for the remedial work of loss or use of the plant or structure during re-painting
(vi) Even where the guarantee meets the life requirement for the coating eventually maintenance will be necessary Unlessthis is taken into account in choosing the protective coating system and the level of surface preparation then the apparentadvantages of the guarantee may be lost by increased maintenance costs
For example with a 5-year guarantee a coating system that after 5 years merely requires washing down and the addition offurther top coats is a better proposition than one that survives the guarantee period but requires re-blasting and completereplacement a few years later
(vii) Problems can arise in determining the degree of remedial work necessary to ensure that where failure occurs before theguarantee period expires the coating is brought up to the standard of the rest of the structure If the coating is touched up to meetthe remaining months of the required period it will lead to increased maintenance costs Additionally if the paintwork has adecorative function repair of small areas on a large facia may give an unacceptable patchwork appearance and yet the bulk ofthe area may not have failed under the terms of the guarantee
Despite these comments guarantees and performance specifications are employed and provided attention is paid to thepossible difficulties that may arise can be a valid form of specification However method specifications are preferred evenwhere a guarantee is involved and these will be considered below
84PREPARATION OF A COATING SPECIFICATION
The coating specification is a contract document and so must be prepared to ensure that it meets the contractual requirementsConsequently much of the specification will include clauses concerned with the financial aspects of the contract in particularresultant penalties for any breaches and time delays These are important matters and must be appreciated by anybody
108 SPECIFICATIONS
preparing a contract Often they make tedious reading but are nevertheless essential to ensure that the contractor understandsthe nature of the contract he is undertaking and financial penalties that might ensue
Such requirements are common to all contracts and will not be discussed in detail here Reference will be made only whereit is considered that such clauses are peculiarly relevant to a coating specification A useful publication has been produced bythe National Association of Corrosion Engineers (NACE) It is called lsquoA Guide to the Preparation of Contracts andSpecifications for the Application of Protective Coatingsrsquo and although based on American practice it will prove useful tothose with limited experience in this field
The preparation of a coating specification requires careful planning The following areas must be considered
(i) Selection of the coating system and the surface preparation to be employed These are discussed in Chapters 14 and 3 Itis not sufficient to select a generic type of system the individual coatings must be specified Furthermore the selectedcoating material must be suitable for the chosen application method
There will often be a relationship between the coating and the surface preparation because some coatings eg 2-packepoxies can be applied only to clean (ie blast-cleaned) surfaces In other cases there is a choice depending on the lsquolifersquoof coating required If manual cleaning methods are to be used then the specific method must be selected becausedifferent methods vary in their effectiveness In all cases the standard of cleaning required must be determined beforepreparing the specification
(ii) The method of coating application must be determined for each coating in the system In some cases application bybrush to all but the smallest of areas will require modifications of some paints eg chlorinated rubber
(iii) The broad specification covers the main steelwork However there are areas that require special treatments eg weldsThese are particularly important because protection is often more difficult at these areas and of course the probabilityof failure is greater
(iv) Handling transport and storage is an area that is often given scant attention in specifications Clear guidelines must beprepared to avoid delays increased costs and poor performance arising from an unnecessary amount of damage to thecoating system
When these and other relevant points have been taken into account the specification can be prepared
85SPECIFICATION REQUIREMENTS
Each specification requires individual treatment and it is difficult to generalise In this section no attempt will be made toprovide lsquomodelrsquo specifications for different situations The general requirements will be discussed but the choice for aparticular set of conditions will be a matter for the specifier to determine using his knowledge of the circumstances involvedin a particular project
Before drafting the specification a number of decisions must be made with regard to the detail to be included and themethods to be employed in achieving the requirements The view of one school of thought is that the specification shouldcover virtually every detail and if the contractor accepts it then no matter what problems may arise they are hisresponsibility The other takes a somewhat different view and allows the contractor a limited choice within strictly laid downrequirements This view is exemplified by the specification of the actual paint to be used Usually the specification indicatesa general type and allows a choice from a number of companies selected by the client In the former case the specific paintand the company supplying it are specified Caution is required in drafting specifications too tightly because some of thecontractorrsquos responsibility may be removed although this does not necessarily arise On the other hand if a particular surfaceprofile and degree of cleanliness is specified there is little point in specifying the abrasives to be used unless this is a genuinerequirement which only certain abrasives will achieve In short all genuine requirements should be specified but there is noadvantage to be gained in placing unnecessary restrictions on the contractor which may lead to delays and increased costs
The following sections indicate the areas to be covered in specifications for new work although the actual requirementswill vary depending on the type of project and the coating processes involved The technical requirements eg selection ofcoatings and surface preparation inspection etc are dealt with in the individual chapters concerned with the specific topics
The specification will generally cover the following
(i) Scope(ii) Surface preparation
(iii) Coating system(iv) Control of coating materials and testing(v) Coating application
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 109
(vi) Areas for special treatment(vii) Handling transport and storage
(viii) Remedial work(ix) Inspection(x) Safety
Each will be considered below
851Scope
It is useful to define the scope of the work and to provide general information that will assist the contractor to carry out thework satisfactorily Aspects that can usefully be included are
(a) Type of structure(b) Location of structure(c) Location of coating operations(d) General environments where coating operations may be carried out(e) Areas of special attention(f) Problems of access and timing of operations (particularly for maintenance painting)
852Surface Preparation
8521Steel
There may be a requirement for standards covering the degree of surface Ousting of the steel ISO Standard 85013 specifiesfour Grades A B C and D For some critical areas D and C may not be acceptable in which case the specification will be forGrades A or B
For some projects a limit on surface defects eg laminations will be specified Generally these can be observed moreeasily after blast-cleaning
8522Decreasing
This will be specified usually in relation to a suitable standard eg SSPC Specification SP-11 or British Standard CP 30124
8523Surface Cleanliness
Blast cleaning Specification for blast cleaning is straightforward because there are suitable standardrsquos that can be quoted inparticular the new ISO Standard 8501 1988 Other standards are also used and may be preferred in some situations inparticular those of the Steel Structures Painting Council and the National Association of Corrosion Engineers5 6 bothAmerican organisations
In practice standards are not always completely satisfactory because the photographs do not always match well with all blast-cleaned surfaces the type of steel can influence the appearance Consequently it is not unusual to specify special test panelswhich are blast-cleaned to an agreed standard and are then used as a reference for the blast cleaning requirements
Manual cleaning The degree of rust and scale removal achieved by manual cleaning methods eg wire brushing andscraping depends upon a number of factors that cannot readily be controlled so it is difficult to provide suitablespecifications ISO 8501 provides pictorial standards prefixed St and these are frequently specified but mainly because thereare virtually no other standards available With manual cleaning it is impossible to remove the adherent layers of rust so thespecification may be written on the lines of lsquoremove all loose rust and scale until further cleaning does not result in anyfurther significant removal of the scale and rust Cleaning should not be continued beyond a situation where the rust is lightlyburnished
110 SPECIFICATIONS
A range of tools and equipment is available (see Section 322) and the types of tool should be specified Manual cleaningwill normally be specified for new work only where oleo-resinous paints are applied to steel exposed in mild environments Itmay also be specified where steel is to be encased in concrete or other materials for interior use Additionally it may bespecified before blast-cleaning where the steel carries thick scale and rust
However manual cleaning is widely used prior to maintenance painting In such situations problems arise in producing areally satisfactory specification There is evidence to suggest that various types of rotary abrader (see Section 322) are moreeffective than most of the older types of tool and equipment If these are selected the specifications should be prepared on thefollowing lines
Before abrading remove all thick rust and scale by suitable methods such as chipping scraping and wire-brushing Thesurface shall then be abraded using suitable tools as specified below
In the situation where manual cleaning is carried out at maintenance care must be taken to avoid undue damage tosurrounding paint Wet methods of abrading may be specified to reduce damage
Prior to or after manual cleaning thorough removal of any oil or grease contamination should be specifiedFlame cleaning Flame cleaning is not widely used but is occasionally specified for maintenance work SSPC Specification
SP4 covered this method but has been withdrawn The method is briefly covered in ISO 8501ndash11988In addition to the surface cleanliness requirements the specification should include any limitations on the use of certain tools
eg where sparks might be considered as an explosion risk steel tools may be banned and alternatives such as bronze toolsmay be specified It may also be advisable to include clauses on the use of power tools in relation to damaging the steelsurface eg indentations and grooving
8524Surface Profile
A new ISO Standard ISO 8501ndash1 has been published for surface profile (see Section 983) This involves the use of specialcomparators which are commercially available This is a suitable method for specifying surface profile However othermethods using various dial gauges are still used and individual profiles will be specified usually as a range eg lsquonot less than25 micro m and not greater than 50 micro mrsquo
No method of surface profile measurement covers the problems of lsquoZrogue peaksrsquo or hackles ie individual peaks wellabove the average These arise from the nature of abrasive blast-cleaning where even if the mixture of abrasives is wellcontrolled some overall variations in profile are inevitable
A typical density of 7 hackles or rogue peaksin2 is quoted for the large-sized abrasive It is therefore not really possible tospecify a limitation on the number of such peaks but they will be influenced by the size of abrasive used If the presence ofrogue peaks could be critical then low maximum profiles should be specified to ensure that the contractor uses only smallabrasives It would also be advisable to specify that the abrasive should be checked to ensure that it does not contain anyoversized particles
8525Soluble Salt Contamination
Methods detailed in Section 9513 can be specified in situations where the presence of soluble corrosion salts is consideredto be critical usually in situations where steelwork is immersed or subjected to very damp conditions
There is no standard for the acceptable amount for these salts so the specifier must decide and the following figures givenin a DIN Technical Report are a guide
lt10 micro gcm2 harmless10ndash50 micro gcm2 to be decided in individual casegt50 micro gcm2 dangerous
8526Maintenance Work
Compared with new work additional problems arise when specifying surface preparations prior to the re-painting ofstructures
Water-blasting may be preferred to dry-blasting or the two may be combined with a final quick dry-blast to remove ruststain arising from the initial water blasting The specification must include clauses to ensure that sound paintwork is notunnecessarily damaged On the other hand all paint considered to be defective must be removed to provide a sound surface for
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 111
subsequent painting Depending on the state of the paintwork it may be necessary to provide for surfaces with different levelsof cleanliness For blast-cleaning Sa2auml will usually be specified but in some circumstances manual cleaning may be requiredand the removal of loose rust to provide an adherent layer suitable for painting should be specified
8527Abrasives and Equipment
Generally reliance is placed on the specification of cleanliness and profile but if there are some doubts as to whether they canbe achieved without further specification clauses then both the equipment to be used and the type and mix of abrasives maybe specified Most specifiers will require to take advice from abrasive suppliers and others because there are no simple rulescovering these matters The specifications may cover the following items
(i) Type of equipment to be used eg centrifugal wheel air blast or water blast(ii) Any limitations affecting the impact velocity of the abrasive eg pressures or speed of wheels
(iii) Type of abrasive eg steel shot(iv) Hardness and chemical composition of abrasives(v) Size of abrasives
(vi) Recycling procedures for the abrasives
The requirements are discussed in Section 323 Usually detailed specifications of this type are not required and aperformance requirement based on profile and cleanliness will be sufficient for most purposes If necessary test panels orplates can be run through the equipment to ensure that the requirements are met and maintained Specifications concerning thesuitability and operational efficiency of the equipment are useful and the requirements can be based on Section 3234 Wherewater blast-cleaning is specified both the quality of the water and any requirements concerning the types and concentration ofinhibitors may be specified
853Coating System
The coating system should be specified in detail phrases such as lsquoprimer undercoat and finishing coatrsquo are of little or novalue Where appropriate standards should be quoted for the coatings There are American standards covering many paintseg Steel Structures Painting Council Specifications and US Federal Standards and similar standards are produced in othercountries However there are few British Standards covering paints Consequently there may be difficulties in specifying theactual paints to be used for work to be carried out in the UK Generic descriptions are often used although they may provideonly a limited indication of the composition or performance characteristics of the particular paint BS 5493 (1977)2 providessome limited information on certain requirements which may be useful However they cover only volume solids minimumpercentage of main pigment in the total pigment and minimum advised dry film thickness Such limited information cannot beused to identify positively all aspects of a paint formulation and it would be unwise to assume that all paints specified to suchdescription would be of equal quality Nevertheless this will ensure that a description such as lsquomicaceous iron oxidepigmented paintrsquo does have a volume solids of 45ndash50 and that a minimum of 80 of the pigment is in fact micaceous ironoxide Large organisations often have their own paint specifications and generally a number of different companies producepaints that meet these requirements Consequently the contractor has a choice of paints all of which meet the specificationMost specifiers though have to rely either on specifications generally available or on proprietary products Even wherespecifications have been published for paints it does not follow that they are readily available from manufacturers MostEuropean paint manufacturers do not stock paints to the SSPC specifications They might be prepared to make special paintsfor a large order but these would probably cost more than their standard products For comparatively small orders it is unlikelyto be worthwhile ordering paints to special specifications or standards For most paints the generic title will usually have tosuffice The manufacturersrsquo data sheets provide some indication of the general characteristics of the paint but these aremainly concerned with application Often phrases such as lsquopaint manufacturerrsquos product ldquoPrdquo or similarrsquo appear onspecifications to provide the contractor with a choice of paint supply This is not really satisfactory and has led to problemswhere the contractorrsquos view of lsquosimilarrsquo could be questioned
For example one coal-tar epoxy coating could easily be replaced by another with completely different applicationcharacteristics cheaper components and no long-term field experience In fact phrases of this type are not suitable in acontract document and if used may require additional clauses on paint testing or application trials to ensure that the paint isactually satisfactory
112 SPECIFICATIONS
The paint should be specified as suitable for the particular type of application to be used eg brushing With somespecialised coatings there may not be alternative coatings with the same compositions and characteristics and in such casesthe actual product should be specified The complete paint system should be specified by individual coats ie blast primerprimer undercoat(s) and finishing coats with the required dry film thickness of each coat and the method to be employed inmeasuring it Wet film thickness measurements may also be specified as a control on the coating process although this willusually appear under the coating application clauses It is advantageous to specify coating materials with different colours ortints as this facilitates inspection of paint application On large projects alternative paints may be specified to make sure thatadequate supplies are available if for some reason the specified paint cannot be supplied Where the colour of the finishingcoat is to be specified relevant standards should be quoted eg BS 48007
854Control of Paints and Other Coating Materials
The specifications should cover the requirements for control on the handling and storage of paints and other coating materialsWhere appropriate any requirements regarding temperatures for storage should be included The specification should provideclear instructions regarding the facilities for storage and the requirements for receipt and issue of paints to ensure that earlydeliveries are not retained beyond their shelf lives while later deliveries are issued immediately
Where paint testing is to be carried out the specification must state clearly whether this is to be done and reported uponbefore the painting commences or whether samples are to be retained for subsequent testing The number of samples requiredand whether they are to be in the form of unopened containers or whether samples are to be taken during paint applicationmust also be made clear The responsibility of the contractor or whoever may be responsible for collecting and dealing withany samples should be specified and where appropriate the method to be used for submitting them for test and the name ofthe test laboratory that will carry out the tests should also be included
The tests will usually be specified separately unless they are to be carried out on-site in which case the details will begiven Site tests will usually be of a comparatively simple nature generally carried out by the inspector If the test results arerequired before any painting is commenced this should be stated
The preparation of paints for use is an important factor in ensuring sound application and appropriate requirements must beincluded in the specification These might include mixing instructions which are particularly important for heavily pigmentedand two-pack materials The specification may call for all paint preparation to be carried out in accordance with the paintmanufacturerrsquos data sheets but it is usually advisable to draw particular attention to critical points Thes may include therestrictions on using certain two-pack materials in low-temperature conditions and the strict use of thinners and solvents inaccordance with the data sheets Any relaxation of these requirements should be made only by agreement with the client orhis representative and this should be stated
855Coating Application
Application has a significant influence on the quality of coating produced but is one of the more difficult parts of the processto control Often the specification covers little more than the dry film thickness requirement There are a number of factorsinvolved in paint application that should be considered for inclusion in a specification The manufacturerrsquos data sheets shouldbe followed implicitly except where the client agrees to changes In particular attention must be paid to the following
(i) Drying time(ii) Minimum and maximum interval before overcoating for the appropriate ambient temperature where applicable
(iii) Use of only the recommended thinner(iv) Only the recommended volume of thinner must be used for the particular application method chosen(v) Correct nozzle orifice to be used as recommended by coating manufacturer for the particular method of spray
application(vi) Nozzle pressures as recommended
(vii) Mixing instructions for paints to be followed(viii) Pot and shelf lives to be noted for the appropriate ambient temperature and paints to be disposed of if they have reached
such lives before application
Specifications should stipulate the requirements for the proper cleaning of equipment and the necessity for checking that it isoperating properly The working conditions will influence the quality of the coating and the requirements will vary dependingon whether the painting is carried out in the shop or on-site but they should be clearly specified
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 113
Ideally the facilities in the shop should be thoroughly checked before any painting is undertaken However where this hasnot been done certain requirements should be stipulated
(i) The minimum and where appropriate maximum temperatures for paint application(ii) Prohibition of heaters that pollute the shop with exhaust products Only indirect heating should be allowed where the
ambient temperature has to be raised and the heating should not impinge directly onto the painted surface(iii) Coatings should not be applied under conditions where condensation or moisture on the surface has occurred or is likely
to occur This can be specified by reference to the relative humidity dew point and steel temperatures (seeSection 9534)
(iv) Lighting must be adequate a figure of 500 lumens falling on the surface is considered to be satisfactory for mostoperations but this will depend on factors such as the type of shop and the colour of the coating In some cases anincreased amount of light may be required
(v) Blast-cleaning facilities must be sited so that dust does not blow onto the areas where coating application is beingcarried out Where appropriate tests can be specified Dust should preferably be removed by vacuum methods ratherthan by sweeping it from one surface to another
(vi) Ventilation must be at a level to ensure proper safety standards both regarding threshold level values and explosivelimits The latter which is normally higher than the former can be reached if operators are using a mask supplied withfresh air and therefore do not notice or concern themselves about the toxicity of the threshold level values
On-site additional restrictions may be necessary on the conditions acceptable for paint application and these should be stipulatedThese will generally cover the suspension of operations during periods of rain snow etc or where condensation has occurredor is likely to do so Where relative humidity checks are specified there should be a requirement that they be carried out closeto the steelwork in question Often condensation will occur on ground-facing or sheltered steelwork even though freelyexposed steelwork may be dry Relative humidity and steel temperature measurements taken some distance from areas liableto condensation may not reveal the potential problems Where shelter eg of suitable sheeting is specified so that site workcan continue under adverse conditions it will still be necessary to check for changes in relative humidity and this should beincluded in the painting requirements
It is always necessary to ensure that surfaces to be painted are free of dust grease etc and methods of checking theserequirements are considered in Section 9513 However when working on-site additional clauses may be required to ensurethat all foreign matter eg cement dust is removed before applying paint In marine situations account must be taken ofchloride contamination even when the surface appears to be dry The specification should call for checks that chloridecontamination is absent or is at an acceptably low level for the coatings being applied
856Treatments of Special Areas
The above discussion has been concerned with the cleaning and treatments of bulk steelwork but in practice steelwork isfabricated This may involve both the welding and bolting together of sections Furthermore fabrication involves cutting anddrilling steelwork These operations and the overall design of the structural elements will have an influence on coatingrequirements The influence of design on corrosion and its control are considered in Chapter 10 and it is recommended thatdesigns should be audited to reduce the likelihood of problems arising because of unsatisfactory features such as water-trapsSo far as the specification is concerned it is important to check beforehand that areas that will be difficult to coat eitherinitially or during maintenance are suitably protected if necessary by extra coats of paint Additionally the stage at whichprotective coatings should be applied in relation to fabrication must be taken into account and reflected in the specification Ifareas of the steelwork are to be fully or partially enclosed then they should be coated before such work is completed Paintingis similar to welding in that access for the operator is necessary if the work is to be properly carried out Treatments in weldedareas should be clearly specified and the following points should be covered
(i) Where a suitable blast primer of the lsquoweld-throughrsquo type is specified then no special treatment of areas to be welded isrequired prior to the actual welding operation
(ii) Where such primers have not been specified then areas adjacent to the weld should be suitably masked or painted withthe full system which must be removed before welding is carried out The distance from the weld where areas are to bemasked or where paint must be removed will depend upon the size and thickness of the steel sections but a strip of 50mm width is considered to be satisfactory for most purposes
114 SPECIFICATIONS
(iii) Although grinding of the weld to a smooth rounded profile may not be required from the standpoint of structuralreliability it may be advantageous to ensure sound performance of the coatings applied to the weld area This should bespecified if required
(iv) The surface preparation requirements after welding should be stipulated mechanical cleaning to remove weld spatterslag etc followed by blast cleaning will provide the best surface for paint application even where the welds have notbeen ground flush Nevertheless whatever choice is decided upon the methods should be specified If alkaline depositsare likely to be produced by the welding process then if the weld is to be hand cleaned eg by wirebrushing suitablewashing with clean water should be specified Additionally a requirement for a check on pH using suitable test papersshould be included This will ensure that alkaline deposits are removed
Welding areas are often weak points with regard to the performance of coatings applied to them and proper treatments shouldbe specified Coatings in the vicinity of welding may well be affected by the heat produced in the process which may beconducted to areas some distance from the weld This may result in the disintegration of coatings and with some materialsthe production of corrosive residues eg acids Such problems should be avoided by suitable specifications
Fasteners such as nuts and bolts present problems of a different nature and the specification should be drafted to ensurethat they are coated to a standard equivalent to that of the rest of the steelwork Where steelwork is coated in the shop andbolted on-site only the finishing coat may be applied on-site unless the specification is written so as to ensure that thefasteners receive an adequate degree of protection
Where manual cleaning is used to prepare the surface of the main steelwork then black bolts may be similarly treated butwhere higher-quality cleaning is specified eg blast-cleaning either the black bolts should be blast-cleaned in situ or bereplaced by pickled or zinc-coated bolts
High-strength friction-grip (HSFG) bolts should be treated in the same way as above but pickling should not be specifiedunless suitable precautions are taken to avoid hydrogen embrittlement HSFG bolts depend upon a suitable level of frictionbetween the faying surfaces to be bolted Consequently the specification should ensure that the surfaces are blast-cleaned andmasked or coated with a material that will provide suitable slip coefficients eg zinc silicate or sprayed metal Wheremasking is used methods of removing the adhesive should be specified At bolted joints it is advised to specify immediatepainting round the joint to prevent ingress of moisture and where appropriate application of a suitable mastic For non-HSFG-bolted joints it will be advantageous to paint the contact surfaces before bolting and if practicable to bolt up while the paintcoatings are still wet The specification should take into account that various services pipes etc will be fitted to the mainsteelwork Where this is part of the overall design then suitable precautions can be taken by stipulating the remedial measuresto be taken where steel is drilled and the coatings to be applied to brackets etc that will be fitted However this work is oftencarried out in an lsquoad hocrsquo manner or designs are changed It may be difficult in some circumstances to deal with the problemin the specifications for coating the new work because those fixing the various services are unlikely to receive a copy In suchcases these matters can only be dealt with at the hand-over inspection or at the first maintenance repaint
857Handling Transport and Storage
A good deal of damage may be inflicted on coatings during handling and transport It is therefore advisable to specify thefundamental requirements necessary to reduce such damage to a minimum and to ensure that where remedial work isnecessary it is carried out correctly so that the coating at damaged areas is equivalent to that originally applied The selectionof the original coating and the decision whether to apply most of the coating in the shop will take into account the probabilityof damage and the difficulties likely to be encountered in repairing coatings (Notes on remedial work are provided inSection 858)
The following points should be borne in mind when preparing this section of the specification
(i) Lifting devices should be of suitable material to prevent mechanical damage eg nylon slings and rubber protectedchains (Fig 81)
(ii) Where appropriate special lugs should be welded to large sections to facilitate lifting (Fig 82)(iii) Attention should be paid to the packaging of components and small items(iv) Coated steelwork should be packed to avoid contact between surfaces Various forms of wrapping and packing should
be considered depending on the size of the steelwork(v) All steelwork should be stacked correctly and raised from the ground on suitable supports eg timber The height of the
stack should be limited to prevent undue pressure on the coatings on the steelwork at ground level(vi) Where steelwork is protected by covers eg tarpaulins these should be arranged to allow ingress of air to provide
ventilation
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 115
(vii) Sections should be marked and stacked to allow for removal with minimum interference of the stack (viii) Steelwork to be transported as deck cargo must be coated to provide protection during the journey and for periods spent
in storage on dock sides etc(ix) Steelwork should be stored so as to prevent lsquopondingrsquo ie the collection of water in pools on horizontal surfaces
(Fig 83)
Considerable damage and deterioration of coatings can occur during the period between shop painting and final erection Thespecification should provide clear recommendations for handling In some situations transport and storage is the critical part ofthe whole coating operation and may determine the type of coating to be used and the relative parts of the system to beapplied on-site and in the shop Coating systems for shop application should be chosen so that they can be repaired effectivelyon-site For example if the blast-cleaned steelwork is coated with a two-pack epoxy primer and a two-pack epoxy micaceousiron oxide paint which for ease of maintenance is to be top-coated with a chlorinated rubber system then all chlorinatedrubber paint should be applied on-site Otherwise if damage down to bare metal occurs during transit it is almost impossibleto repair the system to the specification and to the same standard For example top coats dabbed onto spots of damage maylook satisfactory but will eventually prove weak links in the overall protection Damage to a paint system requires that all ofthe damaged coats are repaired to the correct thickness and with adequate drying times between coats This is likely to proveunpopular with those concerned with the construction programme
Fig 81 Protection of coated steelwork to avoid damage by slings
Fig 82 Use of special lifting lugs
116 SPECIFICATIONS
858Remedial Work
The specification should cover the following points
(i) All remedial repair and painting should be carried out as soon as is practicable and before further coats of paint areapplied
(ii) Where damage does not extend to the steel surface the paintwork should be washed to remove contamination Theoriginal paint system should then be applied to the overall film thickness specified All paintwork should be chamferedto ensure a smooth coating Where appropriate eg for 2-pack epoxies the surface should be lightly abraded to ensuregood adhesion (see Section 13620)
(iii) Where damage extends to the steel surface the surface should be cleaned by the original method specified to therequired standard An area of approximately 25 mm from the damaged area should be cleaned and the adhesion checkedThe cleaned area should then be coated to provide the specified thickness Paint coatings should be chamfered toprovide a smooth surface Where appropriate surrounding paintwork should be abraded to ensure sound adhesion
Other points to be covered include
(i) Removal of all contamination on any sound paintwork to be recoated to ensure good intercoat adhesion(ii) Use of mastic to fill small gaps
(iii) Removal of surface dust and debris before painting
859Inspection and Quality Control
Inspection is covered in detail in Chapter 9 Its purpose is to ensure compliance with the specification and should beindependent of the coating operational work The inspector acts as the clientrsquos representative and his main concern is toensure that the technical specifications are properly followed
Inspection requirements may be included in the individual clauses or in a single section The specification should clearlyindicate the inspectorrsquos responsibilities and authority It is also advisable to indicate the type of instrument or equipment thatwill be used to measure various requirements eg coating thickness Problems can arise when the contractor and inspectoruse different instruments and methods
Proper records are essential and this requirement from the inspector should be specified The records will deal primarilywith such matters as relative humidity temperature and thickness readings related to the inspection work but observationsregarding the progress of the work may be useful These records are for the client and should be so specified
Fig 83 lsquoPondingrsquo arising from inadequate attention to storage
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 117
Paint testing is not usually carried out by the inspector but the specification may call for simple tests on viscosity or densityThe methods should be clearly specified Inspectors may be responsible for the collection and despatch of samples for furtherpaint testing The methods and timing of sampling and the information required on the samples should be specified
Paint testing will usually be carried out in properly equipped laboratories The types of test and the required informationshould be specified
8510Safety
The specification must draw attention to safety requirements (see Chapter 17) In particular nothing must be specified thatbreaks statutory safety regulations or that can be construed as likely to cause a hazard or danger to personnel
Proper safety equipment should be specified for all stages of the work Even though it may be the contractorrsquos primaryresponsibility the specifier should draw attention to the safety requirements expected These should include
(i) Proper ventilation and precautions against explosive hazards in paint shops and confined spaces(ii) Suitable precautions to ensure that operators avoid skin contact with hazardous solvents or paints
(iii) Adequate first-aid equipment available(iv) Proper protective clothing to be worn where appropriate
8511Other Aspects of Specifications
Most corrosion control specifications for structural steel related to protective coatings Other methods may also be includedeither as separate specifications of sometimes as part of the coating specification These include the use of inhibitors and silicagel to control humidity in enclosed spaces cathodic protection procedures and the use of special components eg Monelbolts
REFERENCES
1 System and Specification Steel Structures Painting Manual Vol 2 ed JD Keane Steel Structures Painting Council Pittsburgh1982
2 Code of Practice for Protective Coating on Iron and Steel Structures Against Corrosion BS 5493 British Standards InstitutionLondon 1977
3 Preparation of Steel Substrates before Application of Paints and Related Products ISO 8501ndash1 International StandardsOrganisation 1988
4 Cleaning and Preparation of Metal Surfaces CP3012 British Standardrsquos Institution London 19725 Visual Standard for Surfaces of Raw Steel Airblast Cleaned with Sand Abrasives TM-01ndash70 NACE Houston 19706 Visual Standard for Surfaces of New Steel Centrifugally Blast Cleaned with Steel Grit and Shot TM-01ndash75 NACE Houston 19757 Paint Colours for Building Purposes BS 4800 British Standards Institution London 1981
118 SPECIFICATIONS
CHAPTER 9Quality Control of Coating Operations
91INTRODUCTION
Quality control is applied to most industrial processes and is a standard and relatively easy function for paint applied in acontinuous operation for example coating of cars domestic appliances etc Quality control of the coating of structural steelhowever encounters some unique factors1
Most paint coatings are at least superficially remarkably tolerant of variations in application conditions and proceduresHowever it is generally impossible to tell from the appearance of the coating whether it has been applied over a suitablesurface or has formed the correct polymer to give optimum performance There are as yet no positive tests that can beapplied to a paint film in situ that will provide this assurance Many workers are investigating electrical measurements ofpaint films such as AC impedance testing but such tests are as yet not fully correlated with actual long-term performance
One problem is the manner in which coatings fail Loss of adhesion visible corrosion blistering etc which occur within ayear or two of application are obvious faults It is in everyonersquos interest to avoid such failures particularly since adequaterepair work is nearly always more expensive and troublesome than the initial work and almost inevitably to a lower standardHowever less obvious failures are those where there are shorter times than necessary between maintenance and with therequirement for extensive and expensive surface preparation
It must be added that often there are many people in the coatings chain who are not interested in very long-term durabilityHowever some authorities faced with a likely maintenance programme that was beyond their resources and likely to getworse addressed the problem some years ago and are now reaping the rewards
The UK Department of Transport have now greatly increased the maintenance repainting intervals on motorway bridgesThis has been achieved by comprehensive specifications testing and monitoring of paint materials particular concern withsurface preparation and removal of water-soluble contaminants and last but not least independent painting inspection of theentire coating operation
In the early 1980s British Petroleum adopted QAQC procedures that included full-time independent painting inspectionand now consider that the higher standards of workmanship achieved have shown considerable economic benefit2
One large chemical plant in Germany has also found that intervals between maintenance can be extended considerablyalthough they operate with a fairly high ratio of one inspector to 15ndash25 painters3
Another large manufacturer of chemicals in the United States has estimated that the use of professional painting inspectioncan over 10 years save $941 000 for eve ry $1000000 dollars of the origina l cost of painting
As with all quality control activities they must be carried out independently of those involved in production ie theoperators carrying out surface preparation and coating application These operators should of course be properly supervisedand carry out their work to meet the contract requirements However they may have priorities other than those provided bythe technical specification not least the meeting of deadlines and payment on the basis of the amount of work done in a giventime There is therefore often a genuine conflict between quality and production something not unique to coating processesThe user has to decide whether the additional cost of inspection for example 5 on painting costs is worthwhile Usually thereis no guarantee of performance of the coating system in relation to the inspection so the judgement as to its use must be basedon factors such as the experience of the user with respect to inspection carried out on previous projects the data concerningthe performance of coatings that have been subjected to inspection compared with those that have not and the importance ofthe project itself
The situation is summed up by STThompson5 who states
hellipit depends upon four cornerstones good specifications quality materials qualified contractors and effectiveinspection Failure in any of these areas like the proverbial weak link in the chain will result in decreasedperformances and increased costsmdashoften substantial
Generally any inspection is preferable to none although there are exceptions to this for example where inspection reaches alevel of incompetence that leads to either unnecessary delays possibly entailing considerable additional costs or a failure toapply the correct technical procedures In some cases it could be said with some truth that lsquopoor inspection is worse than noinspectionrsquo Most users who regularly specify inspection for their projects will be aware of these problems but for those withless experience it may be difficult to decide on the benefits or indeed sometimes the nature of the inspection In thefollowing sections the various aspects of inspection will be considered
92INSPECTION REQUIREMENTS
Strictly speaking inspection is carried out to ensure that the requirements of the coating specification are met by the contractorSometimes other duties are added and this may well be advantageous but the prime responsibility of the inspector is clear toensure that the work is carried out in accordance with the specification Although inspection may be carried out by any groupindependent of those involved in production including personnel from the userrsquos own organisation it is often done byindependent firms that have been specially formed for this purpose
Sometimes such firms are invited to prepare the coating specification and even to provide a measure of supervision of thecoating operations This may well prove to be beneficial but does not alter the basic requirements already describedInspection is a quality control measure and should not be confused with other important requirements involved in coatingprocedures The coating specification is the essential basis for providing a sound protective system This is considered inChapter 8 but it must be said that some specifications are not of a standard likely to provide the highest quality of coatingperformance Although the inspector may comment to this effect he has no authority to alter the specification Consequentlyif his advice is not taken he may well find himself in a position where he carries out his duties conscientiously ensuring thatan inadequate specification is correctly applied which may eventually lead to a coating of poor durability It must beappreciated that in such a situation the fault lies with the specification not the inspector where inspection is to be used therequirements should of course be included as part of the specification
The user must be quite clear in his inspection requirements and must not expect more than is intended If a consultancy-management operation is required then this should be decided at the outset No matter how competent the inspector may behe cannot be expected to act as a substitute for a sound specification good management and proper planning The basicrequirements for a good inspector are considered in the next section and the user will be well advised to ensure that these criteriaare met by those called upon to carry out quality control work on his behalf
The nature and importance of the requirements for quality control are being increasingly appreciated so the approach usedshould also be considered in a more critical manner
In some ways the term lsquocoating inspectionrsquo is a misnomer because it may imply that it is confined to an assessment of thefinal coating whereas it covers the whole coating process The term lsquoquality controlrsquo is probably more correct
93THE APPROACH TO QUALITY CONTROL
The aim of quality control is to ensure that coatings attain their full potential of performance Inspection is one of the stepsinvolved but to gain full advantage from it other aspects must also be considered The main stages in obtaining the optimumperformance from coatings can be summarised as follows
(i) A full consideration of the coating requirements and the selection of a system suitable for the particular conditions(ii) Appraisal of the design of the structure relative to coating application and performance
(iii) The choice of coating processes applicable to the fabrication techniques involved or sometimes the choice offabrication to suit the coating
(iv) Preparation of a concise unambiguous coating specification(v) Tendering and acceptance of the requirements by the contractor
(vi) Checking where appropriate on the quality of the materials specified and supplied(vii) Inspection at all stages of the coating process including handling storage and erection
120 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
For maintenance painting as opposed to new work there may be additional requirements as discussed in Chapter 11 eg asurvey of the paintwork and tests to determine the feasibility of the maintenance procedures
Clearly inspection alone will not overcome problems arising from poor decisions in (i)ndash(vi) above although in somesituations the organisation responsible for inspection may be involved in these other areas At the very least such mattersshould be discussed so that the inspector is absolutely clear regarding the requirements and responsibilities for his part of thework He cannot reasonably be expected to interpret unclear or ambiguous specifications and in fact it may be inappropriatefor him to do so Any doubts or problems should be cleared up by discussions among the interested parties before the workbegins
In the authorsrsquo experience the majority of problems that arise over inspection particularly in relation to the standardsrequired could have been avoided by adequate discussion at a pre-contract meeting Unfortunately the cost of a pre-contractmeeting which can be considerable is seldom allowed for by those concerned and yet apart from clarifying the specificationit can also settle important issues such as what action can or cannot be taken by the inspector what the specific safetyrequirements are and how and to whom the inspector should report problems Problems will arise that cannot always beforeseen but there is no excuse for work being held up while for example arguments take place regarding whether thecoating thickness in the specification was intended to be minimum maximum or average
Costs are obviously attributable to all the stages listed above and an opinion must be taken by the engineer of the amountconsidered reasonable for the project For minor works particularly where hand cleaning of the steelwork is to be usedlimitation on cost may be necessary However for important projects eg submarine pipelines tank linings bridges etc nolong-term advantage will accrue from carrying out any stage with less than fully competent personnel with suitable expertisefor the roles they undertake Before considering inspection in detail it is worth discussing some of the related aspects whichwhile not falling within the strict definition of inspection as expressed earlier nevertheless will be of benefit to the inspectionwork
Although many large organisations have specialists capable of selecting coating systems and preparing coatingspecifications others do not carry this expertise in-house Advice can be sought from the coatings suppliers and generally thiswill be of a high standard However it will clearly be biased towards their own products This may not be particularlyimportant with some paint products that are made to a similar formulation and standard by a range of manufacturers It becomesmore crucial however with specialist coatings Often the products from different manufacturers are not the same eventhough their descriptions may be covered by similar generic terminology In these cases independent advice may be preferredAgain by the nature of tendering contractors will often offer a product which is unfamiliar to the engineer and independentassessments may be advantageous The engineer may then take advice from a protective coatings consultant or from theorganisation involved with the inspection Provided the organisation has sufficient expertise the following may be consideredas appropriate areas for advice and discussion
(i) Carrying out an audit of the design in relation to its susceptibility to corrosion and the problems of coating applicationOffering advice on changes to improve the situation taking into account cost and the overall effects of such changes
(ii) Advising on the selection of suitable protective systems and discussing the requirements with coatings suppliers takinginto account future maintenance requirements and overall costs
(iii) Advising on the preparation of a suitable coatings specification and the levels and requirements of inspection to beincorporated
(iv) Discussions and advice on the contractorrsquos quotations with particular reference to the technical merits of any alternativeprotective systems proposed
(v) Carrying out an audit of the contractorrsquos premises where coating application is to take place Assessing the probabilitythat the coating will be applied to provide the requirements of the specification typically that blast-cleaning areas arepositioned so that dust and abrasives are contained in that area and are not carried over to the facilities for coating applicationChecking of all equipment and plant and ensuring that there are proper facilities for handling coated steelwork
(vi) Discussing the programming of the coatings work the equipment and manpower requirements and the methods to beused for handling storing and transporting steelwork
(vii) Discussing the storage and handling of steelwork on-site and other points concerned with the coatings eg touch-upof damaged areas and cleaning and coating of welds
All this goes beyond inspection but is considered here because many so-called lsquoinspection organisationsrsquo operate beyondthe strict interpretation of the quality control requirements Undoubtedly the above approach will prove beneficial to manyengineers
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 121
94REQUIREMENTS FOR AN INSPECTOR
The term lsquoinspectorrsquo here is taken to cover the person actually carrying out the work but on larger projects a team ofinspectors may be involved and the organisation responsible for the inspection may provide different inspectors for specifieparts of the work To simplify the discussion this is also covered by the term lsquoinspectorrsquo Basically the inspector must havethe required technical competence for the work but in view of the nature of the work he has to carry out there are also personalityrequirements Often the inspector is working on his own and because he is involved only with quality there is a basis here forpotential conflict with those attempting to complete the work on time ie the contractors He must therefore be adept in humanrelationships capable of communicating in a clear and concise manner and be capable of resisting pressure to acceptstandards below those required He should have a good knowledge of the coatings industry and most important should beproperly trained for the role he has to undertake (see Section 941)
As in all jobs some inspectors through experience knowledge and personality are able to achieve more than othersHowever such qualities are not universal and providing the inspector is technically competent and understands hisresponsibilities he will be capable of carrying out his work satisfactorily It is implicit that all inspectors by the nature oftheir work must be trustworthy and conscientious
941Training and Certification of Inspectors
One problem since the early days of coating inspection has been the lack of recognised training programmes and systems forthe qualification of coating inspectors Anybody can describe himself as a painting inspector Ex-painters see the job assteadier more prestigious and less arduous than actual painting On the other hand they do have a considerable advantage inthat they are familiar with the problems can communicate with the operatives and can even assist the less experienced Theyalso know all of the short cuts and can be effective in detecting them on the basis of lsquopoacher turned gamekeeperrsquo Thedisadvantage is that in ignorance unless properly trained they can perpetuate bad practices and also their experience of thewide range of protective coatings now available may be limited
British Gas were the first to recognise this problem and some years ago set up the Approval Scheme Examinations forPaint Inspectors This takes place over one day and consists of written and practical examinations and an interview The UKInstitution of Corrosion Science and Technology later introduced a more comprehensive assessment scheme that took placeover a one-week period The scheme eventually lapsed because inspection companies did not receive recognition or financialreturn for their outlay
None of these existing programmes involved any training only examinations and peer review To remedy this lack of anadequate programme in which coating inspectors could be trained before certification and to provide a programme foruniform assessment of experienced inspectors throughout the world the National Association of Corrosion Engineers inAmerica developed a Coating Inspector Training and Certification Programme NACE have declared6 that the aims of thescheme are
(1) To provide professional and independent recognition to coating inspectors if their skills knowledge and experience areto a sufficiently high standard
(2) To build confidence in the persons recognised under the scheme and receive from them an Attestation that they will applythemselves diligently and responsibly to their work behave in an ethical manner and only profess competence in thoseareas in which they are qualified by knowledge and experience
(3) To provide the individual with a sense of achievement since the qualification represents advancement in the chosenfield
(4) To provide an opportunity for training coating inspectors with a wide range of backgrounds including those with noprevious work experience
The Attestation referred to above is a document that all applicants are required to sign There are five clauses to the effect thatthe inspector must recognise and acknowledge safety requirements conservation of resources cooperation with other tradesand that the quality of the inspectorrsquos work and personal conduct will reflect on coating inspection as a whole There are also13 clauses which represent the standards of workmanship required including pursuing the work with fairness honestyintegrity and courtesy treating business matters with the required confidentiality and accepting no gratuities or gifts of anykind whose value could cause a question as to whether they may have influenced the inspectors activities decisions orreports Failure to comply with the requirements of the Attestation can result in a disciplinary action by NACE Presumably
122 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
this includes withdrawal of the Certification which in the USA in particular where it is difficult to obtain inspection workwithout it results in such obligations being taken very seriously
The programme involves three separate week-long periods of classroom and shop training sessions Examinations are givenat intervals throughout with a final written and practical examination at the end of each session Training session 1 is an intensivepresentation of the basic technology of coating inspection The objective is to give the inspector trainee the knowledge andskills necessary for most of the typical inspector work on structural steel coating projects During the week everyone on theCourse has to prepare and blast-clean a small test panel apply primer by conventional spray and overcoat by airless spray(Fig 91) Although this is useful and chastening experience for the inexperienced its main importance is not to train them asblasters or painters but to give them work that must be correctly inspected by themselves An assessment of how well theinspection is carried out is included in the final assessment for the Session
Training session 2 focuses on shop coating processes for steel and the required inspection techniques It also introducesmore sophisticated non-destructive test instruments Training session 3 completes the technology and skills required of aNACE Certified Coating Inspector and includes specialised application techniques and substrates other than steel
There are three levels of recognition under this programme The first two are considered training levels only and consist of
(1) Successful completion of Session 1(2) Successful completion of Sessions 1 2 and 3
The third level is for full Certification as a NACE Coating Inspector and requires
(1) Successful completion of Sessions 1 2 and 3(2) A minimum of 18 monthsrsquo uninterrupted coating related field experience for example as a coating inspector paint crew
foreman blast-cleaning operative or paint manufacturerrsquos representative with field-related responsibilities(3) Successful completion of a Peer Review This interview lasts approximately 2 hours and is designed to test both
practical and theoretical knowledge
The Peer Review is undoubtedly the toughest hurdle of the course and there are a significant number that fail at this pointSuch high standards are necessary to ensure that those approved have the theoretical knowledge the practical experience andsuitable personality In March 1990 there were 895 persons at Level 1 132 at Level 2 and 450 with full certification
95METHODS OF INSPECTION OF PAINT COATINGS
Although the inspectorrsquos main objective is to check that work is carried out in accordance with the specification he shouldnot regard this as a purely passive role In BS 54931 a useful inspection guide is provided This indicates potential defectsmethods of determining them the likely cause and suggestions for action In some cases this guide would now be consideredto be out of date but it contains useful information with regard to the overall approach to be adopted For example in some
Fig 91 Students at a NACE painting inspector training course preparing a test panel prior to blast cleaning
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 123
cases a knowledgeable inspector will be able to offer immediate suggestions for correcting a situation whereas in othersituations he must refer the matter to the engineer not least because of a possible increase in the cost of the operation
The methods used to inspect each phase of the coating operation will be considered below with notes on the more commontypes of instruments and aids employed by the inspector
951Surface Preparation
There are three aspects that the inspector may be called upon to examine visual cleanliness surface profile and freedom fromsalts eg ferrous sulphate (FeSO4) Of these cleanliness is most commonly specified Requirements relating to the state ofthe steel surface ie the amount and type of rusting before blast-cleaning is carried out may also be specified and this is oftenan inspection requirement
9511Steel Surface Before Blast-Cleaning
The specification may cover requirements for the steel surface before blast-cleaning Various clauses may be used to coverthis aspect eg new steel with virtually intact millscale The original Swedish Standard covered four grades of steel surfacedesignated A B C and D ranging from new steel with millscale to fairly badly pitted and rusted steel ISO 8501ndash11988 (BS7079 Part Al 1989)7 which replaces the Swedish Standard SIS 05 59 00ndash19678 includes the same photographs Theinspection in such cases will be of a visual nature using either the Standard or some other suitably specified method
Defects other than corrosion eg laminations and shelling will also be examined visually but often this is more usefullycarried out after blast-cleaning
9512Visual Cleanliness
The lack of suitable instrumentation to assess or measure the requirements for surface cleanliness is a drawback Aninstrument called the lsquoSurcleanrsquo was developed by the Paint Research Association in the UK but has not proved suitable foruse with the present national standards The assessment therefore remains a subjective judgement as to both quantity and typeof residues that are affecting the visual appearance
Current Standards for cleanliness of substrates prior to coating rely entirely on visual assessment of freedom from rust andmillscale The assessment is made with the aid of one of two methods The first and probably the most widely used is bycomparison with photographs of surfaces in varying degrees of visual cleanliness This is the method used in the newInternational Standard on surface preparation which came into force in October 19897 The second method is to use a writtendescription which includes a percentage of visual contamination allowed for each grade This method is used in the NACEStandards and BS 42321967 The latter was withdrawn and replaced by BS7079 in 1989
In general there is no problem in identifying the highest standard ie Sa3 white metal etc by either method the problemarises with the lower standards that allow some residues left on the surface such as Sa2auml NACE 2 SSPC SP 10 etc
The difficulty with the Swedish Standard photographs which incidentally are the same as those now in the InternationalStandard and with the same prefix (Sa3 etc) is that it is often difficult to match the photographs exactly with actual blast-cleaned surfaces One reason is that the type of abrasive used affects the colour of the surface owing to embedded particlesThe Swedish Standard photographs were produced from panels prepared by sand blasting Sand gives a whiter brighter finishthan for example copper slag Another reason is that the depth and shape of the surface profile affects the amount of shadowon the surface deep sharp-edged pits give more shadow shallow depressions give less Also the Swedish Standardphotographs are produced from specific rusted surfaces as represented by the Rust Grades A B C and D Surfaces that haverusted to a greater or different extent will have a different appearance after blast-cleaning Furthermore it is not easy to tellfrom photographs the exact nature of the residues remaining on the surface The standards allow slight stains in the form ofspots or stripes but not particles of scale in spots or stripes and it is difficult to distinguish these using a photograph Finally itis difficult to obtain consistent reproduction of colour photographs to the standard required incidentally a much morestringent standard that is normally necessary for colour illustrations Comparison of different editions of the Swedish Standardshows significant differences between the reprints
The International Standard ISO 8501ndash11988 has tried to overcome these objections as follows(i) It mentions in the text that appearances may be different with different abrasives The new British Standard 7079 Part Al
1989 which is basically identical to the ISO standard has gone one step further and added a supplement which shows
124 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
representative photographic examples of the change of appearance imparted to steel when it is blast-cleaned with differentabrasives The appropriate ISO Committee is considering whether to incorporate a similar supplement to ISO 8501ndash1
(ii) The ISO Standard differs from the Swedish Standard in that the Standard is represented by verbal descriptions and thephotographs are representative photographic examples only This distinction is more for the situation where there is a legaldispute rather than for practical use
(iii) Considerable care is now being taken over monitoring the colour reproduction of each reprint A special working partyhas to approve each colour print run
In North America the situation is complicated there are two large prestigious but separate organisations that have over theyears produced Standards for surface preparation The National Association of Corrosion Engineers (NACE) and the SteelStructures Painting Council (SSPC) both have Standards consisting of written descriptions that are similar but not identicalFor example for second quality ie NACE 2 and SSPC SP 1063 the former states that 95 of the surface shall be free ofresidues the latter says 95 of each square inch and so on NACE further supplemented the descriptions with visualcomparators consisting of steel panels encased in clear plastic that illustrated the grades of cleaning when starting with newsteel One is for air-blasting with sand abrasive9 and the other for centrifugally blasting with steel grit10 SSPC visualstandards to supplement the written specification were based with some exceptions on the Swedish Standard
More recently there has been some cooperation between NACE and SSPC to produce common standards NACE have alsoproduced a new visual comparator of plastic-encased steel to illustrate the surface preparation grades on new steel air-blastedwith slag abrasive SSPC have discarded the Swedish Standard photographs and from October 1989 have published a newvisual standard11 consisting of new photographs of surfaces blasted with different abrasives
It is to be hoped that with a few yearsrsquo experience of all the new standards there will be a distillation of the best and thatthis will become accepted world-wide particularly since the intentions are the same and only the method of expression isdifferent
It should be noted however that in Europe the majority of painting specifications call for second-quality blast-cleaningie Sa2auml whereas in North America there appears to be a general tendency to call for lower standards which are evidentlyconsidered as acceptable For example there is wide use of commercial blast (equivalent to Sa2) or brush-off blast(equivalent to Sal) More recently they have produced a standard known as Industrial Blast Basically this allows for tightlyadhered millscale rust or old paint remaining on no more than one-third of the surface providing that it is defined asdispersed The definition of tightly adherent is defined as impossible to remove by lifting with a dull putty knife
Handmdashand power-tool cleaning also have their visual standards In ISO 8501ndash11988 there are two grades St2 (thorough)and St3 (very thorough cleaning) The photographs are identical to those in the Swedish Standard
SSPC has written standard specifications for hand-tool cleaning12 and power tool cleaning13 which in general terms allowfor the removal of all loose material A new specification entitled lsquoPower Tool Cleaning to Bare Metalrsquo14 has been producedto allow for the new types of abrading machines which are capable of removing adherent millscale rust or paint Thisstandard is considered by SSPC to be equivalent to Sa2
ISO 8501ndash11988 also includes photographs taken from a German DIN Standard and these show the rust grades A B Cand D after flame cleaning These are given the prefix Fl
The problem basically with specifications for surface cleanliness arises from the need to make assessments rather thanmeasurements Experienced inspectors are able to assess surfaces by eye with reasonable accuracy but the method is subjectiveand may lead to disagreement This tends to occur rather more with the use of certain types of abrasives on previously rustedsteel and with Sa2auml or equivalent grades The problem is commonly overcome by preparing test panels to an acceptablestandard prior to blast-cleaning the main steelwork The standard is agreed upon by all parties and used for all assessmentsSometimes an area of the steelwork itself is blast-cleaned to the required standard and used as a reference
9513Surface Contaminants
Apart from the removal of millscale and rust the absence of other contaminants eg oil grease and dust may be specifiedOil In some continuous coating operations in factories a combustion method is used to detect the presence of oil but this
does not appear to be practical for use in the fieldThe water-break test ie observation of the behaviour of a droplet of water on the surface or the Fettrot test can be used
The Fettrot test consists of applying one drop of 01 solution of Fettrot BB dye in ethanol to the surface On horizontalsurfaces free from oil the drop spreads out rapidly and a circular residue remains On vertical surfaces free from oil the dropruns away quickly leaving an oval residue On horizontal surfaces not free from oil the drop remains in its original size until itevaporates leaving a sharply pointed residue On vertical surfaces it leaves a long trace on the surface If the dye Fettrot BB isnot available the test will work equally well with either a 1 solution of Crystal Violet in ethanol or a 1 solution offluorescein in ethanol
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 125
The UV test for oil can be useful in some situations The procedure involves exposing the surface to ultraviolet light andsome but not all oils will fluoresce The test has particular value for the maintenance painting of the internals of oil tanksprovided the oil that is likely to be present does fluoresce under UV irradiation
Soluble iron corrosion products Apart from the cleanliness as indicated by standards (eg Sa2auml) the steel surface evenafter blast-cleaning may be contaminated with salts produced by the corrosion process (see Chapter 3 for an explanation)These are commonly ferrous sulphate (FeSO4) and various chlorides of iron eg FeCl2 Again there are at present nonational or international standards available either for methods of determining such iron salts or for specifying the amountacceptable for various conditions Consequently specifications may call for the absence of such salts or a limit may bespecified based on previous experience
If inspectors are called upon to determine the presence of such salts there are a number of test methods availableGenerally these salts often termed lsquosoluble iron corrosion productsrsquo can be detected in the pits on the steel surface by usinga magnifying glass of about x 15 magnification The visual appearance is not however always a reliable method ofidentifying the presence of such salts Experienced inspectors may be able to indicate with some certainty their presence butnot their identity If suitable photographic standards are prepared the visual method could possibly be developed to provide aquick and satisfactory method for detecting these contaminants At present however the lack of standards would lead toproblems in specifying suitable requirements A number of chemical tests have been devised to detect the presence of ironsalts and in some cases to identify them The salts are usually colourless and are present at the bottom of pits Over a periodof time they react with the steel producing a darkening of the surface so one possible method of checking their presence is tomoisten the steel This is effective but is not sufficiently rapid as an inspection method consequently various reagents havebeen used to produce an immediate chemical reaction involving a colour change The most commonly used test is called thepotassium ferricyanide test because it is based on that reagent So far as the authors are aware it has not been standardisedalthough a summary of the method does appear in BS 5493 (1977)1 (Appendix G) The procedure used is as follows
(1) Potassium ferricyanide papers are prepared by dissolving approximately 5 g of the chemical in 100 ml distilled waterFilter papers of a suitable size and grade eg Whatman medium No 1 9cm are soaked in the solution and allowed to dryin air They should then be stored in a dark receptacle to exclude light Although this is a wise precaution for storage itis probably preferable to prepare new test papers at regular intervals rather than to store the papers for long periods
(2) An area of the blast-cleaned steel surface is moistened with distilled water either by spraying or by using a suitable padToo much water should not be used just sufficient to moisten it When the water has almost evaporated theimpregnated filter paper is pressed on to the damp surface for about 10s using a finger to gently press the paper into closecontact with the steel
Fig 92 Spots on potassium ferricyanide paper indicating presence of soluble iron corrosion products
126 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
(3) The filter paper is then examined for blue spots which indicate the presence of soluble iron salts on the blast-cleanedsurface (see Fig 92)
The test is qualitative and a judgement may be required concerning the requirements for further blast-cleaning No standardsare available to indicate various degrees of contamination and as the test is sensitive very slight spotting may indicate a lowlevel of contamination which might not require further blast cleaning However where the test is specified with a requirementfor no contamination then further blast-cleaning will be required On previously pitted steelwork an unnecessary amount ofblast-cleaning may be required to reach the stage where this test produces absolutely no blue spotting
The test is based on the reaction between iron salts drawn onto the filter paper and the potassium ferricyanide and does notprovide any indication of the type of soluble salt eg whether sulphate or chloride Furthermore a measure of skill is requiredto obtain the right degree of moisture on the surface
An improved test method for determining corrosion salts has been developed over the last few years based on 22-bipyridene indicator papers Although this has not been standardised it is under discussion by the appropriate ISO committeeand is likely eventually to appear as a standard method It is commonly called the Merckoquant test because the indicatorpapers supplied by the chemical firm of Merck are generally used for the test although similar indicator papers are suppliedby other companies Unlike the potassium ferricyanide test it does not identify discrete spots indicating the position ofsoluble salts but provides an average measure of their concentration per unit area (see Fig 93) It is therefore a quantitativeor more correctly allowing for the limitations of the method a semi-quantitative test unlike the qualitative nature of thepotassium ferricyanide method The following procedure is commonly used although if the test is standardised in the futurethe procedures may vary from this and the standard should of course be followed The areas of test surface and the volumeof water recommended have been chosen purely to simplify the final calculations
(1) An area of approximately 250mmouml100mm is marked out on the blast-cleaned surface of the steel (2) A pure cotton wool swab (about 1 g in weight) is soaked in a receptacle containing 50 ml distilled water It is then used
to swab the test area for about 2 min It is subsequently placed into a fresh dry container A(3) The swabbing with water is repeated the swab being placed in the container A(4) The area is then dried with another piece of cotton wool which is placed in container A(5) The remaining water in the first container is transferred to the second container A and the cotton wool swabs are
thoroughly stirred in the water(6) A strip of suitable indicator paper is dipped into the solution in container A
If soluble iron salts have been removed there will be a colour change on the indicator paper and this is compared withcoloured references giving the concentration of ferrous salts present If the volumes and areas noted above are used theferrous iron concentration indicated on the reference slips is twice the concentration of ferrous ions on the steel surfaceexpressed in milligrams per square metres
In the field a plastic bag may be conveniently used as the container To prevent additional contamination of the surfaceoperators should wear clean disposable plastic gloves of the medical variety The test strips should be kept in dry tightlyclosed containers when not in use One strip should be checked with a test solution of known ferrous iron solution stabilisedwith dilute sulphuric acid In a plastic bottle not a glass bottle the solution should remain stable for about 4 weeks
Moisture Instruments have been devised to measure surface moisture but the problems arise in calibrating them to providea useful assessment for specification and inspection purposes Usually visual examination is employed A useful method is tosprinkle a little talcum powder on the surface If the surface is dry and free from contaminants then the powder can be readilyremoved by gentle blowing The method is most usefully employed on smooth paint surfaces but can sometimes be used onblast-cleaned steel
Fig 93 Apparatus required for Merckoquant test for ferrous salts
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 127
Some paints are supplied for application to damp surfaces Problems can arise in determining the amount of moisture that isacceptable and methods of assessing it In such situations advice should be sought from the paint supplier
Test papers can also be used to test for moisture These are prepared by immersing filter papers in 15 (wv) solution ofcobaltous chloride and drying The papers should be stored under dry conditions When placed on the surface to be paintedthey will change from blue to pink in the presence of moisture They are not sensitive to low levels of moisture but might beuseful where primers sold as suitable for application to wet surfaces are used since they might indicate a level that the primerscannot tolerate
Chloride A test is also available for assessing the amount of chloride on a surface This is called the Saltesmo test after theproprietary test discs widely used for the method These discs consist of an indicator paper impregnated with silver chromateencapsulated in a sealed plastic cover The test procedure is similar to that of the Merckoquant test An area of surface about15cmouml20cm is marked out and swabbed with cotton wool Two to three swabbing operations are required followed by a finaldrying with fresh cotton wool A container with 30 ml distilled water is used for the test When the cotton wool swabs havebeen well stirred into the solution using a glass rod the test disc which has to be perforated in the centre with a pin beforeuse is immersed for about 2 min It is then removed and the chloride content is assessed by comparing the colour on the discwith those of a reference scale The test indicates halogen ions but generally these will be chlorides and the amount per unitarea can be calculated from the concentration of the solution and the area cleaned
The test will indicate sodium chloride as well as other soluble chlorides such as ferrous so it can be a useful test to measuresalt contamination on all surfaces including painted ones in a marine situation
The basis of the test is a reaction between chloride ions and silver chromate to form silver chloride The concentration isusually given on the reference scales as NaCl (sodium chloride) The chloride content is then approximately 06 of that of theNaCl The exact proportion can be calculated from the molecular weights The precautions are the same as for theMerckoquant test operators should use plastic gloves and all containers should initially be clean and dry
This test method is probably more suited for determining the concentration of sodium chloride eg from seawater spraythan for determining chlorides left in pits after blast-cleaning It has been concluded by several workers in the field thatquantities of chloride as low as 10 micro m cm2 can be harmful under paint films Since many of the site methods for chloridedetection are not sensitive enough the ISO Committee on Preparation of steel substrates before the application of paints andrelated products has decided that it is preferable to publish a laboratory method for chloride determination that can be carriedout on washings taken from the work face The method which is ISO 8502ndash2 involves titrating with mercurous nitrate usinga mixed indicator of diphenylcarbazone and bromophenol blue This is a standard analytical method The committee is howevercontinuing to look for a suitable method for use on site and is investigating the use of chloride detection ampoules fromJapan
Dust The ISO series of Standards on surface preparation will cover a method for the detection of dust on the surface Basedon an existing South African standard it is likely to be published as ISO 8502 Part 3
The test is a simple one consisting of pressing a pressure-sensitive tape onto the surface (see Fig 94) The tape with thedust adhering to it is then placed on a white background and compared with pictorial ratings for both quantity and particlesize The ISO standard proposes the use of a special spring loaded roller to apply the tape In practice this is difficult to usewithout contaminating the top surface of the tape and is less effective than human fingers in pressing the tape into a pittedsurface it therefore seems to be an unnecessary refinement
As yet there are no recommendations for acceptable levels of dust This is a necessary requirement since it is unlikely thatany surface in an industrial atmosphere will be dust free The acceptable level will depend upon the method of paintapplication brushing being the most tolerant and the type of paint being used
Sampling One of the problems with measurement of surface contamination is the difficulty of sampling from blast-cleanedand possibly pitted surfaces Swabbing the surface is a crude technique that is neither effective nor consistent
Fig 94 Testing for dust using pressure-sensitive tape
128 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
As far back as 1959 Mayne15 suggested the use of a limpet cell but this is difficult and cumbersome on a rough surface Apromising idea has been developed in Sweden by Bresle16 This consists of a flexible cell consisting of a self-adhesive plasticpatch about 15 mm thick and with 40-mm diameter punched hole in the centre The hole is covered by a thin latex film toprovide a sample area (see Fig 95) Water is injected into and withdrawn from the sample patch by means of a hypodermicsyringe
The volume of the sample is small but by leaving the syringe needle in position it is possible to inject and extract the waterseveral times to provide some agitation on the surface and increase recovery This procedure also prevents leakage andenables the patch to be used in any position The Bresle patch method looks promising and is being investigated by theappropriate ISO committee for inclusion in the Standard
Conductivity Conductivity measurements of sample wash liquids from a blast-cleaned surface may well prove to be theeasiest and most reliable method of detecting water-soluble contamination Small conductivity meters (about the size of a pentorch) are now available and only require a small sample of water This would be particularly useful to use in conjunctionwith the Bresle lsquopatchrsquo since this would reduce the possibility of contamination for example from sweaty hands which wouldaffect the reading Several models of larger conductivity measurement cells are available and can be used
Shell Research UK have developed a conductimetric apparatus including a limpet cell that can measure conductivity ofsteel surfaces The method was primarily designed to check the deterioration of zinc silicate primers but can also be used todetect soluble salts A Japanese firm Toa Electronics has also designed a sampling apparatus for measuring liquids onsurfaces
A salt contamination meter known as SCM 400 has been developed in the UK Its method of use is to apply a wet filterpaper to the surface to be tested remove and measure the conductivity of the filter paper in a special apparatus (see Fig 96)
The advantage of conductivity measurement is that it includes all forms of water-soluble contamination ie sodium chlorideas well as ferrous chloride The disadvantage is that it does not distinguish between the ions causing the rise in conductivity
It has been argued that conductivity measurements used to detect salts will be influenced by the pH of the solution and aretherefore unreliable Work by Igetoft17 concludes that an unusually high conductivity measurement of wash water from ablast-cleaned surface will always indicate the presence of ionic species regardless of the pH of the solution and that this isenough to show that the surface is not suitable for painting
A published method that could be adapted for this purpose is a ASTM method for the conductimetric analysis of water-soluble contamination of abrasives18
Fig 95 Using the Bresle sampling patch
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 129
9514Surface Profile
There is no direct relationship between the surface profile and surface cleanliness and specifying to the Swedish Standarddoes not imply any profile requirements The surface profile is the term used to indicate the undulating nature of blast-cleanedsurfaces ie the roughness Over the years a number of devices have been developed to measure surface profile but for fieldconditions three methods are generally used to measure or assess the distance between the summit of any peak on a blast-cleaned surface and the bottom of an immediately adjacent trough
(i) A specially converted dial gauge for direct measurement(ii) The production of a suitable replica of the surface which is measured usually by a dial gauge
(iii) Specially prepared panels used to compare the roughness of the surface being inspected and so assess the profile
All three are used but (iii) the use of a special comparator has been standardised by the appropriate ISO committee and hassome advantages that will be considered later
Dial gauge method This was the first method developed for use in the field Dial gauges are specially manufactured formeasuring surface profile and their operation is straightforward The foot of the gauge is a flat anvil through which protrudesa pointed probe When the anvil is placed on a perfectly flat surface the base and the pointer are level and the gauge readszero Placed on a blast-cleaned surface the probe drops into a valley and the gauge reads the depth Obviously the probe doesnot always fall into the lowest point and several readings must be taken to produce an average profile measurement
The method is quick and easy to use It has been a popular method in the UK but hardly used in the USAReplica method The method above can be used fairly easily on large flat horizontal areas but problems may arise on
undersides and areas with difficult access In such situations replicas may be produced and then measured with an instrumentsuch as a Tallysurf or by optical methods The measurements would be carried out in a laboratory not usually by theinspector However there is a replica method that can be used directly by inspectors in the field
The replicas are produced from a commercial material called Testex Press-o-Film Tape using a specially adapted dialgauge The tape is made up of two separate layers One is an incompressible Mylar backing of thickness 50micro m the other is acompressible material of virtually nil elasticity By placing the tape with the compressible layer on the steel surface andrubbing the backing with a blunt instrument a replica of the surface is produced The tape is then measured with the specialdial gauge The maximum profile can then be calculated by subtracting the thickness of the non-compressible backing ie50micro m from the dial reading
Fig 96 Using the SCM 400 salt-contamination meter
130 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
This method only provides a measure of the maximum profile it does not indicate an average However it has a number ofadvantages It is comparatively easy and quick to use it can be employed on curved surfaces and in positions with difficultaccess Furthermore the tape can be maintained as a record of the profile reading On the other hand the use of tapes adds tothe overall cost Two grades of tape are available (a) Coarse for profiles 20ndash50 micro m and (b) X-Coarse for profiles from 40ndash120 micro m The tapes are of American origin and the specially adapted dial gauge is calibrated in mils (10copy3 in) not in micronsThe tapes are usually supplied in a dispenser containing a roll of 50 test tapes The method is particularly favoured in NorthAmerica where it is a NACE standard recommended practice19
Profile comparators Special steel coupons prepared to provide a range of different surface roughnesses have beenavailable for many years eg lsquoRugo testrsquo specimens These have not been specifically prepared for assessing blast-cleanedsurfaces but can sometimes be used for this purpose generally using a tactile assessment More recently however speciallyproduced gauges have been available to compare average profiles produced by blast-cleaning The Keane-Tator surfaceprofile comparators are commonly used in America but to a lesser extent in Europe The comparator consists of a disc with acentral circular hole and five projections Each of the projections or segments is prepared to a different average profile depthThe disc is placed on the blast-cleaned surface to be assessed A battery-operatedouml5 illuminated magnifier is placed over thecentral hole the surface to be examined can then be compared with the various segments and a match of the profile madeThis may be a direct match say at 50 micro m or may be between the 50 and 75 micro m segments and so regarded as 60 or 65 micro mBeing of American origin these comparators are in practice calibrated in mils Three different discs are produced to representsurfaces blast-cleaned by sand metallic grit and steel shot The discs are a high-purity nickel electroformed copy of a masterwhich has been checked for profile height with a microscope Another set of comparators again produced in the UnitedStates is the lsquoClemtex Couponsrsquo These are stainless-steel specimens treated to provide a range of profiles
A Work Group of the ISO Committee on Surface Preparation carried out extensive trials on all methods of measuringsurface profile They decided that the precision and accuracy of all of the methods was poor and this was probably due to theconsiderable variation in roughness that occurs on a blast-cleaned surface In addition each method tended to give a differentresult They considered therefore that to give an answer in lsquonumbersrsquo itself implied an unjustifiable accuracy that wasunnecessary for its purpose In addition none of the methods was likely to measure rogue peaks They therefore decided toproduce a special surface profile comparator
ISO Standards 8503 Parts 1 to 4 and the identical BS 7079 Parts Cl to C420 describe the specification for the comparatorsthe method of use and the two reference methods to calibrate the comparators namely by focusing microscope or stylusinstrument
The comparators consist of a square with four segments and a hole in the centre (see Fig 97) Segment 1 is the finest andeach segment increases in roughness The blast-cleaned surface is compared with each segment and if between 1 and 2 it iscalled fine between 2 and 3 it is called medium and between 3 and 4 it is called coarse There is one comparator for grit-blasted surfaces and one for shot-blasted surfaces Unfortunately because shot cannot produce the same roughness as grit theterms coarse medium and fine represent different levels between the two comparators In the opinion of the authors it wouldhave been more logical to keep the same levels of roughness between both comparators and to leave the coarse segmentsblank for the comparator for shot blasting
Fig 97 ISO surface profile comparators
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 131
9515Weld Areas
Weld areas are vulnerable and likely to be the first point of failure of a painted structure Their treatment is often neglected inspecifications References to visual cleanliness such as Sa2auml or to surface profile are not applicable
Often the welding inspectorsrsquo requirements are different from those of the painting inspector Most of the chemicalcontamination will arise from welding rods and small portions of the surface should be wetted and tested with pH papersMost welding rods give an alkaline deposit which must be removed before painting particularly for oleo-resinous paintswhich could be saponified The major concern with welds however is the roughness sharp edges undercutting pinholes etcwhich cannot be coated properly and must be eliminated
The International Standard lsquoPreparation Grades of Previously Coated Steel Substrates after Localized Removal of Coatingrsquowhich is likely to be published as ISO 8501 Part 2 (BS 7079 Part A2) is to include photographs taken from a German DINStandard21 which shows examples of treatment of welds Unfortunately the committee has not yet seen fit to include welds innew work which would have been more logical
NACE has addressed the situation more satisfactorily by producing a weld replica in plastic which illustrates the varyingdegrees of surface finish on welds prior to coating The weld comparator includes full seam welds butt welds lap welds andskip or tack welds22
9516Blast-Cleaning Operations and Equipment
Many specifications rely on the inspection of the final blast-cleaned surface as the criterion for acceptance This is areasonable approach based on the view that the contractor will have to operate his equipment satisfactorily in order to achievethese requirements However if the contractorrsquos equipment or the operators using it are not particularly efficient problemsand delay will arise to avoid this inspectors may be required to carry out certain checks This will be concerned mainly withassessing the quality of the equipment and its probable effectivenes in achieving the requirements of the specification
This section is concerned with blast-cleaning but hand tools are often used particularly for maintenance work and theyshould also be checked eg for wear (in the case of wire-brushes and scrapers) Warped and blunt tools are much lesseffective and lead to slower cleaning so where appropriate suitable action should be taken Power-driven tools should also beinspected and where necessary the attachments such as wire-brushes grinding discs etc should be replaced The hosescables and other equipment involved should also be inspected to ensure that they are capable of continuous operation and canreach all parts of the structure to be cleaned Delays due to poor cleaning equipment can largely be avoided through carefulinspection before the work commences
There are two main types of blast-cleaning equipment one using an air compressor and the other relying on rotating wheelsto provide the centrifugal force necessary to provide the abrasives with a suitable velocity for cleaning
Compressed air blast-cleaning machine The following general checks should be made on the compressor and ancillaryequipment
(a) Correct capacity for the work in hand and ability to maintain the required air pressure and volume this can be checkedfrom the manufacturerrsquos data sheets
(b) Compressed air should be free of contaminants and moisture This can be checked by blowing the air onto a piece offilter paper or white cloth of suitable size If there is no discoloration or sign of moisture then the air is clean On the otherhand a trace of oil or moisture would indicate that the various filters and traps are not functioning properly Seriouscontamination of the test paper or cloth may indicate a requirement for further inspection of the air source Where thespecification calls for a complete absence of moisture in the air then a change of equipment or the use of a special dryinginstallation may be called for The risk of water condensation carrying through the system increases with increasing relativehumidity When the humidity is high sometimes the water-separating devices cannot cope and the inspector must advise thesupervisor
(c) The blast-cleaning machine should be checked overall including all the valves and separators(d) The hoses should be of suitable length so that they can be properly operated but they should not be unnecessarily long
as this will reduce the pressure available at the nozzle All couplings should be sound and tight The pressure at the nozzle canbe checked with a special hypodermic needle gauge which is inserted in the hose close to the nozzle during the operation ofthe equipment ie with abrasives being used The small hole which is made seals and does not affect the operation of thehose This check is easily carried out and will ensure that the machine is operating at a suitable pressure (550ndash690 kPa 80ndash100 psi) at the nozzle The pressure gauge on the equipment will indicate the pressure before the air has been forced throughthe hoses The hoses particularly lsquowhip endsrsquo the small pieces of smaller-bore hose used at the nozzle end by the blast-cleaner to ease handling will result in some pressure drop Blast-cleaning may be completely ineffectual if the pressure at the
132 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
nozzle is too low The nozzle is also important and should be chosen for the specific work in hand Nozzles should be checkedfor wear and damage special gauges are available for checking the nozzle diameter If badly worn the nozzle should bereplaced
Centrifugal blast-cleaning machines Only limited checks can be carried out on this type of equipment which is in a self-contained unit without separate compressors hoses etc
(a) Check that the sections to be cleaned can be properly treated The arrangement and number of wheels used in the plantwill influence the area cleaned Adjustments can be made to the equipment but the presence of reentrant angles andcomplexity of shape may result in lsquohiddenrsquo areas which will have to be blast-cleaned by hand later
(b) The degree of cleaning is determined to a considerable extent by the speed of the sections through the machine and ifnecessary this can be adjusted
(c) The abrasives are recirculated in this type of machine and correct screening is required to ensure that the specifiedprofile is obtained
Wet blasting The specification requirements for wet blasting have to take into account that the standards used for dryblasting eg the Swedish Standard are not directly applicable to this method of cleaning Furthermore there is a likelihoodof flash rusting on-site from the moistening of the surface by the water used for cleaning
Nowadays many enlightened paint manufacturers are prepared to accept a degree of oxidation of blast-cleaned surfaces Tobe acceptable such oxidation should not be powdery should be ginger in colour and shown to be free of soluble salts Suchlsquogingeringrsquo as it now tends to be called is due to the differential aeration corrosion cells formed as clean water evaporatesfrom the surface dark brown rust particularly in spots would be an indication of the presence of soluble salts and would beunacceptable
9517Abrasives
The degree of inspection will be determined by the specification requirements and may cover either or both of the following(a) Check on type of abrasive eg steel shot(b) Size of abrasives This can be checked by suitable screening with standard sieves eg to BS410 or ASTM D 451ndash63The sample tested must be representative and should not be taken from the top of the bag where there is likely to be a
preponderance of larger particles The bag selected for sampling should be representative of the batch and the contents shouldbe thoroughly mixed prior to the actual taking of the sample The test is carried out on the following lines
(i) A correctly prepared sample of 200 g of abrasive is weighed(ii) The mesh sizes for the sieves required for the particular abrasive are selected by reference to a suitable standard eg
BS2451(iii) The sieves are arranged in order (they fit together) with the largest mesh size at the top and the receiver under the
smallest mesh size(iv) The weighed sample is poured in and vibrated or shaken for 5 min (v) The contents of each sieve are weighed and the weight is expressed as a percentage of the original sample
(vi) The results are expressed in accordance with the particular standard being used
If the BS2451 method is used the results would be expressed as follows
Taking G24 abrasive as an example total sample passes 100 mm mesh at least 70 is retained by 0710 mm mesh atmost 15 passes 0600 mm mesh and none passes 0355 mm mesh
All sieves must be cleaned prior to the screening and this is best achieved with a hand brush Abrasive should not be pushedfrom the sieve with a pointed metal object as this is likely to damage the mesh and provide incorrect results The above testcan be carried out reasonably quickly but it is sometimes sufficient to screen an un weighed sample of about 400 g throughthe largest and smallest sieves only by shaking for 5 min If all the abrasive has passed through the top sieve and has beenretained by the bottom sieve this would be considered as satisfactory
(c) Checks for contamination of the abrasive may be called for particularly the presence of dust and oil Dust can bechecked using the sample prepared for the screening test on sieves About 100 g is placed in a clean container and water ispoured in so that the abrasive is just covered After stirring to ensure wetting any dust from the sample will be visible on thesurface of the water
The presence of oil can be checked by placing another sample of 100 g in a suitably sized glass beaker Clean solvent egxylene is poured so as to just cover the abrasive after stirring some of the liquid is poured carefully onto a clean glass plate
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 133
The solvent is allowed to evaporate and the presence of oil and grease will be detectable on the glass as a smear As solventsare flammable suitable safety precautions are necessary when carrying out the test
(d) There may be a requirement for a minimum soluble chloride content with some abrasives particularly sand This can beobtained only by standard analysis in a laboratory
For a quick check on contaminants a small sample of the abrasive can be stirred in distilled or demineralized water in aglass container Spot checks can then be made for chloride ferrous ions etc or tested in general for soluble salts with aconductivity test
Standards for abrasives are being produced by both ISO and NACE and when these are published it is likely that more testson abrasives will be called for by users Many of these however will be laboratory determinations such as hardness andtests to determine the relative degree to which blasting abrasives break down during a specifie blasting operation23
952Testing of Liquid Paints
Increasingly and particularly for important projects paint users are checking the quality of paint materials prior to workstarting and during the work Most of the tests must be carried out in a laboratory (see Chapter 16) but the painting inspectoris frequently required to obtain samples and also to carry out some simple tests on site
Sampling is generally by selecting unopened tins at random from stock If samples are required from large containers it isimportant to ensure that sampling is carried out correctly for example to BS39001965 PartA1 Special deliveries of singletins of paint arranged by the contractor are generally not acceptable as a representative sample
On-site a painting inspector may be required to check paint supplies for type colour suitability for the chosen method ofapplication condition gravity and viscosity These latter methods are described in Chapter 16
As the work proceeds and particularly with brush application the inspector may take samples from painters lsquokettlesrsquo forgravity checks These will indicate whether unauthorized thinning has been performed Results should be within 10 of thepaint manufacturersrsquo declared figures but in practice if thinning has occurred it is likely to be so gross as to be obvious Thetests are generally only required to give a scientific basis for the complaint against the applicator Fortunately although this wasa common fault in the past it is less likely with spray application since excessive thinning gives the operator little advantage
953Coating Application
The quality of the coating application has an important influence on the durability of coatings and sound inspectiontechniques will play an important role in ensuring that application is carried out to the required high standard Inspectionshould cover not only the physical application of the coating but other aspects which also affect the quality of the finalcoating These include checks on the ambient conditions at site or in the shop to make sure that they satisfactorily meet thespecification requirements and also checking of paints including storage and mixing The application of metal coatings alsorequires inspection and the inspection methods will be determined by the method of application and the particular metal beingcoated
Good housekeeping has an important influence on the quality of work and the inspector should endeavour to ensure that ashigh a standard as possible is maintained and should seek the cooperation of the contractorrsquos supervisor in this respect
9531Storage and Preparation of Paint
The following checks are necessary to ensure that the paint is correctly stored and prepared for use(a) Paint delivered to the site corresponds to the specification requirements including type eg primer and colour(b) All paints are correct for the method of application to be used eg airless spray(c) Condition of storage a properly prepared store that does not suffer from extremes of temperature should be used When
not in use it should be locked and the key held by a responsible person(d) Batch numbers should be recorded and paint should be withdrawn from store in the correct sequence Withdrawals should
be properly recorded(e) Sufficient paint should be available in store either on-site or at a central depot for completion of the work(f) The inspector should be present when paint is issued at the start of the work period(g) Single-pack paints must be thoroughly stirred This particularly applies to paints containing heavy pigments such as
micaceous iron oxide or zinc dust
134 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
(h) Two-pack materials must be mixed strictly in accordance with the paint manufacturerrsquos data sheets Furthermore otherrequirements such as induction periods and pot life must be strictly adhered to Material must not be used after the expiry ofits pot life it must be discarded Temperature has an effect on pot life If the temperature is markedly higher than that quotedon the paint data sheets the pot life may be decreased and advice should be sought if any doubts exist regarding this aspect
(i) Additions to paints must be strictly in accordance with the manufacturerrsquos recommendations Too much thinner willresult in reduced film thickness too little may cause dry spray pinholes or poor appearance The wrong type of thinner ieone other than that given in the manufacturers data sheet may cause coagulation of the paint In some cases this can be quitespectacular as the coating gels in the spray lines
(j) If test results on paints are required before painting commences it must be checked that they are available and have beensubmitted to the client
9532Paint Application Equipment
All equipment must be in good condition if sound paint coatings are to be achieved Brushes and rollers should be of thecorrect size and shape and must not have worn to an extent where coating application will be affected All spray equipmentshould be checked to ensure that it is in sound working condition and that reserve equipment is available if required
The information in the manufacturerrsquos paint data sheets should be followed regarding pressure tips etc Whereappropriate hoses filters and compressors should be examined to ensure that they are in sound condition and suitable for thework in hand All the equipment must be clean and should be thoroughly checked before operations are started
The condition cleanliness and suitability for the work to be carried out are essential requirements for paint applicationequipment and must be thoroughly assessed and checked beforehand The lack of suitable equipment or its malfunctioningcan lead to serious delays or poor application of the paint both of which will add to the overall costs
9533General Conditions in the Shop and on the Site
The suitability of any workplace for proper paint application should be assessed prior to placing a contract However this isoften not done and the inspector should then satisfy himself that the conditions in the shop are suitable for the work in handThe various requirements can be summarised as follows
(a) Maximum and minimum temperatures and their control Suitability of equipment for heating eg combustible productsshould not be produced inside the shop
(b) Ventilation sufficient to maintain low concentration of fumes and vapours solvent vapours must be kept below theTLV (threshold limit value)
(c) Lighting sufficient intensity to allow for adequate painting and inspection (d) Positioning of various pieces of equipment eg blast-cleaning areas must be properly separated from painting areas to
avoid contamination with dust abrasives etc(e) Suitable areas for storage of painted steel and adequate equipment for handling the painted product(f) Availability of proper protective equipment for operators(g) Sound health and safety procedures(h) At site as opposed to inside a shop there can be no direct control of the ambient conditions However where protective
sheeting has been specified eg to allow for the continuation of work during adverse weather conditions the adequacy ofsuch measures should be checked
(i) There must be adequate access to all surfaces to be painted but a situation frequently overlooked is when parts of thescaffolding (albeit only relatively small areas) are fixed too close to the work surface
The storage conditions for painted steelwork coming to the site should be suitable with proper foundations for the stackedsteelwork ensuring that sections are not resting in mud or on gravel which can damage the coating The sections should bestored to avoid ponding ie collection of water on horizontal areas Suitable slings etc should be available for handling
9534Measurement of Ambient Conditions
Specifications may require paint application to be carried out under certain ambient conditions and the inspector will need tomeasure and assess these requirements The conditions generally taken into account are those appertaining to air temperaturesteel temperature relative humidity and dew point
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 135
Air temperature and relative humidity can be measured automatically using recording hygrographs and thermographswhich record the information on charts to provide daily or weekly records These instruments may be operated by clockworkor electrically Generally however for inspection work various forms of hygrometer and thermometer are usedHygrometers or psychrometers as they are also known are instruments for measuring the relative humidity indirectly Thereadings obtained with these instruments provide wet and dry bulb temperatures and these are converted to relative humiditiesby reference to suitable tables The most commonly used instrument of this type is the whirling hygrometer or slingpsychrometer as it is called in some parts of the world Relative humidity and dew point are important requirementsfor satisfactory paint application and their influence has been considered in Chapter 5 As both are quoted in specificationsthe inspector must have suitable and convenient methods for measuring them
Whirling hygrometer The whirling hygrometer (see Fig 98) contains two identical thermometers one of which is coveredwith a small piece of fabric or wick which is saturated with water this is called the lsquowet bulbrsquo the other being called the lsquodrybulbrsquo The dry bulb records the ambient temperature and the wet bulb records the effects of water evaporating from the wickThe rate of evaporation is influenced by the relative humidity which indicates the amount of moisture in the air The lower thehumidity the faster is the evaporation rate The two temperatures are then compared with standard tables which provide afigure for relative humidity
Certain precautions are necessary with the operation of these hygrometers They should be examined before use andcontinuity of the mercury columns in the thermometer checked The fabric covering the wet bulb should be clean secure atboth ends and wet The small container in the instrument should be filled with distilled water
The following sequence is used for measuring the relative humidity with this type of hygrometer
(i) With the hygrometer prepared for the measurements it is rotated or whirled at about 180 rpm or slightly faster for 20seconds
(ii) In a still atmosphere the operator should walk slowly forward during the whirling operation to avoid any effects fromhis body The operation is best carried out away from direct sunlight
(iii) The temperatures on both thermometers are noted the wet bulb first immediately after the completion of 20 seconds ofwhirling
(iv) The whirling is repeated for another 20 seconds at the same speed as before(v) Both temperatures are read
(vi) The procedure is continued until the temperature reading on each thermometer is constant for two successiveoperations
(vii) The two temperatures are recorded(viii) Suitable meteorological tables supplied by national authorities in most countries are consulted The relative humidity
and dew point can then be read from the tables
The whirling hygrometer may not operate satisfactorily if the air temperature is below freezing point (0EacuteC) and other methodssuch as direct-reading instruments may be required These are however expensive and are not usually considered to be anecessary part of an inspectorrsquos equipment Digital instruments which give instant readings of the dry and wet bulbtemperatures and electrically operated instruments which incorporate a fan to draw air across the wet bulb are availableThese instruments can give substantially different readings from the whirling hygrometer and this can be the cause of disputebetween inspector and contractor The probable reason for this is that the static apparatus samples a smaller and more
Fig 98 Whirling hygrometer
136 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
localised quantity of air Some of the electronic types can be calibrated with standard humidity cells but this merelyestablishes the precision of the instrument not the accuracy of the determination Obviously the whirling hygrometer is moredependent on its correct use by the operator However if the standard procedure is followed and the operator continues to takemeasurements until the readings stabilize then this apparatus however cumbersome and old-fashioned it looks is a standardreference method24
9535Measurement of Steel Temperature
Specifications commonly require that steel temperatures should not be less than 3EacuteC above the dew point to avoid thepossibility of moisture condensing on the surface during painting operations It is therefore necessary to have a simple meansof measuring the steel temperature This is usually measured with a contact thermometer which has magnets attached forfixing to the steel The thermometer contains a small bimetallic couple which acts in a way similar to a thermocouple andrecords the temperature on a dial These instruments are normally cheap but some models can be very inaccurate Eachinstrument should be checked before use and since there is generally no method of calibration discarded if more than 10out
Digital temperature gauges with separate probes are available which provide a direct reading of the surface temperature in amatter of 20 s compared with a stabilisation time of as much as 30 min with the dial type and with greater accuracyHowever these instruments are not necessarily intrinsically safe and may not be permitted for use in hazardous areas
9536Measurement of Paint Film Thickness
A range of instruments is available for the measurement of dry film thickness Provided they are regularly and correctlycalibrated and used properly they will provide reasonably accurate measurements of thickness Other qualitative methods areused such as adjusting the opacity of the paint so that the underlying coat is just obscured when the correct coating thicknesshas been applied Again strong contrasts between successive coats enable both the painter and the inspector to check on thecontinuity of coatings and to ensure that all coats in a system are in fact applied
Apart from checking dry film thickness tests can be done to determine the thickness of the wet film and this has theadvantage that adjustments can be made immediately It is often assumed that provided the minimum thickness of coating isattained then additional thickness is advantageous to the client This is not always correct however and in some cases amaximum thickness may be specified Clearly problems arise if the dry film is greater than this
Wet film thickness measurement For paint applied to steel surfaces this method is used mainly as a guide to the painter andthe inspector dry film thicknesses are usually specified Wet film thicknesses are most commonly measured with a small combgauge This has a number of projections similar to a comb The two at the end are the same length and those in betweenprogressively vary in height (see Fig 56) The gauge is pressed into the wet film perpendicular to the surface with the twoend pieces in contact with the steel surface It is then removed and examined Some of the teeth will have been wetted by thepaint whereas others will have remained proud of the surface of the paint coating so will not have been wetted Each of theteeth or graduated steps is designated by a thickness in micrometres (or mils) and the thickness is taken as being the average ofthe highest step covered and the lowest one not covered eg if the 50 micro m step is wetted and the 75 micro m step is not then thethickness is considered as between those two measurements A range of gauges is available so if none of the teeth is wettedanother gauge should be used Gauges are available in stainless steel and these must be cleaned after use Disposable plasticgauges are also used
Another type of wet film thickness gauge consists of a wheel with two outer rings of equal diameter with a graduated eccentriccentre ring The gauge is held between a finger and thumb and rolled over the painted surface The inner ring is then examinedand the thickness is indicated by the graduation mark where the paint no longer wets the ring
The wet film thickness is only useful if it can be related to the dry film thickness The ratio is as follows dry filmthickness=wet film thicknessouml solids (vol)ccedil 100
Dry film thickness measurement The specification may call for a minimum average or maximum thickness but thespecifier should take into account the inevitable variations in film thickness that occur in practice and provide a realisticrequirement for film thickness Otherwise unnecessary problems are likely to arise during inspection
Many instruments have been developed for the measurement of dry film thickness Only those commonly used in high-quality inspection will be considered here The instruments can be used for measuring the thickness of metal coatings onsteel with certain limitations as well as paint coatings
The non-destructive method most commonly used depends upon measuring the magnetic flux between the instrumentprobe and the ferrous substrate The weaker the flux the bigger the gap and therefore the thicker the apparent coating The
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 137
instruments are divided into three broad types (a) magnetic pull-off (b) fixed probe and (c) electromagnetic induction All ofthese instruments to varying degrees of accuracy operate on the principle of the coating acting as an air gap and this givesrise to errors Rust millscale dirt vacuoles etc will add to the apparent coating thickness Measurements on very soft paintfilms will give low results Also the measuring scale of most of the instruments is not linear and so it is advisable to calibrateover the range required This is normally carried out using plastic shims of known thickness However the most difficult problemis the interpretation of results over a blast-cleaned surface A rough surface alone without any paint will give a reading onthe instrument of anything from 15 to 50 micro m depending on the roughness
Since with thin films in particular it is necessary to know the film thickness above the peaks of the profile allowancemust be made for this in the instrument reading Opinions differ as to the best way this should be accommodated and in factdifferent makers of the same types of instrument give different advice The two most usual methods are as follows
(i) Place a shim of known thickness appropriate to the film to be measured on the unpainted blast-cleaned surface andadjust the instrument to read the shim thickness All subsequent measurements on that surface can then be read directly
(ii) Place an appropriate shim on a polished flat steel plate and calibrate the instrument Then take a number of measurementsdirectly from the blast-cleaned surface Obtain an average figure which can be used as a factor to be subtracted from allfuture results on that surface
Of the two methods the second is recommended for most situations25 The problem with the first method is that shims arelikely to deform under the pressure of the instrument probe Also the roughness of any blast-cleaned surface is very irregularand the calibration could be made over an area that was unrepresentative
The ease and accuracy with which instruments can be adjusted varies with type and make and manufacturerrsquos instructionsshould be followed The various types will be discussed separately
There is an ISO Standard for the measurement of film thickness SSPC have also produced a comprehensive specificationThis includes recommendations for the number of measurements necessary for conformance to a thickness specification Thisis important because it is impossible to apply coatings to a strictly uniform thickness particularly if they are applied as thickfilms Paint manufacturersrsquo data sheets normally give a recommended film thickness but without specifying whether that is aminimum or average value Most engineers interpret it as a minimum but this does raise the average significantly which maynot always be desirable BS 5493 recommends that film thicknesses should be quoted as lsquonominalrsquo The definition is that overany square metre the average of the readings taken should equal or exceed the nominal thickness and in no case should anyreadings be less than 75 of the nominal thickness The disadvantage of this definition is that it does not allow for even onerogue result from the instrument and does not define a maximum thickness permissible
Concerning frequency of measurement the SSPC specification states that for structures not exceeding 300 ft2 fivemeasurements should be taken over an area of 100ft2 spaced evenly over the area Each reading to be the average of threereadings taken close together The average of the five readings should be not less than the specified film thickness and anyone reading (an average of three determinations at one spot) should not be less than 80 of the specified thickness For largerstructures the number of sampling areas is proportionally increased
The SSPC specification also describes the different types of magnetic instrument available and suggests their method ofcalibration Some of their recommendations differ from those given by the instrument manufacturers and it is understood thatthe subject is under review
Magnetic pull-off There are a number of instruments in this category and they are known by various names according tothe country of supply However they can be sub-divided into a number of groups the simplest in operation being the PencilPull-off or Tinsley Gauge This is the size of a small pencil with a clip attached for placing in a pocket The principle ofoperation is straightforward with a magnet attached to a spring held in a housing and a reference mark that moves along ascale When the force exerted by the spring balances the magnetic attraction the magnet pulls from the paint film and a smallmarker can be read from the scale The instrument must be used perpendicularly to the painted surface under test Theseinstruments are cheap and easily carried about but the operating principle makes accurate measurement difficult to achieve
Another instrument of this type works in a somewhat more complex way but again relies upon the tension in a spring (seeFig 99) A hair spring is connected to a lever at the fulcrum and fitted to the instrument housing the outside of which carriesa marked dial fixed to the lever The instrument lever has a small magnet at one end which protrudes through the casing and iscounterbalanced at the other end The instrument is placed on the coating and the dial is rotated so that the spring tension isincreased to a position where the magnetic force balances the spring tension The magnetic force is of course related to theeffect of the coating thickness which acts as an air gap Just beyond the balancing point the small magnet on the lever springsfrom the surface and the dial reading in microns or mils provides a direct reading of the coating thickness Errors that canarise with this instrument include
(i) Use on overhead surfaces which may produce inaccurate readings
138 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
(ii) The effect of vibration in the area of testing may cause loss of magnetic attraction between the magnet in the instrumentand the steel surface This can result in readings that are too high
(iii) If paint films are soft or tacky the magnetic probe of the instrument may press into the film and produce a low readingof the true film thickness
(iv) If the probe is not regularly cleaned metallic abrasives may accumulate at the magnetic tip and lead to incorrectreadings
Fixed probes(i) Twin fixed probe These were one of the original types of paint film thickness instruments They rely on permanent
magnets within the instrument casing Nearby strong magnetic fields as for example from welding equipment or nearbypower lines will interfere with the reading It is recommended in all cases that two readings are taken the second with theprobes turned by 180Eacute
(ii) Single fixed probe This is a relatively new instrument which functions mechanically on a self-balancing magneticprinciple The fixed jewelled tip probe is placed on the coating and a digital reading is obtained from a revolving mechanicaldevice
Electromagnetic induction type The method depends upon measuring the magnetic flux in an electromagnetic circuit It ispreferable to the Eddy current method which is used for most non-ferrous substrates because it is less sensitive to substrateinhomogeneities It is not affected by age (reduced magnetism) by vibration or by heat cycling The display can easily bemade digital and readings can be microprocessed and fed to a print-out device (see Fig 910) The most expensive and the mostaccurate of the portable instruments available has a claimed accuracy of egrave1 to egrave3 of the readings in the lowest rangecompared with egrave10 for the pull-off gauge and egrave15 for the pencil gauge Errors can arise from (i) batteries in poorcondition (ii) pressing the probe into soft films and dirt paint etc on the probe
As with all dry film thickness instruments they require a measure of skill and common sense in their use The use ofmicrometres instead of mils in most countries may have led to some misunderstandings 1 mil is equivalent to 25 micro m and anaccuracy of 05 mil is equivalent to 125 micro m so readings to the nearest micrometre can be considered as very accurate
Assessment is probably a better term than measurement for all instruments because it tends to remove from the operator afeeling of intrinsic accuracy in the method which in practice relies upon many factors that must be appreciated when usingthe instruments
Other instruments and methods for assessing dry film thickness The instruments considered above are in various formsthose most commonly used for measuring the dry film coating thickness They are all non-destructive and this is an advantageHowever there are also instruments that require a small cut in the paint film and could be called lsquodestructiversquo This would becorrect but gives the wrong impression because with most coatings the small area of damage can be repaired withoutdifficulty However it is not a routine measurement and should not be undertaken unless specified Otherwise the contractor
Fig 99 Magnetic pull-off thickness gauge
Fig 910 Electromagnetic thickness gauge with print-out
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 139
is liable to claim compensation for the repair of damage however small The method is mainly used when disputes arise or onnon-metallic substrates
The principle of operation is based on viewing a small cut or a small conical drill hole made in the coating at an angleusing a small microscope held perpendicular to the surface of the coating A graticule is incorporated into the eyepiece andthis allows measurement of the coating thickness Cutting devices with different angles are available and simple conversionscan be made to determine the value of the graticule graduations This information is supplied with the instruments Theconical hole is made by a small hand-rotated drill which must be operated to remove the coating to the steel base The othertype relies upon a knife-type cut and on brittle materials it may be difficult to provide a sharp cut the drill-type may be preferredThe advantages of these instruments lie in their ability to provide a measure of the individual coatings in a system This cannotbe achieved with magnetic instruments which provide a measurement for total thickness only although the individualthickness of coatings can be measured during application
Coating thickness can also be calculated from the amount of paint applied to a known area of steelwork This method is notgenerally used for inspection purposes but is employed in some maintenance and general testing work
9537Detection of discontinuities in coatings
Obviously there is a tendency for applicators to miss areas that are out of sight or have difficult access An importantqualification for a painting inspector is ability and willingness to climb and work at heights Observation by binoculars fromthe ground has limited value With fairly close access the use of a small angled mirror attached to a telescopic handle is usefulfor getting into awkward areas undersides of pipes etc Some consider that the mere visible possession of such an instrumentby the inspector has a worthwhile psychological effect on the painters
Other discontinuities can be difficult to detect visually for example porosity due to dry spray or minute slivers of steelpenetrating from the substrate and pinholing owing to incorrect atomisation or release of bubbles from a porous substrate
Even in multi-coat systems discontinuities such as pinholes and pores may occur in the coating The term lsquoholidayrsquo is widelyused to describe such discontinuities A few pores per square metre may be acceptable in some situations but for immersedconditions particularly for critical requirements such as tank linings or pipe coatings a pore-free coating or one with aspecified limitation on the number of discontinuities may be required Instruments are available for checking the presence ofthese discontinuities They are based on the insulating character of the coating so that an electrical circuit will be completedonly when there is a discontinuity ie no coating The two common forms of test are based on the use of a sponge at lowvoltages or a sparking technique at high voltages
Wet sponge test The principle is straightforward A sponge fitted to a metal plate is moistened with tap water andconnected by a cable through a voltage source to the steel to which the coating is applied (see Fig 911) The wet spongeshould be moved over the surface at about 30cms using a double pass over each area and applying sufficient pressure to maintaina wet surface If a discontinuity is detected the corner of the sponge should be used to determine the exact location
The coating acts as an insulator so that current does not flow unless there is a discontinuity such as a pinhole present Inthis case the circuit is completed and a device in the circuit eg a lighted bulb or an audible signal operates to indicate thepresence of a discontinuity in the film
The voltages vary with different types and makes of instrument but they generally range from 9 V to 90 V the highervoltage being used for thicker coats
Although simple in operation certain precautions are necessary The sponge must be sufficiently wet to allow properoperation but excess moisture on the surface or in the atmosphere may give rise to lsquotrackingrsquo ie the water will conduct
Fig 911 Wet sponge test
140 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
current to a pinhole some distance from the sponge The coating to be tested should also be dry to eliminate tracking The useof a weakened detergent solution eg lsquoTeepolrsquo may be advantageous particularly for coatings of thicknesses above 250 micro m
The advantage of the method is that it cannot harm the coating The disadvantage is that it is only effective at filmthicknesses less than 500 micro m
High-voltage test Although the principle is the same as for the low-voltage test no sponge is used instead a wire brush orother conductive electrode is used (see Fig 912) These instruments are generally either DC or DC pulsed type A direct-current apparatus provides a continuous voltage a pulsed type discharges a cycling high-voltage pulse Both types canaccomplish the desired result but the pulsed type is considered more suitable for the thickest films The DC voltage is variableup to about 30 kV depending on the type of instrument The circuit is similar to that used with the low-voltage system withone end of a cable fixed to the steel structure and the other end to the electrode This is passed over the surface of the coatingat approximately 30cms using a single pass At a discontinuity a spark jumps completing the circuit
At the high voltages used these instruments are capable of burning holes in the coating so they must be used withdiscretion and only at the voltage recommended by the coating manufacturer and as stated in the specification In situationswhere no voltage setting is specified then a reasonable procedure to follow is to use the ratio of 100 V per 25 micro m of thenominal coating thickness since most coatings have quite high dielectric breakdown strengths with 500 V to well over 2000 Vper 25 micro m being quite common Even materials with relatively low dielectric breakdown strength such as glass-fibrereinforced polyesters would require 43 kV to break down a 3mm coating Reducing this by one-third gives 14 kV as a testvoltage which would present no danger of destruction to properly coated areas
In the absence of any knowledge of the coatings or the instrument voltage outputs the best method is to make a very smallhole in the coating and starting with the apparatus at its lowest voltage increase until the test hole is consistently detected
Many applicators are strongly opposed to this test with some justification if it is incorrectly carried out However much ofthe suspected coating breakdown is due to incorrect use of the apparatus non-uniform thickness voids vacuoles or dirtinclusions in the coating Retained solvents can also give erroneous indication
Re-testing should not result in more indications of discontinuities than previously unless the speed of testing or test voltagehas been changed or the coating has been in service or stressed so that its dielectric strength is lower
Devices using AC current are less common but have an application for the testing of coatings that are conductive forexample coal-tar epoxies or rubber linings that contain carbon black pigment The apparatus is not directly connected to thesubstrate but emits a blue corona which when passed over the coating surface will cause a spark to jump from the tip of theprobe to the discontinuity Surface contaminants and moisture can also cause the apparatus to spark Since there is a higherrisk of a severe electric shock from this apparatus it requires greater care in handling
9538Adhesion
Testing of coating adhesion is another destructive test that the inspector may be called upon to carry out in the event of adispute Methods of test as carried out in the laboratory are discussed in Chapter 16 One new form of apparatus designedprimarily for field use is the HATE adhesion tester The load is applied by a hydraulically driven piston through the centre ofthe dolly stuck to the coating surface Its advantage is that it is simple and easy to use and gives a more direct pull off normalto the surface and with an even pull-off force
Fig 912 DC voltage test for discontinuities in a coating
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 141
9539Tests for Cure
An inspector may be required to carry out hardness tests on a coating in order to establish whether it is adequately curedA pencil hardness test is frequently specified for thin stoved finishes and occasionally for air-drying finishes The method
consists of pushing pencils of increasing hardness across a paint film until one is found that scratches the paint film In theUSA the opposite technique is employed so that the hardest pencil is used first and then in decreasing hardness until oneis found that does not scratch the coating The result will depend upon the make of pencil used the pressure applied and theinterpretation of whether the coating is scratched or not It can only be considered a rough indication Fish26 has reported inwork for ISO standardisation that even using one manufacturerrsquos pencils the test did not give consistent results
For thick coatings in excess of 800 micro m there are hand-held portable hardness testers The two most commonly used for testingthe cure of elastomeric coatings are the Barcol hardness tester and the Durometer Both of these instruments have models in asuitable range for testing soft plastics The testers are held against the coating surface and a spring-loaded plunger is driveninto the coating When the resistance of the coating equals that of the spring then a reading can be taken from the dial indicatoron the instrument Results are normally given in hardness for the particular instrument Hardness results from different makesof instrument generally cannot be directly correlated Therefore both instrument and hardness required must be specified
Another test for cure of coatings is the solvent sensitivity test or solvent wipe test It can only be used on chemically curedcoatings such as epoxies There are several slightly different methods of carrying out the test so the method required shouldbe detailed in the specification One method is to saturate a rag in solvent The choice of solvent can make a difference to theresult and should be checked with the paint manufacturer if not specified The saturated rag is then wiped across the surfaceof the coating for a specified number of times If the coating is not properly cured it will stain the rag quite readily If only atrace or none of the coating comes off on the rag this will at least indicate that the surface of the coating is cured
96INSPECTION OF METAL COATINGS
There are fewer stages in the application of metal coatings so inspection is usually more straightforward than with paintcoatings There are four methods of applying metal coatings to constructional steelwork or the components used inconjunction with it
(i) Diffusion eg sherardising of zinc(ii) electroplating
(iii) hot-dipping(iv) spraying
(i) and (ii) are usually factory-applied coatings and inspection is not normally carried out during the processing The thicknessof electroplated components on steel can be checked using the magnetic-type instruments employed for paints Diffusioncoatings contain a series of iron-based alloys so usually the thickness cannot be determined with any accuracy using suchinstruments
Hot-dip galvanised coatings also contain alloy layers so again problems may arise when measuring the thickness withmagnetic instruments In practice these instruments are used for determining the coating thickness of hot-dipped zinccoatings This may be acceptable as a control check where a series of steel sections of similar size is being galvanised but inthe event of disputes other methods must be used These are the determination of the weight of zinc per unit area employingchemical methods or measurements of a cross-section of the coated steel using a microscope Both methods are outside thescope of normal inspection
The thickness of sprayed coatings of zinc or aluminium can be measured with standard magnetic instruments
961Hot-Dip Galvanising
Sometimes the inspector may be called upon to check the process itself but this is rare The specification requirements areusually based on the applied coating in particular its appearance
The following defects would probably be grounds for rejection
Spots bare of galvanising coatingFlux inclusions (stale flux burnt on during dipping)
142 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
Ash inclusions (ash burnt on during dipping)Black spots (included flux particles from flux dusting)Warpage and distortionDamaged surfaces
The following defects may be acceptable unless they are present in gross amounts or are specifically excluded by prioragreement
General roughnessPinholes (entrapped particles)Lumpiness and runsDull grey coatingBulky white depositBlisters (entrapped hydrogen drive-off during pickling)
The specification may stipulate certain requirements in the coating and these must be taken into account in the inspectionprocedures Generally however apart from the defects noted above the zinc coating should be continuous and reasonablysmooth
On larger steel sections minor imperfections may be accepted because removal of defects eg by grinding may be moreharmful than leaving them provided they are of a minor nature Small bare spots may be repaired with a zinc-rich paint orless commonly using metal spray or a special solder
962Sprayed Metal Coatings
Blast-cleaning is essential for sprayed metal coating application and should be at least Sa2auml and possibly Sa3 (or equivalent)for aluminium The cleanliness of the surface is checked as for cleaning prior to paint application The thickness of the coatingcan be measured but apart from this inspection is mainly visual27 28 The coating must have a reasonably uniform texture andbe free from powdery deposit or coarse or loosely adherent particles protrusions and lumps Adhesion checks may be calledfor in the specification these will be carried out in accordance with the specified standard eg BS 2569 Two useful guides tothe inspection of sprayed metal coatings have been produced27 28
97INSPECTION INSTRUMENTS
The inspection requirements should be clearly specified and will involve a range of examinations and measurements Specialinstruments have been developed to measure or assess many of the coating properties
Because of the cost of such instrumentation frequently the dry film thickness gauge is the only instrument possessed bysome paint inspectors The following are considered by many authorities to be the minimum requirements
mdash Carrying case (see Fig 913)mdash Mirror with a telescopic handlemdash Dry film thickness gauge or gauges for the appropriate rangemdash Calibration shims or thickness standardsmdash Wet film thickness gauges of the appropriate rangemdash Gauge and hypodermic needles to measure the air pressure close to blasting nozzle mdash Comparators and needle gauge to measure the roughness of blast-cleaned surfacesmdash Visual standards to measure the cleanliness of blast-cleaned surfacesmdash Tape for dust measurementmdash Cloth test for oil in air supplymdash Test strips for measurement of soluble salt contamination of surfacemdash pH papersmdash Penknife and scraping toolsmdash Illuminated magnifiermdash Wet and dry bulb hygrometer plus spare thermometersmdash Surface thermometer
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 143
mdash Tables or calculator for determination of relative humidity and dew point mdash Method of detection of abrasive contaminationmdash Device for marking defectsmdash Appropriate National Standards and Specificationsmdash Appropriate paint manufacturersrsquo data sheetsmdash Log book report forms and squared paper for diagrams
In addition the following more specialised equipment which may not be necessary for each job should be available ifrequired
mdash Holiday detector of appropriate range and sizemdash Set of sieves for checking abrasive sizingmdash Balance or scalesmdash Eddy current thickness gauge for non-ferrous substratesmdash Density measuring cupmdash Viscosity flow cup and stop watchmdash Adhesion testermdash Ultraviolet lamp (for oil detection)mdash V-cut inspection gaugemdash Fibre-optic inspection instrumentationmdash Camera plus close-up lens and films
98REPORTS AND RECORDS
The inadequacy of records providing data on the performance of coating systems has had an adverse effect on the selection ofsystems suitable for specific situations This lack of records often proves to be of concern when considering maintenanceprocedures because there may be no effective information on the original systems or even on the types of paint used forprevious maintenance work It is always necessary to have a detailed record of coating procedures not least because it mayprovide essential information regarding the cause of premature failures or the problems concerned with particular types of
Fig 913 Case of instruments used by a coatings inspector
144 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
coating application or performance The inspectorrsquos records are not primarily maintained to provide material for a data bankbut if properly prepared and studied they will be of considerable value to all those concerned with a project Some of theessential requirements of a report are given below The details will obviously vary with the nature of the work the type ofsurface preparation specified and the type of coating selected In some situations additional records may be considered to beappropriate
All records must provide dates of the operations concerned and must relate to specifie structural items with clearidentification codes otherwise it may prove impossible to use the report in any meaningful way Furthermore matters such asprogress safety precautions and general comments on standards of workmanship will prove useful
(i) SURFACE PREPARATION Initial condition of steel and details of pre-cleaning inspection Type of surfacepreparation adopted Details of quality demanded Method of quality control agreed Name of instrument agreed andnumber Details of method of preparation
(a) Blast-cleaningType of equipment and manufacturer ventilation arrangement lightingType of abrasive used and gradeArrangements for separation of debris and topping-up abrasive and arrangements for removing dust from workShop conditions and location relative to initial painting areaComments on programmingInspection arrangementGeneral comments
(b) Flame-cleaningType of equipment fuel gases mixing ratiosQuality control arrangement agreedComments on programming
(c) PicklingProcesses agreed Control arrangement for bath conditionComments on programming
(d) Hand cleaningType of tools agreedQuality control arrangements agreedComments on programming including pre-weathering
(e) Incident reportsAny event which affects progress of work significantly ie delays between stages supply problems disputes staff
changes etcRecords of any re-working enforced
(f) General observations especially on labour recruitment and discipline and supervision provided (g) Summary of quality control measurements on profile heights surface cleaning and daily reports on progress
(ii) PROTECTIVE SYSTEMDetails of system coat by coat with film thickness required including any protective metal coatingDetails of quality of finish requiredDetails of mixing ratios for two-pack materialsManufacturerrsquos thinning recommendationsMethod of quality control measurements agreedName of instrument and numberDetails of any special feature in application to be observed ie ambient temperature humidity re-coating times
paint temperature for hot spraying(iii) APPLICATION
(a) Air spray air pressure at gun Nozzle combination details Compressor details viscosity of paint(b) Airless spray airline pressure fluid tip (orifice diametermdash spray angle) air supply details pump capacity viscosity
of paint(c) Roller type of roller and arrangement for brush infilling(d) Brush type of brush(e) Details of any intercoat treatment eg abrading required
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 145
(f) Details of shop conditions heating lighting humidity ventilation housekeeping incident reports any event whichaffects progress of work significantly eg delays between coatings or between cleaning and initial coating on steelsupply problems disputes staff changes records or any re-working enforced
(g) General observations especially on labour recruitment discipline and supervision provided Comments on applicationcharacteristics of materials used and on any equipment employed
(h) Details of quality control measurements film thickness continuity pinholing adhesion general standard of finish
(iv) SITE WORKThe following additional information should be recorded
(a) Daily weather including records of changes during working period and recordings of RH and metal temperature (b) Condition of steelwork on arrival at site(c) Record of any deterioration during storage with details of time of storage(d) Record of damage suffered during construction(e) Details of any remedial work carried out
It should be appreciated that the record is produced for the client and should not be distributed without his agreement It mustbe considered as a factual document but where appropriate comments on the contractorrsquos attitude competence of workforce etc may be valuable to the client However such comments may not be capable of substantiation to the satisfaction ofneutral observers and so should be considered as no more than useful comments preferably provided in a separate documentrather than in the report which may be passed with the clientrsquos agreement to others concerned with the project Valuablethough reports are engineers are usually busy and will not have time to study them thoroughly Consequently a summary ofthe main points on a periodic basis the time interval depending on the project will prove useful to the client
REFERENCES
1 Protective Coating of Iron and Steel Structures Against Corrosion BS 5493 Section 4 British Standards Institution London 19772 Palmer F Improving specifications for offshore and onshore facilities J Protective Coatings and Linings 6(12) (1989) 25ndash83 Hauck JC Painting practices at West German chemical plants an Americanrsquos observations J Protective Coatings and Linings 6
(12) (1989) 56ndash614 Kaminski WW amp Allen JR What is inspection worth J Protective Coatings and Linings (Aug 1984) 30ndash55 Thompson SP Managing a maintenance painting program to reduce costs Corrosion 82 Pre print 146 NACE Houston 19826 International Coating Inspector Training and Certification Program NACE Houston 19827 Preparation of steel substrates before application of paints and related products ISO 8501ndash1 Part Al Specification for rust grades
and preparation grades of uncoated steel substrates and of steel substrates after overall removal of previous coatings InternationalStandards Organisation 1988
8 Pictorial Surface Preparation Standards for Painting Steel Surfaces Swedish Standard SIS 05 5900 Swedish Corrosion InstituteStockholm 3 1967 (Available from British Standards Institution)
9 Visual Standard for Steel Surfaces of New Steel Cleaned with Sand Abrasive NACE TMO 170ndash70 NACE Houston 197010 Visual Standard for Surfaces of New Steel Centrifugally Blast Cleaned with Steel Grit and Shot NACE TM 0175ndash75 NACE
Houston 11 Visual Standard for Abrasive Blast-cleaned Steel (Standard Reference Photographs) SSPC VIS 1ndash89 Guide and Standard SSPC
Pittsburgh 198912 Hand Tool Cleaning SSPC-SP2 SSPC Systems and specifications Vol 2 SSPC Pittsburgh 198213 Power Tool Cleaning SSPC-SP3 SSPC Systems and Specifications Vol 2 SSPC Pittsburgh 198214 Claus J New SSPC specification Power tool cleaning to bare metal J Protective Coatings and Linings (Oct 87) 84ndash9115 Mayne JEO The problem of painting rusty steel J Appl Chem 9 (1959) 673ndash8016 Bresle A New Method for Sampling and Analysis of Impurities from Steel Surfaces Expertus Keniteknik private report Stockholm
Sweden 198917 Igetoft LI Determination of Salts on Blast Cleaned Surfaces Swedish Corrosion Institute Report 610442718 Method for Conductimetric Analysis of Water Soluble Ionic Contamination of Blasting Abrasives ASTM D014602 ASTM
Philadelphia19 Field Measurement of Surface Profile of Abrasive Blast Cleaned Steel Surfaces Using Replica Tape NACE RPO 287ndash87 NACE
Houston 198720 British Standard 70791989 Part C1 Specification for surface profile comparators for the assessment of abrasively blast cleaned
surfaces Part C2 Method for the grading of surface profile comparators for the assessment of abrasively blast-cleaned surfacesPart C2 Method for the grading of surface profile of abrasively blast cleaned steel using a comparator Part C3 Method for thecalibration of surface profile comparators and for the determination of surface profile using a focusing microscope Part C4 Method
146 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
for the calibration of surface profile comparators and for 4he determination of surface profile using a stylus instrument BritishStandards Institution London 1989
21 Korrosionsschutz von Stahlbauten durch Beschichtungen und Uumlberzuumlge DIN Standard 55928 Teil4 Deutsches Institut feacuter Normung1978
22 Visual Comparator for Surface Finishing of Welds NACE Standard RPO 178ndash 89 NACE Houston 198923 State of California Test method for establishing abrasive quality J Protective Coatings and Linings 2(8) 9ndash1324 Whirling Hygrometers BS 24821975 1981 British Standards Institution25 Measurement of Dry Paint Thickness with Magnetic Gauges Systems and Specifications Vol 2 SSPC Pittsburgh26 Fish RA An investigation of the pencil hardness test Paint Technology 34(6) 14ndash1727 Inspection of Sprayed Aluminium Coatings The Association of Metal Sprayers Walsall28 Inspection of Zinc Sprayed Coatings Zinc Development Association London
QUALITY CONTROL OF COATING OPERATIONS 147
CHAPTER 10Designing for Corrosion Control
The design of structures and buildings is usually considered in the context of shape appearance and structural integrityHowever there are other aspects of design which are less obvious but can nevertheless have an important influence on theoverall economics of a structure The protection against corrosion both initially and over its lifetime accounts for a notinconsiderable part of the overall cost of a structure Therefore any aspects of the design that increase costs should be ofconcern The purpose of this chapter is to indicate areas where the design itself may adversely affect the performance ofcoatings or increase the probability of corrosion
In many structures the detrimental influence of certain design features may cause problems related to maintenanceHowever the additional breakdown of coatings and consequent rusting is often assumed to be an inevitable situation thatoccurs with all steelwork The possibility that it could be avoided by attention to the detailed design is often not taken intoaccount This is to some extent understandable because the designer has problems with other aspects of design and fabricationand even if aware of problems from corrosion tends to assume that these will be satisfactorily dealt with when the structurehas been painted
The adage lsquocorrosion control begins at the drawing boardrsquo is correct but presupposes that at this stage there is anappreciation of design in relation to its effect on corrosion It is interesting to note that more attention appears to be paid tothese matters for offshore structures compared with those built inland This no doubt arises from the very aggressivesituations that offshore structures have to withstand and the necessity to reduce repainting to a minimum because of thedifficulties involved
Although coating breakdown and steel corrosion are likely to occur over a longer timespan on structures exposed to lessaggressive conditions they still occur so action should be taken to avoid any situation that unnecessarily causes such problems
101ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS
The nature of the conditions to which structures are exposed has a marked effect on the selection and performance ofprotective coatings and also on the overall effect of design Generally the more aggressive the conditions the greater theinfluence of adverse design features on the performance of coatings For example bimetallic corrosion (see below) may notbe appreciable when steel structures are exposed to comparatively clean inland conditions but the same alloys coupled tosteel under immersed conditions in seawater may cause serious problems Other features eg crevices are also likely to causeadditional problems in more aggressive environments particularly under immersed conditions where maintenance and remedialaction will be much more difficult to carry out It follows therefore that increased attention should be paid to all aspects ofdesign where structures are exposed to severe environments However the effect of environment is often in terms of time tofailure rather than the absence or occurrence of corrosion
102MATERIALS
In plant construction the materials used are of major importance The selection of suitable alloys for pipework heat exchangerspumps etc is an essential part of the design requirement For the types of structure covered in this particular book thematerials are usually fairly standard steel sections and slight variations in composition are unlikely to affect the overallperformance of protective systems Nevertheless there are certain aspects of material selection that may influence corrosion
(i) Fasteners are often the weakest part of a structure with regard to protection This arises from a number of causes such asthe greater likelihood of damage to the coatings because fasteners act as projections More important however is the stage atwhich they are protected Often the main structural sections are painted in the works before transportation to site prior toerection The sections are then bolted and often the fasteners receive inadequate protection sometimes no more than the final
on-site coat applied to the structure Zinc-coated bolts will in many situations raise the standard of protection to theequivalent of that of the main structure painted in the works For some situations fasteners produced from alloys such as stainlesssteel or lsquoMonelrsquo may be preferred to carbon steel Such alloy fasteners are advantageous where the nuts and bolts require to beremoved during the life of the structure Carbon steel bolts tend to rust at the threads which makes removal very difficultAttention must however be paid to problems of bimetallic corrosion when using alloy fasteners and where appropriate theyshould be coated
(ii) Galvanised wall ties used in the exterior brickwork cavities of buildings have in some cases corroded at anunacceptable rate and in many situations stainless steel is now preferred This is a design problem because the cavities are notnecessarily dry particularly where the ties are fixed to the outer wall Bricks are porous and may allow the ingress ofmoisture particularly in situations of driving rain
(iii) The employment of alloys or alloy-clad material may be preferred to the use of conventional coatings in some criticalareas of a structure Typical examples are the use of a lsquoMonelrsquo cladding on the risers of offshore oil production platforms andlsquoIncalloyrsquo welded overlays on parts of marine structures Clearly attention must be paid to galvanic effects in such situationsand the different alloys must be insulated from each other Sometimes carbon steel clad with titanium or stainless steel may beused in this case sound sealing of the edges is essential
(iv) Stainless steels may be used for certain parts of structures or buildings When they are freely exposed to air very littlecorrosion will occur However when they are immersed in seawater the presence of crevices or overlaps can lead to corrosionand the same precautions should be used at crevices as for carbon steel (Section 105) The reason for the corrosion is that theprotective (passive) oxide film breaks down and because of lack of oxygen in the crevice is not repaired so that the stainlesssteel acts like carbon steel Deposits and fouling on the surface of stainless steel immersed in seawater can also cause pitting
103BIMETALLIC CORROSION
The corrosion arising from connecting two alloys one of which is more noble (or cathodic) than the other leads to bimetalliccorrosion of the less noble (or anodic) alloy The relative nobility of metals is shown in various lsquogalvanic seriesrsquo the mostcommon of which is that produced for immersion in seawater (see Table 101) The extent of the corrosion depends upon anumber of factors
(i) The presence of an electrolyte and its conductivity bimetallic corrosion does not arise under dry indoor conditions Itmay occur under
Table 101Simplified galvanic series of alloys and metal coatings used for structuresa
Cathodic (protected) Titanium
Austenitic stainless steels (passive)
Nickel alloys eg lsquoMonelrsquo
Copper alloys
Lead tin
Austenitic stainless steels (active)
Carbon steel cast iron
Cadmium
Aluminium
Zinc
Anodic (corroded) Magnesiuma Based on tests in seawater
damp conditions in air especially in areas that remain moist for prolonged periods eg crevices However it is likely to bemost severe under immersed conditions particularly in high-conductivity seawater
(ii) The relative positions of the alloys in the galvanic series generally the effects are likely to be greater when alloys arewell separated and corrosion will be less when they are close together Some alloys dependent on passive films for theircorrosion resistance appear in two positions in the series depending on whether they are lsquopassiversquo or lsquoactiversquo ie whether ornot the protective surface film has broken down Stainless steels are usually far more noble than carbon steels so will increasethe corrosion of the carbon steel to a considerable extent but when lsquoactiversquo ie corroding themselves they are a good dealless noble
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 149
(iii) The relative size of the two alloys has a significant influence on the rate of corrosion For example a larger area of barecarbon steel in contact with a small area of stainless steel will not be severely attacked overall but where the stainless steel ismuch greater in area than the carbon steel considerable corrosion of the latter may occur This situation may occur whenstainless steel or other alloy fasteners eg lsquoMonelrsquo are used in conjunction with painted steel structures If there are anysmall pores or pinholes in the coating the small area of bare carbon steel will provide a very large cathodeanode ratio withthe more noble bolts and severe pitting of the carbon steel may occur This is of course likely to be most severe underimmersed conditions
(iv) The formation of corrosion products on the less noble metal or other polarisation effects may lead to a reduction incorrosion or even to its being stifled On the other hand in some situations eg in coastal marine atmospheres the corrosionproducts may be hygroscopic leading to prolonged periods of lsquowetnessrsquo and increased corrosion attack
There are a number of methods of combating bimetallic corrosion but wherever practicable it should be avoided by not mixingdifferent alloys especially in aggressive environments However where this is not practicable the following approaches shouldbe considered
(i) Insulate materials to prevent electrical contact this may be achieved in some situations by the use of suitable plasticgaskets or washers In other cases the painting of both alloys may prove satisfactory
(ii) Where practicable ensure that the more noble alloy is smaller in area than the less noble one(iii) Ensure good drainage from bimetallic joints and avoid such joints in areas of potential water entrapment and at
crevices(iv) Allow for adequate access for inspection of any bimetallic joints that may be considered as critical parts of the
structure For example where facia cladding is fixed to a building bimetallic joints may be lsquohiddenrsquo for 50 years ormore and it is not possible to predict with any certainty how they will react Moisture may reach the joints from leaks ordeterioration of materials in other parts of the building Even the use of high-duty coatings will not guarantee protectionover such prolonged periods
(v) Bimetallic joints should not be lsquohiddenrsquo in concrete or other porous materials without a sound protective coating
104ACCESS FOR INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Adequate access for inspection and maintenance of the protective system is usually an essential requirement of any designSometimes the design is such as to preclude reasonable access This situation should be avoided but where this proves to beimpracticable suitable action must be taken to ensure that undetected corrosion does not result in the loss of structuralintegrity
It is unlikely that any conventional organic or metallic coating can be relied upon for periods over 20 years withoutmaintenance Three possible approaches may be considered
(i) to build in what is often termed lsquoa corrosion allowancersquo (ii) to use a more corrosion-resistant alloy
(iii) to employ a thick coating of concrete
Each of these possibilities carries inherent problems A corrosion allowance is simply the addition of sufficient steel to thesection to allow for the anticipated loss by corrosion The allowance is usually conservatively calculated so in most situationswill satisfy the requirements for the environmental conditions This method is used for much sheet piling but generally anyincrease in corrosion over that allowed for is not critical Again it is used for some areas of bridges eg at the abutmentsHowever when using this approach the possibilities of enhanced local corrosion or changes in the initial environment mustbe taken into account Often the addition of a coating to the steel even where a corrosion allowance has been added is worthconsidering because it will add a safety margin of some years
The use of an alloy that is more corrosion resistant than steel is sometimes a sound approach although in most situationsthe additional cost proves to be unacceptable However the characteristics of the alloy must be fully appreciated especiallywhere it has to be embedded in some other material because while an alloy may overall be very corrosion resistant it may beattacked by alkaline materials or at crevices formed during construction
The use of concrete to protect the steel is widely practised with water pipes where because of the compressive nature of thecoating it generally performs well However the thickness must be sufficient in atmospheric situations to allow for thecarbonation layer of the concrete Furthermore if chlorides diffuse through the concrete layer and reach the steel surfacecorrosion may occur despite the alkaline nature of concrete The possibility of monitoring the corrosion of steel in
150 DESIGNING FOR CORROSION CONTROL
inaccessible areas is always worth considering because this does allow time to decide on a suitable course of action if problemsarise
The above discussion has been concerned with areas where access and inspection are generally physically impossible butthere are also situations where access is possible but very difficult Alternatively access may be possible for visual inspectionbut not for remedial work In some ways such conditions cause more problems because often insufficient attention is paid toensure that the steelwork is satisfactorily protected in such situations Access in this sense can have two aspects Theproblems may be concerned with the cost and the difficulties of erecting scaffolding Often this is inevitable although onbridges and other structures suitable permanent methods of access are included in the design However the access problemmay also arise from the difficulties of inspecting and later reaching the steel surface to allow for adequate repainting Thesesituations can be avoided sometimes with comparatively small changes in design
Figure 101 illustrates the situation where the design unnecessarily precludes the possibilities of sound cleaning andrepainting Sometimes access is not impossible but because of the array of service pipes and other equipment leads toconsiderable difficulties particularly with the cleaning of the steelwork before repainting
The problems that can arise are illustrated in Fig 101 The relative positions of different structural elements may bearranged in such a way that access for maintenance pointing is virtually impossible or even if there is some access thecleaning and painting of the steel is likely to be inadequate Often comparatively minor changes in design will overcome theproblem
Access problems of a somewhat different kind can occur where an array of pipes and other equipment leads to difficultiesin cleaning and adequate painting In such cases it may be worth considering the lsquoboxing-inrsquo of such areas The inside of suchlsquoboxesrsquo where the services are located should where practicable be treated to remove moisture and some form of inspectioncover should also be incorporated Generally the boxing-in of inaccessible areas is not recommended without some form ofaccess for inspection because if for example there is leakage into the box considerable corrosion may occur The addition ofservices after construction of the main elements often poses difficulties particularly if pipes are fitted too close to othersteelwork so that it is virtually impossible to reach some parts for maintenance work Often there is no reason why pipesshould be fitted flush although additional costs may be incurred in using extended brackets to allow for access Alternativelyit may be possible to provide brackets that are easily removed to allow for painting of the whole pipe
The use of galvanised steel for pipes pipe hangers and fasteners is recommended in such areas A particular problem ariseswith lsquoback-to-backrsquo angles The space between such angles is too small to allow proper cleaning and painting once they are inplace Consequently rusting eventually occurs If the angles are exposed to corrosive fumes inside a building a serioussituation can arise in a comparatively short time The problem can be avoided by changing the design eg using T-barsWhere the problem becomes apparent during maintenance the gap can be cleaned to the best practicable level and masticused to seal it Another but more costly way of dealing with the situation is to weld in a spacer plate
Where access of any type is likely to be a problem the design should be examined carefully to see whether an alternativeapproach can be adopted In particular it may be possible to re-design parts of the structure so that critical elements are fullyaccessible
105CREVICES
A crevice is a very small gap between two steel surfaces which allow access of air and moisture often through capillaryaction but does not provide sufficient space to allow for cleaning and repainting during service Typical crevice situations areshown in Fig 102 The presence of a crevice or overlap does not necessarily provide a corrosion problem For example twoheavy steel plates bolted together may produce a crevice between the contact faces However although rusting may occurwithin this gap it may simply be stifled as the space between the plates is filled with rust On the other hand a similar
Fig 101 Insufficient access for maintenance
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 151
situation with thin steel sheets bolted together could well result in buckling of the joint and shearing of the bolts It is notpossible to provide strict guidelines on situations which are safe but generally small gaps in bolted heavy steel sections willwithstand the pressure set up by the formation of the rust
As the formation of rust results from the reaction of the steel to produce an oxide or hydroxide the corrosion product will havea considerably greater volume than the steel from which it is produced (Fig 103) because 2Fe Fe2O3H2O Rusts canproduce high stresses within a crevice and Fig 104 shows the typical buckling effect on steel railings at the coast Thisproblem with the formation of corrosion products in a confined space can arise with alloys other than steel and the effect issometimes descriptively called lsquooxide jackingrsquo It is the same basic process that results in the spalling of concrete fromreinforcements that are corroding Crevices are often a more serious problem with alloys such as stainless steel because thepassive film may break down at a crevice particularly if chlorides are present This can lead to severe pitting and maypreclude the use of the alloy for many situations Typically crevices arising from gaskets at joints may produce seriousproblems
The difficulty with crevices arises because moisture and air gain access through the gap and so allow corrosion to proceedHowever because of the size of the gap it is not possible to clean or repaint it Where practicable crevices should be avoidedor at least sealed Sometimes welding in preference to use of bolted joints may solve the problem Welding of the entrance ofthe crevice or filling with mastic are other approaches although mastics may harden and contract or crack over a period oftime (see Fig 105) leading to the formation of a further crevice Sometimes the solution is to increase the gap so that creviceconditions no longer operate For example it is preferable to allow for a gap between bricks or masonry and steel rather thanto have close contact where rust exerts direct pressure on the brittle building materials causing cracking There is clearly anadvantage in painting the contacting faces before they are bolted together in a structure It is preferable to bolt the sectionstogether while the paint is still wet to make sure that any gap will be filled with the paint
106GROUND-LEVEL CORROSION
The conditions at ground level are often more severe than on other parts of a structure This arises from splashing that mayoccur from rain or the movement of vehicles on roads and from the collection of water where insufficient attention has beenpaid to the detailing at the point where the steel enters the ground Problems occur with most structures but can be severe onlamp posts railings and similar steel furniture which may be fabricated from comparatively thin material The effects of saltsexacerbate the situation in coastal areas It is advisable to provide additional protection at ground level This may be achievedby applying thicker coats of paint but the use of properly designed concrete plinths is preferable (see Figs 106 to 108)
Fig 102 Typical crevice situations
152 DESIGNING FOR CORROSION CONTROL
107ENTRAPMENT OF MOISTURE AND CONDENSATION
The entrapment of moisture and dirt in elements of a structure can lead to enhanced corrosion or the reduction in life ofcoatings Condensation also may lead to similar effects The problem with moisture arises from the prolonged periods ofcontact that may occur with an electrolyte which because it is generally well aerated can attack the steel fairly rapidly atdefects in the coating Furthermore where coatings are chosen to resist atmospheric influences they are seldom so protectivewhen in more or less permanent contact with aqueous solutions It should also be borne in mind that other design featuressuch as bimetallic couples and crevices are likely to be more active under prolonged damp conditions
Figure 109 illustrates typical situations where moisture may be entrapped and indicates possible methods of overcoming theproblems
Drainage holes often act as a simple solution provided they are properly sited Clearly they must be positioned at theplaces where water is likely to collect generally at the lowest points This can be checked fairly easily but from observationson some structures drainage holes are not always placed in the most appropriate positions They must be of sufficientdiameter to ensure that they do not become rapidly blocked with leaves and other debris The use of suitable drainpipes willensure that the water is not allowed to run over other parts of the structure Ledges should if possible be avoided as they act
Fig 103 Rust formation in crevices
Fig 104 Deformation of railings by rusting in crevices (Reproduced by courtesy of the Institute of Metals London)
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 153
to collect dirt and moisture Often hygroscopic particles in the dirt collected will cause a permanently wet poultice ofcorrosive matter to remain in contact with the steel again causing breakdown of coatings followed by corrosionCondensation produced by warm humid air impinging on a colder surface can equally be a problem In interior situations itcan often be avoided by suitable ventilation provided the surfaces are reasonably insulated from the exterior environmentDifficulties can arise with sheet steel roofs where the temperature of the metal surface varies from that of the ambientconditions inside the building
Condensation inevitably occurs on the undersides of sections on many structures eg on bridges over rivers The extentwill depend upon the actual conditions and size of the structure The solution is usually based on the selection of suitablecoatings to resist the conditions Anti-condensation coatings are widely employed in highly humid conditions such as thoseexperienced in parts of breweries
108GEOMETRY AND SHAPE
The geometry and shape of structural elements influences corrosion in a number of ways Smooth simple surfaces are theeasiest to clean and paint and so are most likely to provide the best resistance to corrosion Most design problems arisebasically from the protrusions changes of plane sharp angles and edges and general lack of clean lines which are inevitable with
Fig 105 Cracking of mastic
Fig 106 Corrosion at ground level
154 DESIGNING FOR CORROSION CONTROL
the fabrication and erection requirements of complex structures Although such lack of homogeneity cannot be completelyavoided steps can be taken to reduce its overall influence to a minimum For example it is easier to coat tubular rather thanangular sections Clearly for a variety of reasons round sections cannot always be used Nevertheless where there is a directchoice based on technical and economic factors tubular members will generally prove to be easier to protect from corrosionThis arises from their lack of edges and overall smoothness of lines Additionally coatings such as tapes can be used withmuch greater ease on such members
Edges are always difficult to protect (see Fig 1010) and improved coating thickness will be achieved if they are contouredto a smoother shape Although additional stripe coatings can be applied at edges they are by their nature features that caneasily be damaged
Generally large flat areas are much easier to protect than a range of sections of different shapes with random orientationsof plane As fabrication and design have developed structures have tended to provide cleaner lines It is interesting tocompare the two bridges across the Forth in Scotland The rail bridge requires almost constant painting with its complexlattice girders whereas the more modern road bridge is much easier to maintain Provided they are cleaned flush with themain surface welds generally provide cleaner lines than bolts or rivets Complex structural geometry provides problems for
Fig 107 Design of column base
Fig 108 Concrete plinth to protect steel at ground level
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 155
satisfactory coating and any improvements that can be made by the designer will improve the durability of protection and easeof maintenance
109TANKS
Many of the features already discussed can be conveniently illustrated by examining possible approaches to the design ofwater tanks Although they have been simplified the two sketches of tanks in Fig 1011 demonstrate some of thefundamental points to be covered
(i) Access for protection of the underside(ii) Drainage at the lowest point
(iii) Welded structure for smoothness(iv) Circular construction for ease of maintenance
It would be unreasonable to ignore the additional fabrication costs that might be involved in the lsquoimprovedrsquo design but fromthe standpoint of corrosion protection it is undoubtedly superior
1010FABRICATION AND CONSTRUCTION
During fabrication additional items may be welded on to the main elements such as brackets and hooks to assist with thehandling and erection of the steelwork These can be advantageous from the protection standpoint because they can assist inthe avoidance of damage to the coating
Fig 109 Various solutions to the problem of water entrapment
Fig 1010 Contouring of sharp edges
Fig 1011 Design of tanks
156 DESIGNING FOR CORROSION CONTROL
Generally their presence on the steel sections do not cause any problems so they may be left in place and painted This maybe satisfactory if the welds are properly cleaned (see below) before painting Sometimes they are flame-cut to remove them orif small mechanically removed If these broken surfaces are not ground to a resonable finish coatings applied to them arelikely to fail prematurely
Welds Weld spatter is the term given to the small globules produced during welding which stick to the steel in the vicinityof the weld These provide points for pinpoint rusting of coatings applied over them and should be removed
Flux residues remaining from welding may be alkaline and so will affect coatings These residues should be removed Discontinuous or lsquoskiprsquo welds are frequently used for situations where continuous welding is not considered necessary
Although satisfactory from an engineering point of view they are difficult to coat satisfactorily particularly when used for lapjoints they should be avoided
Butt joints are easier to protect than lap joints which present a crevice situation on one side which will inevitably promotecoating breakdown
Generally welds are easier to coat than nuts and bolts However unless they are prepared properly before paintingundercutting flux and spatter can all cause problems
Nuts and bolts With so many sharp edges and the ease with which paint coatings applied to them can be damaged nuts andbolts can be a problem Often the thickness of paint applied is less than on the main structural elements It is not uncommonto see fasteners rusting and causing rust streaks on an otherwise well-protected structure Furthermore the presence of a jointwhen steel is bolted adds to the difficulties of providing sound protection because it may act as a crevice
1011CORROSION OF STEEL IN CONTACT WITH OTHER MATERIALS
Where steel-framed buildings are clad with masonry and similar materials these materials can crack if they are in directcontact with steel which corrodes Unlike heavy steel sections which are able to resist the pressure of the rust brittle materialscannot do so and consequently are physically damaged It may therefore be advisable to paint the steel if there is anylikelihood of moisture reaching the surface through inadequate joints leaking roofs etc It may be preferable to design thebuilding so that there is no direct contact between the steel and other materials used in the construction
Some porous materials can promote corrosion of steel if they are in direct contact with it eg wood particularly if it becomesdamp Again it is advisable to paint both contacting surfaces
FURTHER READING
British Standards Institution (1969) Recommendations for the Design of Metal Articles that are to be Coated BS 4479 British Standards Institution (1986) Method for the Determination of Bimetalic Corrosion in Outdoor Corrosion Tests BS 6682British Standards Institution (1984) Commentary on Corrosion at Bimetalic Contacts and its Alleviations PD 64841979 (Confirmed
1984)Chandler KA amp Stanners JF Design in High Strength Structural Steels Iron and Steel Institute Publication No 122 London 1969
pp 127ndash33Chandler KA Design on steel structures for the prevention of corrosion Br Corros J Supplementary Issue 10 (1968) 42ndash7Shrier LL (Ed) Corrosion Vol 2 Newnes and Butterworths London 1976 Section 103
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 157
CHAPTER 11Maintenance Painting
111INTRODUCTION
Maintenance of protective systems on structures is an essential part of the overall strategy of protection (see Fig 111)Maintenance costs enormous sums of money throughout the world yet in many cases scant attention is paid to the overallproblems of re-painting Often an almost fatalistic attitude is adopted yet with the correct approach considerable economiesare possible There are examples of structures where 30 coats of paint have been applied over the years this can be checkedby microscopic examination of detached paint flakes (see Fig 112) Such areas generally have not corroded but on the samestructure other parts have rusted quite badly because virtually no paint is present on the steel It is possible that at the next re-painting a thirty-first or thirty-second coat will be applied to the sound areas and they will continue to protect the steel whilethe corroded parts will after wire-brushing and application of a three-coat system be rusting again within a year or so
The situation may be slightly more serious because the amount of corrosion may have reached a stage where the structuralstability has been affected and welding of additional steel may be required Although thick coatings generally will protect thesteel internal tension arising from the number of coats applied over the years may lead to cracking and flaking there istherefore a limit to the number of coats that can be applied and eventually the whole coating may have to be removed
The above scenario does occur but it would be unfair to maintenance engineers to suggest that it is typical of all structuresand plants Nevertheless unless certain clearly defined steps are taken it is often difficult to avoid this situation particularlywhen the re-paint is being carried out largely for cosmetic reasons and the overall appearance is considered to be moreimportant than the protection of the steel from corrosion There are two main reasons for carrying out maintenance re-painting
(i) Preservation of the structurersquos integrity so that it can perform its function satisfactorily over its design life without theneed for structural repairs
(ii) To preserve its appearance this may be a legal requirement in certain situations but generally it is more concerned withmaintenance of a satisfactory overall environment and is of course taken to be a measure of efficiency and goodhousekeeping
Clearly (i) is the more important but (ii) cannot be discounted particularly where buildings and structures are visible to thepublic and shoddy appearance has a serious effect on the environment
It might be assumed that in the process of maintaining the appearance the structural integrity would automatically becovered However this is not necessarily so because appearance is a matter of visual approval often at some distance from
Fig 111 Maintenance painting of Ironbridge the first iron bridge in the world
the structure and important structural elements may not be apparent to the viewer Therefore even where constructions areregularly painted for aesthetic reasons it is still necessary to take account of lsquohiddenrsquo steelwork Some paint types forexample bitumen often have sufficient elasticity to accommodate the expansion of corrosion products on the steel surfacewithout obvious disruption of the paint film
Conversely the structural preservation may be achieved without necessarily providing an overall attractive appearance tothe structure itself A considerable amount of corrosion can occur on some parts of steelwork without affecting the integritywhereas on other parts attack by corrosion may be critical It follows therefore that a proper plan must be formulated basedon the requirements If appearance is unimportant and the critical areas are properly protected from corrosion then verylimited re-painting may be required particularly on structures with a short life expectation However this approach must arisefrom a decision made on the requirements not as a result of indecision regarding the overall attitude to maintenanceFurthermore an element of monitoring should be incorporated to ensure that corrosion is maintained within acceptable limits
In some situations painting can be avoided altogether by adding suitable corrosion allowances In fact this may be essentialif the design involves spaces where access for re-painting is impossible
Having decided the reasons for regular re-painting and the requirements involved there should be a clearly formulated planof action to ensure satisfactory and economic maintenance procedures Undoubtedly this is best carried out at the initialdesign stage but revision of the plan may be necessary during the lifetime of the structure because of changes in the use andpurpose of the structure alterations in the environment and developments of new materials and techniques for coatingsteelwork
112THE GENERAL APPROACH TO MAINTENANCE PAINTING
It must be said at the outset that the efficiency of maintenance treatments will be directly related to and affected by the initialprotective system and the standard of maintenance treatments over a period of years It is much easier to plan maintenance ona new structure that has been adequately protected to meet the service conditions On older structures the level and cost ofmaintenance will be determined by the history of painting over its lifetime If there has been a long record of neglect or if theoriginal protective systems and surface preparation of the steelwork were inadequate for the service conditions no amount oftouching up will solve the technical and economic problems posed
In such situations only the complete cleaning of all corroded steelwork and the virtual re-painting of the structure will providea long-term economic solution Unfortunately in many situations it will not be possible to blast-clean the steelwork so otherless effective cleaning methods will have to be used This will result in shorter periods between re-painting and an increase inthe overall costs of maintaining the structure This is particularly disadvantageous for structures with long design livesTypically highway bridges may be designed to last for over 100 years and a proper approach to maintenance is essential ifcosts are to be controlled On other structures designed for say 25 years the problem is less acute and while the appearance maybe poor the structural integrity may be unaffected It is therefore important at the outset to determine the reasons for re-painting and to formulate a clear strategy for the maintenance of structures The ad hoc approach often adopted is unsatisfactoryboth from the technical and economic standpoints
It is worth making a point regarding maintenance budgets because in times of financial stringency they are the ones mostlikely to be cut and are always subject to reductions to an unrealistic level for the work required To some extent attitudes arechanging because the importance of asset preservation is better appreciated nowadays In situations where immediate savingsare required it may be quite reasonable to reduce maintenance budgets including those for re-painting However theremaining part of the budget should be spent on the critical parts of the structure to ensure maximum benefit from the
Fig 112 Cross-section showing number of paint coats applied over the lifetime of the structure
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 159
expenditure and this is not usually done In fact it can only be done if maintenance is properly planned so that individualareas can be assessed
113PLANNING MAINTENANCE
Planning is always necessary particularly in difficult situations such as on offshore structures where re-painting must becarried out over a limited period However planning is being considered here in the sense of a long-term commitment tomaintenance This will involve decisions regarding the acceptable criteria of breakdown of paint coatings before re-painting iscarried out
There is a divergence of opinion concerning the most suitable time for repainting Some authorities consider fixed timeperiods eg every 5 years to be the most economic approach whereas others consider that a certain level of failure shouldoccur and this is determined by regular inspections There is not however general agreement on the most suitable criterion ofbreakdown this varies from about 05ndash5 rusting of the steelwork with some organisations preferring to re-paint before anynoticeable rusting occurs
Although ideally re-painting should be carried out before any breakdown occurs this is not necessarily the most economicapproach particularly if the whole structure is to be painted The essential requirement is to avoid expensive steel preparationoperations this is achieved by ensuring that re-painting is carried out before this situation arises The breakdown of paint andsubsequent rusting of steel does not follow a linear course in the early stages and a delay of 1 year can lead to an increase inrusting from 05 to 2 a further yearrsquos delay could lead to 5 As the area to be treated will be greater than this the delayof a year might result in a difference of say 2ndash10 in the area to be cleaned and painted this of course could lead to asignificant increase in costs This is illustrated in Figs 113 and 114 based on work carried out by the British Iron and SteelResearch Association1 In these investigations the course of paint breakdown was followed and a grade was allocated atperiodic intervals Grade 4 representing about 01 surface rusting was taken as the criterion of failure
As can be seen in Fig 113 there is an optimum re-painting period Figure 114 demonstrates the rapid increase inbreakdown after 6 years exposure However as noted earlier it is not always practicable to carry out blast-cleaning in whichcase other less effective methods will have to be used leading to shorter periods between re-painting particularly if there is agood deal of rusting
Although improved hand-cleaning methods including use of special discs are available as alternatives to blast-cleaningthey are comparatively expensive in the time required for use and are unlikely to provide cleaning to the same standard Theabove discussion has been concerned with conventional paint coating systems of up to about 200 micro m total thickness Thickercoatings possibly over 1 mm in thickness do not generally fail in the same way Often the adhesion between the coating andsteel weakens leading to flaking over comparatively large areas rather than the local spread of rust The criterion formaintenance with such coatings may be different and will be determined by factors other than the amount of rust formed onthe steel surface
Irrespective of the particular criterion chosen it is clearly necessary to inspect structures so that maintenance can beproperly planned and this will be considered below
Fig 113 Optimum repainting period for paint coating (Reproduced by courtesy of the Institute of Metals London)
160 MAINTENANCE PAINTING
114INSPECTIONS AND SURVEYS FOR MAINTENANCE
Some form of inspection is carried out on all structures but from the standpoint of corrosion and coatings it is often of asomewhat cursory nature frequently being carried out from a point some distance from the steelwork to be examined Insome cases this is the only practicable way of inspecting a structure because of problems of access In these situations theuse of binoculars and viewing from different positions may provide useful information However wherever possible closecontact inspection is necessary to determine the extent and requirements for maintenance Undoubtedly proper surveys arethe most satisfactory way of assessing the situation Obviously there is a cost factor involved in carrying out such surveysparticularly for access to allow close examination of the coating Consequently this level of examination may be limited tocertain parts of the structure to reduce costs to a reasonable level The experience and competence of the surveyor will clearlybe important in providing an overall view of the maintenance requirements on parts that have not been physically examinedThe purpose of a survey can be summarised as follows
(i) To assess the extent of coating breakdown and rusting over the structure as a whole(ii) Based on assessment (i) to determine the critical areas for maintenance and the overall methods to be used for the
surface preparations and re-coating(iii) To provide a basis for the preparation of a sound specification for the re-coating work(iv) In conjunction with (iii) to obtain tender prices for the maintenance work
The survey should cover both the deterioration of coatings and actual corrosion of the steel In some situations corrosion canbe measured by simple direct methods using calipers and gauges Sometimes other methods such as ultrasonics may berequired It is of course usually necessary to remove rust before making such measurements although ultrasonic probes areavailable with which such removal is not necessary
Often the amount of corrosion cannot be determined because the original thickness of the members is not known In suchcases it is still possible to measure the thickness of steel remaining which is the essential requirement for determiningwhether it is structurally stable The survey also provides opportunities to determine whether specific features of the designare promoting corrosion of the steel or breakdown of the coatings eg water traps or crevices recommendations for remedialaction can be made to alleviate such problems
1141Survey Procedures
The procedures will be determined to some extent by the nature and siting of the structure Where access is comparativelyeasy a full survey can be carried out without too much difficulty However where the structure is in continuous use eg ahighway bridge then both the costs and difficulties of a full survey may be such that only a limited survey can be carried outIts effectiveness will depend very much on the expertise of the surveyor Such surveys require careful planning to ensure that
Fig 114 Rate of breakdown of paint coating with time (Reproduced by courtesy of the Institute of Metals London)
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 161
a reasonable overall assessment is made because the most inaccessible parts may be those that will require most attentionduring maintenance
The engineer responsible for the structure should discuss the work with the surveyor to ensure that a cost-effective plan isproduced The main options open to the engineer are
(i) A full survey of the whole structure This will not always be practicable and will be the most time-consuming andexpensive option Where the deterioration of the protective coating it not uniform it may be the required option if long-termprotection is to be achieved The type of structure will be a determining factor as will the overall history of coatingmaintenance Only close examination will determine the exact nature of a surface defect Often what appears to be a soundcoating when viewed from a distance proves to be in the early stages of failure eg there may be a lack of local adhesion thatcan spread to large areas over a period of time
(ii) A limited survey is more common particularly where access is difficult Such surveys should be carefully planned toensure that representative areas are examined to provide a reasonable assessment of the whole Certain areas are always moreprone to coating breakdown and corrosion than others and where practicable these should be included
11411Planning the Survey
The engineer must decide the extent of the survey and the requirements for inspection The survey should be carried out asnear to the time of maintenance painting as is practicable It should not be carried out more than a year beforehand sinceadditional breakdown may have occurred in that time so the survey may then not provide an accurate assessment of therequirements In the case of limited surveys the actual areas to be examined must be defined and the requirements specifiedThe type of access for each area must be decided with agreement on the testing to be carried out in situ and the recordingrequired Additionally any laboratory testing should be specified
The areas must be designated in some suitable way with numbered location and with sketches where required Althougheach structure requires separate treatment the overall approach is well illustrated by considering a bridge
Planning a bridge survey The Department of Transport (UK) has its own specifications and standards for highway bridgesand these include survey requirements which must be followed However in the case of other bridges and similar structureswhich do not necessarily follow the Departmentrsquos procedures variations may occur
The engineer should supply drawings of the structure so that the areas to be surveyed can be suitably markedAlternatively the surveyor may prepare simple sketches for this purpose
Bridges can be divided into well-defined areas
(i) Main span(s)(ii) Span supports eg piers and abutments
(iii) Superstructures eg parapets towers (on suspension bridges) cables etc(iv) Special areas eg bearings and joints
SAMPLE AREASMain span On mainspans for a limited survey sample areas of reasonable size should be selected at right angles to the
main beams so that all beams are included The widths of band may vary but should not be less than 05 m For each beamthis would provide a number of different areas for examination Other transverse elements such as stiffeners would also beincluded For a box girder there would be only one sample areas on each side and on the soffit making a total of three Theinsides of box girders should be treated in the same way and should include elements such as stiffeners and diaphragmsWelded and bolted areas should be included in sample areas
The number of sample areas will be determined by the size and nature of the bridgeSpan supports Sample areas can be chosen at intervals at right angles to the main direction of the support as horizontal
bands round the supportSuperstructure Parapets can be sampled in a manner similar to that for the main span Other features such as cables require
individual decisions for adequate samplingSpecial areas The selection of special areas will depend on the bridge design but would include bearings expansion joints
and special features that had not been included in the other sample areas
162 MAINTENANCE PAINTING
11412Inspection and Testing
The type of inspection and requirement for testing should be agreed for each sample area The types of observation and tests areconsidered below
(i) Observations(a) Type and amount of coating breakdown by visual assessment This must be carried out to provide the maximum amount
of information both for the maintenance requirements and as an indication of the performance of the coating There are anumber of published methods that can be used but the essential requirement is for all those concerned with the maintenanceprocedures to be clear what the observations mean Vague comments such as lsquosome blistering and slight rustrsquo can beambiguous The recording methods can be based on the following
BS 3900 Part H1 Designation of intensity quantity and size of common types of defects H2 covers blistering H3rusting H4 cracking and H5 flaking The ISO equivalents are given in the appendix to Chapter 16
ASTM standards D610plusmn68 covering the evaluation of the degree of rusting on painted steel surfaces
D659ndash74 for chalkingD660ndash44 for checkingD661ndash44 for crackingD662ndash44 for erosionD714ndash56 for blisteringD772ndash47 for flaking
These standards contain photographs or diagrams with numbered ratings which can be used to provide a fairly rapid andaccurate assessment of a painted surface However useful though these methods are it is often advantageous to include adescription and photograph particularly where the appearance does not closely relate to the standard photograph If deeppitting is evident the depth should be estimated and included in the observations A more accurate indication is provided if a pitgauge is used
(b) An indication of obvious surface contamination should be provided(c) Areas showing abnormal or severe breakdown should be reported as these may require special attention during
maintenance(d) Where breakdown is associated with specifie design features or occurrences such as dripping of water onto an area this
should be reported(e) Where appropriate the surveyor should use a suitable magnifier preferably illuminated (ouml10 to ouml20 magnification) to
obtain further information eg on checking and surface contamination(ii) Non-destructive testing The thickness of the coating can be measured with suitable dry film thickness gauges These
are described in Chapter 9 with an indication of methods of calibrating and usage
Fig 115 Adhesion testing on a large structure
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 163
(iii) Destructive tests Adhesion can only be tested by destructive methods Various test methods are available The methodin which a lsquodollyrsquo is stuck onto the painted surface and then pulled off using a calibrated pull-off adhesion tester provides aquantitive reading (see Fig 115) However it is difficult to use during a survey and is slow and relatively expensiveGenerally it is not recommended for survey work
BS 3900 Part E6 the cross-cut test is a straightforward test for panels in the laboratory but is difficult to carry out correctlyon site
ASTM D3359ndash83 Method A is simple and capable of providing the required information (see Figs 116 and 117) It iscarried out using a sharp blade eg a lsquoStanleyrsquo knife and cutting through the coating to the metallic substrate preferably withone stroke The cut approximately 50 mm long is then repeated across the original cut at an angle of approximately 30Eacute toform a St Andrewrsquos Cross Adhesive tape is then applied over the centre of the cross and pulled sharply from the surface Themaximum length of detachment of paint from the position of the crossed cuts is reported The greater the length the poorerthe adhesion
Further tests using the end of the knife to detach more of the coating will in experienced hands reveal additionalinformation that will indicate whether the paint can be mechanically cleaned or locally blast-cleaned or must be removed overa large area The surveyor should report the results of these tests and where appropriate indicate the state of the surface fromwhich the paint has been detached eg whether clean rusted steel or primed steel
(iv) Paint flakes Paint flakes when examined microscopically can provide useful information such as thickness ofindividual coats in a system Special thickness measurement instruments that use an inclined or V-cut can be used but it is notalways easy to determine individual coatings
Paint flakes should be stored in individual bags with proper identification(v) Site analytical tests Tests for surface contamination are detailed in Section 9513(vi) Solvent swab test The surface of the paint is rubbed with a cotton wool swab wetted with xylol If the top surface
dissolves readily it indicates that the paint is of the non-convertible type such as chlorinated or acrylated rubber Thisinformation will influence the choice of coating for re-painting
(vii) Laboratory tests Certain tests may require to be carried out in well-equipped analytical laboratories The test sampleswill be collected by the surveyor identified and then sent to a suitable laboratory for analysis Other tests are morestraightforward and may be carried out by the surveyor with comparatively simple equipment An experienced surveyorshould be able to examine detached paint flakes provided he has access to a binocular microscope with a magnification of ouml30to ouml45
High magnifications do not have sufficient depth of focus for the roughness of a paint flake to be examined Paint flakes aregenerally not mounted and polished like metallurgical specimens because the polishing process tends to destroy the surface ofthe paint Examination of cross-sections of paint flakes gives useful information on individual coating thicknesses andadhesion between coats Also the underside of the flakes can be examined for contamination
Fig 116 X-cut test satisfactory
164 MAINTENANCE PAINTING
Ideally the microscope should have a camera attachment so that monocular photographs can be taken Since theenlargement of the magnification of the final prints will be different from the microscope enlargement this should bedetermined so that direct measurements can be made from the photographic prints
The presence or absence of lead pigments may govern the choice of surface preparation method Other environmentalfactors eg vicinity to a river or public place may also require the analysis for other toxic substances such as cadmium andchromium
In the laboratory a range of techniques can be used for the comprehensive analysis of paint (see Section 166) The routinedetermination of water swab samples will include chlorides sulphates pH and total dissolved solids The engineer shouldspecify whether analysis is required for other suspected contaminants
11413Access for Surveys
Arrangements for access must be made in advance of the survey Failure to do this may lead to expensive delays Scaffoldingis rarely justified except possibly at some areas of special interest Ladders are the cheapest form of access and may besuitable for the examination of limited areas However they are not really suitable for the type of examination required insurveys and moving them can also be time consuming particularly where they have to be lashed to members for safetyreasons Access should be by mobile lifting platforms or hydraulic hoists for most parts of a structure but other methods maybe required for areas that present difficulties of access The surveyor has to carry out a number of tests so satisfactory accessis important
11414Health and Safety during Survey
All the necessary requirements must be made known to the surveyor beforehand Particular attention should be paid tosurveys carried out internally in enclosed spaces An additional person must be available to assist should an accident occur
Fig 117 X-cut test failure
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 165
11415Recording of Survey
It is convenient to record on printed sheets which cover the main items to be included in the report These would include
mdash Identity of sample areamdash Film thickness measurementsmdash Breakdown of coating (type and quantity)mdash Swab testsmdash Adhesionmdash Paint flakes and other samples takenmdash Photograph identification (when taken)mdash Comments on contamination of surface exposed substrates and any areas requiring special attentionmdash Weather and date of survey
If sketches assist then they should be includedPhotographs will often be of assistance to engineers particularly where the breakdown is of an unusual nature or where the
state of the area is difficult to describe Where reports are to be photocopied additional colour prints should be prepared to beincluded in all reports
Administrative details will also be included to cover the location and type of structure name of surveyor analyticallaboratories etc
11416Recommendations
On the basis of the survey recommendations can be made on surface preparation and re-painting of the structure On a largestructure the recommendations will vary depending on the state of the coating at different parts Additionally any otherrecommendations that will be of value to the engineer should be included eg design features that have promoted corrosion
11417Comments on Surveys
Surveys can be quite expensive and are carried out primarily to determine coating maintenance procedures However ifcarried out regularly surveys provide a lsquolog bookrsquo of coating performance This will be useful for determining suitablecoatings for other structures and will indicate likely problem areas so that subsequent surveys may be more limited in scope withan overall saving in cost On parts of the structure where the breakdown is such that complete removal of the coating is to berecommended only limited detail of the paint breakdown is required The general methods of a survey should be used even ifthe overall examination is carried out on a limited scale
1142Feasibility Trials
The Department of Transport (UK) advises a feasibility trial after its bridges have been surveyed before a specification formaintenance painting is prepared This is a sound approach because it is often difficult to determine both the extent of thesurface preparation requirements and the difficulties in achieving them Furthermore this type of trial provides an opportunityto check compatibility of coating systems It also ensures that contractors who tender for the work will be aware of anydifficulties involved in the maintenance painting and will therefore be able to provide tenders that meet the requirements ofthe client with a minimum of disagreement Although such trials add to the overall cost they may prove to be economic onsurveys of structures other than bridges
115MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
The two main aspects to be dealt with are (i) surface preparation and (ii) repainting The survey prior to maintenance shouldprovide sufficient information to determine the type and level of surface preparation and painting required Even the most
166 MAINTENANCE PAINTING
limited survey is advisable to ensure that a reasonable specification can be produced Without this maintenance repaintingmay prove to be a difficult and often unsuccessful operation
1151Surface Preparation Prior to Re-Painting
As already noted maintenance of paint coatings is most economically achieved by re-painting before there is any seriousdeterioration of the coating or rusting of the steel substrate In such a situation the procedures are fairly straightforward onconventional coatings used for land-based structures On more specialised structures eg offshore structures and dock gatesspecial procedures may be required and these will often be specific to the particular situation although the same approachwill usually be adopted
(i) Where coatings are firmly adherent with no signs of incipient breakdown such as blistering they should not be removedas they will provide a sound basis for the maintenance coats Generally further coats can be applied without difficulty afterthe surface has been thoroughly washed to remove contaminants However some coatings eg two-pack epoxies harden toan extent where some abrasion of the coating is required before re-painting to ensure good adhesion Even oleo-resinouspaints may require some abrading to remove gloss On small areas power-operated discs may be satisfactory to provide theabraded surface but on larger areas light blast-cleaning will usually be more economic
(ii) Where there is some minor deterioration of the paint coating but no rusting of the steel substrate then all loose paintshould be removed by the methods noted above ie by power-operated tools or blast-cleaning The choice will be determinedby environmental and economic factors The surface must be washed before further coatings are applied
(iii) If the deterioration has reached a stage where the coating is failing and the steel is rusting the procedures will bedetermined by the extent of the breakdown The only really effective way of cleaning steelwork where there is a considerablearea of rusting is by blast-cleaning but this is not always practicable It may not be possible for environmental reasons to useopen blast-cleaning and vacuum methods ie with recovery of the abrasive may be uneconomic particularly from the pointof view of time required for cleaning In such situations power tools may be the only acceptable method although sometimesflame-cleaning may be appropriate This will depend upon the actual structure and limitations regarding the use of suchequipment Flame-cleaning is not an economic method for large areas although it may be useful for certain limited parts of astructure It must be used with care by skilled operators (see Section 325) This method removes or damages the coating onthe reverse side of areas being cleaned and is not effective in removing all the rust from steel However this is the situationwith all methods other than blast-cleaning except in the case of very small areas which can be ground to remove all rust
It follows that if there is a considerable area of rusting to be dealt with and blast-cleaning is not practicable then themaintenance coatings applied to such surfaces will tend to provide comparatively short lives
The coating breakdown may well be quite severe at welds and a decision must be made regarding the cause of thisbreakdown It may be necessary to grind weld areas to avoid a repetition of such failures after re-painting
The requirements for surface preparation prior to re-painting can be summarised as follows Suitable action must be takento provide a firm base for future coats of paint The effectiveness of this operation will to a large extent determine the life ofthe coatings applied during maintenance If rust and poorly adherent paint are the surfaces to which new paint is applied thenpoor performance will be inevitable Further requirements concerning paint compatibility are discussed below
(iv) The above comments have been concerned with paint films but metal coatings also eventually require maintenance andthis is usually achieved with paint coatings Hot-dip galvanised coatings may be used bare ie not painted and over a periodof time the zinc will corrode away usually not evenly over the whole surface leaving a mixture of zinc alloy layer and rustUndoubtedly it is preferable to paint galvanised surfaces before any significant rusting of the steel substrate occurs At thisstage it is comparatively easy to remove loose zinc corrosion products by manual cleaning methods and then to apply a paintsystem
If the galvanised steel has been painted and no rusting is occurring the treatment will be similar to that for paint coatingsapplied directly to steel There is usually no requirement to remove areas of sound galvanised surface even if the paint hasflaked or weathered away All loose paint should of course be removed In situations where a great deal of rusting of the steelhas occurred blast-cleaning is probably the only satisfactory way of treating the surface prior to re-painting Sherardisedcoatings should be treated in a similar way to those that have been hot-dip galvanised For small areas of breakdown power-operated abrasive wheels can be used but this is uneconomic for large areas Sprayed metal coatings present a more difficultproblem particularly if they have been painted a procedure rarely adopted nowadays for zinc
Some authorities consider that once the underlying sprayed zinc coating has corroded under the paint film then the onlycourse of action is to blast-clean the surface with sharp abrasives to remove the whole of the coating system ie paint andzinc Others consider the light blast-cleaning to remove the paint and surface zinc corrosion products is a satisfactoryprocedure provided dry-blast methods are used Wet-blasting of zinc sprayed coatings is not recommended except where theyare to be completely removed This is because of the difficulties of ensuring that the remaining zinc coating is completely dry
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 167
before re-painting Again where previously non-painted zinc sprayed coatings are to be painted it is preferable to removezinc corrosion products by dry brushing methods Although painting of zinc sprayed coating is not considered good practiceby many authorities it may be necessary to apply paint over badly corroded zinc coatings if the removal of the remaining zinccoating by blasting is impractical In such situations power-operated tools can be used to remove zinc and corrosion productsbut a layer of the sprayed coating will remain on the steel surface provided rusting has not occurred
Sprayed aluminium coatings are generally less of a problem than those of sprayed zinc but in situations where they havevirtually corroded away they require to be removed by blast-cleaning Other methods such as the use of power tools areunlikely to be effective in removing the whole coating although they can be used for removing surface corrosion products
1152Painting
The effectiveness of maintenance painting will be determined by the substrate to which the paint is applied the compatibilityof the material used in relation to the coating on the structure and the overall thickness of the final coating The importance ofpreparing the surface properly both the steel and retained coatings has been discussed above Although the necessity toprovide a sound base for maintenance coatings is obvious it is sometimes difficult to achieve under practical conditions andin such situations it is unlikely that the coatings will provide long-term protection If they are applied to steel that is rusty orif chloride and sulphate salts remain after blast-cleaning then further corrosion under the paint film is probable withblistering cracking and eventual flaking Again if the retained paint coating has poor adhesion to the steel than it may wellflake off carrying the maintenance coating applied to it
Compatibility between the coatings on the structure and those applied during maintenance is essential For examplealthough chlorinated-rubber paints can be applied to epoxies the reverse situation may lead to problems because the strongsolvent in the epoxy will soften the chlorinated-rubber binder As noted earlier where paints have hardened during service itmay be necessary to abrade them to provide a key for the maintenance coatings
The choice of coatings will depend upon a number of factors On general land-based structures it is usually advantageous toapply the same types of paint provided they have given sound protection However there is often a requirement to up-gradethe overall protective system using more durable coatings In such cases checks for compatibility are essential and this shouldpreferably be carried out on the structure Generally a number of different types of area have to be dealt with as follows
(i) Intact paint coating of acceptable thickness usually apart from washing down with clean water no further action isrequired
(ii) Reasonably intact coating but with slight blistering or flaking after removal of all the loose paint coating the surface iswashed to remove contamination and undercoat(s) and finishing coats are applied to provide the required thickness
(iii) Areas where there has been rusting of the steel or where the coating has been removed prior to re-painting a fullprotective system including where appropriate an inhibitive primer should be applied to the appropriate thickness
Careful application to ensure a smooth final coating is necessary and the finishing coating is generally applied over the wholestructure after the various areas have been patch painted Metal coatings are treated in the same general way but it is a moredifficult operation particularly where there is a variation in the state of the metal coating on different parts of the structureand it may be useful to obtain specialist advice
116ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS DURING REPAINTING
Unlike the initial protection of steelwork which can be carried out in a shop with reasonably controlled conditions the onlyenvironmental control usually possible when carrying out maintenance painting is the choice of an appropriate time of the yearfor the work On some structures it is possible to use covers to protect the steelwork during painting operations and in specifiesituations this is worth considering Generally though for a variety of reasons this approach is not usually followedConsequently the choice of suitable times for repainting may be limited particularly in areas such as Northern Europe wherethe spring and summer months are the only ones that are really suitable In other areas of the world periods of intense rain orhigh humidity should be avoided where practicable
To avoid condensation of moisture on the steelwork during painting the steel temperature should not be less than about 3EacuteCabove the dew point This has been discussed in more detail in Section 523 for initial paint applications but conditions inEuropean winters are unlikely to meet these requirements during a large part of the day Rainfall snow and ice also affect thesurface and such conditions should be avoided In the UK if for some reason re-painting has to be carried out under adverse
168 MAINTENANCE PAINTING
environmental conditions then the use of temporary shelters should be considered and if necessary indirect heating anddehumidification equipment should be used In such cases good ventilation is essential
Apart from the weather other environmental problems may have to be faced eg limitations on noise and dust and closeproximity of other buildings and equipment that may be damaged particularly by blast-cleaning operations These add to theproblems of maintenance and require careful planning and organisation beforehand if they are to be overcome They also addemphasis to the advantages of carrying out maintenance so that blast-cleaning can be avoided ie before any serious rusting ofthe steel or breakdown of coatings manifest themselves
Maintenance painting offshore is often far more difficult than on land-based structures Some of the reasons arise from theweather situation and others from the nature of offshore operations Some of the points that have to be taken into account are
(i) The short period during which painting can be carried out usually for less than 6 months in the North Sea the period isoften termed the lsquoweather windowrsquo
(ii) The aggressive environment with salt in the air and splashing of steelwork with seawater(iii) The limited accommodation space available for the operatives(iv) The lack of spare space for cleaning and painting equipment on the comparatively small platform(v) Overall problems of access and the expense of transporting access equipment to the platform
(vi) Lack of fresh water for cleaning purposes(vii) Limitation on the time operatives are expected to work offshore with frequent changes of personnel
Although these and other problems make the task of maintenance painting difficult the same basic procedures as those forland-based structures are used but the planning organisation and control of the work must be at the highest levelFurthermore it must be accepted that sometimes it will be impossible to provide coatings of the required standard A usefulpublication has been produced on offshore maintenance painting that provides recommendations based on practicalexperience of this type of work The state of the art of offshore maintenance painting (North Sea British Section) of existingsystems on fixed offshore structuresrsquo 1984 Corrosion Control Engineering Joint Venture PO Box 253 Leighton BuzzardBedfordshire UK
REFERENCE
1 Iron and Steel Institute Sixth Report of the Corrosion Committee Special Report No 66 London 1959
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 169
CHAPTER 12Control Methods other than Coatings
Although most structural steelwork is protected from corrosion by coatings other control methods are also adopted in particularcathodic protection which is considered below Methods such as inhibition water treatment and air conditioning are used inspecial circumstances and reference is also made to these in this chapter The other system of controlling corrosion withoutthe use of coatings is to employ low-alloy weathering steels these steels are also discussed in this chapter
121CATHODIC PROTECTION
Cathodic protection has only a limited application as a method for preventing the corrosion of steelwork but it is used formany important structures particularly offshore and so is an important method of corrosion control The concept of cathodicprotection is straightforward but in practice specialist advice should be sought to obtain economic protection In this chapteronly the broad principles will be considered but a number of useful publications are listed at the end of the chapter for thosewishing to pursue the matter further
An essential point concerning cathodic protection is that it can be used only where steel is immersed in water or buried insoil of suitable conductivity It is not a method that can be suitably employed with steel exposed in the atmosphere Althoughattempts have been made to develop coatings with suitable conductivity so that cathodic protection could be used in theatmosphere these have not proved to be of practical value for steelwork The method has been used to protect steelreinforcement in concrete but the conditions are different from those for structural steelwork Certain metal coatingsparticularly zinc do provide a form of cathodic protection to steel but this is not the primary reason for using them
1211Basic Principles
The basic principles of corrosion are considered in Chapter 2 and the main points can be summarised as follows
(i) Corrosion at ambient temperatures is electrochemical(ii) The process can be sub-divided into two reactions one at the anode and the other at the cathode
(iii) For such reactions to occur there must be a suitable electrolyte present
For steel (or strictly iron) the two reactions can be depicted as follows
at the anodeat the cathode
As can be seen there is an electrical balance because all the electrons released in the anodic reaction are consumed in thecathodic reaction If electrons are supplied to the iron from an external source such as by impressing a current then the anodicreactions will be suppressed and the potential of the iron will be lowered If it is lowered sufficiently then no current will flowbetween the anodes and cathodes on the iron surface so corrosion will cease This is the basis for cathodic protection andprovided sufficient current is supplied corrosion will be prevented If insufficient current is applied there will be partialprotection and the corrosion rate will be reduced below what would be anticipated in the absence of cathodic protection
1212The Application of Cathodic Protection
To achieve cathodic protection it is necessary to supply an external current so that no local currents flow on the steel surfaceie to supply electrons to the steel In order to achieve this it is necessary to set up a cell with an auxiliary anode the steelbeing the cathode Additionally an electrolyte is necessary to ensure that the electrochemical cell can operate There are twoways of achieving these requirements in environments such as water or soil where there is sufficient conductivity to allowproper operation of the cell
(i) By application of a current from an external source using an inert anode ie impressing the current This is called theimpressed current method
(ii) By using an active anode of more negative potential than the steel and electrically connecting it to form a cell Electronspass to the steel which becomes the cathode so preventing or reducing corrosion In this method the anode eg zinc islsquosacrificedrsquo to protect the steel and it is called the sacrificial anode method
Both methods are widely used and in practice have relative advantages and disadvantages
1213Sacrificial Anode Method
Zinc aluminium and magnesium all have more negative potentials than iron or steel and are used as anode materials toprovide full or partial cathodic protection to steelwork Over a period of time they corrode and so must be replaced at suitableintervals
The anodes are manufactured into suitable shapes and sizes and are electrically connected to the steel in various wayswhich will not be considered here However the method of connection must be such as to ensure good electrical contact
In practice the exact composition of the anode material is important because it must fulfil certain requirements Clearly itmust maintain a sufficient negative potential to ensure that cathodic protection is achieved but it must also continue tocorrode during use If the anode becomes passive ie develops a protective surface film it will not operate properlyAdditionally it must develop a high anode efficiency To achieve these requirements certain small alloy additions may bemade eg indium to prevent passivity in aluminium anodes Alternatively some elements may be detrimental eg iron inzinc anodes and they must be maintained below a certain level The quality control of anode compositions is an essentialrequirement if sound cathodic protection is to be achieved A typical installation is shown in Fig 121
1214Impressed Current Method
In this method again in the presence of a suitable electrolyte current from a DC source is delivered through an auxiliaryanode so that the steel becomes the cathode of a large electrochemical cell ie the potential is reduced to a level wherecorrosion does not occur (see Fig 122) A number of different materials have been used as auxiliary anodes including high-silicon irons graphite and lead alloys A long-life anode material can be produced by coating metals such as titanium withplatinum
1215Choice of Method for Cathodic Protection
In some situations both methods may be employed Generally however depending on the particular circumstances either thesacrificial anode or impressed current method is used There are relative advantages and disadvantages with both methodsThese are summarised below
The impressed current method The main advantages are that there is better control with this method to provide theperformance required that fewer anodes are required and that the high driving voltage provides efficient protection of largerstructures Against these factors there are disadvantages compared with the sacrificial anode methods
(i) Supervision of operation needs to be at a higher level(ii) A source of power is required
(iii) Although capable of good control over-protection can result with poor control which may cause problems with coatingsand high-strength steels
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 171
(iv) It is possible to connect the electrical circuit incorrectly so that corrosion rather than protection is induced(v) In some marine situations physical damage of the anodes may be more likely
The sacrificial anode method The main advantages are that initial costs are lower and the installation is comparativelystraightforward and usually additional anodes can be added if required The disadvantages include the following
(i) There is a limit on the driving voltage and this is generally lower than with the impressed current method(ii) The available current is determined by the anode area and this may lead to the need for the use of a considerable
number of anodes(iii) In some soils the low conductivity of the environment may be a problem
1216Practical Applications of Cathodic Protection
Cathodic protection can be used only where there is an electrolyte of suitable conductivity The main areas of use are asfollows
Fig 121 Sacrificial anode on immersed structure
Fig 122 Cathodic protection by impressed current general principles
172 CONTROL METHODS OTHER THAN COATINGS
(i) Water-immersion (exterior surfaces) ships offshore structures marine installations submarine pipelines dry docksetc
(ii) Underground or buried steelwork (exterior surfaces) pipelines sewers water distributors underground tanks etc(iii) Interior surfaces of tanks condensers and heat exchangers etc
Cathodic protection if properly applied should be capable of stopping all forms of corrosion including those arising frompitting crevices and bacterial activity Generally the most economic employment of cathodic protection will be inconjunction with suitable coatings The method ensures that corrosion does not occur at damaged bare steel areas or atpinholes or pores in the coating so the costs of operating the system are less than would be the case with uncoated steel
There is in fact one important exception to this general approach Most offshore structures are not coated in the fullyimmersed regions and protection is achieved by cathodic protection alone There is some divergence of view regarding thisapproach because one large oil company does coat the immersed area of its platforms Clearly this is an economic calculationbased on the cost of coating as opposed to the costs of operating the cathodic protection system with more anodes It shouldbe added that the immersed steelwork that is initially uncoated does form a calcareous deposit arising from the action of thecathodic protection and the reaction of salts in seawater
It is not intended in this book to discuss the design of such systems in any detail but rather to indicate the areas wherecathodic protection can be beneficially employed and the factors involved in the choice and design In broad terms thefollowing points must be taken into account
(i) Total superficial area to be protected(ii) Estimate of current requirements
(iii) Determination of resistivity (conductivity) of the environment(iv) Assessment of electrical current requirements for the system(v) Selection of the most suitable method ie impressed current or sacrificial anode method material and number of
anodes required and calculation of the type of anode(vi) Cost
It is not possible to measure the current necessary to achieve cathodic protection because the original anodic and cathodicareas are present on the same steel surface To overcome this the potential of the structure is measured by means of a suitablereference electrode A number of different electrodes are used and when quoting potentials it is necessary to refer to the actualelectrode used to measure them The most commonly used reference electrode is coppercopper sulphate (CuCuSO4) especiallyfor soils Silversilver chloride (AgAgCl) is often used for immersed situations unlike the CuCuSO4 electrode it does notrequire a salt bridge Calomel (saturated potassium chloride (KCl)) electrodes are generally reserved for laboratory work andfor calibration purposes Zinc can also be used It is not particularly accurate but is cheap and may provide long-termreliability as a semi-permanent fixed reference electrode
The potentials at which cathodic protection will be obtained in different environments are based on both theoreticalconsiderations and practical experience For example in seawater at 25EacuteC the potential at which full protection of steel willbe obtained with respect to the AgAgCl reference electrode is considered to be copy08V In polluted water a more negativepotential may be required and in the presence of sulphate-reducing bacteria copy09 to copy095V with reference to AgAgCl isconsidered necessary The current requirements can be calculated theoretically if certain assumptions are made In practicethe current density required will be influenced by a number of factors eg seawater velocity oxygen concentration electricalresistivity of the environment presence of bacteria etc
For off-shore structures the various classification societies eg Lloyds or national authorities lay down requiredstandards and of course these have to be adhered to Generally the design of a suitable cathodic protection system is aspecialised matter The number and positioning of the anodes the operating controls and determination of suitable monitoringprocedures are matters that will determine both the cost and efficient operation of the system
122CONDITIONING OF THE ENVIRONMENT
Corrosion has been defined as a chemical or electrochemical reaction between a metal or alloy and its environment Generallysteel is coated to prevent or reduce reaction with the environment but in some circumstances it may be preferable to treat theenvironment to reduce or prevent corrosion The approach depends on whether the environment is primarily air or an aqueoussolution so the two will be considered separately
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 173
1221Treatment of the Air
Most steelwork is exposed to air but generally there is no way in which the environment can be treated to reduce externalcorrosion except in the sense that buildings and structures can be sited in less corrosive parts of a complex However wherethe air is enclosed eg inside a building or in a lsquobox structurersquo it is possible to take action to reduce the corrosiveness of theair As noted in Chapter 2 the main factors that determine the corrosivity of air are the presence of moisture and pollutantssuch as sulphur dioxide or contaminants such as chlorides The simplest method of treating the environment is to removemoisture Often complete removal of moisture is not required because by lowering the relative humidity to a suitable levelcorrosion becomes inappreciable Generally a level of about 50 relative humidity is satisfactory although in some caseseg in the presence of chlorides it may be necessary to reduce it below that figure
Relative humidity is influenced by temperature and often it can be reduced by heating rooms or air-conditioningequipment can be installed to remove moisture from the air Sometimes in fairly air-tight enclosures such as box girders onbridges the humidity can be controlled by using desiccants such as silica gel or activated alumina Silica gel is considered tobe effective for 2ndash3 years if used at the rate of 250 gm3 of void provided the space is well sealed and manholes are keptclosed1 There is a change of colour when silica gel has lost its effectiveness and it is necessary to incorporate a system bywhich this can be checked The desiccant can be heated to remove moisture and re-used In the UK the Transport and RoadResearch Laboratory (Department of Transport) has developed a method of enclosing structural members on bridges withplastic sheeting to provide an enclosed environment somewhat similar to that inside a box girder2 This reduces the attack onthe steel members because the environment is to some extent controlled and rain dirt and other corrosive species do not comeinto contact with the steel surface Trials are still in progress but early results show promise Where steel sections arecompletely sealed a small amount of corrosion may occur because some moisture will be trapped inside the box or tube butonce this has reacted with the steel no further serious corrosion is likely Corrosion can be avoided by purging air spaces andfilling them with inert gases This method is employed with certain holds on ships
Air is often treated with desiccants to remove moisture but volatile corrosion inhibitors are also used to retard or preventthe corrosion of steel surfaces in packages This is a comparatively expensive method and is not used for large steel sectionsbut may be adopted for smaller steel components
Volatile corrosion inhibitors (VCI) are used for this purpose The term Vapour phase inhibitorrsquo (VPI) is also sometimesused but VCI covers all types of this class of inhibitor The mechanism will not be considered in detail but these inhibitors arechosen to provide different degrees of volatility which then react in the vapour phase with any moisture in the package toprovide an inhibitive solution at the steel surface The most common inhibitors are dicyclohexyl ammonium nitrite (DCHN)and cyclohexylamine carbonate (CHC) CHC is more volatile than DCHN and more soluble in water Both types may attackcopper alloys and other materials so must be used with some caution on assemblies
The VCIs are available commercially usually under proprietary names in the form of impregnated wrapping papers and asgranules in porous sachets Proprietary products may contain a mixture of the two inhibitors sometimes with additions ofother inhibitors
1222Treatment of Aqueous Solutions
Although steelwork is used in seawater and river water there is usually no practical way in which the waters can be treated toprevent corrosion In soils some treatments are possible but generally they rely upon the use of non-corrosive backfills incontact with pipes
There are methods of treating water to reduce its corrosiveness These include the removal of oxygen a method commonlyused for boiler waters and making the solution alkaline These are not applicable to general structural steelwork althoughthere may be situations where water is contained within constructional members For example with some buildings the fireprotection system relies upon water being pumped through tubular members and control of alkalinity may be a suitable wayof preventing internal corrosion A common method of controlling corrosion in aqueous situations is to use inhibitors Theseare chemicals added to the water in suitable concentrations which retard either the anodic or cathodic action at the steelsurface and based on this are commonly called anodic or cathodic inhibitors Typical examples of the former type arechromates nitrites and phosphates all of which can be considered as acting to reinforce oxide films on the steel Cathodicinhibitors are generally considered to include silicates and polyphosphates but in some cases the inhibitors may have aninfluence on both anodic and cathodic reactions Inhibitors are important in the oil industry in both the extraction and refiningprocesses but these are specialised topics which will not be considered here
174 CONTROL METHODS OTHER THAN COATINGS
123ALLOY STEELS
The corrosion resistance of steels can be markedly improved by adding other metals to produce alloys The most resistant ofthe common steel alloys is stainless steel It is a good deal more expensive than ordinary steel and although widely used inprocess plant is employed to only a limited extent in structures mainly for fasteners in particularly aggressive situations andsometimes for bearings It is more widely used on buildings for cladding balustrades doors etc
Although there are a number of different groups within the overall classification of stainless steel the one most commonlyused in buildings and structures is austenitic stainless steel so described because of its metallurgical structure In fact steelswith 12 or more of chromium fall into the category of stainless steels but the common austenitic types contain over 30 ofalloying elements 18ndash20 chromium 8ndash10 nickel and about 3 molybdenum
The other group of alloy steels that have been used for structures and buildings are much lower in alloy content only about2ndash3 These are called lsquoweathering steelsrsquo the best known of which is the US Steel Corporation version lsquoCOR TENrsquo alsoproduced under licence in other countries Unlike stainless steels they have been used for structural members as well ascladding for buildings
1231Stainless Steels
These steels owe their corrosion resistance to the formation of a passive surface oxide film basically Cr2O3
12311Corrosion Characteristics of Stainless Steels
The austenitic stainless steels are virtually uncorroded when freely exposed in most atmospheric environments The 304series without molybdenum additions may exhibit rust staining arising from slight pitting but the actual loss of steel by corrosionis negligible The 304 steels are attacked to a greater extent in marine atmospheres because of the presence of chlorides andthis may lead to a rust-stained appearance but again produces little loss of metal The 315 and 316 steels perform well even inmarine atmospheres and often under immersed conditions However in some immersed situations corrosion can occurparticularly in stagnant conditions where marine growths can form Such organisms shield the steel from oxygen so thatbreakdown of the passive film is not repaired Any area where the film cannot be repaired is a potential site for pitting Suchsituations as overlaps and crevices may provide conditions where pitting may occur This is not likely to be serious in mostatmospheric conditions but may be more severe under immersed situations Pitting occurs to a much greater extent onstainless steels than on carbon steels This arises from the presence of the very protective film which becomes cathodic to anysmall breaks where local corrosion occurs In the presence of an electrolyte the corroding area ie the anodic part of the cellis in contact with a large cathodic area which intensifies the local corrosion Since the passive film is very adherent at the edgeof the local anodic area corrosion tends not to spread sideways but rather to penetrate into the alloy ie to cause pitting Suchpitting can be serious if comparatively thin sheet material is used as a pipe for transporting liquids because eventually thesteel is perforated by the pitting allowing escape of the liquid In most situations where stainless steel is used for structuresthis is not such a serious problem but care should be taken with the design of stainless steel fabrications particularly wherethey are exposed to chlorides which are the species most likely to cause pitting Marine situations are obviously affected bychlorides but attention should also be paid to the effects of de-icing salts when stainless steel is used on bridges
These steels are often used as components for structures and buildings but they are also used for architectural panelsGenerally 316-type material is employed for this purpose and care must be exercised during construction to ensure thatmortars and cements do not come into contact with the panels Problems of pitting can occur particularly with chloride-containing concretes especially if they are allowed to set and are not immediately removed
In cities and large towns where stainless steel may be used for cladding the accumulation of dirt can lead to localbreakdown of the passive film and it is advantageous to wash the steel down occasionally possibly when windows are beingcleaned3
1232Low-Alloy Weathering Steels
In the early 1970s a large number of bridges as well as other structures and buildings were constructed from these steels thebest known of which was called lsquoCORTENrsquo mainly in the USA but also in many other countries including the UnitedKingdom Small additions of alloying elements such as copper nickel chromium and somewhat higher amounts of silica and
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 175
phosphorous than in ordinary steels resulted in an alloy content of only 2ndash3 This had the effect of reducing the corrosionrate in air compared with that of unalloyed steel Furthermore although initially weathering steels rusted in a similar mannerto ordinary steels after a period of some months the rust became darker and more adherent than conventional rustConsiderable test work on small panels throughout the world confirmed the advantages of these steels provided they werefreely exposed in air at inland sites Their performance compared with ordinary steel showed less improvement when exposedclose to the sea and if they were immersed in water or buried in soil their corrosion rate was similar to that of ordinary steelIn air the general trend is illustrated in Fig 123 where not only was the corrosion lower than for mild steel but after anumber of years it tailed off to a greater extent
In situations where the corrosion rate of these steels is low enough then coatings are not required at least for aconsiderable period of time This of course assumes that appearance is not a vital factor The steels are more expensive thannon-alloyed high-strength steels However with the savings in both initial protection and a number of maintenancerepaintings an apparently sound economic case could be made for their use in structures
In practice there have been disappointments with these steels in some locations particularly where they have been incontact with salt solutions These can arise from chloride contamination in marine environments or the use of de-icing salts onbridges
The essential advantage of these steels only manifests itself where the steels are freely exposed in air so design featureswithin the structure can influence the corrosion rate For example moisture collects at crevices so the steels tend to corrodeat a greater rate and at areas that remain constantly damp increased corrosion rates are again likely
The appearance of these steels is a matter of taste To some the structures built from them look like rusty steelwork thatneeds painting On the other hand many architects consider the appearance to be an architectural advantage The steels havebeen used for some large and prestigious buildings often for architectural effect Generally the economic advantages aremore likely to occur with structures
Although there probably is a place for weathering steels in certain situations the design of structures and buildings musttake into account the corrosion properties of the steels This has not always been done in a satisfactory way A paper byTinklenberg and Culp4 sums up what is probably a fairly representative view of many bridge authorities in the USA Theauthors say
hellipin 1977 a comprehensive evaluation of weathering steel was started This investigation identified a number ofproblem areas These included salt contamination crevice corrosion pitting millscale accumulation of debris thecapillarity of the rust by-products and the potential of corrosion fatigue When it was determined that these structureshad to be painted and that other equal strength steels were available at a lower cost the initial reasons for selectingweathering steel were no longer validhellip
A number of practical points regarding the use of the steels can be made Problems may arise if these steels are used inenvironments where chlorides are present The rust formed tends to be somewhat more flaky and the steel itself is attackedlocally to produce a form of pitting Clearly chlorides are present in quantity near the coast and generally steel companiesadvise that weathering steels should not be used in such situations The advice on the distance from the coast where such
Fig 123 Comparative corrosion of mild steel and low-alloy steel in atmospheric tests (after Ref 5)
176 CONTROL METHODS OTHER THAN COATINGS
steels can be used varies and depends on wind direction and general topography but 1000m from the coastline is commonlyrecommended as being suitable
If the steels are not freely exposed they may corrode at a rate similar to that of ordinary steels This can be a problem atoverlaps and at crevices With thin-gauge material eg sheet the volume of rust formed at overlaps may be sufficient to causebuckling This is not likely to be a problem with heavy sections but with sheet it is necessary to fill such gaps either withmastic or by painting the overlapping surfaces Although weathering steel in the form of sheets has been used to cladindustrial buildings problems at overlaps have arisen and in some cases sheets have perforated over a period of time It isprobably inadvisable to use these steels in sheet form for cladding in most environments There is some evidence to show thatnorth-facing steelwork (in the Northern hemisphere) produces a less compact rust than steel exposed in other directions Itseems possible that this may indicate a higher rate of corrosion although there are no published data on this aspect Howevernorth-facing surfaces tend to remain damp for longer periods particularly in the winter months
During the early periods of exposure weathering steels may cause staining of other building materials eg concrete thiscan occur because before the rust has fully developed rainwater can remove various particles of hydroxide and oxide whichare then deposited on to the surface of the adjacent material Although rain is the main carrier any condensation dripping fromthe steel can also cause staining This staining is difficult to remove particularly on materials such as concrete which areporous and not particularly smooth Suitable design eg by using plastic sheets or temporary drainage will generallyovercome the problem
Staining also occurs at ground level where weathering steels are employed for buildings or structures Various methodshave been proposed for alleviating this problem including special drainage grilles and chippings at the foot of walls onbuildings which can be replaced when the rust has stabilised on the steel with elimination of staining
Other problems have arisen from the use of weathering steels particularly in buildings Before the rust stabilises andbecomes reasonably adherent a considerable amount is deposited in the general area There have also been reports of the rustaffecting air-conditioning systems
12321Comments on Weathering Steels
Although the original data on weathering steels probably provided an over-optimistic view of their potential performance inpractice there may well be advantages in some situations in using these steels as an alternative to coatings Undoubtedlymany of the problems have arisen from lack of attention to design detailing or from the effects of chlorides The latter isclearly likely to cause difficulties where de-icing salts are used or where the steels are used near the coast
In mild atmospheres the steels can be used with some confidence in more aggressive environments it may be advisable tomonitor the loss of steel by corrosion so that suitable measures can be taken to ensure structural stability if the corrosion rateproves to be unacceptable This would usually entail cleaning the steel and painting However if such painting could bedeferred for 15ndash20 years this might be considered to be economically advantageous particularly in situations where accessfor maintenance was difficult
Prior to considering the use of weathering steels for any application advice should be sought from the manufacturers toensure that optimum performance is attained
REFERENCES
1 Protective Coating of Iron and Steel Structures Against Corrosion BS 5493 British Standards Institution London 1977 p 842 Bishop RR amp Wirnett MA An alternative to bridge painting TRRL Supplementary Report 1980 Crowthorne Berkshire UK3 Chandler KA Stainless Steels Iron and Steel Institution Publication 117 London 1969 p 1274 Tinklenberg GL amp Culp JD J Protective Coatings and Linings 1(1) (1984)26
FURTHER READING
Peabody AW Control of Pipeline Corrosion NACE Houston 1971Shrier LL Corrosion (2 vols) 2nd edn Newnes-Butterworth London 1976Uhlig HH Corrosion and Corrosion Control 2nd edn Wiley New York 1971
NACE Publications
Control of External Corrosion on Underground or Submerged Systems 1969 RP-01ndash69Design Installation Operation and Maintenance of Impressed Current Deep Groundbeds 1972 RP-05ndash72Control of Corrosion on Offshore Steel Pipelines 1975 RP-06ndash75
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 177
Control of Corrosion on Steel Fixed Offshore Platforms Associated with Petroleum Products 1976 RP-01ndash76
British Standards
CP 10211973 Cathodic Protection The following further British Standards refer to cathodic protection in particular situationsCP310 1965 Water SupplyCP 1013 1965 EarthingCP 2001 1957 Site InvestigationsCP 3009 1970 Thermally Insulated Underground Piping SystemsCP 2004 1972 FoundationsCP 2005 1968 SewerageCP 2010 Pipelines
178 CONTROL METHODS OTHER THAN COATINGS
CHAPTER 13Coating Defects and Failures
131INTRODUCTION
A coating failure can be considered to have arisen in any situation where the coating system has failed to attain its potentiallife Often the failure cannot be attributed to a single cause but occurs because of a general lack of attention to a number offacets involved in the coating process typically selection of the wrong system for the environment inadequate surfacepreparation and poor quality control of application Failures of this type have serious economic implications because areduction in the anticipated life from say 6 years to 4 years involves a considerable increase in costs for maintenance Anyorganisation faced with a continuing failure to achieve the coating lives that can be reasonably anticipated in a particular setof circumstances would be well advised to examine its own processes for selection specification and quality control
However it is often difficult to pinpoint the causes of an overall failure to achieve the potential life of coatings withoutdocumentary evidence to provide a clear background to the conditions and quality of the coating operations Someorganisations have carried out in-depth investigations and by changing their approach to steelwork protection have savedlarge sums of money hence such failures should not be considered as inevitable However there are also failures that occurwithin months sometimes weeks of application often the causes can be determined with some certainty These present adifferent problem from long-term failures
When a failure occurs within for example a year of application a serious and costly situation will arise and immediateaction is required The cause must be established if at all possible so that it will not be repeated when the remedial work iscarried out Another reason for the investigation of such a failure arises from the costs involved and the requirement toestablish some responsibility for meeting them The costs of this type of remedial work can sometimes be many times thosefor the application of the original coating system Generally new access scaffolding is required and the conditions for re-coating may be very much worse than those for the original work It should also be appreciated that remedial work of thisnature is unlikely to achieve the original standards possible under the controlled ambient conditions in a shop
It is important to be aware of the causes of such failures so that they can be avoided in future They can be categorised inrelation to the stage of the coating process at which lack of attention to some requirements eventually led to the problem
132SURFACE PREPARATION
Lack of adequate surface preparation is probably the cause either directly or indirectly of a majority of coating failures Failuresarise from surface preparation procedures in a number of ways but most of them are related either to adhesion or under rustingof the coating Some of the common causes of such failures are
(i) Use of steel which is excessively laminated or has other surface defects arising from manufacture(ii) Use of steel which has corroded and pitted to a considerable extent prior to blast-cleaning It is difficult to clean such
steel to a satisfactory standard and generally it is not suitable for structures where a high level of protection is required(iii) Incorrect blast-cleaning profile for the particular coating this is more commonly a problem with high profiles which are
not satisfactorily covered by paint at the peaks However with very thick coatings a very low profile may not providethe conditions for sound adhesion and this may lead to failures
(iv) Failures often arise from the surface preparation used to clean welded areas (Fig 131) Even where the main steelworkhas been blast-cleaned the welded areas are often only wirebrushed so providing a poor surface for paint applicationAdditionally welds may provide a rough surface equivalent to a coarse profile again leading to coating breakdownPremature failure of coatings often occurs on or near bolts because of inadequate protective treatments (Fig 132)
(v) After blast-cleaning the steel must be protected to a degree sufficient to prevent rusting until the full coating system isapplied Generally a blast primer of some type is used and this is satisfactory for a short period However if the steel isexposed outdoors particularly in an aggressive environment for a long period corrosion may well occur and salts willform If this steel is painted without further thorough cleaning premature breakdown of the coating can be anticipatedEven where a full priming coat is applied problems can occur if there are long periods of storage outdoors Similarproblems can arise where there are long delays in cladding and roofing buildings so that inadequately protected steelwhich will eventually be exposed internally is exposed to exterior conditions for prolonged periods
(vi) Where steel is to be exposed to aggressive situations and particularly where it is to be immersed the standardsemployed for blast-cleaning for coatings exposed in milder conditions may not be sufficient to ensure adequatecleanliness eg the presence of soluble chloride salts after blast-cleaning may lead to localised failures
133COATING MATERIALS
If coating materials are defective in some way then this will clearly lead to problems and proper control procedures arenecessary to avoid this situation However failures can arise from incorrect use of materials that are basically sound
(i) Inadequate mixing of paints particularly two-pack materials(ii) Excessive use of thinners or use of the wrong type of thinners
(iii) Use of paint after the expiry of the stated shelf life(iv) Using two-pack materials beyond their pot life(v) Use of paint not suitable for the ambient conditions experienced eg paints suitable for use in temperate climates may
be unsuitable in very hot climates(vi) Selection of a coating material not suitable for the environmental conditions of exposure eg oleo-resinous paints for
steelwork that is cathodically protected
Fig 131 Corrosion at weld largely due to roughness of the weld profile
Fig 132 General rust spotting and corrosion around bolts due to inadequate protective treatments
180 COATING DEFECTS AND FAILURES
134COATING APPLICATION
The application techniques for all coating materials have a significant effect on performance Often poor applicationprocedures result in a reduced overall life but these can also be the cause of early failures Some typical causes are listedbelow
(i) Operators with insufficient experience of a particular type of coating material may produce what appears to be a soundcoating However it may be defective and cause problems later Typically this occurs with fast-drying paints if thespray gun is too far from the surface This means that particles of paint will have time to dry out and not be wet enoughto flow into a continuous film This is called lsquodry sprayrsquo Coating over such a porous powdery layer with a wet film ofpaint can make this difficult to detect from the finished film Nevertheless it remains an inferior product
(ii) The condition of the equipment is equally important If it is poorly maintained or of the wrong type although thecoating material will be applied apparently satisfactorily it will not necessarily cure or dry to provide a suitableprotective film Poor intercoat adhesion or solvent entrapment may well occur leading to early failures
(iii) Poor application procedures can result in excessive discontinuities in the film eg pinholes These may not be apparentfrom a visual examination but can lead to rusting and coating breakdown particularly under immersed conditions
(iv) Unsuitable ambient conditions whether of temperature or relative humidity may cause problems leading to lack of cureof two-pack materials or adhesion problems arising from moisture on the surface
(v) Some paint coatings must be overcoated within specified time limits Failure to observe these requirements can lead topoor intercoat adhesion
(vi) Generally the application of an inadequate thickness of paint will result in a reduction of the coating life Howeverwith some paints excessive thickness of coating can lead to problems such as entrapment of solvent producingdiscontinuities in the film
Many paint failures arise from poor application which affects adhesion and the film properties These defects are not alwaysimmediately apparent so careful control of application processes is essential
Materials other than paint can fail to protect steel adequately if they are not properly applied For example themanufacturersrsquo instructions must be followed when applying tapes to ensure that the steelwork is correctly wrappedCorrosion can occur under badly applied tapes and may not be evident for a considerable time Sprayed metal coatings arealso subject to poor application arising from the nature of the equipment and the skill of the operator Factory-appliedprocesses eg electroplating hot-dip galvanising and plastic coatings all require careful control which is usually in thehands of the companies producing the coatings Failures can however occur on all these materials if they are not properlyapplied
135TRANSPORT AND STORAGE
The use of correct handling techniques will reduce damage during transport and storage to a minimum but it is inevitable thatsome damage will occur It should be noted that excessive damage to a coating is not necessarily a sign of excessively roughhandling but may signal that the coating as a whole is soft and has poor adhesion to the substrate due for example toentrapped solvent
Although mechanical damage to a coating during fabrication handling transport and storage is strictly a failure it isusually obvious and is repaired However despite re-painting these damaged areas can be a source of weakness in thesystem particularly if rusting has occurred and inadequate cleaning methods are employed before re-painting Mechanicaldamage can be particularly troublesome on factory-applied coatings because it is generally not possible to repair the coating tothe original standard of that applied in the works Special kits of repair materials are often available for plastic coatings andthese are usually superior to touch-up with paints
136TYPES OF COATING DEFECTS
As already observed there may be a reduction in life without any obvious visual defects in the coating and a carefullaboratory investigation may be required to determine the cause of failure In many cases however visible effects aremanifested and some of the more common types will be considered below
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 181
1361Adhesion Loss (Flaking Peeling etc)
Loss of adhesion is generally visible as the lifting of the paint from the underlying surface in the form of flakes or scales Ifthe cohesive strength of the film is strong the coating may form large shallow blisters Excessive mechanical damage duringhandling can often be a symptom of poor adhesion The following points are the main causes of loss of adhesion
(i) Loose friable or powdery active or inert materials on the surface before painting ie rust dirt zinc salts (Fig 133) dryspray millscale chalking
(ii) Contamination preventing the paint from wettingrsquo the surface ie oil grease silicones amine bloom plasticisermigration
(iii) Surface too smooth to provide mechanical bonding ie galvanising aged polyurethane or epoxy coatings too shallowblast profile
(iv) Application of catalysed materials in too advanced a state of their curing ie in excess of pot life
1362Bacterial or Fungal Attack
Bacteria or fungi can thrive on a dirt layer on the surface of a paint film without detriment to its protective properties In somecases however bacteria can use certain components of a coating as their food source The result can be a rapid failureMunger1 quotes the case of the use of coal-tar epoxies under sewage conditions Coal-tar epoxies with amine-type curingagents have excellent resistance but coal-tar epoxies with polyamide curing agents are rapidly attacked and fail quickly
1363Bleeding
Bleeding is the brown staining of a coloured topcoat due to the migration of bituminous material from an undercoat such as acoal-tar epoxy asphalt etc
1364Blistering
There are two forms of blistering one arises within the coating itself and the other is caused by corrosion of the substrateBlistering within coatings is generally caused either by solvents which are trapped within or under the paint film or by waterwhich is drawn through the paint film by the osmotic forces exerted by hygroscopic salts at the paint-substrate interface Thegas or the liquid then exerts a pressure and if it becomes greater than the cohesive strength of the paint film the blisters break(see Fig 134)
Solvent entrapment can arise from lsquoskin curingrsquo of the top layer of the coating Overcoating or immersing the coatingbefore the solvent has had an opportunity to evaporate also causes entrapment within the coating The measurement orevaluation of the degree and size of blistering can be carried out by the use of standard photographs or diagrams such asthose published by ASTM or BS3900 Part Hl (ISO 46281)
Fig 133 Loss of adhesion arising from zinc salts on zinc-rich primer
182 COATING DEFECTS AND FAILURES
Coatings applied to steel generally fail eventually by disruption of the paint film due to the large volume of corrosionproducts accumulating at the coating-metallic interface If the thickness of the paint coating is initially inadequate then thecorrosion will be of an overall nature but when corrosion arises from water and aggressive ions being drawn through the filmby the osmotic action of soluble iron corrosion products then the attack will start from corrosion pits This can be overall orconfined to isolated areas Corrosion does not automatically spread under paint films if the adhesion is good
The blistering of paint films on steel in seawater involves the operation of corrosion cells on the metal surface Irondissolves at anodic areas and hydrogen evolves at the cathodic areas leaving an accumulation of sodium hydroxide in thecathodic blisters Anodic blisters that develop before the appearance of rust are small and filled with acid liquid they readilyfracture and become the seat of anodic pits Paints based on linseed and other drying oils are attacked by alkalis and thereforesuch paints are especially prone to blistering under immersed conditions
1365Blooming or Blushing
Blooming (often called blushing in the USA although in the UK this term is confined to this phenomenon on lacquers thatcure by evaporation eg nitrocellulose) is a deposit like the bloom on a grape which sometimes forms on glossy finishescausing loss of gloss and dulling of colour It is generally caused by high humidities or condensation during the curing periodThis occurs with amine-cured epoxies in particular when they are applied at relative humidities in excess of 85 It is notgenerally considered detrimental to the coating but can reduce the adhesion of subsequent overcoats It can normally beremoved by wiping the surface with a rag saturated in the appropriate solvent
1366Chalking
Chalking is the formation of a friable powdery coating on the surface of a paint film caused by disintegration of the binderdue to the effect of weathering particularly exposure to the actinic (photochemically active) rays of the sun and condensationfrom dew
Different binders react at different rates for example epoxies react quite quickly whereas acrylics and polyurethanes canremain unchanged for long periods Chalking of epoxies however is generally considered to be a surface phenomenon onlyand therefore not harmful except to the decorative appearance Oil-based paints however are thin enough to be eroded away(Fig 135) so that eventually the undercoat is lsquogrinningrsquo through In all cases it is generally considered the most acceptable
Fig 134 Blisters containing water andor solvent
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 183
form of failure since the surface preparation for subsequent maintenance consists only of removing loose powdery materialand it is generally not necessary to remove the old coatings completely
1367Cissing Crawling and Fisheyeing
Cissing crawling and fisheyeing are all forms of surface defect where the paint has not lsquowettedrsquo the surface correctly and thewet paint recedes from small areas leaving either holes of various shapes and sizes or attenuated films The cause is generallyoil grease or silicones on the surface to be painted or water or oil in the paint during application A typical source of suchcontamination is the air supply to the spray gun These defects can also be caused by the use of the wrong solvent
1368Cobwebbing
Cobwebbing is the formation of thin spider-web-like strings during the spraying of fast drying solvent-evaporation typecoatings such as chlorinated-rubber or vinyls It is caused by the too rapid evaporation of the solvent such as when theapplication is carried out under high ambient temperatures
1369Cracking
Cracking may be visible or require the use of some form of magnifier to detect it There are various types of cracking and arange of terminology is employed to describe them
Hair cracking Fine cracks which do not penetrate the top coat they occur erratically and at randomChecking Fine cracks which do not penetrate the top coat and are distributed over the surface giving the semblance of a small
pattern Cracking Specifically a breakdown in which the cracks penetrate at least one coat and which may be expected to result
ultimately in complete failureCrazing Resembling checking but the cracks are deeper and broaderCrocodiling or alligatoring A drastic type of crazing producing a pattern resembling the hide of a crocodile (Fig 136)In addition there is a special form of cracking called lsquomud crackingrsquo which on a small scale resembles the appearance of dried-
out mud and is an effect specific to overthick applications of zinc silicates or emulsionsAll paint films but especially coatings containing solvents are subjected to an internal stress which may have the effect of
reducing their tolerance to external stresses If a coating cracks spontaneously this is because the internal stress has increasedto a value greater than the tensile strength Internal stresses are dependent upon plasticisation pigmentation ageing and theconditions under which the coating was applied and cured
In some instances eg some anti-fouling paints water can act as a plasticiser and the films remain flexible under immersedconditions but crack when dried out In other cases eg oil-based paints water and ageing can gradually leach out theplasticising elements and the film becomes brittle with age In yet other cases eg chlorinated rubber the plasticiser elements
Fig 135 Erosion of paint coating
184 COATING DEFECTS AND FAILURES
migrate under the influence of heat Paint films can be sufficiently flexible for most purposes but not when applied over asofter or more flexible undercoating for example alkyd paints which are applied over bitumen coatings generally crack inthe particular form known as crocodiling
13610Complete or Partial Failure to Cure of Two-Part Materials
Catalysed materials such as two-pack epoxies and polyurethanes will sometimes dry without the addition of the catalystHowever such a film is incorrectly cured and will not give the service intended The paint film is generally softer than thefully cured coating and may have a tendency to sag
Even if the two materials are added together they must be adequately mixed and in the correct proportions or again thepolymer formed will not be the correct one and will be less durable Also there might be a tendency for the mixed coating tohave a shorter pot life than expected and it may even set up in the pot or in the spray lines (lsquoSet uprsquo is the term used forconversion of a liquid paint to a gel-like consistency or for thickening ie increase in viscosity) With the exception of theisocyanate-cured epoxies the two-pack epoxies will not cure adequately at ambient temperatures below 5EacuteC
13611Dry Spray
This occurs when during the spraying of paint the particles hitting the surface are insufficiently fluid to flow together to forma uniform coating the result is a powdery layer The defect is generally caused when fast-drying materials such as zincsilicates or two-pack epoxies are sprayed with the gun too far away from the surface or with very strong cross-currents ofwind
13612Fading
Changes in colour of paints are mainly due to ultraviolet degradation of the coloured pigments or dyes Selective deteriorationof one pigment can cause a complete colour change for example from green to blue but generally the effect is of the brightercolours fading and becoming dull with time
13613Lifting or Pulling Up
This is the softening and expansion of a previously applied paint when a new paint with strong solvents is applied over it Theeffect is often similar to that obtained with lsquopaint removersrsquo It can be prevented by careful choice of overcoating paints toensure that their solvents are compatible or in some instances by allowing the previous coat to dry and harden to anacceptable degree
Fig 136 Cracking of paint film applied over bituminous coa ng
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 185
13614Orange Peel
Incorrect spray application such as with the gun too close to the surface or with air pressure too low for proper atomisationcan produce a surface effect that causes a paint film to resemble the skin of an orange Before the coating has lsquosetrsquo it issometimes possible to brush out the excess paint otherwise it generally means waiting until the coating has cured sandingdown and applying a further coat
13615Pinholes and Holidays
Pinholes are minute holes formed in a paint film during application and drying They are often caused by air or gas bubbleswhich burst forming small craters in the wet paint film which fail to flow out before the paint has set Some confusion arisesfrom the term lsquoholidayrsquo which is sometimes defined as skipped or missed areas left uncoated with paint but is often used toindicate pinholes
13616Pinpoint Rusting
Pinpoint rusting consisting of small isolated spots of rust often forming a directional pattern associated with the blast cleaningor paint spray operation is caused by the high peaks of the blast-cleaned surface not being adequately covered by the paintfilm If it is caught at an early enough stage the remedy can often be no more than sanding down and application of morepaint
13617Runs and Sags
A run is a downward movement of a paint film over an otherwise flat surface which is often caused by the collection ofexcess quantities of paint at irregularities in the surface eg cracks small holes etc The excess material continues to flowafter the surrounding surface has set It is unwise to consider such defects as affecting only the appearance and therefore beingunimportant for industrial applications since due to surface tension effects the perimeters of such areas can be accompaniedby pinholes or holidays
Runs and sags in a paint film application can be symptomatic of more than just over-thick application or excess thinners Withtwo-pack catalysed materials it can also indicate failure to add the catalyst correctly or the use of a paint beyond its shelf life
13618Saponification
In painting practice this refers to the decomposition of an oil-containing binder by reaction with alkali and water The effectoccurs particularly on new concrete or with immersed coatings used in conjunction with cathodic protection
13619Skin Curing
Skin curing is the term used to describe the situation in which the top surface is cured faster than the body of a coating Thisnormally results in a soft cheesy type film The effect can be produced by curing of paint in direct strong sunlight or by forcedheating of the top surface particularly with thick films which cure by chemical reaction eg two-pack epoxies However itcan also occur to a different extent with films that cure by oxidation or by evaporation The effect may be particularlypronounced on heavy steel sections where the substrate may be at a significantly lower temperature than the top of the paintsurface The effect is further accelerated when the paint surface is black
To prevent skin curing it is advisable to avoid direct heating of two-pack epoxy and polyurethane surfaces and also paintingand curing in very strong sunlight If the latter is unavoidable the effect can sometimes be minimised by coating the driedbut not cured surface with whitewash
186 COATING DEFECTS AND FAILURES
13620Spot-Blast Boundary Breakdown
During maintenance painting when spot blast-cleaning is carried out it is necessary to feather backrsquo the adjacent andapparently sound adjacent paint surface However this partial blasting operation often damages the old paint more than isobvious to the eye and in particular weakens its adhesion Consequently on exposure the paint film is penetratedby moisture etc at this point and eventually fails by a particularly localised form of corrosion blistering
Figure 137 shows a typical example where a spot-blasted weld plus new paint and the surrounding untouched old paintare in good condition but corrosion blistering has occurred in a clearly defined area where the new and old paint haveoverlapped
13621Thickness Faults
Edges of steel sections are not only generally subject to more mechanical damage than other areas but will also generallyhave thinner paint films The attenuation at an edge depends on its radius and the type of coating but reductions of 80 arenot uncommon Nuts and bolts and threaded sections also provide many edges and corners that are difficult to coat adequately
Weld areas are often the first part of a structure to show failure This may be due to contamination from welding rods orfrom soaps used for weld tests but is generally due to inadequate preparation in the form of lack of removal of sharp edgesundercuts etc which then protrude into the paint film thickness Blast-cleaning alone is seldom adequate for such areas
13622Uneven Gloss
A patchy appearance to a glossy finish can be due to inadequate sealing of a porous substrate moisture in the film changes intemperature during application or paint applied over an inadequately cured coating
13623Undercutting
Undercutting is corrosion that penetrates laterally under a paint film It can start from a break in the film or from an edge It mayalso arise from corrosion products that have not been removed adequately before coating Corrosion occurs rapidly under suchconditions because the rust retains moisture and coupled with any soluble iron corrosion salts forms an ideal corrosion cell
The measure of a good protective coating is its ability to withstand or minimise undercutting This is almost always relatedto its adhesion properties The greater the adhesion the less tendency for the coating to be undercut
13624Wrinkling
Wrinkling of a paint film as it dries is characteristic of oil-based paints applied in too thick a film In these cases the surfaceof the film cures by oxidation from the atmosphere but the lower layers of the paint take considerably longer to cure
Fig 137 Corrosion blistering at overlap between old and new paint at a spot-blasted area
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 187
REFERENCE
1 Munger CG Corrosion Prevention by Protective Coatings NACE Houston p 354
188 COATING DEFECTS AND FAILURES
CHAPTER 14The Selection of Coating Systems
141INTRODUCTION
The selection of the most suitable system of corrosion protection for a specifie situation is not necessarily a simple matterMany factors may be involved in the selection process and the final choice may well be a compromise In particular thefollowing information must be considered
(i) The conditions that have to be resisted by the chosen system eg immersed sea conditions(ii) The ability of the various systems to resist such conditions
(iii) For coatings able to provide the necessary protection the nature of other problems that have to be considered to providean economic solution
When a suitable system has been selected engineers frequently ask lsquoHow long will it lastrsquo This is clearly an importantquestion After all if an alloy is selected for a particular purpose you would expect to be provided with information on sayits tensile strength Information on durability of coatings is not so readily available Although some types of coating would beexpected to last longer than others in a particular set of circumstances the coating material is only one factor in determiningthe life of a protective system It is therefore worth summarising some of the factors that influence the durability of coatings
(i) Standard of surface preparation of the steel(ii) Application procedures
(iii) Thickness of coating(iv) Design of structure(v) Local variations in the environment
If all other requirements such as surface preparation are met then clearly the coating material will play a major role indetermining durability However without testing a particular material in the specifie situation where it is to be exposed only abroad view of the durability can be expressed For example a chlorinated-rubber coating supplied by one company will notnecessarily perform in the same way as that from another Consequently actual livesrsquo cannot be predicted Generally a broadindication such as 5ndash10 years is the best information likely to be offered
With some coatings a lesser standard of surface cleanliness may be acceptable for shorter life requirements or for mildenvironments eg in dry interiors However if adhesion is not satisfactory then the potential life of the protective systemwill be significantly reduced because it will start to blister and flake from the steel so allowing rusting to occur If intercoatadhesion is unsatisfactory then detachment of coatings can occur with an obvious reduction of the protective value of thesystem
There is general agreement on many aspects of steel protection eg the importance of a high standard of surfacepreparation However there are often wide divergences of opinion when it comes to selecting protective systems for specificsituations Even where considerable attention has been given to the matter of choosing the most suitable system eg onoffshore structures there is rarely agreement on the overall virtues of one particular coating system To some extent this isunderstandable because specifiers have had varying experiences with coating systems and the high level of salesmanship of paintcompanies and other coating suppliers must also be taken into account Generally the system will be chosen from one of thefollowing groups
(i) Paint coatings
(ii) Metallic coatings(iii) High-duty or special coatings such as neoprene
Paint coatings are usually but not always the cheapest initially However taking into account the aggressiveness of theconditions to which the steelwork will be exposed and maintenance the most economic may be within any of the abovegroups or even a combination of different types Under immersed or buried conditions cathodic protection may be used withor without coatings For other situations alloys may be selected and methods of corrosion control such as inhibition may bepreferred to coatings However this chapter is concerned only with the selection of coating systems
Many factors will be taken into account when determining the most suitable coating system for a particular situationSometimes a single requirement may determine the type of system Usually however the various factors tend to result in acompromise choice depending on their relative importance and the views of the specifier which may well be determined bypersonal experiences good or bad of a coating system
A limited number of well-recognised factors will generally determine the broad choice of coating Then other factors willbe considered in the final selection
142FACTORS INFLUENCING THE SELECTION OF COATING SYSTEMS
(i) The environmental conditions are clearly of fundamental importance For aggressive situations only highly resistantcoatings will be considered whereas for mild conditions less resistant and usually cheaper coatings may be preferred not onlybecause the coating materials are cheaper but because generally other parts of the coating process eg application are alsomore straightforward (Environmental conditions are considered in detail in Section 143)
(ii) Access for maintenance is clearly an important factor particularly if there is only a limited period during whichmaintenance painting can be carried out eg on an offshore structure If access is both difficult and expensive this willobviously influence the nature of the coating system to be selected On the other hand if access is straightforward although itmay still be desirable to choose a high-quality system it will not be an economic necessity from the standpoint ofmaintenance costs
(iii) Apart from the problem of access the requirements for maintenance will vary and depending on the pattern it may bepreferable to apply less resistant coatings which have advantages eg in application with repainting at regular intervals toensure a sound protective film In other situations there will be a preference for long periods between maintenance
(iv) The importance of the structure will clearly influence the choice of coating system Structures are not all equallyimportant with respect to problems arising from maintenance planned or unplanned The financial losses ensuing from therequirement to take a structure wholly or partly out of service will vary considerably Structures considered important in thesense that problems will be costly to rectify or will produce unwelcome publicity will generally be coated to a higher standardthan others
(v) The facilities to apply the selected coating must be available within the time-requirement of the project Where thecoating system is considered at an early stage then the required arrangements for coating application can usually be organisedthough sometimes at a considerable cost However the choice of eg a galvanised coating would be influenced by theknowledge that the nearest plant was 500 miles from the fabrication shop Again there is a limit to the size of section that canbe galvanised and this would have to be taken into account in the design of some structures Although galvanising has beentaken as an example the situation can arise with all shop-applied coatings and many other coatings which require specialistapplication
(vi) The choice of the coating may well be influenced by the problems of transportation to a site some distance from wherethe coating is applied The resistance of the coating to mechanical damage and the ease and standard of repair of such areaswill be important factors in the selection process
(vii) When cathodic protection is employed then the system chosen must be of the non-saponifiable type which excludesthe commonly used oleo-resinous paints
(viii) The ability to carry out maintenance without undue problems is important and it may be preferable to choose coatingsthat will not require special operations such as blast-cleaning to ensure good intercoat adhesion when repainting
(ix) Ease of application both initially and at maintenance may influence the choice of coating system particularly if theapplication is to be carried out at a site where there is a shortage of skilled operators
(x) Cost is always important and usually plays an important a role in the selection of coatings (see Section 145)(xi) The choice of the coating may be determined by its ability to resist certain chemicals or solvents eg for tank liningsMany other factors can be taken into account Some although not important technically may nevertheless affect the
approach to selection so all of them must be considered at an early stage Typically if the requirement is for a glossy bluefinish a range of materials can be discounted Even if such a material can be applied as a finishing coat to a system of more
190 THE SELECTION OF COATING SYSTEMS
durability but less pleasing appearance overall maintenance requirements will be affected by the need to retain the cosmeticappearance
Experience is clearly an important element to be taken into account when selecting systems provided it actually relates tothe situation in hand Differences in climatic conditions particularly temperature may have a
Table 141Types of environment
Type Description Typical systems
Atmospheric exterior
Slight pollution inland (rural) Areas without heavy industry with low pollution levels A B C N
Polluted inland (semi-industrial) A reasonable level of pollution arising from industrialprocesses sited some distance away Suburban areas of largecities
D N1 P Q1
Highly polluted inland (industrial) High pollution near certain industrial processes air-bornechemical particles and sulphur dioxide
E F R M
Chemical pollution inland (chemical) Near specifie chemical process plants with severe pollutionby specific corrosive species
E F G M
Coastal non-polluted (marine) Near the coast away from industry but with chloridecontamination
B F R1
Coastal polluted (industrial-marine) As above but with additional pollution from industrial orchemical processes
F J K R1 M
Atmospheric interior
Very warm Virtually no condensation typically inside a modern officebuilding
A
Dry some condensation Not always heated so some condensation Typically generalstorage building
B D
Prolonged condensation This covers a range of environments inside buildings whereindustrial processes take place May be very corrosive to steelif chemical fumes persist Typically a pickling shop
F G J M
Immersed Although seawater is generally more corrosive than riverwater from the coating selection viewpoint they can beconsidered as one environment
Cathodic protection L U R T
Splash zone between low and high tides Particularly corrosive to steel More problems than with fullyimmersed because cathodic protection not effective
L U
Soil burial A range of soils of different corrosivity but generally high dutycoatings andor cathodic protection used
Cathodic protection S
Refer to Section 144 for details of systems
considerable effect on the performance of a coating With metal coatings the life may be directly related to the conditions ofexposure and these must be known in some detail before relating the probable performance at one site to that obtained atanother
143SELECTION OF COATINGS FOR SPECIFIC ENVIRONMENTS
Environments can be categorised in different ways but the broad classifications in Table 141 are commonly used Sometimesdescriptive terms such as lsquoRuralrsquo are used and these have been included The table also provides an indication of the types ofsystems that might be used in the particular environments Others could equally well be used but the table serves to showinitial system selection
Of course in practice the local environment is more important than the broad type This is illustrated in Fig 141 whichshows the influence of distance from the coast although all coastal sited structures would be considered to be in the samegeneral coastal environment
When considering the aggressivity it should be appreciated that the environments do not necessarily have the same effecton bare steel and coatings (see Table 142) Environments that would not be considered particularly corrosive to steel maycause early breakdown of some coatings Even the colour of the paint may influence its performance in some environmentsUltraviolet rays from the sun have no significant effect on steel corrosion but can cause breakdown of organic coatings
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 191
The corrosiveness of an environment to steel is important because if the
Table 142Paint performance and steel corrosion in different environments
Type of environment Sheffield Calshot
Exteriorpolluted Coastalnon-polluted
Corrosion rate of bare steel (Uumlmyear) 109 28
Life to first maintenance of oleoresinous paint system (years) 6 6
Data from Sixth Report of the Corrosion Committee Iron and Steel Institute Special Report No 66 London 1959
coating breaks down to allow rusting of steel the rate will influence the course of further coating breakdown
Fig 141 Effect of distance from coast on performance on lamp standard (South East Asia) (a) 10m from costmdashsteel rusting (b) 50m (c)100m
192 THE SELECTION OF COATING SYSTEMS
144CLASSIFICATION OF COATINGS
Hundreds of different coating materials are available and these can be incorporated into an almost indefinite number ofcoating systems However the various coatings fall within fairly easily defined groups Although there are many differenceswithin the groups there are even greater differences between groups Consequently the first stage of selection is to choose thetypes of coating that are likely to be suitable in a particular set of circumstances
To assist in the selection process the various coatings which are discussed in detail in other chapters have been classifiedbelow The main properties are summarised but the sections noted in brackets after each group should be consulted for fullerinformation At the end of each group a number of typical protective systems are listed These should be taken purely as anillustration of the way in which the systems are designed Depending on the actual conditions to which the steel is exposedand other factors to be discussed later other systems may well be superior An increase in the overall thickness of theprotective system will also increase the lsquolifersquo
1441Paints
Oil and Oleo-resinous Paints (Section 491)
(i) Comparatively cheap(ii) Easily applied and maintained
(iii) Some are decorative(iv) Reasonable protection in non-aggressive environments
But note
(i) Saponifymdashcannot be used with cathodic protection(ii) Slowish drying
(iii) Low film thickness
Types within the group
(a) Alkydmdashdecorative gloss(b) Silicone alkydmdashhigh gloss good weathering resistance expensive (c) Urethane alkydmdashbetter abrasion resistance than ordinary alkyd(d) Epoxy estermdashhard improved chemical resistance useful as primer(e) Tung-phenolicmdashnot decorative more resistant than ordinary alkyds
Typical coating systems
A Zinc phosphatemdashalkyd primer 30micro mAlkyd undercoat 25micro mAlkyd undercoat 25micro mAlkyd gloss finish 25micro m
mdash105micro m
Suitable for general steelwork in non-aggressive environments where decorative aspects are importantB Zinc phosphatemdashalkyd primer 75micro m
High-build alkyd undercoat 50micro mHigh-build alkyd gloss finish 75micro m
mdash200micro m
More protective than (A) Would require airless spray application Suitable for general steelwork where decorativeaspects are required
C Zinc phosphatemdashalkyd primer 75micro mHigh-build alkyd undercoat 50micro m
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 193
Silicone alkyd gloss finish 75micro mmdash200micro m
Where high standard of appearance and good weather resistance required Additional cost compared with system (B)D Zinc phosphatemdashepoxy ester primer 50micro m
Tung-phenolic micaceous iron oxide undercoat 50micro mTung-phenolic micaceous iron oxide finish 50micro m
mdash150micro m
More resistant than the alkyd systems to the more polluted
environments but not decorative An additional coat of alkyd finish could be applied to provide a decorative finishGenerally though this type of system is particularly suited to industrial plants
SOLVENT EVAPORATION PAINTS (Section 492)
(i) One-pack chemically resistant(ii) Quick drying
(iii) Some choice of colour(iv) Easy maintenance repainting(v) Do not saponify
But note
(i) Limited temperature resistance(ii) Limited solvent resistance
(iii) Tend to be rather soft and easily damaged in transit so works application often uses a chlorinated-rubberalkyd as alsquotravelrsquo coat
Types within the group
(a) Chlorinated rubber All similar in corrosion(b) Vinyl protection but variations(c) Acrylated rubber in properties(d) Bituminousmdashcheap limited resistance non-decorative(e) Vinyl tarmdashreasonably cheap superior to bituminous
Typical coating systems
E Zinc phosphate-chlorinated rubber (CR) alkyd primer 50micro mHigh-build CR undercoat 75micro mCR finish (gloss) 25micro m
mdash150micro m
Suitable for more aggressive atmospheric environments where appearance is of some importance particularly if somechemical fumes to be resisted
F Zinc phosphate CR primer 50micro mHigh-build CR undercoat 75micro mHigh-build CR finish 75micro m
mdash200micro m
More resistant than (E) but less decorative although colours available Suitable for immersed conditions withadditional coat added for aggressive environment
G Two coats of vinyl tar 250micro m
194 THE SELECTION OF COATING SYSTEMS
A comparatively cheap coating for resistance to chemical and moist atmospheres Not decorativeH Two coats of high-build bitumen 250micro m
A cheap coating for immersed conditions Also can be used for damp internalsituations
CHEMICAL REACTION PAINTS (See Section 493)
(i) The most durable and tough of the paints used for steelwork(ii) Can be applied to greater thicknesses than other types
But note
(i) Two-pack requires more control in mixing and application(ii) High surface preparation standard required
(iii) Old coatings may require abrading before repainting(iv) More expensive than other types
Types within the group
(a) Epoxymdashdifferent curing agents excellent durability range of colours(b) Polyurethanemdashsimilar to epoxy better weathering properties and gloss Good abrasion resistance Moisture-sensitive
during application Graffiti resistant(c) Coal tar epoxymdashcheaper form dark colours mainly for immersion(d) Urethane pitchmdashsimilar to coal tar epoxy(e) Moisture-cured urethanemdashone-pack atmospheric moisture-cured Hard durable coating In some cases can be applied
in adverse weather conditions Graffiti resistant
INORGANIC ZINC SILICATE PAINTS (INORGANIC BINDER) (Section 494)
(i) Hard resistant film used as a primer for other systems or as single coat(ii) Temperature resistant to 400EacuteC
But note Requires care in application
Typical coating systems
J Inorganic zinc silicate primer 25micro mTwo-pack epoxy undercoat 150micro mTwo-pack epoxy finish 150micro m
mdash325micro m
High-durability system for aggressive situations such as offshore platforms Prior to maintenance painting finish mayrequire abrading For ease of maintenance a final coat of chlorinated rubber may be applied
K High-build two pack polyurethane 125micro mAliphatic polyurethane finish 40micro m
mdash165micro m
High durability with high gloss and colour retentionmdashreduces maintenance to a minimumL Three coats of coal-tar epoxy 300micro m
For immersed conditions piling and interiors of tankscontaining suitable aqueous solutions
M Moisture-cured urethane primer 50micro mMoisture-cured urethane undercoat 25micro mMoisture-cured urethane finish 30micro m
mdash105micro m
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 195
For aggressive conditions with the advantages of a one-pack material
ZINC-RICH PAINTS (ORGANIC BINDERS) (Section 494)
(i) Generally used as primer with some galvanic protection properties(ii) Used to repair zinc and aluminium metal coatings Two-pack superior to one-pack binders
1442Metal Coatings (Chapter 7)
ZINC COATINGS
(a) Hot dip galvanised
(i) Durability depends on environment (long life in mild areas) (ii) Most suitable for bolted structures
(iii) Limit on size of dipping baths
(b) Sherardisedmdashused for components to be eventually painted(c) Electroplatedmdashused for components to be eventually painted(d) Sprayed
(i) Problems have arisen when painted(ii) Good durability in milder environments when sealed
(iii) No limit on size (cf hot-dip galvanising)
ALUMINIUM COATINGS
(a) Sprayed
(i) Only practicable way of coating structural sections with aluminium(ii) When sealed provides good durability in a range of environments
Typical metal-coated systems
N Hot-dip galvanised zincmdashabout 85micro m (to BS 729)Long life in many interior situations Life in atmosphere depends on environmentmdashlong life in mild environments
P Thicker coating similar to (N) but steel blast cleaned before galvanisingQ Zinc sprayed (BS 2569 Part 1) 100ndash350micro m
No limitation on size of steel and thicker coatings can be appliedR Aluminium sprayed (BS 2569 Part 1) 100ndash350micro m
Generally improved corrosion resistance compared with (Q) No limitations on size More control required on surfacepreparation and application than with (Q)
Metal coatings plus additional protection All metal coatings can be painted to provide longer life and to improve appearanceHowever sprayed metal coatings are preferably sealed rather than painted Suitable treatment of galvanised surfaces arerequired to ensure good adhesion of paint coating
N1 P1mdashas for N and P with range of paint systemsQ1 R1mdashas for Q and R but sealed
196 THE SELECTION OF COATING SYSTEMS
1443High-Duty Coatings (Chapter 6)
Many are used for specialised situations The following may be used for more general structural steelworks where a highlevel of protection is required
S Coal tar enamel Hot application thick coatings Generally use with glasswrap Used for larger buried or immersedpipes
T Fusion bonded epoxies Used for pipelines particularly smaller-diameter under immersed conditionsU Solventless epoxies Thick coatings can be produced eg 500 Uumlm in one application
145COSTS OF PROTECTIVE SYSTEMS
Some form of economic assessment is required to provide a basis for the selection of protective systems The initial cost isimportant but proper comparisons can be made only by taking into account the total costs over the life of a structure ie allthe maintenance costs added to the initial cost In practice comparative protective coating costs are meaningful only over a periodof about 30 years so for structures with long design lives eg highway bridges there is little point in assessing costs over aperiod of 100 years
To achieve genuine comparisons the costs are usually based on Net Present Value (NPV) The calculation is based on thestandard formula for compound interest
where i is the interest rate expressed as a decimal eg and n is the number of years This formula is the basis of lsquodiscountingrsquoie future value can be discounted to present value If the interest rate is say 10 then if a sum of pound1000 is required in 3yearsrsquo time the present value would be
In other words if pound750 is invested now at 10 it will provide the pound1000 required for maintenance in 3 years time The calculation can be carried out for the lifetime of the structure by adding all the maintenance period costs together If
additionally the initial cost of protection is included then the formula for calculating the total cash required for protectionincluding investing for maintenance ie net present value (NPV) is
where C=initial cost M=maintenanc e cost in year n1 n=number of years to each maintenance period and i=interest rate In practice it is difficult to make accurate assessments of NPV because of the variables such as inflation and interest rates
which cannot be forecast with any certainty On the technical side it is not always an easy matter to predict the time periodbetween maintenance paintings Many other factors can also make long-term forecasting difficult These include thefollowing
(i) Over the lifetime of a structure changes may be made that influence the costs of maintenance Further services may berequired parts may be added or alterations may be made and these may involve increased costs arising from accessdifficulties
(ii) The actual use for which the structure was designed may change so altering the maintenance requirements(iii) The environment may alter for a variety of reasons not least the construction of other plants in the vicinity which may
increase the overall aggressivity of the conditions that the coating has to withstand Furthermore this may increase overallcosts because of the requirement to prevent damage to other structures adjacent to the one being repainted eg from blast-cleaning operations
(iv) The design life of a structure is based on certain long-term assumptions which may change with time This may involvethe closure of plants making a structure obsolete alternatively the life may be increased well beyond the initial intention
(v) Changes in the nature of the area in which a structure is sited may lead to requirements for a higher standard ofappearance so leading to increased maintenance for purely aesthetic reasons
(vi) During the lifetime of a structure new techniques for surface preparation and coating application may be developedThese and the introduction of new coating materials may alter the approach to maintenance and result in a complete re-assessment of the protective requirements
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 197
The overall economic assessment may be outside the control of the specialist concerned with steel protection becauseaccountants will decide the requirements for the return on investment Their techniques will be determined by and theirdecisions will be made on facts and data not necessarily available to the coatings specialist or engineer concerned with theproject Methods such as the lsquointernal rate of returnrsquo may be used to determine the advantages to be gained on different levelsof investment It may be decided that little financial benefit will accrue from a higher initial cost of protection despite thelonger-term benefits of lower maintenance requirements
The engineer or coating specialist should offer clear alternatives with a reasonable assessment of costs and at least for theinitial protection these can be determined with some accuracy
1451Calculating the Costs of Alternative Protective Systems
The basic economic assessment concerns the overall comparison of different systems for protecting a structure The numberof systems suitable for a particular situation will vary In a rural atmosphere almost every possible system could beconsidered whereas for the immersed part of a jetty to be cathodically protected only a limited number of types of systemwould be technically feasible The concept that materials are only a small part of the total cost so that the best coatings shouldalways be used is not necessarily sound Often a high-performance material may cost little more than another less-protectivecoating but the costs of application supervision and maintenance may add considerably to the overall cost
In calculating costs technical and lsquocommon sensersquo aspects should not be ignored The costs that are relevant are thosequoted not general costs provided by a manufacturer or supplier at a time when he is not directly involved in the project
The main costs to be considered are for
(i) Surface preparation(ii) Coating application
(iii) Coating material(iv) Overheads
If a paint system is taken as an example then (i)ndash(iii) above can be established reasonably easily The overheads cover toolsand equipment supervision administration inspection scaffolding delay costs and disruption costs The delay and disruptioncosts may be greater for one system than another and in some cases may be the fundamental factor in choosing a system
The actual costs will be obtained directly from contractors where work is offered to tender or where particular firms areinvited to offer quotations for the protective system In such cases the overhead costs such as tools equipment andsupervision will be included in the overall price As the cost will be based on a specification this must be prepared so thatdisputes are kept to a minimum otherwise costs may well escalate Where the work is being carried out by direct labour allthe overhead costs must be included in the calculations Each of the main factors will be considered briefly
14511Surface Preparation
A cost survey in 1981 indicated that blast-cleaning to Swedish Standard Sa2auml on-site cost about pound5m2 whereas manualcleaning to St2 cost about pound1m2 These figures must be treated with caution because in other surveys costs of manualcleaning have been quoted as half the cost of blast-cleaning When making an economic assessment the actual costs for thespecific job must be used Sometimes quotations will show variation from one firm to another based not on the actual costsbut whether the firm prefers to carry out a particular type of surface preparation
It is impossible to provide actual costs because these will be determined by a range of factors but in general terms thecomparative costs would be
Table 143
Standard of cleaning x(poundunit area)
Sa2 15xndash2x
Sa2auml 2xndash2aumlx
Sa3 2aumlxndash4x
expected to fall within the ranges given in Table 143 For cleaning on-site the costs would be at least 25 and up to 100greater than for cleaning in the fabricatorrsquos shop
198 THE SELECTION OF COATING SYSTEMS
14512Coating Application
In broad terms the labour costs for application are in the ratio of about 1234 for airless spray (the cheapest) air spray rollerand brush On the other hand paint lsquolossesrsquo for the methods are about 30 for air spray and 5 for roller and brush soadditional paint costs must be balanced against labour costs Further additional costs may arise with spraying eg for maskingand protection of adjacent steelwork
Paint and sprayed metal coatings are usually costed by area whereas hot-dip galvanising is costed by weight of steel Thetype of paint influences the application costs Generally alkyd and oil paints would cost 15ndash20 less to apply than the two-pack types of paint A recent survey of application costs for airless spraying showed that for two-pack materials the cost waspound026m2 compared with pound017m2 for oil alkyd and chlorinated rubber paints
14513Coating Materials
The cost of metal coatings can be calculated fairly easily although hot-dipped galvanised coatings are usually specified asweight per unit area and sprayed coatings by thickness For paint coatings prices should not be compared by the price perunit volume of wet paint because of the variations that occur in solids content The factor of importance is the dry film thicknessunit area covered Paints generally have a solids content of 40ndash50 (volvol) but this can be much lower with some resins onthe other hand with solventless paints the solids are virtually 100
Covering powers are quoted by paint manufacturers and these usually include an allowance for losses during applicationSuch losses arise in a number of ways eg by overspraying and paint remaining in the can or application equipment at the endof the day The losses depend on the efficiency of the applicator but some are inevitable Furthermore it is not possible toachieve the exact thickness of paint coating specified so it will in practice be slightly thicker hence requiring additionalpaint Rough surfaces also require additional paint to give adequate coverage
14514Overheads
Overheads may cover a considerable percentage of the total cost of painting They will of course be included in a tender for ajob They are important because if they are more or less fixed irrespective of the paint system to be used then in calculatingthe cost per unit of life of a coating system the longer-life and usually more expensive paints will show to advantage
14515Other Aspects of Coating Economics
Many of the costs involved in coating can be assessed fairly accurately but others are more difficult to calculate The type ofpaint may have an influence quite apart from its durability Typically oil paints with red lead dry slowly and this may add tothe overall cost in the applicatorsrsquo shops or on-site Many epoxy paints will not cure below about 5EacuteC so delays may arise insome circumstances There may be a critical time period for overcoating certain types of paint this may cause problems andadd to the overall cost Some types of paint systems require careful handling to prevent damage during the full-drying periodof the film Stacking of steelwork can be a problem with some paint films because they tend to stick together if not fully dryeg chlorinated rubber When determining comparative costs prior to selection of the coating system specific figures must beused rather than general costs per unit area These costs vary considerably with the type of work and must be taken intoaccount The geometry of the steelwork eg simple surfaces in tanks compared with lattice girders and the problems ofaccess will have a marked influence
1452Initial Costs of Protective Systems
The Steelwork Corrosion Protective Guide (see Further Reading) published jointly by steel paint and metal coating interestsprovides costs for a number of commonly used systems The actual costs are now out of date but the broad comparisons areincluded in Table 144 Clearly there can be widespread variations in practice depending upon the type and situation of thestructure Nevertheless the table provides some indication of initial costs and also requirements for deciding whether coatingsare to be applied in the shop or on site
STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL 199
1453Final Choice of Coating System
The final choice may not be determined on the basis of any sophisticated economic assessment Problems of maintenance maybe such that the most durable system will be chosen A similar decision might be made for a very aggressive environmentSometimes the requirement of corrosion avoidance is strong enough to warrant the lsquobest possible systemrsquo On the other handfor comparatively unimportant structures in rural areas a cheap initial system with either frequent repainting or maintenancelsquoas requiredrsquo may be considered adequate
The thickness of the system will be a determining factor for the durability so the number of coats specified may beimportant The selection
Table 144 Comparative costs of protective systems
Surface preparationa Protective systemb Thickness (micro m) Site- or shop-applied Comparative cost
MC Zinc phosphatealkyd 35 Site x
HB zinc phosphatealkyd 75
HB alkyd 60
BC Sa2auml Blast primer 20 Shop 126x
HB zinc phosphate alkyd 60 Shop
HB alkyd 60 Site
BC Sa2auml Two-pack zinc-rich epoxy 25 Shop 158x
HB zinc phosphatealkyd 75 Shop
MIOalkyd 50 Site
MIOalkyd 50 Site
Pickle Hot-dip galvanisation 85 Shop 116x
Pickle Hot-dip galvanisation 85 Shop
T wash Site 17x
HB chlorinated rubber 75 Site
BC Sa2auml Two-pack zinc-rich epoxy 25 Shop
Two-pack MIOepoxy 85 Shop 17x
Two-pack MIOepoxy 85 Shop
HB chlorinated rubber 75 Site
BCSa2 Hot-dip galvanised 140 Shop 16x
BC Sa3 Sprayed aluminium or sprayed zinc two coats ofsealer
150 Shop 22x
a MC=manually cl eaned BC=blast cl eanedb HB=high build MIO=micace ous iron oxide pigment
of a suitable system is important but surface preparation and application will determine its overall durability To achieve theoptimum durability both good specifications and sound quality control are essential requirements
FURTHER READING
Useful publications on the costs and economic assessment of protective coating systems include the following
Brevoort GH amp Roebuck AM (1979) The simplified cost calculation and comparison of paint and protective coating systems Expandedlife and economic justification Corrosion 79 Paper no 37 NACE Houston 1979
National Association of Corrosion Engineers Direct calculation of economic appraisals of corrosion control measures RP-OZ-72 NACEHouston
Sisler CW Materials Protection 9 (1970) 23Federal Highway Administration Coatings and corrosion costs of highway structural steel Report No FHWA-RD-79ndash121 Washington
1980Roberts JW amp Davis LH Evaluation of bridge corrosion cost model NACE Conference 1982 Paper 140Steelwork Corrosion Protection Guide External Environments Available from Paintmakers Association of Great Britain Ltd London
200 THE SELECTION OF COATING SYSTEMS
CHAPTER 15Protective Systems for Different Situations
151GENERAL STEELWORK EXPOSED TO THE ATMOSPHERE
The choice of coating system will be determined to some extent by the type of structure its relative importance and theenvironment of exposure Metal coatings will often provide long maintenance-free lives in mild environments hot-dipgalvanising sprayed zinc and sprayed aluminium have all been used for this purpose without additional paint coatings Itshould however be appreciated that the corrosion of zinc is closely related to the amount of pollution in the atmosphereConsequently bare zinc coatings are not generally suitable for any but the mildest of atmospheres Even in these conditionsthe appearance of metal coatings is not always particularly satisfactory
Bare hot-dip galvanised coatings can be painted after a period of exposure but on the whole if the galvanised coatings arenot likely to provide 10ndash15 years life before painting it is probably better to paint them initially
Sprayed zinc coatings do not fall into the same category as hot-dip coatings so far as painting is concerned The porousnature of the sprayed coatings leads to problems of satisfactorily cleaning them after a period of exposure Consequentlythere is a strong possibility of failure if the paint coating is applied to weathered zinc-sprayed steelwork If sprayed zinccoatings are to be used they should be sealed Some authorities do not consider sprayed zinc coatings to be suitable for structuresin most situations sprayed aluminium coatings preferably sealed provide long-term protection provided they are properlyapplied to the steelwork Metal coatings are not widely used for steel structures despite their undoubted merits in manysituations However they have been used for electricity transmission towers and for gantries carrying electric cables onrailway systems in both cases at least for the industrial areas paint systems were applied after a period of weathering Metalcoatings particularly hot-dip zinc are useful for rails and balustrades on structures and are recommended as a coating forfasteners
Most steelwork is protected with paint In many ways paint is a more flexible material and can be applied more easily thanmetal coatings particularly on-site The facilities for applying paint are also far more widely available than for other types ofcoating Compared with bare metal coating paint also has the advantage of being available in a wide range of colours and canbe selected to provide a good cosmetic appearance However metal coatings also have advantages over paint coatings Theirlives are more predictable they generally have better abrasion resistance and no drying time is involved which makes foreasier handling They are also more resistant to damage and zinc in particular provides protection of the steel at scratchesHot-dip coatings also have an important advantage which is often overlooked They do not require the somewhat complexprocess of coating which is required for paint Therefore inspection is easier and generally defects in the coating can bereadily observed
Generally for atmospheric structures exposed inland or in non-industrial conditions on the coast oleo-resinous types ofpaint eg alkyd modified phenolic and epoxy esters (particularly for priming coats) are used Silicone alkyd top coats areused in some situations to provide better gloss retention Chlorinated-rubber and vinyl paints are also used quite widely theirchemical-resistance properties are not always required but they are one-pack materials that can be maintained easily and havea high resistance to moisture However they are not particularly suited to conditions of high ambient temperature Except inmarine situations two-pack materials such as epoxies and urethanes are not widely used for general structures in the UK butsuch coatings are being used to a greater extent in other parts of the world
The oleo-resinous coating system is usually applied in three or four coats to provide a suitable total film thickness Thesystem is made up of a primer undercoats and a finishing coat The choice of pigment for the primer is limited in mostcountries by health legislation which has led to a ban on or at least discouragement from using lead pigments and in somecases chromates Consequently zinc-rich or zinc phosphate-pigmented primers tend to be widely used Zinc-rich paints aregenerally formulated as two-pack materials although one-pack formulations can be obtained Zinc phosphate is formulated ina range of binders to suit the rest of the coating system
The overall thickness of the coating influences the lsquolifersquo of the system particularly with thinner film coatings eg 150ndash250micro m For example the recommended thicknesses in BS 5493 (1977) would indicate that on blast-cleaned steel an increase inlife of about 1 year is obtained for an addition of about 20 micro m to the thickness of a chlorinated-rubber system exposed in apolluted inland site
Consideration will now be given to a few typical structures exposed in the atmosphere to indicate specific problems thatmay arise
1511Bridges
The design of the bridge has an important influence on the long-term maintenance requirements and sometimes on theselection of the initial protective coatings The straightforward constructions with beams and girders (continuous or boxgirders) commonly used for highway bridges are easier to protect than the more complex truss and lattice type Suspensionbridges add further problems because of the requirement to protect the cables
Bridges will be exposed in virtually every type of environment from the mild rural atmosphere to the industrial-marinesituation where apart from chlorides industrial pollution may be intense depending upon the industries in the proximity ofthe bridge Large areas of steel are more easily coated than the smaller ones used for trusses with their greater number ofedges and joints
The design of the bridge structure influences coating performance in other ways Because of the construction with a largedeck area rain does not flow from the whole structure as with for example a gantry but tends to collect and run away atselect points such as expansion joints and at the ends of the bridge Often the water collects in an open area of steelworkpromoting coating breakdown Again the undergirders of a bridge may be almost permanently sheltered from the sun andmay remain damp for long periods Paintwork near bearings also tends to break down more rapidly than the freely exposedfacias An additional hazard on many road bridges is the widespread use of road salts which can lead not only to thepremature breakdown of coatings but also to accelerated corrosion of the steel and increased maintenance costs
Very serious corrosion of bridges has occurred in some parts of the world but in view of their importance a high degree ofattention is usually paid to the selection of coating systems Furthermore increased attention to maintenance requirements isbeing given to most bridges Modern bridges are usually blast-cleaned to take a variety of coating systems In the UK theDepartment of Transport has produced its own requirements for protective coatings for bridges based on the environment ofexposure and paints are restricted to a limited number of binders including silicone alkyd modified phenolic chlorinatedrubber and epoxy ester (for primer) Similar systems are in operation in other countries In the USA the use of oleoresinoussystems including lead-based primers continues but there is an increasing use of more resistant paints such as vinyls andepoxies with zinc-rich primers
Non-highway bridges including a large number of rail bridges are protected with a wide range of coatings The generalrequirements are similar to those for road bridges Where colour is not important micaceous iron oxide (MIO) pigments areoften used for the weathering coats
1512Buildings
Steel-framed buildings are often fully encased with masonry or brickwork in which case the selection of the coating systemswill be determined by the protection afforded by the encasement It is often assumed that no water will penetrate encasingmaterials but roofs leak and joints are not always watertight If the designer is satisfied that there will be no ingress of wateronto the steelwork then both the surface preparation and the coating system can be at a low level eg wirebrushing and asuitable primer with possibly a finishing coat Even in this case it may be advantageous to apply a resistant coating eg athick bituminous coating at the foot of columns because if there is any leakage water will tend to collect there If there is anydoubt regarding ingress of water then a full protective system should be applied Where access for inspection is not possiblethis should also be taken into account when selecting the coating system
Simple corrosion-monitoring specimens installed at vulnerable points and withdrawn inspected and weighed at regularintervals can be a useful safeguard and a more sensible and economic approach than initial application of high-performancecoatings which either are unnecessary or if they are necessary to guard against changes in conditions are unlikely to last thelife of the structure Corrosion specimens would give warning of for example accidental water ingress so that the fault couldbe rectified A genuine problem with this approach arises from the requirement for periodic checks on the monitoring deviceHowever this could be included in the maintenance requirements which should be prepared for all structures and buildings
Where steel is fully exposed to the atmosphere then a high-quality paint system applied to blast-cleaned steel or togalvanised steel is essential to ensure long periods between maintenance
202 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
Although there are no basic problems in selecting coating systems for the main steelwork elements in buildings where thesteel is freely exposed difficulties may arise where some form of fire protection has to be incorporated into the overallcoating system Fire protection is a specialised topic and it will not be discussed here but problems may arise inside buildingswhere the steel is protected for fire protection rather than corrosion prevention Some methods of fire protection completelyenclose the steelwork and it may be assumed that this will also act as a protection against corrosion This is not necessarily thecase In dry warm conditions corrosion protection does not have to be of a high quality but in damp situations moisture maywell penetrate to the steel so a reasonably protective coating system should be selected Inside buildings the protective systemwill be determined by the conditions and may have to be of the highest quality eg in electroplating shops In some chemicalatmospheres paints will not provide sufficient protection and specialised coatings may be necessary eg glass-fibre-reinforced plastics However in warm dry conditions conventional alkyd systems will provide adequate performancealthough where colour is not a determining factor hot-dip galvanised coatings should be considered
Although wirebrushing may suffice as the method of preparation for steelwork in many buildings the paint system will lastlonger if applied to blast-cleaned steel
The conditions may be worse than had been anticipated because of combustion products from equipment or in warehousesfor example because doors are left open for prolonged periods In buildings where because of the nature of the equipmentused or because of the type of manufacturing operation in progress eg food processing flakes of paint or rust areunacceptable thorough surface preparation may be essential
When selecting coatings for the interior steelwork of buildings the possibilities of delays in roofing and cladding should betaken into account Coating systems suitable for dry interiors will not necessarily withstand the exterior conditions prevailingbefore the building is completed If this extends for some months re-painting may be required earlier than anticipatedSimilarly long-term protection of steelwork due to delays in construction will lead to the same premature breakdown
1513Storage Tanks (Exterior)
Tank designs range from simple cylindrical shapes to complex spherical structures with architectural connotations Theexterior system will be determined by the environment and other factors considered in Chapter 14 but because of theirdesign tanks often provide special problems Generally they are welded from a number of plates and because of the size ofmany of them they cannot easily be fabricated to the finished product in the shop Consequently there is often a good deal ofwelding on-site To ensure sound performance of the exterior coating all these welds should be blast-cleaned before paintingAs this represents a large percentage of the total area it is often more economic to carry out the cleaning and painting on-siterather than in the shop To some extent this will influence the choice of protective systems particularly if the tank is beingconstructed close to other plants or buildings
For water tanks the American Waterworks Association lists a number of paint systems which are considered suitable forexterior protection These include a threemdashor four-coat alkyd system a two-coat alkyd system with a silicone alkyd finish athree-coat vinyl system and a zinc-rich primer with an alkyd-modified chlorinated-rubber finishing coat These systems willcover the requirements for most environments where a specific colour is specified for the weather coat However if the tankcontains running water colder than the ambient temperature there is a likelihood of condensation on the outside surface andalkyd-based systems are likely to blister For tanks containing materials other than water the exterior coatings must take intoaccount possible spillage and wherever practicable should be chosen with this in mind
152OFFSHORE STRUCTURES
The selection of systems for offshore structures is not a straightforward matter and there is no general agreement on the mostsuitable systems for the different parts of the structure Although the choice of suitable systems to withstand the variousconditions encountered may not be difficult the problems involved in application storage and handling may be immenseGenerally a short delay in commissioning a platform designed for oil or gas production can cost millions of pounds so itwould be misleading to suggest that in all circumstances the protective coatings are the main priority despite the aggressivenature of the environments that the steelwork has to withstand
Maintenance is a problem with offshore structures where accommodation for operatives is limited and the time availablefor painting covers only a few months of the year Furthermore the costs of access are much greater than for onshorestructures A range of coatings has been developed mainly to take account of the difficulties involved in protecting thesestructures
Most large platforms are the responsibility of organisations with technical expertise available but in the future a number ofsmaller structures are likely to be constructed for purposes other than oil production It is therefore worth considering the
PROTECTIVE SYSTEMS FOR DIFFERENT SITUATIONS 203
approach to protection of structures built off the coast An offshore structure has to resist different environmentsatmospheric immersed and splash zone and sometimes depending on the type of structure mud on the sea bed Each ofthese will be considered separately
1521Atmospheric Zone
The approach to coating selection is similar to that for other atmospheric marine environments Generally chemical-resistantcoatings such as epoxies urethanes chlorinated rubber and vinyls will be selected The selection of a particular system isdetermined by the organisationrsquos experience and view of the coatings available As experience is gained at a particulargeographical location eg the North Sea changes are made in the system so that specifications for new structures are oftensignificantly different from those used for the older ones All steel is blast-cleaned to at least Sa2auml and sometimes even toSa3 A blast primer will generally be used to protect the steelwork after blast-cleaning although the system primer may beapplied immediately depending on circumstances such as the requirement for welding
The following systems indicate the approach taken by different organisations They are typical but other systems have alsobeen used
(a) Vinyl system (3ndash4 coats) 200ndash250 micro m(b) Zinc phosphate pigmented two-pack epoxy primer two-pack epoxy (2 coats) 300 micro m(c) Inorganic zinc silicate primer two-pack epoxy (2 coats) 325 micro m(d) Chlorinated-rubber system (3ndash4 coats) 250ndash300 micro m
The dry film thicknesses indicated are for the complete systems Although two-pack epoxy materials are very resistant to the environment they tend to chalk fairly quickly so in some
situations a final coat of urethane has been applied Again because epoxies may require some abrasion to ensure soundadhesion when re-painting chlorinated-rubber finishing coats have been considered as a way of easing maintenancerepainting In the authorsrsquo view this is not a very satisfactory approach because of the problems that may arise if epoxycoatings have to be reapplied at some time This may entail the complete removal of the chlorinated-rubber coating at theareas to be repainted to avoid the possibility of attack by the solvents in the epoxy
1522Immersed Zone
The main control method in this zone is cathodic protection generally without the use of coatings although someorganisations do specify coal-tar epoxide coatings The decision whether or not to use coatings is an economic one Wherecoatings are used fewer anodes will be required to protect the steel and they would be expected to last longer On the otherhand the cost of painting the large areas of submerged steelwork is not inconsiderable and adds to the difficulties of planningand programming the construction work
1523Splash Zone
This is the most aggressive of the three environments considered and because of the conditions where seawater spray iscontinually wetting the area is the most difficult to maintain in a satisfactory manner Generally coatings similar to thoseused for the atmospheric zone are employed in the splash zone usually at a greater film thickness This is not completelysatisfactory but is usually considered to be a practical way of dealing with the situation Sometimes the steel thickness isincreased to act as a lsquocorrosion allowancersquo and to allow for abrasion and wear it is then usually coated with the same systemas the rest of the structure Other more resistant coatings are also employed for example on the hot riser pipes which areparticularly prone to attack in this area The following coatings have been used on different structures
(i) Corrosion-resistant sheathing usually a nickel-copper alloy such as Monel 400 This is fitted round the tubular memberand welded into place to seal gaps between the sheathing and steelwork This is an expensive form of protection and isnot widely used except on hot risers The sheathing can also be torn by impact and seawater can then penetrate betweenit and the steelwork
(ii) Thick rubber or neoprene coatings up to 15 mm in thickness(iii) Various forms of polymeric resins and glass-flake-reinforced polyester material
204 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
In principle special tapes could be used on tubular members but so far as the authors are aware these have not beenused to any extent in practice
153SHIPS
Ships can be considered in the context of structures although some of the problems concerned with the protection andmaintenance of the steelwork are different from those encountered in static marine structures In particular there are twomajor differences from the approach to protection that might be afforded to piers and jetties (i) ships can be dry docked toallow access to the underwater parts for maintenance and (ii) the speed and fuel costs are markedly affected by marinefouling that collects on the hull so additional coatings must be applied to provide anti-fouling properties Nevertheless inbroad terms ships are protected in much the same way as other structures and the same general principles apply In fact thewidespread use of blast-cleaning for structural steelwork owes much to the shipbuilding industry which was among the firstto appreciate the need to provide automatic cleaning facilities as part of the construction process
1531Surface Preparation
Ship plate is commonly blast-cleaned in automatic plants before fabrication It is then usually protected with a suitable blastor prefabrication primer which is quick-drying and can be lsquowelded-throughrsquo Such primers are often applied in an automaticspraying unit direct from the blast-cleaning operation which is carried out in a centrifugal type machine Often a pre-heatingplant is used to warm the steel before entry into the blast-cleaning plant to improve adhesion of the primer particularly in coldweather
Generally the standard is to Sa2auml or the equivalent For some coatings Sa3 may be specified As shipyards are on thecoast particular attention must be paid to the effects of chloride which may contaminate the surface in the form of NaCl(sodium chloride) or produce chloride-containing corrosion salts during the storage of the ship plate
1532Areas to be Protected
Protective treatments vary with the particular areas of the ship under consideration The main areas are as follows
(i) Underwater plating shipsrsquo bottoms which are completely immersed in service(ii) Boot-top plating which is somewhat similar to the splash zone and parts may be more or less completely immersed
depending on the loading of the ship(iii) Topside and superstructure exposed to the atmosphere and affected by sea salts(iv) Cargo holds and tanks carrying a variety of different materials(v) Ballast tanks containing seawater
(vi) Accommodation units which on exterior surfaces may be exposed to conditions similar to those of the topside(vii) Machinery rails etc on decks
(viii) Machinery internal which will have to withstand oil grease and seawater from leaking pipes
In the next few sections a broad outline of the types of coating systems used will be given However selection of protectivecoatings for ships is a specialist undertaking and the specification will usually be prepared by those who are knowledgeable ina particular field eg naval vessels oil tankers or small work boats Each of these has different requirements
1533Underwater Plating
The conditions that have to be resisted by the underwater plating include seawater which is a high-conductivity electrolyteabrasion and the possibility of damage particularly in harbours Furthermore as most shipsrsquo hulls are cathodically protectedthe coating must be resistant to saponification so excluding conventional oleo-resinous paints from consideration Thefollowing types of binders are generally used for underwater plate coal-tar epoxy chlorinated rubber vinyl and bitumen orpitch To differentiate these coatings from the anti-fouling coatings they are commonly termed lsquoanti-corrosive or ACcompositionsrsquo The thickness applied will depend upon the type of ship and the conditions it will have to withstand and canvary from 200 to 600 micro m total film thickness
PROTECTIVE SYSTEMS FOR DIFFERENT SITUATIONS 205
Although with modern painting high-build coatings can be applied in one application it is usual to apply a multi-coatsystem to avoid the possibilities of pinholes in the coating Some authorities consider that zinc-pigmented primers should notbe employed for underwater service while others consider them to be suitable there is conflicting evidence on this aspect andadvice should be sought from paint manufacturers when selecting primers
1534Anti-fouling Paints
As already noted the attachment of fouling to shipsrsquo hulls impairs the operational efficiency of the ship so special coatingsare applied over the anti-corrosive compositions Most anti-fouling coatings incorporate biocides such as copper and itscompounds to control fouling by poisoning the growths Other compounds such as mercury and arsenic are also used andbecause copper compounds are expensive other substances have been investigated as replacements and are in some casesemployed in anti-fouling coatings
The anti-fouling paints work by providing a concentration of poison in the vicinity of the painted surface Provided this ismaintained at a suitable concentration all fouling organisms will be killed Such paints must therefore be formulated so theycan supply the toxins at a suitable rate while at the same time supplying sufficient coating life to allow for reasonable periodsbetween dry dockings Two main types of coating are used In the one commonly used for many years the paint matrixremains unattacked and the toxin particles are leached out at the required rate A more recent development is a coating with asoluble matrix which is often described as a lsquoself-polishingrsquo type In this type layers of the paint containing the toxin areremoved to provide the necessary concentration of poison This has an advantage because suitable coloured layers can beincorporated to provide an indication of the level of toxin left in the paint Furthermore there may be some advantage in thecontinuously smoother surface produced with this type of coating
Anti-fouling paints containing copper or mercury should never be applied directly to the steel surface because of thepossibility of galvanic attack The performance of anti-fouling coatings may be affected by the action of the anti-corrosivecompositions and tie coats over which they are applied It is therefore advisable to contact the coating manufacturerto ensure compatibility of all the coats in the system It is usual to apply a barrier coat over the remains of any old anti-foulingcoats eg aluminium-pigmented bitumen when applying further anti-corrosive coatings during maintenance painting
1535Boot Topping
As the boot-topping area is similar to the splash zone high-quality protective coatings must be selected On some ships thedecorative aspects may be important so coloured finishes are employed Cathodic protection is not effective in this areabecause it is often not immersed in the sea Nevertheless the coatings for this area are often similar to those selected for theunderwater plates although epoxy polyamides may be used in preference to coal-tar epoxies
1536Topsides and Superstructures
In many ways the approach to the selection of coatings for these areas is similar to that for general structures exposed toatmospheric marine conditions The decorative aspects may be important particularly for passenger ships because of themoist atmosphere the coatings have to withstand small spots of rust generally produce a considerable amount of rust stainingParticular attention should be paid to edges and welds to ensure coating integrity
Alkyds particularly silicone alkyds chlorinated rubber vinyl and epoxies are all used for these situations The systems aregenerally of three or four coats including suitable primers and the dry film thickness is 175ndash 200 micro m
1537Steel Decks
Steel decks are difficult to protect satisfactorily because of the combined effects of corrosion abrasion wear and therequirement for safety reasons of non-slip properties The non-slip requirements are generally obtained by using speciallyformulated paints containing grit or by adding suitable grit to the finishing coat Sprayed metal coatings have also been usedon some decks
Although alkyds chlorinated-rubber and bituminous coatings have been used for weather decks where there is heavytraffic epoxies and urethanes are commonly preferred Zinc silicates have also been used but are not suitable where the cargoesare of an acid or alkaline nature The coating thickness will depend on the conditions of use but may be 450 micro m or even more
206 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
1538Machinery Pipes etc
Often these are supplied fully coated or at least primed and it is difficult to generalise on the selection of coatings because theconditions vary so much Coatings similar to those used for the superstructure are suitable
Machinery in the bilge areas and below deck level may have to withstand oil grease steam and seawater Careful attentionis required to such areas and the application of a high-quality coating such as an epoxy during ship construction will bebeneficial However because of conditions difficulties of access for re-painting and the inevitable damage that will occur theproblems may be of design more than of protection
1539Cargo and Ballast Tanks
These tanks may have to withstand very aggressive conditions not only from the nature of the cargoes carried but also fromseawater ballast and washing-out Although crude oil leaves a wax-type film on the surface of the tank and may provide someprotection it is not continuous Consequently any seawater ballast can result in local attack and pitting Some crude oilscontain sulphur compounds which may react to form acids which will of course attack the steel Refined oil products providelittle protection The coating or lining for the tank must be selected to withstand the corrosive effects of the cargo and a widerange of coatings is used depending on the requirements
However it is generally possible to find an epoxy system with a carefully selected curing agent which providing it can beapplied correctly will withstand most cargoes
Where ballast tanks are permanently filled with seawater cathodic protection is a suitable control measure Where the tanksare out of ballast for reasonably long periods a joint cathodic protection-coal-tar epoxide coating is often used
Owing to the problems of protecting cargo tanks methods other than conventional coatings are widely used These include
(i) Dehumidification to remove moisture from empty tanks or above oil cargoes(ii) Inhibitors
(iii) Oil films floated on the surface of the ballast water(iv) Injection of inert gases to remove oxygen(v) Wax and grease coatings
15310Freshwater Tanks
Tanks for non-potable water can be coated with bituminous solutions or coal-tar epoxies usually to a thickness of 150ndash200micro m However a non-tainting coating must be used for drinking water This may be a suitably formulated bituminous paint orcertain epoxies Clearly the regulations governing coatings for potable water must be complied with
154CHEMICAL PLANTS
The approach to the selection of coating systems will be determined by the nature of the plant and the processes being carriedout which will influence the local environment in a number of ways Emission of polluted gases although generally subjectto government regulations in most countries still occurs and leakages from joints are by no means unusual The coatings to bechosen must therefore take into account the actual conditions that are likely to be encountered in practice No matter howcarefully coatings are selected initially if there is not a properly organised maintenance programme then serious problemswill almost certainly arise in some plants
On many structures such as highway bridges the amount of corrosion occurring where coatings break down is not likely tocause serious structural problems if maintenance is delayed for a year or two The maintenance costs will increase but in mostenvironments the loss of steel by corrosion will be acceptable This is equally true of many chemical plants but with othersspillage and leakage of chemicals if not suitably resisted by appropriate coatings will result in serious corrosion oftennecessitating the replacement of sections of the plant
For steelwork exposed in corrosive areas blast-cleaning is essential before application of paint coatings If the steel hasbeen stored in the plant for any length of time the rust will contain corrosive salts and these will not be removed by hand-cleaning methods such as wire brushing so premature breakdown of coatings applied over the rusty steel will occur In somesituations thick grease paints may be applied over rusted steel but generally these will not be used on plants where
PROTECTIVE SYSTEMS FOR DIFFERENT SITUATIONS 207
personnel can come into contact with the surface In the most corrosive areas where acidic or alkaline fumes are present orwhere the corrosive fluids are in contact with the steel even thick paint coatings may not suffice and glass-reinforced plasticmaterials or other high-duty coatings discussed in Chapter 6 may be required Such coatings must be applied with great carebecause if corrosive solutions are able to penetrate damaged areas of the coating serious corrosion can occur For the averagetype of chemical environment the high-resistance paints such as epoxies urethanes chlorinated rubbers and vinyls willgenerally provide adequate protection provided they are applied to a reasonably high film thickness of at least 200 micro m
In America zinc silicate coatings are widely used as primers with systems based on the above binders This primer is not sowidely used in many other parts of the world where a primer based on the main binder used for the undercoats and finishingcoats is used A particular problem occurs with the exterior surfaces of machinery and equipment eg pumps and valveswhich are often supplied with the manufacturerrsquos coating system This may be satisfactory in some situations but often thecoating is not adequate for the conditions It is virtually impossible to obtain equipment painted to the clientrsquos specification soadditional coats should be applied where this is practicable Alternatively the coatings should be removed by blast-cleaningwhere this will not cause damage to the equipment and re-painted to a satisfactory standard
Tapes can be used to protect pipes but care must be taken to ensure that the steel is well cleaned before wrapping and thatthe manufacturerrsquos procedures are correctly followed Regular examination is advisable because if there is ingress ofmoisture to the steel quite severe corrosion may occur without any obvious deterioration of the tape Pipes are usually colourcoded and this must be taken into account Often the conditions are sufficiently corrosive to preclude the use of any coatingin which case suitably resistant alloys must be used However for many situations in chemical plants where there is unlikelyto be condensation on the surface oleo-resinous paints will be suitable the choice will depend on the environment and thetype of plant
It is always advisable to carry out an inspection of newly painted steelwork within a few months of application Small areasof damage should be touched up immediately after erection but further damage tends to happen during the first few months asadditional services are added If at this inspection there are clear signs of early coating failure suitable action should betaken before this spreads over a larger area of the plant
155OIL REFINERIES AND INSTALLATIONS
Oils are used as temporary protectives for steel so it might be assumed that protection of steelwork in oil installations wouldnot be a problem In fact crude oil can be very corrosive and often other corrosive chemicals are produced in these plantsFurthermore there are considerable temperature variations on the exterior surfaces of different parts of the plant arising fromthe process operations with consequent expansion and contraction of the surfaces To meet these and other requirements theexternal steelwork should be blast-cleaned generally to Sa2auml and epoxies or similar resistant coatings applied to surfacesexposed to the atmosphere Coal-tar epoxy can be used for any underwater or buried steelwork probably with cathodicprotection Hot-dip galvanised coatings may be considered for less corrosive areas where colour is not important
156SEWAGE SYSTEMS
The major corrosion problem with the immersed parts of sewage systems occurs when hydrogen sulphide is generated Thegas is produced bacteriologically in the sewage accumulating in slimes and sludges where anaerobic conditions exist Thehydrogen sulphide tends to be absorbed onto surfaces and is oxidised to form sulphuric acid The problem is accelerated inhot climates or where industrial acid wastes are also discharged into the sewer Correct design of the system such as ensuringthat the sewage stays oxygenated as long as possible and that the sewer is well ventilated is the best approach to corrosioncontrol However most metals in the system will require some form of protection by coatings Such coatings should have ahigh water resistance and good resistance to impact damage The coating should also be capable of patch repair
For the interior of pipelines PVC linings are increasingly being used If in situ coating is required the choice is often an aminecured coal-tar epoxy The use of solventless coal-tar epoxies is considered to have advantages This would reduce thepossibilities of pinholes but requires sophisticated equipment and skilled operation to apply The method allows theapplication of very thick quick-drying films of paint but this also emphasises the need for a high standard of surfacepreparation notably surfaces free from contamination and rough enough to provide an adequate key
For the steelwork in aggressive atmospheric environments two-pack epoxies are preferred and a cosmetic finish withexcellent weathering properties can be obtained by making the final coat one based on a two-pack polyurethane Repair orrepainting of such systems requires at least sweep blasting or abrading of the surface For steelwork in a relatively non-aggressive atmosphere but in damp conditions the chlorinated rubber or vinyl systems are suitable These are available inlight decorative colours and if in good condition can be repaired or repainted without extensive surface preparation
208 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
157SHEET PILING
Sheet piling is used for retaining purposes and is not always coated If for example it is used as temporary piling duringexcavation prior to foundation construction it probably will not be painted Generally where it is driven into soils it is notcoated except under conditions that are particularly corrosive In such situations cathodic protection may be used
One of the most aggressive environments for piling is on the coast where it may be used for harbour and dock installationsor on beaches as groynes The conditions involve four zones similar to those on an offshore structure atmospheric intertidal(splash zone) immersed in the sea and buried in the ground Generally problems arise at the intertidal and immersed areasThe protection of the area exposed to the atmosphere is not usually a problem and it can be repainted without great difficultyThe part buried in the soil does not usually require a coating but the immersed and intertidal zones are generally coated Apartfrom the difficulties of maintenance painting these areas are prone to damage whether in harbours or on beaches Oneapproach is to use thicker steel to provide a lsquocorrosion allowancersquo possibly with a coating Alternatively or additionallycathodic protection may be used for the immersed zone
There is no general agreement on the most economic coating system for sheet piles A number of comprehensive testprogrammes have been conducted on a variety of coatings but it is difficult to draw any firm conclusions from the resultsThey vary depending on the particular test programme Some coatings have performed well in most tests eg neoprene butthis would be considered too expensive for most situations Sprayed aluminium coatings have also performed well in anumber of tests On the more conventional coatings for this purpose coal-tar epoxies have generally performed well In oneseries of tests the performance of these coatings was inferior when applied to bare blast-cleaned steel compared withapplication to a zinc silicate primer On the other hand an organic zinc-rich paint was much less effective under immersedconditions
Isocyanate-cured pitch epoxies have performed well in some tests but the selection of suitable coatings will be influencedby the likelihood of damage In many situations cathodic protection would be advisable Often the reverse of the pile in seawaterconditions can be protected without difficulty but cathodic protection can be applied to both sides of sheet piles
158JETTIES AND HARBOURS
In some ways the problems are similar to those experienced by sheet piling in the sense that the steelwork has to withstandthe conditions produced by the four zones atmospheric splash immersed and buried or mud-line
The selection of suitable coatings for the atmospheric zone is not a problem and will be determined by the factorsconsidered for other situations eg
(i) Difficulties of access for maintenance(ii) Periods required between maintenance re-paintings
(iii) Difficulties arising from loss of use of facilities during maintenance(iv) Appearance including colour(v) Geographical situation
(vi) Likelihood of damage arising from the use of the facilities eg ships damaging paintwork(vii) Whether the facilities are part of an industrial complex with pollution of the air in addition to air-borne sea salts
(viii) Possibility of abrasion from industrial processes
Metal coatings particularly hot-dip galvanised steel (painted) in the atmospheric zone and sealed sprayed aluminium coatingsin the immersed zone may be considered in some situations However both metals act sacrificially in seawater and problemsmay arise if they are connected to large areas of adjacent bare steel or poorly coated steel because the metal coatings willcorrode rapidly to protect areas of bare steel Generally resistant coatings such as epoxies and chlorinated rubber will beconsidered for long-term protection of steelwork exposed in the atmosphere although conventional oleo-resinous coatingswill be suitable for many situations provided maintenance painting is carried out regularly
For the immersed and splash zones coal-tar epoxies or urethane pitches will generally be selected preferably with cathodicprotection Where long-term protection is essential in some situations solventless epoxies and other special materials appliedas thick coatings may be preferred The selection of coatings for the interior surfaces of tanks and the external surfaces ofpipelines is discussed in Chapter 6
PROTECTIVE SYSTEMS FOR DIFFERENT SITUATIONS 209
159STEEL IN REINFORCED CONCRETE
Two of the materials most commonly used for structures and large buildings are steel and reinforced concrete This book isconcerned primarily with structural steel but many of the problems that arise with reinforced concrete result from thecorrosion of the steel reinforcements or rebar as they are commonly called
Cases of corrosion of rebar with subsequent serious deterioration of concrete structures have been reported over manyyears However in the last 10ndash15 years the problem has taken on a new significance both in buildings and structuresParticularly severe corrosion has occurred on many large bridge decks in North America
For many years the general view was that unlike steel structures those of reinforced concrete were not subject tosignificant corrosion However in many situations this has proved not to be so and attention is being focused on the problem
1591Concrete
The corrosion of rebar is basically the same as for any other steel but to appreciate the particular problems that occur withconcrete it is necessary to look at some of the properties of this material Concrete is produced from the followingconstituents
(i) Cement(ii) Fine aggregate eg sand
(iii) Coarse aggregatemdashgravel or crushed rock(iv) Water
Additionally other materials called admixtures may be used to modify the properties of the concrete Of the variousconstituents cement is the most important from the corrosion standpoint
15977Cement
Cement is produced by mixing suitable components such as limestone and clay and heating them to about 500EacuteC Thisproduces a series of reactions that result in a mixture of calcium silicate aluminates or aluminoferrites When these are mixedwith water to produce mortar or cement the important aspect so far as corrosion is concerned is the alkaline nature of the finalproduct
15912Admixtures
Admixtures of inorganic or organic materials are added immediately before or during mixing to modify the properties in someway eg to increase or decrease the setting time Of these calcium chloride used as an accelerator is the one that mostinfluences corrosion because of its chloride content
15913Basic Chemistry of Concrete
In the setting of concrete as the aggregates are basically inert they have little direct influence on the concrete The exceptionis when aggregates contain chloride eg sand from near the coast The main reaction of interest is that between the cementand water which provides material for the lsquocementingrsquo together of the constituents and produces the density hardness andstrength of the concrete
When water is added the reactions with cement are fairly complex and are described in detail in text books on concreteBasically a series of hydrates are formed eg calcium silicate hydrate calcium aluminate and calcium aluminoferritehydrates The reactions which may continue in wet concrete for some time lead to a hardening of the concrete
The important aspect of these reactions from the corrosion standpoint is the alkalinity produced both in the mass of thematerial and in the moisture remaining in the pores and capillaries Additionally chlorides if present react with calciumaluminate and calcium aluminoferrite to form insoluble chloroaluminates and chloroferrites in which chloride is found in anon-active form In practice the reaction is not complete so some active soluble chloride will remain in the concrete
210 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
Nevertheless concretes or cements with a high proportion of these phases reduce the availability of chlorides which as willbe discussed later is a primary cause of steel corrosion
15914Properties of Reinforced Concrete
Although strong in compression concrete is weak in tension so steel reinforcement bars or meshes are used to improve thetensile strength Steel does not normally corrode in an alkaline environment however in some circumstances which will bediscussed in detail later problems can arise if certain corrosive species are available to react with the steel The properties ofthe concrete that have the most influence on the diffusion or ingress of these species are its permeability and porosity whichare to some extent controlled by the mix of the concrete
1592The Corrosion of Rebar in Concrete
The mechanism of steel corrosion has been considered in Chapter 2 and this is applicable to rebar corrosion Basically theprocess can be divided into reactions that occur at the anode and those occurring at the cathode with the reactants combiningto form ferrous hydroxide which is oxidised to rustmdashFe2O3H2O The corrosion occurs at the anodic areas
In alkaline solutions steel becomes passive ie a protective film is produced which prevents these reactions occurring orif they do occur the corrosion is very slight As concrete produces an alkaline reaction little or no corrosion of the steel occursprovided the passive film remains intact However certain corrosive species such as chlorides can attack the film or diffusethrough it so allowing corrosion to occur Passivity can also be broken down by the ingress of acid solutions which neutralisethe alkalinity
Processes which lead to the breakdown of the passive film will be considered next
15921Breakdown of Passivity
Passivity can be broken down by natural deterioration of concrete called carbonation or by ingress of corrosive speciesespecially chlorides
15922Carbonation
Air contains a number of acidic gases in particular carbon dioxide and sulphur dioxide Concrete is permeable and allows theslow ingress of these acidic gases which react with the alkaline components in the concrete eg calcium hydroxide to formcarbonates and sulphates at the same time neutralising the alkalinity
These reactions result in what is termed a carbonated layer in the concrete so called even if sulphates predominate If thecarbonated layer reaches the steel surface then as the environment is no longer alkaline passivity breaks down and the steel isnot protected from corrosion This situation can arise as follows
(i) Over a period of time carbonation may progress to the point where it reaches the steel reinforcement The rate ofcarbonation in most sound concrete is generally low under auml mm per year so if the depth of cover is 20mm thereinforcements will be in an alkaline environment for a long time Where the depth of concrete cover is 50ndash70 mm thenno problems should arise during the design life of most structures provided other factors do not lead to a loss ofpassivity
(ii) Certain types of cracks formed by shrinkage or loading may allow the ingress of acid species and the carbonated layerso formed may reach the steel even though the general cover is adequate Many factors will determine the probability ofcorrosion arising from cracks eg their depth and width whether they move as a result of alternating loads and thedegree to which they are self-sealed by corrosion products debris etc so preventing the ingress of corrosive species
(iii) Where reinforcement bars or mesh are not correctly placed local reductions in cover may occur with premature failureof passivity of the steel at a few places This may be superficial but in some circumstances can lead to more generalfailure
PROTECTIVE SYSTEMS FOR DIFFERENT SITUATIONS 211
15923Chlorides
Chloride ions can penetrate the passive film or may replace hydroxyls in its structure so destroying passivity at least locallyIf sufficient chloride is present then general passivity breakdown occurs Chlorides react with calcium aluminate and calciumaluminoferrite in concrete to form insoluble compounds However some active chloride always remains free to reducepassivity and promote corrosion Chlorides may arise from the material used to make the concrete or from external sources
Chlorides in concrete Chlorides may be present in the aggregates if they are taken from marine environments or they maybe present in the water if this is of a saline nature Although problems have arisen from such chloride-containing materialsparticularly in the Middle East there is now a general appreciation of the inadvisability of using such materials forreinforced concrete Some admixtures particularly calcium chloride used as a set-accelerator may also cause corrosionproblems
Chlorides from external sources The two sources of external chlorides are
(i) Seawater which contains a high proportion of chlorides(ii) De-icing salts such as sodium chloride used to reduce the freezing point of ice particularly on bridge decks
Chloride concentration There appears to be no definite threshold level of chloride below which corrosion is unlikely to occurVarious figures have been used eg 015 (based on cement content) in a bridge deck has been stated to be safe with nolikelihood of corrosion whereas over 03 chloride is a cause for concern Chloride limits for cement mixes have been set byvarious authorities eg 2 CaCl2 as a limit but there appears to be no general agreement on threshold levels
15924Influence of Concrete on Corrosion
Corrosion will occur only if the corrosive species reach the steel surface so the permeability of the concrete has an influenceWith sound aggregate the best path for the ingress of corrosive ions is the cement phase the permeability of which will beinfluenced by the water to cement (WC) ratio A low WC ratio reduces permeability so retarding the ingress of ions to thesteel surface
Other aspects of the concrete mix influence to a greater or lesser extent the overall protective value of the concrete egaggregate grading degree of compaction adequacy of cure These and the earlier factors considered all affect permeabilitywhich has a direct relation to corrosion Additionally high permeability will increase the rate of carbonation
15925Concrete Cover
It has been established in test work and from practical experience that the cover ie the thickness of concrete covering thesteel is of fundamental importance to the protective qualities of concrete Adequate cover will ensure that carbonation doesnot reach the steel surface so decreasing the overall permeability of the concrete Standards and Codes of Practice egBSCP114 Part 2 lsquoStructural use in reinforced concrete in buildingsrsquo indicate the correct cover for different situations
1593Types of Failure with Reinforced Concrete
The basic problem with the corrosion of reinforcing bars arises not so much from loss of strength but from the bulky corrosionproducts that are formed
The rust exerts a considerable degree of force on the concrete in contact with it Possibly as much as ten times theconcretersquos tensile strength As the concrete has a low degree of elasticity the force leads to cracking delamination and eventualspalling of the concrete This results in loss of protection to the reinforcing bars and the danger arising from pieces of concretefalling from the structure or building The various forms of failure tend to be progressive with cracks leading to spalling
The early stages of corrosion are not necessarily visible so a structural survey must take this into account Delaminationmay not be obvious without close examination The rust may have forced the concrete away from the reinforcement but thecracks may not be obvious at that stage although the concrete has in fact failed Often the depth of cover determines whether acrack or delamination occurs
212 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
1594Corrosion Control Methods
Control methods should be incorporated before corrosion occurs and a number of approaches have been used
(i) Ensuring that the concrete is of a high standard with low permeability and with adequate cover to the steel(ii) The use of suitable membranes for waterproofing to reduce the ingress of moisture chlorides etc
(iii) Protecting the reinforcements with suitable coatings Zinc in the form of galvanised coatings and powder epoxycoatings have been used
(iv) Retarding the ingress of ions into the concrete Various coatings have been applied to the exterior surfaces of theconcrete structure or building to achieve this
(v) Using corrosion-resistant reinforcements eg stainless steel or carbon steel clad with stainless steel or nickel(vi) Cathodic protection has also been used to retard further attack where corrosion of rebars has already occurred
Other methods have also been considered but have limited practical value These include inhibition of the concrete and theuse of wax beads and other suitable materials to seal the internal pores of the concrete
15941Coatings
Coatings have been used in two different ways (a) application to the concrete surface to retard the ingress of corrosivespecies particularly chlorides (b) Coating of the rebars to protect them from attack
Coating of concrete Various methods have been used
(i) Paint coatings such as epoxies chlorinated rubbers and vinyls(ii) Sealers that penetrate the concrete to some extent eg epoxies and acrylics
(iii) Renderings of thick coatings eg epoxy mastics applied by trowel They also tend to fill in minor surface defects(iv) Materials that block the concrete pores eg silicates and polyurethanes
The concrete has to be properly prepared to ensure that the coatings adhere properly Their effectiveness has not beenestablished and investigational work is in progress to provide long-term data
Coating of rebar Two particular coatings have been used for this purpose (a) hot-dip galvanised zinc (b) powder epoxies(i) Hot-dip galvanised rebar There are differing views on the effectiveness of zinc-coated rebar Tonini and Cook1
conclude that zinc-coated bars offer a minimum performance enhancement over unprotected bars of at least four times Theirpaper and others produced by lsquozinc interestsrsquo demonstrate this enhanced performance However other authorities are not soenthusiastic The test methods used to obtain some of the data have been under scrutiny It is probably fair to say that in casesof loss of alkalinity due to carbonation or low concrete cover galvanising the rebar is an effective way of retarding the onsetof corrosion However the reduction in corrosion where high chlorides prevail is less marked A restriction on the use ofgalvanised rebar is the general requirement for bending of the bars before rather than after galvanising Additionally zinccorrodes in highly alkaline situations so that while the steel may be protected problems may arise from the zinc corrosionproducts
(ii) Epoxy-coated rebar Fusion-bonded epoxy coatings have been used for rebar since the early 1970s They are similar tothose used for pipelines and have been discussed in Chapter 6 They should not be confused with the paints used on concretesurfaces Epoxy-coated rebars are specified in North America for a number of situations particularly for bridge decks Theyhave not been widely used in the UK partly because of problems with standards It seems likely that they will be used to agreater extent in future Problems such as damage to the coating may occur but practical data on their performance areencouraging
15942Cathodic Protection
Where rebars have corroded to produce deterioration of concrete cathodic protection has been employed as an alternative toconcrete removal and repair The high electrical resistivity of concrete means that specially designed systems are requiredwith specially designed anodes Wyatt and Irvine2 have produced a useful review and a book on this topic has recently beenpublished3 The basic principles of cathodic protection are discussed in Chapter 13
PROTECTIVE SYSTEMS FOR DIFFERENT SITUATIONS 213
REFERENCES
1 Tonini DE amp Cook AR The performance of galvanised reinforcement in high chloride environments NACE compilation ofpapers on Rebar Corrosion 1976ndash1982 NACE Houston
2 Wyatt BS amp Irvine DJ A review of the cathodic protection of reinforced concrete Materials Performance 26(12) (1987) 12ndash213 Berkeley KGC amp Pathmanaban S Cathodic Protection of Reinforcement Steel in Concrete Butterworths London 1990
214 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
CHAPTER 16Testing of Coatings
161INTRODUCTION
It is virtually impossible to predict the lsquolifersquo of organic coating systems from a knowledge of their formulations even if thesewere available to users which normally they are not A good deal of performance data are available for metallic zinc coatingsand to a lesser extent for aluminium so it is possible to provide a reasonable assessment of their performance in manysituations It is not possible to provide similar data for organic coatings such as paint Even within generic groups eg chlorinatedrubber there can be wide differences so the performance of a paint supplied by one manufacturer will not necessarily be thesame as that from others Additionally the performance of any paint is significantly influenced by the surface preparation ofthe steel prior to coating and the application of the paint Hence data on lives of coatings have to be obtained in one of twoways (a) experience of a coating in a situation similar to that where it is to be used and (b) by carrying out tests
Experience is important when selecting coatings but some caution is required The conditions of exposure the surfacepreparation and the type of structure should be very similar when applying previous performance data to predict futureperformance of a coating Furthermore the coating must be very similar and this should be checked with the manufacturer toensure that the formulation has not been changed in any significant way
Apart from the lsquolifersquo of the coating other aspects of performance eg drying time and hardness may also be required andagain tests have been devised to check on many of these There are other reasons for testing and generally they fall into one orother of the following categories
(i) Development of new coating materials(ii) Comparative tests to determine the best coatings for a particular situation
(iii) Quality control measures for coatings and coating materials(iv) Specialised tests for determining the composition of paints particularly for failure investigations
There is also investigational work or research on the fundamental properties of coatings and their mode of protection Suchwork is carried out by large paint and material manufacturers universities and organisations concerned with research This isnecessary for obtaining a fundamental understanding of coatings and leads to the development of new and improved materialsand application procedures The detailed work and the results obtained are published in journals and discussed at conferencesGenerally the results and data produced are of more interest to those involved in research and development of coatings thanto users The methods and techniques employed in research will not be discussed in any detail here because they go beyondthe requirements of testing and form a specialist topic
Users and specifiers of protective coatings may carry out the tests themselves or use data supplied by others such as paintmanufacturers These will usually fall within groups (ii) or (iii) above It is always essential to check that the results of the testare valid for the situation where they are to be applied This is particularly important when studying the results of tests carriedout by other organisations Typically if the tests are carried out on coatings applied to cold-reduced steel panels thecomparisons between different coatings may be valid but the actual lsquolifersquo obtained may not provide a good indication of thedurability of the coating when applied to other types of surface
The methods of carrying out tests can also be divided into a number of categories
(i) Tests on the dried film to determine and check the physical and mechanical properties of films eg hardness andabrasion resistance usually carried out in a laboratory
(ii) Measurement of properties of the dried film such as film thickness and freedom from pores often carried out on-site(iii) Tests of properties of the liquid paint eg viscosity and specific gravity
(iv) Laboratory tests to determine the ability of the coating to resist certain environmental conditions eg salt-spray testsThese are sometimes called lsquoaccelerated testsrsquo
(v) Tests carried out on coated steel in a natural environment often at special test sites These are generally termed lsquofield testsrsquo (vi) Determination of the performance of a coating on an actual structure These may be called lsquoservice trialsrsquo but equally
they may be used to monitor the performance of coatings
Each of these methods of testing will be dealt with but first some general points concerned with testing will be considered
162TEST REQUIREMENTS
Of the various test requirements the most difficult to achieve is that of durability Tests of the paint system to be used in theenvironment where a structure is to be constructed are likely to provide the most realistic results but the time factor precludesthe use of such tests for most situations Although it is not always a requirement that coatings should be tested to failure aprolonged period of testing is inevitable particularly for modern high-performance paints Attempts have been made todevelop more rapid ways of assessing coating performance but with limited success
A lack of precision with tests is often excused on the grounds that lsquoat least it separates the sheep from the goatsrsquo Unfortunatelyeven this is not necessarily so For example sample panels prepared with artificially thick films of paint on small test panelscan perform better than in practice and the converse can apply
Tests on the dried paint film are usually carried out to the requirements of national or international standards eg ISO 4628or the equivalent BS 3900 (1969) lsquoMethods of test for paintrsquo this means that the tests are reproducible and so it should bepossible for different laboratories to obtain very similar results on the same materials From this viewpoint such tests areuseful as a method of quality control However they are concerned with what might be described as the lsquointrinsic qualitiesrsquo ofthe paint film under the particular test conditions It does not follow that a test eg for adhesion carried out under thestandard conditions would necessarily give the same results if carried out on a different substrate Nevertheless theadvantages to the user of such test methods which will be considered in Section 163 is that they can form a basis for a paintspecification Despite their limitations they do provide a general indication that a particular batch of paint meets therequirements of the specification or standard concerned In some cases the tests may have a practical significance egscratch-resistance but it should be appreciated that most such tests are carried out on simple coats of paint rather than on thepaint systems used in practice
In the hands of specialists almost any test will provide useful information provided the results are correctly interpretedProblems can however arise when tests are standardised and appear in national or international standards While it is clearlyadvantageous to have standard procedures and equipment it cannot be assumed that all tests carried out to the standard willprovide the same results on particular coatings or materials It is not uncommon for results to vary between laboratories Thiswas demonstrated over 40 years ago when a special series of tests was formulated to compare the results of salt spray andsulphur dioxide tests carried out by experienced personnel in a number of different laboratories1 It is important to appreciatethe limitations of tests and not to be tempted into directly applying results of simple tests to more complex situations
Tests on paint films are usually carried out in the laboratory but it is possible to use the test methods on paint films appliedto actual structures Such tests do not always meet the requirements of a standard which is generally related to a specified setof conditions Nevertheless they may provide very useful practical information
Tests on the paint itself again provide evidence of quality and demonstrate whether it meets the requirements set out eitherin standards or in the paint manufacturersrsquo data sheets Although such tests are usually carried out in properly organisedlaboratories some are straightforward requiring simple apparatus and can suitably be carried out on-site eg specific gravitytests
Tests involving the properties of the paint film are those primarily concerned with application and are probably the mostimportant from the usersrsquo standpoint These cover paint film thickness both wet and dry sag tests holiday detection and porosityAll of these have a direct influence on durability in the sense that films containing holidays or applied at thicknesses outsidethe specification requirements are likely to fail more quickly
All the above types of test play an important role in ensuring that the quality of the paint its application properties and itsactual application meet the requirements set either by the manufacturer or users of the paint However they do not providedirect information on the probable durability of the paint system to be used There are two general ways of attempting to makesuch assessments
The best way of determining the performance of a coating or paint system is to actually expose it to the conditions it willhave to withstand in practice This is generally quite impracticable except where long-term procedures for maintenancepainting are involved In such situations it may be possible to apply coating systems to the actual structure and then tomonitor their performance over fairly prolonged periods This is a form of service trial and probably is the best type of
216 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
method for determining paint durability However it has limitations which will be considered later The more usual way oftesting paints in natural environments is by means of what are generally termed lsquofield testsrsquo Paint coatings are applied to steelspecimens and exposed to natural environments such as the atmosphere immersed in seawater or even buried in soilAlthough the environments are obviously only representative they do at least to some extent reproduce many of the factorsmet in practice These will be considered in Section 165 but clearly there are some technical limitations to such tests
There are other disadvantages with lsquonatural testingrsquo not least being the costs involved To carry out a field test correctlyrequires at least one properly organised test site and generally more than one in order to cover a range of conditions The testsites may be some distance from the main workplace which involves travelling at regular intervals and usually the site has tobe monitored for environmental factors such as pollution rainfall etc The biggest disadvantage of field tests is the timerequired to obtain results Although it is not always necessary to expose coatings until they fail a prolonged period of testingis usually required These disadvantages and limitations have led to attempts to develop more rapid ways of assessing theperformance of coatings These have followed three directions
(i) Attempts to simulate the main factors involved in natural exposure by designing either complex testing cabinets or morecommonly by developing fairly simple tests such as the lsquosalt-sprayrsquo
(ii) On the basis of theoretical principles of paint protection the development of tests to determine characteristics related toperformance Such tests have mainly been based on various measurements of the electrical properties of the film egelectrical resistance or permeability and have involved a variety of techniques These have included electrical impedancemeasurements differential scanning calorimetric techniques (DSC) resistance measurements ellipsometry techniques andmany other approaches
(iii) Development of combined laboratory technique and natural exposure tests where the paint coatings are exposed undernatural conditions but the changes in properties are investigated by some of the techniques used in (ii)
Tests to determine the resistance of paint films to a variety of different chemicals and solutions are usually effective ifproperly carried out eg suitable immersion tests
Despite the considerable efforts that have been applied to laboratory tests it must be said that few of them have proved to beparticularly useful in predicting the practical performance of paints This is a sweeping statement but both authors have beeninvolved in the conduct and development of test methods Based on this experience they must conclude that while in thehands of specialists all the test methods provide useful information none of them can be considered to be in the category ofstandard performance tests Many of them are useful control tests for quality and reliability of manufacture and others providea good indication of some general characteristics such as resistance to ultraviolet light The tests in group (i) are often calledaccelerated tests but generally this is a misnomer because it is virtually impossible to determine a factor relating the testresults to the performance under practical conditions Those in group (ii) although considered as test methods in somepublished papers are really investigations into the nature of protection by paints The approach noted in (iii) would probablyprovide the most useful form of testing but as yet no standardised procedures have been developed
Although testing has limitations it is necessary both for the development of new products and for assessing current paintcoatings In the following sections the test methods and equipment used will be considered
163LABORATORY TESTING OF PAINT FILMS
Before discussing the various tests available for testing paint films it is worth considering the preparation of the film to betested In standard test procedures it is necessary to have the paint film itself prepared in some standardised way This leads tocertain problems because when paints are applied to a steel substrate their properties and the structure of the dried film are notthe same throughout the film One surface is in contact with and adhering to the steel with the nature of the adhesive forcesdepending upon the state of the steel substrate The paint surface in contact with the environment air and water has differentproperties depending upon the internal stresses in the film and the film itself is not homogeneous This has been shown byvarious workers eg Mills and Mayne2 have detected what they term lsquoDrsquo areas which have properties different from the restof the film Furthermore even within the films the drying process influences the structure particularly in the periodimmediately after the film has dried These effects may persist for some time as the drying process continues The visco-elastic properties of paint films cause certain problems that do not arise with other materials such as metals Although metalsare not completely homogeneous they can be manufactured into representative test specimens which provide a reasonableassessment and measure of properties such as hardness elasticity etc It is more difficult to achieve the same degree ofobjectivity when preparing paint films for testing
The method of application of the paint has an effect on the properties and structure of the film It is therefore necessary tostandardise the application procedure so far as is practicable Additionally the paint must be prepared and sampled to ensurethat the tests are carried out on representative samples Details are provided in most standards concerned with paint testingThese usually cover application by spray brush and dipping However a method using what is generally termed a lsquodoctor
TESTING OF COATINGS 217
bladersquo is sometimes referred to and it is worth commenting on this In this method a calibrated blade is drawn over paintapplied to the surface of a test panel the excess paint being removed by the blade The advantage of this method is theproduction of an even wet film the thickness of which lies within a comparatively small band of values This ensures thattests can be carried out on films of about the same thickness This may be convenient and suitable for some test procedures butthe method of application bears no relation to those used in practice
If this method is used for comparative testing of different paints the results may be misleading because an advantage ofsome paint films may lie with the thickness of coating produced by methods such as brushing or spraying For examplepaints for brush application require a compromise between good flow characteristics to provide a smooth film without ridgesand furrows and sufficient structure to prevent attenuation of the film on contours and edges Inevitably this will differ withindividual formulation
Many of the paint tests included in standards such as BS 3900 are not of direct interest to most paint users They includetests for properties such as fineness of grind wet-edge time and combustibility and will not be considered here For those whorequire such tests the various standards provide a clear description of the methods to be used Other tests which will be ofmore interest to the general user are considered below but the appropriate standards should be studied to obtain the fullrequirements of the test procedures
1631Determination of Drying Time
The drying time may be defined as the length of time that elapses between the application of the paint and a certain level ofhardness and lsquodrynessrsquo There are gradations in the level of hardness and varying terminology is used hard dry dry enough tobe handled and for further coats of paint to be appliedmdashsometimes described as lsquoovercoating timersquo and lsquothrough-dryrsquo surfacedry indicating that the surface is dry but the rest of the paint film may still be soft sometimes called lsquodust dryrsquo the othercommonly used term touch dry is self explanatory
The tests to determine these various stages are straightforward The two most commonly used tests are for lsquosurfacersquo andlsquohard dryrsquo The former can be determined by distributing sand grains or small glass balls (ballotini) of a specified size onto thesurface to be tested and lightly brushing them off If they do not stick to the surface the paint is surface dry Traditionallypainters have tested for lsquohard dryrsquo by twisting their impressed thumb on the painted surface movement of the underlying paintindicating that the underlying layers are still soft Accordingly this method has been copied as a laboratory test apparatus (BS3900) which faithfully reproduces the action The thumb test however is still a useful guide particularly at the work faceStages between these two may be checked in various ways lsquoTack-freersquo may be considered as the stage where a light weightabout 200 g placed on a filter paper on the paint film causes no damage
The drying time is influenced by temperature which is specified in standard tests and also by the degree of ventilationDrying time does not involve precise measurement but is useful and generally appears on manufacturersrsquo data sheets A testconnected with drying time is sometimes specified This is a pressure test to determine whether two painted surfaces will stickwhen pressed together This can occur if steel sections are stacked before the paint is hard enough to resist such pressure Thepressure test will indicate the delay required before sections can be stacked It is carried out by painting circular discs whichare placed together in a suitable apparatus under specified pressures
Methods are described in BS 3900 Parts C2 and C3
1632Adhesion Tests
Adhesion is a property of paint films that is difficult to assess other than in comparative terms Adhesion has been discussedin Section 441 and its practical significance on performance cannot easily be established Where the adhesion is poor in thesense that the paint can be comparatively readily removed from the substrate this is generally considered to indicate theexistence of a potential problem
Many tests have been devised to test adhesion some 20 methods have been listed in a publication by Gardner and Sward3
and this is not complete Some methods give a numerical measure of adhesion whereas others are qualitative Some test theadhesion by direct pull-off of the paint film whereas others use a shearing mechanism Almost all measure to a degree someother property such as brittleness or cohesive strength There is still a good deal to be learnt about adhesion and its influenceon the durability and performance of paint films Therefore all the available tests are open to some form of criticism but inpractice serve a useful purpose if their limitations are taken into account Some of the more commonly used methods arenoted below
The lsquocross-hatchrsquo or lsquogridrsquo method is comparatively simple and is probably the most widely used practical test A series of11 parallel cuts each eg 1 mm apart are made through the paint film to the steel substrate This is then repeated across the
218 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
first series of cuts at right-angles to them This results in a grid of 100 squares each 1 mm2 in area The cuts can be madeseparately with a sharp knife or razor blade However a specially designed cutter which forms the parallel cuts in one actionis also available The adhesion is generally determined by applying a piece of self-adhesive tape to the grid pressing it ontothe paint film then jerking it away Alternatively light brushing may be specified The number of squares remaining indicatesthe adhesion ie the fewer removed the better the adhesion but both the British and International Standard also categorisethe appearance of the cuts even if no squares are detached The width between the cuts should be increased to 2 mm for filmsbetween 50 and 250 micro m in thickness
Although the lsquocross-hatchrsquo method is straightforward when carried out in the laboratory difficulties can arise when it isused on paint applied to structures so a simpler method may be employed This is discussed in Section 11412 It consistsbasically of using a sharp knife blade to cut a St Andrews Cross through the paint system to the steel substrate then removingthe coating by a suitable method to check the adhesion
Pull-off tests are also widely used partly because they provide a numerical value for adhesion although its relation toactual film performance is vague Various designs of apparatus for carrying out the test are available but the principle ofoperation is similar for all of them (see Fig 161) A small cylindrical piece of steel of known diameter sometimes called alsquodollyrsquo is glued to the paint film at right angles to the film surface It is then connected to a device that exerts a force sufficientto pull off the small steel cylinder The force required to remove the cylinder is a measure of adhesion if the coating is pulledfrom the steel substrate Sometimes the film breaks under the applied force Depending on where the break occurs this maybe a measure of intercoat adhesion or cohesion Although the test is simple to operate it is essential for the force to be appliedat right angles to the film A strong adhesive which does not contain solvents likely to attack the paint film must be used toglue the lsquodollyrsquo to the paint surface In the majority of instances the fast-curing adhesives have insufficient strength and thetwo-pack epoxy type is used but must be left for at least 24 hours before testing
The cross-cut test is described in BS 3900 Part E6 The pull-off test in Part E10A simple method of checking adhesion is to push a knife blade between the paint film and the steel substrate then to prise
off the paint This is probably the oldest method and is clearly subjective Nevertheless in the hands of an experiencedoperator it is a quick and useful test A mechanical form of this method has been used called the adherometer The forcerequired to remove the paint film with a small sharp knife can be measured
1633Abrasion Resistance
Abrasion takes many forms It can be slow attrition by for example sand slurries It can be a continual polishing action egthe rubbing of dirt engrained overalls It can be the abrasive blasting of sand blowing in the wind It can be a heavy weightdragged across the surface and so on It is therefore important to carry out the type of test relevant to the service required
Abrasion resistance tests are probably more commonly carried out on special paints used for shipsrsquo decks and road markingrather than for protective coatings Various test methods are used but they generally rely upon testing the resistance of thecoating to the abrasive action of a material such as sand The abrasive material is either dropped or blown onto the paintedsurface (see Fig 162) The Taber abraser uses wheels with abrasive which rotate with the revolving test panel Wheels ofdifferent roughness with different loading pressures can be used to suit the specifie requirements
Fig 161 Adhesion testing using a Hounsfield Tensometer
TESTING OF COATINGS 219
1634Physical State of the Film
A number of tests are used to determine the physical state of the film in particular the hardness and resistance to deformationSome of the tests probably cover more than a single property so they have been grouped together Many of these tests aremore appropriate to stoving finishes applied to sheet steel used for domestic appliances and some of them cannot be carriedout directly on paints applied to steel plates Nevertheless the properties may have relevance to protective coatingsparticularly where some form of test is included in a paint standard or specification
The scratch test as its name implies is a method of determining the ability of a paint film to withstand the scratchingmotion of a sharp pointed object The ability to withstand scratching is less important for protective coatings than for stoveddecorative coatings However the test itself does also provide an indication of the hardness of the paint film Many deviceshave been developed for this test including the use of pencils of different hardness ie 9H to 6B Such methods are notparticularly useful except as a rough check because all pencils of say 4H are not necessarily of the same hardness The usualinstruments for scratch resistance are based on the use of a hardened steel point attached to an adjustable arm which isweighted in some way The point is then moved down the paint film and the weights are adjusted until the paint film ispenetrated to the substrate Such devices may be manual or automatic The Scratch test is described in BS 3900 Part E2
The hardness of the paint film can also be measured by various pendulum devices These are based on the damping effectof the film on the movement of a pendulum As the pendulum loses kinetic energy the amplitude of the swing decreases Thiscan be used as a measure of hardness because the hardness of the paint film is related to the energy absorbed and the time thependulum continues to swing Many different types of pendulum test have been devised but two types are now in general usethe Persoz pendulum and the KonigAlbert pendulum the latter being considered to be easier and quicker to use The methodsof use are published in various standards which include the temperature and relative humidity requirements There is also alimit to the variation of film thickness allowed for comparing different paint films Pendulum damping tests are described inBS 3900 Part E5
Indentation hardness is commonly used as a measure of the physical or mechanical properties of alloys such as steelHowever because of the visco-elastic nature of paint films the instruments cannot be used in quite the same way on them andoften the time factor must be taken into account when carrying out the test Basically the instruments used for the test are micro-hardness testers employing an indenter which may be a ball or pyramid-shaped pressed into the paint film under a specifiedload The method is not generally used as a routine measure for protective coatings but the determination of the depth ofindentation at various periods does provide information regarding the mechanical properties of the film The Buchholz testhas been standardised in BS 3900 Part E9
There are a number of tests available for determining the flexibility or resistance to deformation of paint films The twomost commonly used are the mandrel test and the Erichsen test The mandrel test is carried out by bending steel sheetspecimens coated with paint around cylinders or mandrels of different diameters The film is placed in tension being onthe outer face of the steel specimen and the size of mandrel required to produce cracks in the film indicates its flexibility Theflexibility is greater for films that resist cracking when bent on smaller mandrels Conical mandrels are also used to allow fora series of tests on one piece of equipment The Bend test is described in BS 3900 Part El
Fig 162 Testing abrasion by falling sand
220 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
The Erichsen test also provides information on film flexibility and resistance to deformation It is a cupping test in whichthe coated specimen is placed horizontally on an apparatus so that the paint film is in contact with a hemispherical steel head(20 mm diameter) The head is pressed into the specimen under load until the paint which is stressed as the steel specimen isitself extended into a hemispherical shape cracks The cracks are usually determined by examination with a magnifyingdevice (ouml50) The criterion is the smallest depth of indentation that results in cracking The depth is usually measured directlyfrom a scale on the apparatus This test is widely used for industrial finishes but is probably of less value in determining theproperties of protective films because such films are rarely deformed in this way during manufacturing processesFurthermore the test is influenced by the degree of adhesion between the paint and the substrate which is standardised in thetest procedures but may not relate to practical conditions for painted structural steel The cupping test is covered by BS 3900Part E4
A final test in this category that is worth noting is the impact or falling-ball test This consists of dropping a steel ball ofstandard size and weight from a predetermined height onto a painted specimen The effect of the impact on the paint film isthen determined This is a useful test for determining the ability of different types of paint to withstand impact whichcommonly occurs during the handling and transport of painted steel sections For use as a rapid indentation test the steel ballcan be dropped onto the reverse side of the specimen ie the non-painted side The test is sometimes carried out with thepanels at low temperature as this is considered to provide additional useful data Impact tests are described in BS 3900 PartsE3 and E7
1635Film Thickness
The thickness of a paint film is an important property and is generally specified for protective coating treatments Unlike mostof the tests considered above it is regularly carried out in fabricators shops or on painted structures The instruments fordetermining film thickness are commonly used by operators and others who are not usually concerned with the laboratorytesting instruments As these tests are a vital part of quality control they are discussed in detail in Chapter 9 dealing with thattopic However for testing purposes particular methods may be used that would not generally be applied to quality controlwork It will therefore be convenient to summarise the various methods of measuring the thickness of paint films
(i) The average thickness of the paint film can be calculated from the amount of paint used to cover a specific area of steelprovided certain properties of the paint are known
This method can be used satisfactorily for brush application It is necessary to know the volume solids or percentage ofsolvent by volume and to make allowance for the roughness of the surface and loss due to application The method has apractical use when it is difficult or impossible to measure wet or dry film thickness by the usual instrumentation methods butit obviously will give no indication of the uniformity of the coating
The formula used is based on Imperial measurements but can be converted to metric units
where t is the film thickness in mils (0001 in) G=gallons of paint used to cover area A A=area covered (ft2) P=weight of agallon of paint (lb) M=volatile content (per cent by weight) and V=weight per gallon of volatile matter (lb)
The values of P and M can be measured by weighing a known volume of paint and by measuring the loss in weight ondrying V can be measured in the laboratory but it is usually possible to obtain the data from the paint manufacturers Manydata sheets contain the nominal solids content by volume (per cent) so a direct conversion from the weight of wet paint to drypaint can be made
(ii) Where a small strip of the paint film can be completely detached from the steel this can be measured by means of amicrometer or after suitable mounting with a graduated microscope
(iii) The most common method of determining the thickness of a paint film on steel is non-destructively by using instrumentsbased on magnetic or electromagnetic principles A range of such instruments is available and their operation is based on themagnetic attraction between the steel base and the steel probe on the instrument The paint film acts as an air gap so affectingthe magnetic force and this can be related to the film thickness The instruments are generally calibrated on shims of suitablethickness These instruments are considered in detail in Section 9536 BS 3900 Part C5 covers the determination of filmthickness
TESTING OF COATINGS 221
164TESTING OF PAINTS
The tests considered in Section 163 have been concerned with paint films but there are also tests on the liquid paint that areof interest to the paint user Of these only one the determination of the density is likely to be carried out in a routine way asa check on the paint itself Other tests such as flow time are really within the province of the paint maker The determinationof flow time is straightforward and is carried out by using a flow cup container with a standard orifice The temperature of thetest is standardised and the cup is filled with paint and the time is measured until the first break occurs in the flow or until astandard volume eg 50 ml has been collected
A sag test is a useful laboratory test to determine the thickness of paint that can be applied on a vertical plane withoutsagging The result must be related to ambient temperature The test is described in BS 3900
The density of the paint is determined using a small cup generally known as a lsquoweight per gallon cuprsquo although nowadaysdensities are expressed in metric terms (kglitre) The cup which holds a standard volume of paint eg 100 ml is filled and acap with a small hole is placed on top Excess paint exudes through the hole and is removed The cup with paint is weighedand this weight after subtracting the weight of the cup and cap provides the necessary data to calculate the density
where V is the volume of the cup in millilitres and w (the weight of the paint) is in gramsThere are occasions where the volatile content of the paint is required Provided a controllable oven is available this can be
simply determined A small amount of paint eg 2ndash3 g is placed in a suitable container and weighed It is then placed in anoven at 105EacuteC for about 3 hours It is then removed and re-weighed The container and paint are returned to the oven for afurther half hour removed and re-weighed If the weight is not the same as that obtained after 3 hours it is returned andreweighed until the weight is constant The difference in the original and final weight provides measurement of the volatilecontent which can be expressed as a percentage of the weight of the original paint sample
where w1 is the original weight of paint and the container w2 is the weight of the container and w3 is the final weight of paintand the container All the weights must be in the same units
165LABORATORY PERFORMANCE TESTS
The tests discussed above do not provide a direct indication of the durability or protective value of the paints exposed underpractical conditions As already discussed in Section 161 attempts have been made to develop laboratory tests that willprovide data on the durability of paint coatings Although there must be doubts regarding many of these test methods they arewidely used so they will be considered briefly with comments on their limitations
Two separate aspects of such tests must be taken into account (i) durability and appearance of the coating itself and (ii) theeffect of any coating breakdown on the corrosion of the steel substrate The two important factors determining (i) areultraviolet radiation and moisture whereas (ii) is mainly influenced by moisture and pollutants and contaminants such assulphur dioxide (SO2) and chlorides There are four types of laboratory test in general use
(i) Weathering resistance(ii) Salt-spray
(iii) Sulphur dioxide(iv) Humidity
1651Artificial Weathering
A number of standards cover the requirements for artificial weathering but the basic operation of the apparatus described inBS 3900 is as follows The specimens to be tested are placed around the perimeter of a steel drum which revolves slowly onits axis They are subjected to atomised sprays of distilled water and high-intensity light from a 1600-W carbon arclamp during each revolution (see Fig 163) The cover of the drum containing the specimens incorporates a ventilation fanand BS 3900 Part F3 lays down a 24-hour testing cycle with various combinations of the atomisers and the fans in and out ofthe operation The test panels are examined every 7 days At the end of the full specified test period part of the paint isremoved to examine the underlying steel for signs of corrosion Other types of apparatus use different types of lamp and
222 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
exposure and cooling cycles However it is generally agreed that this test serves little or no purpose so far as determining theprotective value of paint films because disruptive corrosion rarely occurs during the time scale of the test Even if corrosionoccurs it cannot be considered to be realistic because the only corrosive agent is distilled water The test conditions are morerelevant to the weathering properties of films eg chalking However even this does not necessarily correlate with naturalexposure conditions Nevertheless the test is widely used for paints and probably is most suited to comparisons of coatings ofa similar type particularly for quality control purposes
An interesting test has been developed by Timmins4 which he has termed the lsquoprohesion testrsquo the term prohesionindicating protection and adhesion The film to be tested is subjected to a cycle of quite severe exposures including swellingaction with moisture and pollutants followed by heating and cooling and an adhesion test It is claimed to provide results thatcorrelate well with the practical performance of coatings The paint industry has on the whole been somewhat sceptical of thistype of testing and there are as yet no plans to include it in the appropriate British Standard However it does have meritsalthough like many other test methods of this type it requires an objective assessment of its value by a number oforganisations
1652Salt-Spray Tests
These tests are more widely used than accelerated weathering tests and because the salt is based on sodium chloride (NaCl) itmight appear that such tests would provide a reasonable assessment of the protective properties of paint films Although thereis some correlation with marine conditions at least with some paint coatings on the whole the test does not provide a verygood basis for classifying the resistance of coatings to natural environments This has been demonstrated in a number of testprogrammes particularly those carried out by the former British Iron and Steel Research Association1
There are a number of variations in the standards for salt-spray and salt droplet tests but they all operate on the same broadbasis A salt solution usually containing a specified percentage of NaCl or sometimes more complex mixtures is eithersprayed as a mist or atomised into droplets which reach the painted steel surface The specimens then remain damp by virtueof the high humidity in the test cabinet Various modifications to the salt-spray test eg the addition of acetic acid toaccelerate attack have been used for some purposes Although the test rapidly picks out defects in the film eg holidays itcannot be regarded as providing a true acceleration of what occurs in practice Tests which combine exposure to UV light andto aggressive elements such as salt spray in a cycle of different conditions are generally claimed to give better correlation withnatural results Tooke5 has reported on such an environmental test chamber which compared with long-term tests on-site gavean acceleration of 85 times This however was for a particular sea coast site and other sites and different types of paint couldgive a completely different order of results Some types of paint noticeably zinc-rich primers can give an outstandingly good
Fig 163 Artificial weathering apparatus
TESTING OF COATINGS 223
performance under very severely corrosive test conditions whereas in a natural environment which is less corrosive in bothduration and degree other priming systems may perform equally well or better
1653Sulphur Dioxide Tests
In industrial environments sulphur dioxide is an important factor in determining the rate of corrosion In the comparatively smallconcentrations present in most atmospheres its effect on steel corrosion is greater than the effect on paint coatings Variousdesigns of apparatus have been used (typically that shown in Fig 164) but most of them employ a concentration of sulphurdioxide considerably higher than that found in natural environments A number of test methods have been developedincluding that described in ISO 3231 (BS 3900 Part F8) lsquoDetermination of resistance to humid atmospheres containingsulphur dioxidersquo
1654Humidity and Condensation Tests
Humidity tests rely on condensation of moisture on painted panels to assess the resistance of the paint film to water absorptionand blistering In the apparatus described in BS 3900 Part F9 the relative humidity is maintained near 100 at temperaturesover 40EacuteC but both temperatures and humidity can be controlled on modern cabinets Although humidity testing may beuseful for testing materials to be used in the tropics and for certain problems concerned with packaging it seems less useful asa means of assessing paint films Blistering of paint films is often far more pronounced in humidity cabinets than would beexpected from the performance of the same films under natural exposure conditions The effect of condensation of moistureon paint films is a likely accelerator of breakdown and subsequent corrosion of the steel substrate but the conditions of mosthumidity tests do not appear to reproduce natural condensation conditions particularly well
Other forms of condensation tests have been developed The lsquoClevelandrsquo box consists of an insulated metal tank containingwater which is raised in temperature very slightly by the means of aquarium-type heaters The test panels are supported tomake a continuous roof to the tank with the painted surface facing the water The slight difference in temperature between thetwo surfaces of the metal test panel causes light condensation to form on the paint This test has the advantage thattemperatures are closer to those experienced under normal ambient conditions and the condensation formed is similar toatmospheric dew
1655Other Laboratory Tests
Many special tests have been devised to assess particular properties of coatings Coatings for use under immersed conditionsin seawater have been tested in rotor apparatuses (see Fig 165) In these either the main tank revolves around the specimensor more commonly specimens are rotated in a circular tank containing natural or synthetic seawater Special rigs have beendesigned to investigate coatings used under heat transfer conditions such as occur with risers on offshore platforms Methodshave also been developed to assess heat resistance These special tests have not been standardised and often have been used
Fig 164 Sulphur dioxide exposure test
224 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
by only one testing organisation Many such procedures rely very much on the expertise of those involved in the design andoperation of the test and are not suitable for general use
166INSTRUMENTS FOR SPECIALISED ANALYSIS
A number of instruments and methods are available for tests on coatings and coating materials These are not used routinelybut provide important information about coatings which usually cannot be obtained by other methods They are particularlyuseful for investigating paint failures and for determining the types of coatings present on structures This may be of valueprior to maintenance painting
Arcspark spectrograph This test is used to determine the inorganic elements in a coating It will detect the presence ofmetallic elements such as lead zinc and barium A small sample of the coating is subjected to an electric arc and the light soproduced is transmitted through a prism which divides the light into a spectrum This is compared with standards and as eachelement has a distinctive spectrum the presence of individual elements can be determined On some spectrographs thecomparative analysis is carried out by computer Generally the test is qualitative as this is all that is required but quantitativemeasurements can be made
If coatings contain lead this must be taken into account when planning maintenance this method can be used to determinethe presence of metallic pigments
Atomic absorption This is also a test to determine metallic and other inorganic elements in a coating and is a quantitativetest The coating sample is dissolved in an acid and then sprayed into a flame The light is analysed by means of a computer toprovide the information regarding the type and amount of a particular element
Infrared spectrograph This instrument can be used to analyse the binder or resin used in a coating Infrared radiation ispassed through a sample which absorbs infrared frequencies according to its composition The absorption is then analysed toprovide the required information
Gas-liquid chromatography This method is used for the analysis of organic liquids and so can be used to determine thetypes of solvent used in paints
Differential scanning calorimeter This is a method of measuring the gain or loss of heat in a chemical reaction and can beused to determine the curing characteristics of heat-cured coatings such as fusion-bonded epoxy
Fig 165 Rotor test apparatus used for testing coatings for immersed conditions (BISRA) (Reproduced by courtesy of the Institute of MetalsLondon)
TESTING OF COATINGS 225
167FIELD TESTS
The application of paint to a steel panel followed by exposure outdoors is one of the simplest and oldest methods of assessingthe performance of coatings However its very simplicity as a method can lead to problems Often the problem with fieldtests in common with many other types of test is the lack of a clear aim when formulating the programme
Many paint companies carry out tests for a number of reasons other than the determination of protective properties Theseinclude the development of new coatings tests for colour retention comparative tests on formulations containing different rawmaterials and others of a similar nature All these tests of paint properties are important but the techniques required are oftendifferent from those used for assessing the protective properties of coatings Where the properties of the film eg gloss arebeing assessed the substrates to which the paints are applied may not be particularly important Furthermore if the tests arebasically to determine the decorative effects of the paint film it is sensible to ensure that a maximum of ultraviolet lightreaches the coated specimen It is therefore usual to expose flat specimens at 45Eacute facing south (in the Northern Hemisphere)Generally steel sheet of comparatively thin gauge is used for such tests This makes for easy handling and fairly simplewooden exposure racks are often used
Tests to determine the protective qualities have factors in common with the above procedures but the requirements are notnecessarily the same In temperate climates moisture is often more important than sun although this may not be so in otherplaces eg the Arabian Gulf Consequently the sheltered surfaces may be more important than those exposed to the sunAgain north-facing surfaces remain damp for longer periods than south-facing ones (in the Northern Hemisphere) so theorientation of specimens should be considered in relation to this Rain has a two-fold effect on protective coatings While itprovides moisture essential for corrosion it also washes corrosive deposits from the surface Consequently coated surfacessheltered from the rain may perform less well than those that are freely exposed Furthermore paints applied to panels of thinsheet steel will generally dry out quicker than on heavy steelwork and the degree of exposure to winds will also affect theduration of periods of condensation
Vertical and horizontal exposure may provide more useful results than the more common angled exposure It is easier tocompare the performance of coatings applied to standard flat specimens but examination of paint on a structure will show thatbreakdown often begins at features such as welds joints nuts and bolts and faying surfaces rather than on the main steelworkthat is freely exposed It may therefore be preferable to design specimens that contain some or all of these features Coatingsapplied to such complex specimens are more difficult to assess than those applied to rectangular sheet or plate but theinformation provided may be of more value A compromise is to use small I-beams Tests are carried out for a variety ofreasons and the procedures will to some extent be determined by the purpose of the work Typical reasons for field tests are
(i) Comparison of different paint systems to obtain general information(ii) Comparative tests to determine a suitable coating system for a specific purpose eg a bridge in a given location
(iii) Tests to assess the effectiveness of different primers in a paint system(iv) Assessment of different methods of surface preparation of the steelwork(v) As part of a research investigation to determine the effects of factors such as film thickness
There are of course many other purposes for which field tests would be carried out Once the aim of the tests has been clearlydefined a number of decisions regarding the test procedures must be made Some of these are discussed below
1671Type of Specimen to be Used for the Tests
For tests on coatings for structural steelwork it is preferable to use steel plate rather than sheet for the specimens The enablesthe surface preparation of the test specimens to be similar to that to be used in practice blast-cleaning is more difficult tocarry out satisfactorily on thin gauge material If the tests are for new stuctures preparation of steel from the mill ie carryingmillscale is satisfactory However for tests on coatings for maintenance it may be advantageous to weather the steel beforeblast-cleaning If the coatings are to be applied to rusty steel surfaces it will be virtually impossible to obtain standardsubstrates for the test Some standardisation can be achieved by weathering all the specimens at the same site for the sameperiod before cleaning However rust formed at one period of the year will be different from that formed some months laterso the substrates will not be representative of more than one type of rust
The specimen size is not of itself important but generally larger ones are more representative of practical conditionsFurthermore the application of the coating is likely to approach a practical situation as the size of specimen increases Themethod of application raises a problem Contrary to popular belief there is some evidence that different methods ofapplication produce paint films of different degrees of homogeneity6 Most heavy industrial painting is carried out using an
226 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
airless spray gun but this generally requires too large a sample of paint and has too high an output for practical and economicpreparation of test panels Generally the use of airspray rather than brush for the application and a specimen size of say 25cm2 provide a reasonable compromise between obtaining a representative area and avoiding problems of handling heavy steelplates
As noted earlier inclusion of channels or more complex shapes including welded areas and nuts and bolts may beadvantageous in some situations A typical small-beam test is shown in Fig 166 For special tests a range of differentlyshaped specimens may be used eg pipes tubes and small angles Sometimes very large specimens may be used eg for testson coatings suitable for sheet piles
1672The Coating
The coating to be tested will be determined by the nature and purpose of the test However there are a number of points worthnoting The thickness of each coating in multi-coat system as well as the total thickness should be measured Each coatingshould be applied to the manufacturerrsquos recommended thickness when proprietary paints are being tested Thickness has aninfluence on performance so this must be taken into account when assessing the results It is not uncommon for the results offield tests to be more a reflection of coating thickness than the intrinsic qualities of the paints
It is difficult to achieve what might be termed lsquopractical application conditionsrsquo on test specimens This arises in part fromthe size but also because applicators tend to be particularly careful when painting test panels It is difficult to overcome theseproblems but with spray application it is advisable to place the test specimen on a larger background to ensure more realisticcoverage The use of the same applicator for all the test specimens is also likely to provide a degree of standardisation
It may be considered appropriate to lsquodamagersquo the coating in some way to assess under-rusting at the damaged area Thiscan be achieved by applying a thin strip of self-adhesive tape to the specimen before applying the coating This is removedafter the coating has dried so leaving a bare strip Any residues from the adhesive can be removed by solvent of a type thatdoes not affect the paint This method is more suited to larger areas Scratches made after the paint has dried and carried outso as to expose the substrate are widely used A suitable sharp scribing device is required to ensure that the substrate isexposed but the method is less reliable than the lsquotapersquo method described above because paint films have differing degrees ofelasticity and recovery and therefore the configuration of the scratch mark will vary
It is usual to coat both sides of rectangular test specimens and all surfaces of more complex test pieces Generally theedges do not receive the same thickness of coating as the main areas so it is advisable to apply stripe coatings to a distance of15ndash30 mm from the edge depending on the size of the specimen These areas are not usually included as part of the test areafor assessment purposes
Specimens are usually painted indoors and ideally this should be carried out under controlled conditions of temperature andhumidity in well-ventilated conditions Generally temperatures of 23 egrave 2EacuteC and a relative humidity of 45ndash55 are consideredsuitable Provided all the coatings are applied over a short period slight variations in these conditions will not be criticalHowever wide variations should be avoided Specimens should be painted in a vertical position on proper racks positionedaway from direct sunlight Where coatings are applied outdoors the conditions and time of year should be appropriate to the
Fig 166 Use of small beams for testing
TESTING OF COATINGS 227
practical conditions that will eventually be encountered Suitable covers should be available to avoid rain dropping onto thespecimens before the paint coating has dried
1673Exposure of Specimens
Many field tests are carried out at sites organised for the purpose (Fig 167) The essential requirement is a test rack (or racks)to which the specimens are fixed Depending on the nature scale and duration of the tests these will usually be made of woodor steel For the larger test specimens preferred for tests on protective coatings steel racks will usually be more suitable The racks are designed to provide the desired orientation for the exposure eg facing south at 45Eacute to the horizontal and generallyare straightforward in design and construction The main point is to ensure good drainage and to avoid situations where waterruns from one specimen onto another There are a few other points to be noted
The test specimens must be insulated from each other and the stand Plastic washers are frequently used to achieve thisFigure 168 indicates various methods of fixing specimens to an exposure stand The stands should be placed on firm groundand on reasonably permanent sites it is advantageous to place them on a concrete base Where a series of stands are requiredthey should be placed so that no shadows are cast by one stand on another Similarly they should be placed so that buildingstrees etc do not cast shadows If this is impracticable then the stands should be situated so that they all meet the sameexposure conditions The test racks should be placed well clear of the ground preferably at least 1 m above ground level ifsituated on growing vegetation as this will avoid dampness For tests on protective systems the use of H-girders will usuallybe more suitable Each girder should be well spaced from its neighbour and laid with a slight slope from the horizontal atleast 1 m from the ground This will then provide a variety of exposure conditions on the flanges webs uppermost andunderneath surfaces
1674Test Sites
Often the test site is an area close to the location of the particular organisation responsible for carrying out the tests This maybe satisfactory for a particular series of comparative tests provided the conclusions drawn from the tests are relevant to theconditions Generally though one test site cannot represent all the conditions likely to be encountered in practice Variousclassifications have been adopted to represent practical conditions The two main factors for tests on protective coatings arethe climatic conditions and degree of pollution although additional factors such as the effects of splash zones where steel ispartially immersed in the sea may also have to be taken into account Sometimes the site is chosen to represent a specific set ofconditions as shown by tests at the end of a pier (Fig 169)
16741Climatic Conditions
Where tests are carried out in a specific country where the climatic conditions do not vary to any great extent one test sitemay be sufficient However for test programmes with a wider purpose the effects of climatic variations must be consideredThe scope of such conditions has been considered in BS 3900 and should be consulted The broad categories of climate are asfollows
(i) Humid tropical (a) with and (b) without a dry season(ii) Tropical
(iii) Very dry steppe and desert(iv) Warm temperate subdivided into climates (a) without a dry season (b) with dry summer and (c) with a dry winter
Fig 167 Exposure test site
228 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
(v) Polar(vi) High mountain
The climatic conditions have a considerable effect on the durability of paint films in particular ultraviolet radiation andhumidity This influences their protective properties Pollution also affects the paint film eg the resistance of some bindersto specific chemical attack It also has a significant influence on the corrosion of the steel substrate where coatings have failedto protect whether through damage poor films or local breakdown
Fig 168 Method of attaching specimens to a test rack (a) using plastic washers are also required on the other side of the frame) (b) cornerhole suspension using wire (c) top hole suspension
TESTING OF COATINGS 229
16742Atmospheric lsquoPollutionrsquo
Atmospheric pollution arises in various ways but from the corrosion standpoint sulphur dioxide resulting from the burningof fuels and industrial processes is probably the most important pollutant Locally various corrosive species arise fromindustrial and chemical processes and they can be aggressive to both coatings and steel particularly if they are markedlyacidic or alkaline
Near the coast chloride is the most important contaminant although being a natural part of the environment it cannotstrictly be described as a pollutant The quantity of dirt particles in the air can also influence breakdown of coatings and thecorrosion of steel A dirt-laden atmosphere generally reduces paint degradation by UV but increases corrosion of bare metals
A number of general categories of atmosphere are recognised although there is no completely satisfactory method ofcategorising atmospheric environments often the local variations over a few hundred metres may be considerableFurthermore the construction of a process plant in an area can completely alter its nature Unlike climatic conditions whichdo not vary within the broad classifications atmospheric pollution does not remain the same Test sites must therefore bemonitored to ensure that they continue to provide the conditions required for the particular tests conducted at the sites Thegenerally accepted classification of areas in relation to atmospheric pollution has been considered and the various broadcategories are listed in Table 141
1675Monitoring of Test Sites
All test sites should have an element of monitoring to ensure that the conditions are known and to allow for variations in testresults arising from changes in the environmental conditions The extent of the monitoring will be determined by the nature ofthe test programme and the relevance of certain measurements It is common practice in laboratory tests to include a specimenwith a coating of known performance under the test conditions This can be done on large-scale long-term tests but is notalways satisfactory There is a fairly simple form of monitoring pollution although it does not provide information regardingsunshine ie ultraviolet radiation or temperatures The method consists of exposing small weighed specimens of zinc andorsteel and then after a suitable period removing the specimens and after cleaning off all corrosion products in a suitable chemicalsolution re-weighing them From the initial and final weights the size of specimen and the density of the metal the corrosionrate can be calculated The advantage of the method is simplicity and cheapness Although it is related more to steel corrosionthan to coating performance it will provide data capable of indicating whether serious changes have occurred in theenvironmental conditions ie whether the corrosion rate has changed significantly
There is a range of more complex equipment and apparatus for measuring the environmental variables Much of this isautomatic and so can only be used on sites where a supply of electricity is available Clockwork and battery versions may beavailable for some instruments However these may operate for comparatively short periods without attention so increasingthe number of visits to the site to service them The following can be measured automatically or manually temperaturerelative humidity direction and speed of wind sunshine rainfall and radiation All these measurements will not necessarilybe required for tests on protective coatings
Fig 169 Tests on specimens exposed at the end of a pier
230 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
Measurements can be made to determine sulphur dioxide and chlorides the most important of the pollutants in the atmosphereDeposits of solid matter and acidity can also be measured Some of the methods for measuring these pollutants will bediscussed below However there is no point in collecting an enormous amount of data unless it is to be related to the tests inhand Such data can be processed fairly easily nowadays with the availability of computers and are necessary for certain testprogrammes However some caution should be exercised by those responsible for test programmes because much of theinformation collected at a cost may not be used Furthermore the microclimate ie the climate at the coating surface maybe more important than the general environmental climate particularly on a large test site
1676Methods of Measuring Atmospheric Pollution
16761Sulphur Dioxide
Volumetric methods can be used in which the air is bubbled through a suitable solution of hydrogen peroxide and the acidityis measured The lsquolead dioxidersquo method is not automatic but is simple A lead peroxide paste is applied to a gauze which iswrapped round a porcelain cylinder This is placed in a small louvred box The sulphur dioxide in the air reacts to form leadsulphate which is determined by suitable chemical methods The gauzes are usually changed monthly Other methods canalso be used eg LeClercrsquos method in which a strip of filter paper impregnated with a solution of sodium hydrogen carbonatein glycerol is exposed at the site The amount of sulphate ions can be measured by standard analytical methods Other ionssuch as chloride can also be determined All of these methods give a reasonable estimate of sulphur dioxide but variations canoccur depending on the exact siting of the detection devices When practicable they should be freely exposed well aboveground level
16762Chlorides
Chlorides cannot easily be determined with any accuracy because (unlike sulphur dioxide which is gaseous) they react assolid particles eg sodium chloride (NaCl) and these have to be collected or made to react in some way so that chloride canbe determined for example by the LeClerc method However more commonly a method devised by Ambler which bears hisname is used In the Ambler method absorbent gauze or filter paper is used partially immersed in distilled water containingglycerol The concentration of chlorides in the solution is determined by standard methods The Irsid method named after aFrench research organisation is also used Chlorides and sulphates are collected in a small trough connected to or close to aflask Rain washes the deposits into the flask and the solution is analysed Any particles remaining on the trough are washedinto the flask before it is removed prior to analysis
16763Solid Matter in Smoke
This can be determined by passing air through a filter paper suitably clamped between two devices connected to the tubescarrying the air The device can be fitted to the volumetric apparatus used to measure sulphur dioxide (noted above) Theintensity of the stain on the filter is a measure of the solid particles collected and it can be compared with standards to obtainan estimate of the solid content of the air
1677Conduct of Field Tests
The conduct of field tests is comparatively straightforward Larger-scale tests are carried out by organisations with expertisein this area and they will not be considered here Smaller test programmes may be carried out by those with less experienceand a few points are worth noting
(i) Field tests generally proceed for comparatively long periods so the test site even if it is small should be secure(ii) Identification of the test specimens is essential For site inspections the positions of the specimens on the racks will
suffice but when they are returned to the laboratory for examination permanent identification marks are essential Forreasonably short-term tests identification by painting small numbers on the face of the panel may be suitable For longer-term
TESTING OF COATINGS 231
tests small identification holes should be drilled parallel to the edge The number then relates to the distance from the topedge or side (see Fig 1610)
(iii) Before the tests are started the frequency and type of inspection should be decided It is not possible to offer specificadvice because this will be determined by the purpose of the test However the criterion of performance should be clearlydefined otherwise time will be spent collecting a large amount of data which may prove difficult to process Where thecriterion of failure is protection by the coating until rusting of the underlying steel occurs then this is reasonablystraightforward A degree of rusting eg 01 or 05 of the steel surface is predetermined and the time to reach this ismeasured The comparison between the different systems is then based on the time taken for such breakdown to occur It isworth pointing out that most observers tend to overestimate percentages of rust particularly where it occurs at small discretepoints Some form of assessment chart should be prepared indicating the appearance of particular percentages For exampleon a specimen 25 cm ouml25 cm even 05 will cover 3cm2 which can seem fairly considerable when appearing as rust spots
This straightforward approach will not always be acceptable not least because of the prolonged periods that may berequired before breakdown occurs Other criteria may be adopted eg blistering and flaking However some specialistknowledge may be required to determine the importance of such breakdown in relation to the overall protective performanceFurthermore it must be appreciated that in practice the protective coatings will be re-painted at a suitable point ofbreakdown and this strictly is the criterion of protection
The properties of the film itself may be of interest eg gloss and chalking and there are standard methods for determiningthese properties
(iv) Clearly sound reporting procedures are essential particularly for longer-term tests Standard sheets with clearlydefined requirements are preferable to descriptions which are difficult to interpret Furthermore the various inspections maybe carried out by different observers whose methods of expressing and describing breakdown may vary British Standard3900 provides standard methods of designating quantity and size of common types of paint defects such as blistering rustingand flaking Photographs of the specimens at different stages provide a visual indication of the performance of coatingswhich is useful over the test period However even the best photographs do not always provide a true picture of the situationso some notes should accompany them All photographs should be clearly identified with date and specimen number weatherconditions and the face that has been photographed
168SERVICE TRIALS
Service trials are similar to field tests in that they are carried out in natural environments but instead of exposing specimenson racks actual structures are used Examples of such tests are patch painting trials on bridges or gasholders These may be
Fig 1610 A method of identification of specimens for long-term test programmes (Specimen No 651 ignoring the first auml in from theedges then using scale in=1)
232 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL
carried out with a specific purpose in mind such as the choice of suitable maintenance procedures and coatings Howeverthey may be carried out to obtain general information on coating performance under conditions that are more realistic thanthose for field tests
There are advantages in carrying out tests on structures because the test areas can be quite large and the application of thecoatings is more realistic On the other hand such tests are more difficult to control particularly with regard to thecomparisons of performance of different coating systems The environment may vary markedly on different parts of a largestructure because of prevailing winds and the effects of sheltering by the structure itself for example on large structure in theNorthern hemisphere the north-facing areas and the undersides of beams will tend to remain damp for longer periods thanareas that are south-facing or freely exposed Some points to be taken into account when considering service trials are listedbelow
(i) Test areas should be chosen carefully avoiding unusual features but taking into account representative ones such aswelds and bolts
(ii) Test areas should be grouped so that they are similarly orientated A number of such groups may be used but thecoatings to be tested should so far as is practicable be exposed to similar conditions
(iii) Where tests are carried out on older painted structures the condition of the paint substrate must be taken into accountIt should be photographed before and after the test to check whether breakdown of the test systems is occurring on defects onthe original paint system
(iv) Test areas must be chosen to allow proper access for inspection and must be clearly marked for record purposes(v) The use of as many replicate test areas as can be conveniently accommodated is recommended The position of
replicates should be arranged randomly in relation to the structure(vi) All coating thicknesses must be measured Generally it is preferable to both weigh the paint before application and to
measure the dry film thickness(vii) The trial should be adequately supervised and full information should be given to those involved with the structures
This should prevent accidental repainting of the test areas and unnecessary damage by operators who may be concerned withmatters other than steel protection
(viii) Although paint is usually applied to the structure test panels may be used and fixed to the steelwork This has theadvantage that they can be removed for closer examination and also eliminates problems arising from the presence ofpreviously applied paint films on the structure However they suffer from the disadvantages of field test panels being rathersmall and not taking into account the effects of steel mass Such panels must be properly fixed to the structure not least toavoid serious accidents
169TESTS IN WATER AND SOIL
Tests in which specimens are buried in soils are generally undertaken by specialist organisations and it is recommended thatadvice should be sought before carrying out such work Immersion tests in water follow the general lines of atmospheric testsso far as the preparation of the specimens is concerned However the exposure of such specimens requires more complexequipment such as rafts and is again usually carried out by specialists Owing to the electrolyte present usually seawater it ismore difficult to ensure that specimens are insulated from the test racks and from each other Furthermore fouling may occuron specimens leading to problems with inspection The siting of rafts or test rigs must take into account the tidal flow andlocalised pollution of the sea and it is often difficult to ensure that one set of specimens can be arranged so that they are notsheltered by others
1610FORMULATING THE TEST PROGRAMME
The essential requirement when formulating a test programme is to be clear and precise about its objective If this is not donethen there will be a tendency to collect data hoping that it will somehow be sorted out at the end of the programme This willentail extra cost and time and may result in a mass of data which is of limited value
If for example the decision is made to obtain data on six different primers the objective of the test programme should bedecided in advance The following possibilities may be considered
(i) The effectiveness of the primers to protect steelwork before the final system is applied(ii) The relative durability of the primers when included in a similar type of paint system
(iii) Relative durability under a range of different systems(iv) The relative effectiveness in system(s) in a range of environments
TESTING OF COATINGS 233
(v) Their performance on steel cleaned to different levels andor by different methods (vi) Problems with overcoating after specific time delays
(vii) Effectiveness of different methods of applying the primers
There are clearly other possibilities but after due consideration the objectives of the particular test can be decided and the testprogramme can be formulated to achieve them
Apart from defining the purpose of the programme the programme must provide valid dataThe problem with field tests is the time taken to obtain results To reduce this time it may in some circumstances be
sufficient to apply only one coat of paint to a primer in comparative testsThere is little point in carrying out field tests unless the results are of practical significance If to achieve this the cost and
time are considered to be too great then it may be advisable to abandon this method of testing and to consider alternative waysof obtaining the basic data required
1611REPORTING THE RESULTS OF TESTS
Tests are carried out for a variety of purposes but except where the tests have been conducted to provide copy for advertisinga product the method of reporting should follow certain well-defined lines Whether the results are produced in an internalreport or are published for information to a wider audience sufficient detail must be provided to enable the reader to draw hisown conclusions based on a clear understanding of the purpose of the tests and the method of conducting them
The report should generally contain the following
(i) The purpose and objectives of the test programme(ii) Individuals andor organisations responsible for the programme
(iii) Procedures adopted to achieve the purpose(iv) Test site(s) used an indication of why they were selected and some information about the location climate pollution
etc at the site(v) Method of exposing test panels or selection of areas for service trials
(vi) Size and composition of the test panels or areas for service trials(vii) Surface preparation type equipment used and where carried out Where appropriate size and type of abrasive
(viii) Method of coating application and where carried out(ix) Frequency and type of inspection methods used eg BS 3900(x) Results preferably in tabular form with some indication of order of merit etc Although descriptions of breakdown are
useful it is easier to compare results if they are in some form of table(xi) A discussion of the results so that the reader can appreciate the reasons for the final conclusions that are to be drawn
(xii) Conclusions should be reasonably short and to the point They should be separate from the discussion(xiii) A summary or synopsis of the work should be included at the beginning of the report This enables the reader to
determine the type of work and his interest in it
If information on periodic assessments is to be included then it may be advantageous to include this in an appendix or aseparate part of the report This allows the main points to be highlighted in the body of the report
REFERENCES
1 First Report of the Methods of Testing (Corrosion) Sub-Committee J Iron Steel Inst 158 (1948) 462ndash932 Mills DJ amp Mayne JE O Corrosion Control by Organic Coatings NACE Houston p 123 Gardner HA amp Sward GG Paint Testing Manual 12th edn Gardner Laboratory Maryland 19624 Timmins FD Avoiding paint failures by prohesion J Oil and Colour Chemists Assoc 62 (1979) 131ndash55 Tooke WR Corrosion 80 Conference Paper No 115 NACE Houston 19806 Bayliss DA amp Bray H Materials Performance 20(11) (1981) 29
234 STEELWORK CORROSION CONTROL